RENESAS M16C6N

REJ09B0009-0230
16
M16C/6N Group
R8C/10
(M16C/6N4)
Group
Hardware Manual
RENESAS 16-BIT SINGLE-CHIP MICROCOMPUTER
M16C FAMILY / M16C/60 SERIES
Before using this material, please visit our website to verify that this is the most
updated document available.
Rev. 2.30
Revision date: Oct. 24, 2005
www.renesas.com
Keep safety first in your circuit designs!
•
Renesas Technology Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with
them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or property damage.
Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or mishap.
Notes regarding these materials
• These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the
Renesas Technology Corporation product best suited to the customer's application; they do
not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other rights, belonging
to Renesas Technology Corporation or a third party.
• Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any third-party's rights, originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts,
programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in these materials.
• All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication of these
materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology Corporation without notice
due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor for the latest product information before purchasing a product
listed herein.
The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors.
Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or
other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors.
Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corporation by
various means, including the Renesas Technology Corporation Semiconductor home page
(http://www.renesas.com).
• When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product
data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of the information
and products. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability or other loss resulting from the information contained herein.
• Renesas Technology Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for
use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is potentially at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas
Technology Corporation product distributor when considering the use of a product contained herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation,
vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use.
• The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corporation is necessary to reprint or
reproduce in whole or in part these materials.
• If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions,
they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government and cannot be imported into a country other than the approved destination.
Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/
or the country of destination is prohibited.
• Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation for further details on these materials or
the products contained therein.
How to Use This Manual
1. Introduction
This hardware manual provides detailed information on the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) of microcomputers.
Users are expected to have basic knowledge of electric circuits, logical circuits and microcomputers.
2. Register Diagram
The symbols, and descriptions, used for bit function in each register are shown below.
XXX Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
*1
b0
0 0
Symbol
XXX
Bit
Symbol
Address
XXX
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
*5
RW
b1 b0
XXX0
XXX Bit
XXX1
(b2)
(b4-b3)
0 0: XXX
0 1: XXX
1 0: Do not set a value
1 1: XXX
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
XXX Bit
Function varies depending on
mode of operation
XXX6
*2
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0",
When read, its content is indeterminate.
XXX5
XXX7
RW
*3
WO
*4
RW
RW
XXX Bit
0: XXX
1: XXX
RO
*1
Blank:Set to “0” or “1” according to the application
0:
Set to “0”
1:
Set to “1”
X:
Nothing is assigned
*2
RW :
RO :
WO :
– :
Read and write
Read only
Write only
Nothing is assigned
*3
• Reserved bit
Reserved bit. Set to specified value.
*4
• Nothing is assigned
Nothing is assigned to the bit concerned. As the bit may be use for future functions, set to “0” when
writing to this bit.
• Do not set to this value
The operation is not guaranteed when a value is set.
• Function varies depending on mode of operation
Bit function varies depending on peripheral function mode.
Refer to respective register for each mode.
*5
Follow the text in each manual for binary and hexadecimal notations.
3. M16C Family Documents
The following documents were prepared for the M16C family (1).
Document
Contents
Short Sheet
Data Sheet
Hardware Manual
Hardware overview
Hardware overview and electrical characteristics
Hardware specifications (pin assignments, memory maps, peripheral
specifications, electrical characteristics, timing charts)
Software Manual
Detailed description of assembly instructions and microcomputer
performance of each instruction
Application Note
• Application examples of peripheral functions
• Sample programs
• Introduction to the basic functions in the M16C family
• Programming method with Assembly and C languages
RENESAS TECHNICAL UPDATE Preliminary report about the specification of a product, a document, etc.
NOTE:
1. Before using this material , please visit our website to verify that this is the most updated document
available.
Table of Contents
SFR Page Reference ............................................................................................................ B-1
1. Overview ............................................................................................................................... 1
1.1 Applications .................................................................................................................................................. 1
1.2 Performance Outline .................................................................................................................................... 2
1.3 Block Diagram .............................................................................................................................................. 3
1.4 Product List .................................................................................................................................................. 4
1.5 Pin Configuration ......................................................................................................................................... 5
1.6 Pin Description ............................................................................................................................................. 9
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) ........................................................................................... 12
2.1 Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) ........................................................................................................ 12
2.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1) .................................................................................................................. 12
2.3 Frame Base Register (FB) ......................................................................................................................... 13
2.4 Interrupt Table Register (INTB) .................................................................................................................. 13
2.5 Program Counter (PC) ............................................................................................................................... 13
2.6 User Stack Pointer (USP), Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP) ........................................................................... 13
2.7 Static Base Register (SB) .......................................................................................................................... 13
2.8 Flag Register (FLG) ................................................................................................................................... 13
2.8.1 Carry Flag (C Flag) ............................................................................................................................ 13
2.8.2 Debug Flag (D Flag) .......................................................................................................................... 13
2.8.3 Zero Flag (Z Flag) .............................................................................................................................. 13
2.8.4 Sign Flag (S Flag) .............................................................................................................................. 13
2.8.5 Register Bank Select Flag (B Flag) .................................................................................................... 13
2.8.6 Overflow Flag (O Flag) ....................................................................................................................... 13
2.8.7 Interrupt Enable Flag (I Flag) ............................................................................................................. 13
2.8.8 Stack Pointer Select Flag (U Flag) ..................................................................................................... 13
2.8.9 Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) .............................................................................................. 13
2.8.10 Reserved Area ................................................................................................................................. 13
3. Memory ............................................................................................................................... 14
4. Special Function Register (SFR) ......................................................................................... 15
5. Reset ................................................................................................................................... 31
5.1 Hardware Reset ......................................................................................................................................... 31
5.1.1 Reset on a Stable Supply Voltage ..................................................................................................... 31
5.1.2 Power-on Reset ................................................................................................................................. 31
5.2 Software Reset .......................................................................................................................................... 33
5.3 Watchdog Timer Reset ............................................................................................................................... 33
5.4 Oscillation Stop Detection Reset ............................................................................................................... 33
5.5 Internal Space ............................................................................................................................................ 33
6. Processor Mode .................................................................................................................. 34
6.1 Types of Processor Mode .......................................................................................................................... 34
6.2 Setting Processor Modes ........................................................................................................................... 34
7. Bus ...................................................................................................................................... 40
7.1 Bus Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 40
7.1.1 Separate Bus ..................................................................................................................................... 40
7.1.2 Multiplexed Bus .................................................................................................................................. 40
A-1
7.2 Bus Control ................................................................................................................................................ 41
7.2.1 Address Bus ....................................................................................................................................... 41
7.2.2 Data Bus ............................................................................................................................................ 41
7.2.3 Chip Select Signal .............................................................................................................................. 41
7.2.4 Read and Write Signals ..................................................................................................................... 43
7.2.5 ALE ________
Signal ......................................................................................................................................... 43
7.2.6 The
RDY
Signal ................................................................................................................................. 44
__________
7.2.7 HOLD Signal ...................................................................................................................................... 45
7.2.8 BCLK Output ...................................................................................................................................... 45
7.2.9 External Bus Status When Internal Area Accessed ........................................................................... 47
7.2.10 Software Wait ................................................................................................................................... 47
8. Clock Generating Circuit ..................................................................................................... 51
8.1 Types of Clock Generating Circuit ............................................................................................................. 51
8.1.1 Main Clock ......................................................................................................................................... 58
8.1.2 Sub Clock ........................................................................................................................................... 59
8.1.3 On-chip Oscillator Clock .................................................................................................................... 60
8.1.4 PLL Clock ........................................................................................................................................... 60
8.2 CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock ................................................................................................ 62
8.2.1 CPU Clock and BCLK ........................................................................................................................ 62
8.2.2 Peripheral Function Clock .................................................................................................................. 62
8.3 Clock Output Function ............................................................................................................................... 62
8.4 Power Control ............................................................................................................................................ 63
8.4.1 Normal Operation Mode ..................................................................................................................... 63
8.4.2 Wait Mode .......................................................................................................................................... 65
8.4.3 Stop Mode .......................................................................................................................................... 67
8.5 Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Function ............................................................................. 72
8.5.1 Operation When CM27 Bit = 0 (Oscillation Stop Detection Reset) .................................................... 72
8.5.2 Operation When CM27 Bit = 1 (Oscillation Stop, Re-oscillation Detection Interrupt) ........................ 72
8.5.3 How to Use Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Function .................................................. 73
9. Protection ............................................................................................................................ 74
10. Interrupt ............................................................................................................................. 75
10.1 Type of Interrupts ..................................................................................................................................... 75
10.2 Software Interrupts ................................................................................................................................... 76
10.2.1 Undefined Instruction Interrupt ......................................................................................................... 76
10.2.2 Overflow Interrupt ............................................................................................................................ 76
10.2.3 BRK Interrupt ................................................................................................................................... 76
10.2.4 INT Instruction Interrupt ................................................................................................................... 76
10.3 Hardware Interrupts ................................................................................................................................. 77
10.3.1 Special Interrupts ............................................................................................................................. 77
10.3.2 Peripheral Function Interrupts .......................................................................................................... 77
10.4 Interrupts and Interrupt Vector ................................................................................................................. 78
10.4.1 Fixed Vector Tables .......................................................................................................................... 78
10.4.2 Relocatable Vector Tables ............................................................................................................... 79
10.5 Interrupt Control ....................................................................................................................................... 80
10.5.1 I Flag ................................................................................................................................................ 82
10.5.2 IR Bit ................................................................................................................................................ 82
10.5.3 ILVL2 to ILVL0 Bits and IPL ............................................................................................................. 82
A-2
10.5.4 Interrupt Sequence .......................................................................................................................... 83
10.5.5 Interrupt Response Time .................................................................................................................. 84
10.5.6 Variation of IPL when Interrupt Request is Accepted ....................................................................... 84
10.5.7 Saving Registers .............................................................................................................................. 85
10.5.8 Returning from an Interrupt Routine ................................................................................................ 86
10.5.9 Interrupt Priority ............................................................................................................................... 86
10.5.10
Interrupt Priority Resolution Circuit ................................................................................................ 86
______
10.6 INT
Interrupt ............................................................................................................................................. 88
______
10.7 NMI Interrupt ............................................................................................................................................ 90
10.8 Key Input Interrupt ................................................................................................................................... 90
10.9 CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt ....................................................................................................................... 90
10.10 Address Match Interrupt ......................................................................................................................... 91
11. Watchdog Timer ................................................................................................................ 93
11.1 Count Source Protective Mode ................................................................................................................ 94
12. DMAC ................................................................................................................................ 95
12.1 Transfer Cycle ........................................................................................................................................ 100
12.1.1 Effect of Source and Destination Addresses .................................................................................. 100
12.1.2 Effect of BYTE Pin Level ................................................................................................................ 100
12.1.3 Effect of Software
Wait ................................................................................................................... 100
________
12.1.4 Effect of RDY Signal ...................................................................................................................... 100
12.2 DMA Transfer Cycles ............................................................................................................................. 102
12.3 DMA Enable ........................................................................................................................................... 103
12.4 DMA Request ......................................................................................................................................... 103
12.5 Channel Priority and DMA Transfer Timing ............................................................................................ 104
13. Timers ............................................................................................................................. 105
13.1 Timer A ................................................................................................................................................... 107
13.1.1 Timer Mode .................................................................................................................................... 111
13.1.2 Event Counter Mode ...................................................................................................................... 112
13.1.3 One-shot Timer Mode .................................................................................................................... 117
13.1.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Mode ........................................................................................... 119
13.2 Timer B ................................................................................................................................................... 122
13.2.1 Timer Mode .................................................................................................................................... 125
13.2.2 Event Counter Mode ...................................................................................................................... 126
13.2.3 Pulse Period and Pulse Width Measurement Mode ...................................................................... 127
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function .................................................................... 130
15. Serial Interface ................................................................................................................ 141
15.1 UARTi ..................................................................................................................................................... 141
15.1.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode .............................................................................................. 151
15.1.2 Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode ............................................................................... 159
15.1.3 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) ............................................................................................................ 167
15.1.4 Special Mode 2 .............................................................................................................................. 176
15.1.5 Special Mode 3 (IE Mode) ............................................................................................................. 181
15.1.6 Special Mode 4 (SIM Mode) (UART2) ........................................................................................... 183
15.2 SI/O3 ...................................................................................................................................................... 188
15.2.1 SI/O3 Operation Timing ................................................................................................................. 191
15.2.2 CLK Polarity Selection ................................................................................................................... 191
15.2.3 Functions for Setting an SOUT3 Initial Value ................................................................................. 192
A-3
16. A/D Converter .................................................................................................................. 193
16.1 Mode Description ................................................................................................................................... 197
16.1.1 One-shot Mode .............................................................................................................................. 197
16.1.2 Repeat Mode ................................................................................................................................. 199
16.1.3 Single Sweep Mode ....................................................................................................................... 201
16.1.4 Repeat Sweep Mode 0 .................................................................................................................. 203
16.1.5 Repeat Sweep Mode 1 .................................................................................................................. 205
16.2 Function ................................................................................................................................................. 207
16.2.1 Resolution Select Function ............................................................................................................ 207
16.2.2 Sample and Hold ........................................................................................................................... 207
16.2.3 Extended Analog Input Pins ........................................................................................................... 207
16.2.4 External Operation Amplifier (Op-Amp) Connection Mode ............................................................ 207
16.2.5 Current Consumption Reducing Function ...................................................................................... 208
16.2.6 Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion ..................................................................... 208
17. D/A Converter .................................................................................................................. 210
18. CRC Calculation .............................................................................................................. 212
19. CAN Module .................................................................................................................... 214
19.1 CAN Module-Related Registers ............................................................................................................. 215
19.1.1 CAN Message Box ......................................................................................................................... 215
19.1.2 Acceptance Mask Registers........................................................................................................... 215
19.1.3 CAN SFR Registers ....................................................................................................................... 215
19.2 CANi Message Box ................................................................................................................................ 216
19.3 Acceptance Mask Registers ................................................................................................................... 218
19.4 CAN SFR Registers ............................................................................................................................... 219
19.5 Operational Modes ................................................................................................................................. 225
19.5.1 CAN Reset/Initialization Mode ....................................................................................................... 225
19.5.2 CAN Operation Mode ..................................................................................................................... 226
19.5.3 CAN Sleep Mode ........................................................................................................................... 226
19.5.4 CAN Interface Sleep Mode ............................................................................................................ 226
19.5.5 Bus Off State .................................................................................................................................. 227
19.6 Configuration CAN Module System Clock ............................................................................................. 228
19.7 Bit Timing Configuration ......................................................................................................................... 228
19.8 Bit-rate ................................................................................................................................................... 229
19.8.1 Calculation of Bit-rate ..................................................................................................................... 229
19.9 Acceptance Filtering Function and Masking Function ............................................................................ 230
19.10 Acceptance Filter Support Unit (ASU) .................................................................................................. 231
19.11 Basic CAN Mode .................................................................................................................................. 232
19.12 Return from Bus Off Function .............................................................................................................. 233
19.13 Time Stamp Counter and Time Stamp Function .................................................................................. 233
19.14 Listen-Only Mode ................................................................................................................................. 233
19.15 Reception and Transmission ................................................................................................................ 234
19.15.1 Reception ..................................................................................................................................... 235
19.15.2 Transmission ................................................................................................................................ 236
19.16 CAN Interrupt ....................................................................................................................................... 237
A-4
20. Programmable I/O Ports ................................................................................................. 238
20.1 PDi Register ........................................................................................................................................... 238
20.2 Pi Register ............................................................................................................................................. 238
20.3 PURj Register ........................................................................................................................................ 238
20.4 PCR Register ......................................................................................................................................... 239
21. Flash Memory Version .................................................................................................... 251
21.1 Memory Map .......................................................................................................................................... 252
21.1.1 Boot Mode ...................................................................................................................................... 252
21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting .............................................................................. 253
21.2.1 ROM Code Protect Function .......................................................................................................... 253
21.2.2 ID Code Check Function ................................................................................................................ 253
21.3 CPU Rewrite Mode ................................................................................................................................ 255
21.3.1 EW0 Mode ..................................................................................................................................... 256
21.3.2 EW1 Mode ..................................................................................................................................... 256
21.3.3 FMR0, FMR1 Registers ................................................................................................................. 257
21.3.4 Precautions on CPU Rewrite Mode ............................................................................................... 262
21.3.5 Software Commands ..................................................................................................................... 264
21.3.6 Data Protect Function .................................................................................................................... 269
21.3.7 Status Register (SRD Register) ..................................................................................................... 269
21.3.8 Full Status Check ........................................................................................................................... 271
21.4 Standard Serial I/O Mode ...................................................................................................................... 273
21.4.1 ID Code Check Function ................................................................................................................ 273
21.4.2 Example of Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode .......................................................... 277
21.5 Parallel I/O Mode ................................................................................................................................... 278
21.5.1 User ROM and Boot ROM Areas ................................................................................................... 278
21.5.2 ROM Code Protect Function .......................................................................................................... 278
21.6 CAN I/O Mode ........................................................................................................................................ 279
21.6.1 ID Code Check Function ................................................................................................................ 279
21.6.2 Example of Circuit Application in CAN I/O Mode ........................................................................... 282
21.7 Electrical Characteristics ........................................................................................................................ 283
21.7.1 Electrical Characteristics (T/V-ver.) ................................................................................................ 283
21.7.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.) .......................................................................................... 284
22. Electrical Characteristics ................................................................................................. 285
22.1 Electrical Characteristics (T/V-ver.) ........................................................................................................ 285
22.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.) .................................................................................................. 306
23. Usage Precaution ............................................................................................................ 342
23.1 External Bus ........................................................................................................................................... 342
23.2 PLL Frequency Synthesizer ................................................................................................................... 343
23.3 Power Control ........................................................................................................................................ 344
23.4 Protection ............................................................................................................................................... 346
23.5 Interrupt .................................................................................................................................................. 347
23.5.1 Reading Address 00000h ............................................................................................................... 347
23.5.2 _______
Setting SP ...................................................................................................................................... 347
23.5.3 NMI Interrupt .................................................................................................................................. 347
23.5.4 Changing
Interrupt Generate Factor .............................................................................................. 348
_____
23.5.5 INT Interrupt ................................................................................................................................... 348
23.5.6 Rewrite Interrupt Control Register ................................................................................................. 349
23.5.7 Watchdog Timer Interrupt .............................................................................................................. 349
A-5
23.6 DMAC .................................................................................................................................................... 350
23.6.1 Write to DMAE Bit in DMiCON Register ........................................................................................ 350
23.7 Timers .................................................................................................................................................... 351
23.7.1 Timer A ........................................................................................................................................... 351
23.7.2 Timer B ........................................................................................................................................... 354
23.8 Serial Interface ....................................................................................................................................... 356
23.8.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode .............................................................................................. 356
23.8.2 Special Modes ............................................................................................................................... 357
23.8.3 SI/O3 .............................................................................................................................................. 358
23.9 A/D Converter ........................................................................................................................................ 359
23.10 CAN Module ......................................................................................................................................... 361
23.10.1 Reading CiSTR Register .............................................................................................................. 361
23.10.2 Performing CAN Configuration .................................................................................................... 363
23.10.3 Suggestions to Reduce Power Consumption .............................................................................. 364
23.10.4 CAN Transceiver in Boot Mode.................................................................................................... 365
23.11 Programmable I/O Ports ...................................................................................................................... 366
23.12 Electrical Characteristic Differences Between Mask ROM and Flash Memory Version Microcomputers .... 367
23.13 Mask ROM Version .............................................................................................................................. 368
23.14 Flash Memory Version ......................................................................................................................... 369
23.14.1 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting .................................................................... 369
23.14.2 Stop Mode .................................................................................................................................... 369
23.14.3 Wait Mode .................................................................................................................................... 369
23.14.4 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode ................. 369
23.14.5 Writing Command and Data ......................................................................................................... 369
23.14.6 Program Command ...................................................................................................................... 369
23.14.7 Lock Bit Program Command ........................................................................................................ 369
23.14.8 Operation Speed .......................................................................................................................... 370
23.14.9 Prohibited Instructions ................................................................................................................. 370
23.14.10 Interrupt ...................................................................................................................................... 370
23.14.11 How to Access ............................................................................................................................ 370
23.14.12 Rewriting in User ROM Area ...................................................................................................... 370
23.14.13 DMA Transfer ............................................................................................................................. 370
23.15 Flash Memory Programming Using Boot Program .............................................................................. 371
23.15.1 Programming Using Serial I/O Mode ........................................................................................... 371
23.15.2 Programming Using CAN I/O Mode ............................................................................................. 371
23.16 Noise .................................................................................................................................................... 372
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions ........................................................................................ 373
Register Index ....................................................................................................................... 375
Specifications written in this manual are believed to be accurate, but are not guaranteed to be entirely free
of error. Specifications in this manual may be changed for functional or performance improvements.
Please make sure your manual is the latest edition.
A-6
SFR Page Reference
Address
0000h
0001h
0002h
0003h
0004h
0005h
0006h
0007h
0008h
0009h
000Ah
000Bh
000Ch
000Dh
000Eh
000Fh
0010h
0011h
0012h
0013h
0014h
0015h
0016h
0017h
0018h
0019h
001Ah
001Bh
001Ch
001Dh
001Eh
001Fh
0020h
0021h
0022h
0023h
0024h
0025h
0026h
0027h
0028h
0029h
002Ah
002Bh
002Ch
002Dh
002Eh
002Fh
0030h
0031h
0032h
0033h
0034h
0035h
0036h
0037h
0038h
0039h
003Ah
003Bh
003Ch
003Dh
003Eh
003Fh
Register
Symbol
Page
Processor Mode Register 0
Processor Mode Register 1
System Clock Control Register 0
System Clock Control Register 1
Chip Select Control Register
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
Protect Register
PM0
PM1
CM0
CM1
CSR
AIER
PRCR
35
36
53
54
41
92
74
Oscillation Stop Detection Register
CM2
55
Watchdog Timer Start Register
Watchdog Timer Control Register
WDTS
WDC
94
94
Address Match Interrupt Register 0
RMAD0
92
Address
0040h
0041h
0042h
0043h
0044h
0045h
0046h
0047h
0048h
0049h
004Ah
004Bh
004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
Address Match Interrupt Register 1
RMAD1
Chip Select Expansion Control Register CSE
PLC0
PLL Control Register 0
47
57
Processor Mode Register 2
PM2
57
DMA0 Source Pointer
SAR0
99
DMA0 Destination Pointer
DAR0
99
DMA0 Transfer Counter
TCR0
99
DMA0 Control Register
DM0CON
98
DMA1 Source Pointer
DMA1 Destination Pointer
SAR1
DAR1
004Fh
0050h
0051h
0052h
0053h
0054h
0055h
0056h
0057h
0058h
0059h
005Ah
005Bh
005Ch
005Dh
005Eh
005Fh
0060h
0061h
0062h
0063h
0064h
0065h
0066h
0067h
0068h
0069h
006Ah
006Bh
006Ch
006Dh
006Eh
006Fh
0070h
0071h
0072h
0073h
0074h
0075h
0076h
0077h
0078h
0079h
007Ah
007Bh
007Ch
007Dh
007Eh
007Fh
92
99
99
DMA1 Transfer Counter
TCR1
99
DMA1 Control Register
DM1CON
98
The blank areas are reserved.
B-1
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Control Register
CAN0 Successful Reception Interrupt Control Register
CAN0 Successful Transmission Interrupt Control Register
INT3 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B5 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B4 Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
Timer B3 Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
CAN1 Successful Reception Interrupt Control Register
INT5 Interrupt Control Register
CAN1 Successful Transmission Interrupt Control Register
SI/O3 Interrupt Control Register
INT4 Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
DMA0 Interrupt Control Register
DMA1 Interrupt Control Register
CAN0/1 Error Interrupt Control Register
A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register
Key Input Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Receive Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Receive Interrupt Control Register
Timer A0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A1 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A2 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A3 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A4 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B1 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B2 Interrupt Control Register
INT0 Interrupt Control Register
INT1 Interrupt Control Register
INT2 Interrupt Control Register
C01WKIC
C0RECIC
C0TRMIC
INT3IC
TB5IC
TB4IC
U1BCNIC
TB3IC
U0BCNIC
C1RECIC
INT5IC
C1TRMIC
S3IC
INT4IC
U2BCNIC
DM0IC
DM1IC
C01ERRIC
ADIC
KUPIC
S2TIC
S2RIC
S0TIC
S0RIC
S1TIC
S1RIC
TA0IC
TA1IC
TA2IC
TA3IC
TA4IC
TB0IC
TB1IC
TB2IC
INT0IC
INT1IC
INT2IC
80
80
80
81
80
80
80
80
80
81
81
81
81
81
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
81
81
81
CAN0 Message Box 0: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 0: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 0: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 1: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 1: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 1: Time Stamp
216
217
Address
0080h
0081h
0082h
0083h
0084h
0085h
0086h
0087h
0088h
0089h
008Ah
008Bh
008Ch
008Dh
008Eh
008Fh
0090h
0091h
0092h
0093h
0094h
0095h
0096h
0097h
0098h
0099h
009Ah
009Bh
009Ch
009Dh
009Eh
009Fh
00A0h
00A1h
00A2h
00A3h
00A4h
00A5h
00A6h
00A7h
00A8h
00A9h
00AAh
00ABh
00ACh
00ADh
00AEh
00AFh
00B0h
00B1h
00B2h
00B3h
00B4h
00B5h
00B6h
00B7h
00B8h
00B9h
00BAh
00BBh
00BCh
00BDh
00BEh
00BFh
Register
Symbol
Page
Address
00C0h
00C1h
00C2h
00C3h
00C4h
00C5h
00C6h
00C7h
00C8h
00C9h
00CAh
00CBh
00CCh
00CDh
00CEh
00CFh
00D0h
00D1h
00D2h
00D3h
00D4h
00D5h
00D6h
00D7h
00D8h
00D9h
00DAh
00DBh
00DCh
00DDh
00DEh
00DFh
00E0h
00E1h
00E2h
00E3h
00E4h
00E5h
00E6h
00E7h
00E8h
00E9h
00EAh
00EBh
00ECh
00EDh
00EEh
00EFh
00F0h
00F1h
00F2h
00F3h
00F4h
00F5h
00F6h
00F7h
00F8h
00F9h
00FAh
00FBh
00FCh
00FDh
00FEh
00FFh
CAN0 Message Box 2: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 2: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 2: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 3: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 3: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 3: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN0 Message Box 4: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 4: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 4: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 5: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 5: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 5: Time Stamp
B-2
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN0 Message Box 6: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 6: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 6: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 7: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 7: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 7: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 8: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 8: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 8: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 9: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 9: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 9: Time Stamp
216
217
Address
0100h
0101h
0102h
0103h
0104h
0105h
0106h
0107h
0108h
0109h
010Ah
010Bh
010Ch
010Dh
010Eh
010Fh
0110h
0111h
0112h
0113h
0114h
0115h
0116h
0117h
0118h
0119h
011Ah
011Bh
011Ch
011Dh
011Eh
011Fh
0120h
0121h
0122h
0123h
0124h
0125h
0126h
0127h
0128h
0129h
012Ah
012Bh
012Ch
012Dh
012Eh
012Fh
0130h
0131h
0132h
0133h
0134h
0135h
0136h
0137h
0138h
0139h
013Ah
013Bh
013Ch
013Dh
013Eh
013Fh
Register
Symbol
Address
0140h
0141h
0142h
0143h
0144h
0145h
0146h
0147h
0148h
0149h
014Ah
014Bh
014Ch
014Dh
014Eh
014Fh
0150h
0151h
0152h
0153h
0154h
0155h
0156h
0157h
0158h
0159h
015Ah
015Bh
015Ch
015Dh
015Eh
015Fh
0160h
0161h
0162h
0163h
0164h
0165h
0166h
0167h
0168h
0169h
016Ah
016Bh
016Ch
016Dh
016Eh
016Fh
0170h
0171h
0172h
0173h
0174h
0175h
0176h
0177h
0178h
0179h
017Ah
017Bh
017Ch
017Dh
017Eh
017Fh
Page
CAN0 Message Box 10: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 10: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 10: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 11: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 11: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 11: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN0 Message Box 12: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 12: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 12: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 13: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 13: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 13: Time Stamp
The blank areas are reserved.
B-3
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN0 Message Box 14: Identifier /DLC
CAN0 Message Box 14: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 14: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN0 Message Box 15: Identifier /DLC
CAN0 Message Box 15: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 15: Time Stamp
CAN0 Global Mask Register
C0GMR
218
CAN0 Local Mask A Register
C0LMAR
218
CAN0 Local Mask B Register
C0LMBR
218
Address
0180h
0181h
0182h
0183h
0184h
0185h
0186h
0187h
0188h
0189h
018Ah
018Bh
018Ch
018Dh
018Eh
018Fh
0190h
0191h
0192h
0193h
0194h
0195h
0196h
0197h
0198h
0199h
019Ah
019Bh
019Ch
019Dh
019Eh
019Fh
01A0h
01A1h
01A2h
01A3h
01A4h
01A5h
01A6h
01A7h
01A8h
01A9h
01AAh
01ABh
01ACh
01ADh
01AEh
01AFh
01B0h
01B1h
01B2h
01B3h
01B4h
01B5h
01B6h
01B7h
01B8h
01B9h
01BAh
01BBh
01BCh
01BDh
01BEh
01BFh
Register
Symbol
Page
Flash Memory Control Register 1
FMR1
257
Flash Memory Control Register 0
FMR0
257
Address Match Interrupt Register 2
RMAD2
92
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register 2 AIER2
Address Match Interrupt Register 3
RMAD3
Address
01C0h
01C1h
01C2h
01C3h
01C4h
01C5h
01C6h
01C7h
01C8h
01C9h
01CAh
01CBh
01CCh
01CDh
01CEh
01CFh
01D0h
01D1h
01D2h
01D3h
01D4h
01D5h
01D6h
01D7h
01D8h
01D9h
01DAh
01DBh
01DCh
01DDh
01DEh
01DFh
01E0h
01E1h
01E2h
01E3h
01E4h
01E5h
01E6h
01E7h
01E8h
01E9h
01EAh
01EBh
01ECh
01EDh
01EEh
01EFh
01F0h
01F1h
01F2h
01F3h
01F4h
01F5h
01F6h
01F7h
01F8h
01F9h
01FAh
01FBh
01FCh
01FDh
01FEh
01FFh
92
92
The blank areas are reserved.
B-4
Register
Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Flag
Symbol
TBSR
Timer A1-1 Register
TA11
135
Timer A2-1 Register
TA21
135
Timer A4-1 Register
TA41
135
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1
Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 0
Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 1
Dead Time Timer
Timer B2 Interrupt Occurrence Frequency Set Counter
INVC0
INVC1
IDB0
IDB1
DTT
ICTB2
132
133
134
134
134
136
Timer B3 Register
TB3
123
Timer B4 Register
TB4
123
Timer B5 Register
TB5
123
Timer B3 Mode Register
Timer B4 Mode Register
Timer B5 Mode Register
Interrupt Cause Select Register 0
Interrupt Cause Select Register 1
SI/O3 Transmit/Receive Register
TB3MR
TB4MR
TB5MR
IFSR0
IFSR1
S3TRR
123
125
126
128
89
89
189
SI/O3 Control Register
SI/O3 Bit Rate Generator
S3C
S3BRG
189
189
UART0 Special Mode Register 4
UART0 Special Mode Register 3
UART0 Special Mode Register 2
UART0 Special Mode Register
UART1 Special Mode Register 4
UART1 Special Mode Register 3
UART1 Special Mode Register 2
UART1 Special Mode Register
UART2 Special Mode Register 4
UART2 Special Mode Register 3
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
UART2 Special Mode Register
UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART2 Bit Rate Generator
U0SMR4
U0SMR3
U0SMR2
U0SMR
U1SMR4
U1SMR3
U1SMR2
U1SMR
U2SMR4
U2SMR3
U2SMR2
U2SMR
U2MR
U2BRG
150
149
149
148
150
149
149
148
150
149
149
148
146
145
UART2 Transmit Buffer Register
U2TB
145
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U2C0
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U2C1
146
147
UART2 Receive Buffer Register
145
U2RB
Page
124
Address
0200h
0201h
0202h
0203h
0204h
0205h
0206h
0207h
0208h
0209h
020Ah
020Bh
020Ch
020Dh
020Eh
020Fh
0210h
0211h
0212h
0213h
0214h
0215h
0216h
0217h
0218h
0219h
021Ah
021Bh
021Ch
021Dh
021Eh
021Fh
0220h
0221h
0222h
0223h
0224h
0225h
0226h
0227h
0228h
0229h
022Ah
022Bh
022Ch
022Dh
022Eh
022Fh
0230h
0231h
0232h
0233h
0234h
0235h
0236h
0237h
0238h
0239h
023Ah
023Bh
023Ch
023Dh
023Eh
023Fh
Register
CAN0 Message Control Register 0
CAN0 Message Control Register 1
CAN0 Message Control Register 2
CAN0 Message Control Register 3
CAN0 Message Control Register 4
CAN0 Message Control Register 5
CAN0 Message Control Register 6
CAN0 Message Control Register 7
CAN0 Message Control Register 8
CAN0 Message Control Register 9
CAN0 Message Control Register 10
CAN0 Message Control Register 11
CAN0 Message Control Register 12
CAN0 Message Control Register 13
CAN0 Message Control Register 14
CAN0 Message Control Register 15
Symbol
Page
C0MCTL0
C0MCTL1
C0MCTL2
C0MCTL3
C0MCTL4
C0MCTL5
C0MCTL6
C0MCTL7
219
C0MCTL8
C0MCTL9
C0MCTL10
C0MCTL11
C0MCTL12
C0MCTL13
C0MCTL14
C0MCTL15
CAN0 Control Register
C0CTLR
220
CAN0 Status Register
C0STR
221
CAN0 Slot Status Register
C0SSTR
222
CAN0 Interrupt Control Register
C0ICR
222
CAN0 Extended ID Register
C0IDR
222
CAN0 Configuration Register
C0CONR
223
CAN0 Receive Error Count Register
CAN0 Transmit Error Count Register
C0RECR
C0TECR
224
224
CAN0 Time Stamp Register
C0TSR
224
CAN1 Message Control Register 0
CAN1 Message Control Register 1
CAN1 Message Control Register 2
CAN1 Message Control Register 3
CAN1 Message Control Register 4
CAN1 Message Control Register 5
CAN1 Message Control Register 6
CAN1 Message Control Register 7
CAN1 Message Control Register 8
CAN1 Message Control Register 9
CAN1 Message Control Register 10
CAN1 Message Control Register 11
CAN1 Message Control Register 12
CAN1 Message Control Register 13
CAN1 Message Control Register 14
CAN1 Message Control Register 15
C1MCTL0
C1MCTL1
C1MCTL2
C1MCTL3
C1MCTL4
C1MCTL5
C1MCTL6
C1MCTL7
219
C1MCTL8
C1MCTL9
C1MCTL10
C1MCTL11
C1MCTL12
C1MCTL13
C1MCTL14
C1MCTL15
CAN1 Control Register
C1CTLR
220
CAN1 Status Register
C1STR
221
CAN1 Slot Status Register
C1SSTR
222
CAN1 Interrupt Control Register
C1ICR
222
CAN1 Extended ID Register
C1IDR
222
CAN1 Configuration Register
C1CONR
223
CAN1 Receive Error Count Register
CAN1 Transmit Error Count Register
C1RECR
C1TECR
224
224
CAN1 Time Stamp Register
C1TSR
224
Address
0240h
0241h
0242h
0243h
0244h
0245h
0246h
0247h
0248h
0249h
024Ah
024Bh
024Ch
024Dh
024Eh
024Fh
0250h
0251h
0252h
0253h
0254h
0255h
0256h
0257h
0258h
0259h
025Ah
025Bh
025Ch
025Dh
025Eh
025Fh
0260h
0261h
0262h
0263h
0264h
0265h
0266h
0267h
0268h
0269h
026Ah
026Bh
026Ch
026Dh
026Eh
026Fh
0270h
0271h
0272h
0273h
0274h
0275h
0276h
0277h
0278h
0279h
027Ah
027Bh
027Ch
027Dh
027Eh
027Fh
The blank areas are reserved.
B-5
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN0 Acceptance Filter Support Register C0AFS
224
CAN1 Acceptance Filter Support Register C1AFS
224
Peripheral Clock Select Register
CAN0/1 Clock Select Register
56
56
PCLKR
CCLKR
CAN1 Message Box 0: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 0: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 0:Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 1: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 1: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 1:Time Stamp
216
217
Address
0280h
0281h
0282h
0283h
0284h
0285h
0286h
0287h
0288h
0289h
028Ah
028Bh
028Ch
028Dh
028Eh
028Fh
0290h
0291h
0292h
0293h
0294h
0295h
0296h
0297h
0298h
0299h
029Ah
029Bh
029Ch
029Dh
029Eh
029Fh
02A0h
02A1h
02A2h
02A3h
02A4h
02A5h
02A6h
02A7h
02A8h
02A9h
02AAh
02ABh
02ACh
02ADh
02AEh
02AFh
02B0h
02B1h
02B2h
02B3h
02B4h
02B5h
02B6h
02B7h
02B8h
02B9h
02BAh
02BBh
02BCh
02BDh
02BEh
02BFh
Register
Symbol
Page
Address
02C0h
02C1h
02C2h
02C3h
02C4h
02C5h
02C6h
02C7h
02C8h
02C9h
02CAh
02CBh
02CCh
02CDh
02CEh
02CFh
02D0h
02D1h
02D2h
02D3h
02D4h
02D5h
02D6h
02D7h
02D8h
02D9h
02DAh
02DBh
02DCh
02DDh
02DEh
02DFh
02E0h
02E1h
02E2h
02E3h
02E4h
02E5h
02E6h
02E7h
02E8h
02E9h
02EAh
02EBh
02ECh
02EDh
02EEh
02EFh
02F0h
02F1h
02F2h
02F3h
02F4h
02F5h
02F6h
02F7h
02F8h
02F9h
02FAh
02FBh
02FCh
02FDh
02FEh
02FFh
CAN1 Message Box 2: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 2: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 2: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 3: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 3: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 3: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN1 Message Box 4: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 4: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 4: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 5: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 5: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 5: Time Stamp
B-6
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN1 Message Box 6: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 6: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 6: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 7: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 7: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 7: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 8: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 8: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 8: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 9: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 9: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 9: Time Stamp
216
217
Address
0300h
0301h
0302h
0303h
0304h
0305h
0306h
0307h
0308h
0309h
030Ah
030Bh
030Ch
030Dh
030Eh
030Fh
0310h
0311h
0312h
0313h
0314h
0315h
0316h
0317h
0318h
0319h
031Ah
031Bh
031Ch
031Dh
031Eh
031Fh
0320h
0321h
0322h
0323h
0324h
0325h
0326h
0327h
0328h
0329h
032Ah
032Bh
032Ch
032Dh
032Eh
032Fh
0330h
0331h
0332h
0333h
0334h
0335h
0336h
0337h
0338h
0339h
033Ah
033Bh
033Ch
033Dh
033Eh
033Fh
Register
Symbol
Address
0340h
0341h
0342h
0343h
0344h
0345h
0346h
0347h
0348h
0349h
034Ah
034Bh
034Ch
034Dh
034Eh
034Fh
0350h
0351h
0352h
0353h
0354h
0355h
0356h
0357h
0358h
0359h
035Ah
035Bh
035Ch
035Dh
035Eh
035Fh
0360h
0361h
0362h
0363h
0364h
0365h
0366h
0367h
0368h
0369h
036Ah
036Bh
036Ch
036Dh
036Eh
036Fh
0370h
0371h
0372h
0373h
0374h
0375h
0376h
0377h
0378h
0379h
037Ah
037Bh
037Ch
037Dh
037Eh
037Fh
Page
CAN1 Message Box 10: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 10: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 10: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 11: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 11: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 11: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN1 Message Box 12: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 12: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 12: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 13: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 13: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 13: Time Stamp
The blank areas are reserved.
B-7
Register
Symbol
Page
CAN1 Message Box 14: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 14: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 14: Time Stamp
216
217
CAN1 Message Box 15: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 15: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 15: Time Stamp
CAN1 Global Mask Register
C1GMR
218
CAN1 Local Mask A Register
C1LMAR
218
CAN1 Local Mask B Register
C1LMBR
218
Address
0380h
0381h
0382h
0383h
0384h
0385h
0386h
0387h
0388h
0389h
038Ah
038Bh
038Ch
038Dh
038Eh
038Fh
0390h
0391h
0392h
0393h
0394h
0395h
0396h
0397h
0398h
0399h
039Ah
039Bh
039Ch
039Dh
039Eh
039Fh
03A0h
03A1h
03A2h
03A3h
03A4h
03A5h
03A6h
03A7h
03A8h
03A9h
03AAh
03ABh
03ACh
03ADh
03AEh
03AFh
03B0h
03B1h
03B2h
03B3h
03B4h
03B5h
03B6h
03B7h
03B8h
03B9h
03BAh
03BBh
03BCh
03BDh
03BEh
03BFh
Register
Count Start Flag
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag
One-Shot Start Flag
Trigger Select Register
Up/Down Flag
Symbol
TABSR
CPSRF
ONSF
TRGSR
UDF
Page
109,124,137
110,124
110
110,137
109
Timer A0 Register
TA0
Timer A1 Register
TA1
Timer A2 Register
TA2
108
135
108
135
Timer A3 Register
TA3
108
Timer A4 Register
TA4
108
135
Timer B0 Register
TB0
123
Timer B1 Register
TB1
123
Timer B2 Register
TB2
123
135
Timer A0 Mode Register
Timer A1 Mode Register
Timer A2 Mode Register
Timer A3 Mode Register
Timer A4 Mode Register
Timer B0 Mode Register
Timer B1 Mode Register
Timer B2 Mode Register
Timer B2 Special Mode Register
TA0MR
TA1MR
TA2MR
TA3MR
TA4MR
TB0MR
TB1MR
TB2MR
TB2SC
Address
03C0h
03C1h
03C2h
03C3h
03C4h
03C5h
03C6h
03C7h
03C8h
03C9h
03CAh
03CBh
03CCh
03CDh
03CEh
03CFh
03D0h
03D1h
03D2h
03D3h
03D4h
03D5h
03D6h
03D7h
03D8h
03D9h
03DAh
03DBh
03DCh
03DDh
03DEh
03DFh
03E0h
03E1h
03E2h
03E3h
03E4h
03E5h
03E6h
03E7h
03E8h
03E9h
03EAh
03EBh
03ECh
03EDh
03EEh
03EFh
03F0h
03F1h
03F2h
03F3h
03F4h
03F5h
03F6h
03F7h
03F8h
03F9h
03FAh
03FBh
03FCh
03FDh
03FEh
03FFh
108
108
111 138
113 115,138
118 115
120 115,138
123,125
126,128
138
136
UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U0MR
UART0 Bit Rate Generator
U0BRG
146
145
UART0 Transmit Buffer Register U0TB
145
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U0C0
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U0C1
146
147
UART0 Receive Buffer Register U0RB
145
UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U1MR
UART1 Bit Rate Generator
U1BRG
146
145
UART1 Transmit Buffer Register U1TB
145
UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U1C0
UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U1C1
146
147
UART1 Receive Buffer Register U1RB
145
UART Transmit/Receive Control Register 2 UCON
148
DMA0 Request Cause Select Register DM0SL
97
DMA1 Request Cause Select Register DM1SL
98
CRC Data Register
CRCD
212
CRC Input Register
CRCIN
212
The blank areas are reserved.
B-8
Register
Symbol
Page
A/D Register 0
AD0
A/D Register 1
AD1
A/D Register 2
AD2
A/D Register 3
AD3
A/D Register 4
AD4
A/D Register 5
AD5
A/D Register 6
AD6
A/D Register 7
AD7
A/D Control Register 2
ADCON2
196
A/D Control Register 0
A/D Control Register 1
D/A Register 0
ADCON0
ADCON1
DA0
195,198,200
202,204,206
211
D/A Register 1
DA1
211
D/A Control Register
DACON
211
Port P0 Register
Port P1 Register
Port P0 Direction Register
Port P1 Direction Register
Port P2 Register
Port P3 Register
Port P2 Direction Register
Port P3 Direction Register
Port P4 Register
Port P5 Register
Port P4 Direction Register
Port P5 Direction Register
Port P6 Register
Port P7 Register
Port P6 Direction Register
Port P7 Direction Register
Port P8 Register
Port P9 Register
Port P8 Direction Register
Port P9 Direction Register
Port P10 Register
P0
P1
PD0
PD1
P2
P3
PD2
PD3
P4
P5
PD4
PD5
P6
P7
PD6
PD7
P8
P9
PD8
PD9
P10
246
246
245
245
246
246
245
245
246
246
245
245
246
246
245
245
246
246
245
245
246
Port P10 Direction Register
PD10
245
Pull-up Control Register 0
Pull-up Control Register 1
Pull-up Control Register 2
Port Control Register
PUR0
PUR1
PUR2
PCR
247
247
247
248
196
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
Rev.2.30
Oct 24, 2005
1. Overview
The M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) of single-chip microcomputers are built using the high-performance silicon
gate CMOS process using an M16C/60 Series CPU core and are packaged in 100-pin plastic molded QFP
and LQFP. These single-chip microcomputers operate using sophisticated instructions featuring a high level
of instruction efficiency. With 1 Mbyte of address space, they are capable of executing instructions at high
speed. Being equipped with two CAN (Controller Area Network) modules in M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4),
the microcomputer is suited to drive automotive and industrial control systems. The CAN modules comply
with the 2.0B specification. In addition, this microcomputer contains a multiplier and DMAC which combined
with fast instruction processing capability, makes it suitable for control of various OA, communication, and
industrial equipment which requires high-speed arithmetic/logic operations.
1.1 Applications
• Automotive, industrial control systems and other automobile, other (T/V-ver. product)
• Car audio and industrial control systems, other (Normal-ver. product)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 1 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
1.2 Performance Outline
Table 1.1 lists a performance outline of M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4).
Table 1.1 Performance Outline of M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Performance
Normal-ver.
T/V-ver.
CPU
Number of Basic Instructions 91 instructions
Minimum Instruction
41.7ns (f(BCLK) = 24MHz,
50.0ns (f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
Execution Time
1/1 prescaler, without software wait) 1/1 prescaler, without software wait)
Operation Mode
Single-chip, memory expansion and microprocessor modes
Address Space
1 Mbyte
Memory Capacity
See Table 1.2 Product List
Peripheral Port
Input/Output: 87 pins, Input: 1 pin
Function
Multifunction Timer
Timer A: 16 bits ✕ 5 channels
Timer B: 16 bits ✕ 6 channels
Three-phase motor control circuit
Serial Interface
3 channels
Clock synchronous, UART, I2C-bus (1), IEBus (2)
1 channel
Clock synchronous
A/D Converter
10-bit A/D converter: 1 circuit, 26 channels
D/A Converter
8 bits ✕ 2 channels
DMAC
2 channels
CRC Calculation Circuit
CRC-CCITT
CAN Module
2 channels with 2.0B specification
Watchdog Timer
15 bits ✕ 1 channel (with prescaler)
Interrupt
Internal: 31 sources, External: 9 sources
Software: 4 sources, Priority level: 7 levels
Clock Generating Circuit 4 circuits
• Main clock oscillation circuit (*)
• Sub clock oscillation circuit (*)
• On-chip oscillator
• PLL frequency synthesizer
(*) Equipped with a built-in feedback resistor
Oscillation Stop Detection Main clock oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function
Function
Electrical
Supply Voltage
VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V (f(BCLK) = 24MHz, VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V (f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
Characteristics
1/1 prescaler, without software wait) 1/1 prescaler, without software wait)
Power
Mask ROM 20mA (f(BCLK) = 24MHz,
18mA (f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
Consumption
PLL operation, no division)
PLL operation, no division)
Flash Memory 22mA (f(BCLK) = 24MHz,
20mA (f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
PLL operation, no division)
PLL operation, no division)
Mask ROM 3µA (f(BCLK) = 32kHz, Wait mode, Oscillation capacity Low)
Flash Memory 0.8µA (Stop mode, Topr = 25°C)
Flash Memory Program/Erase Supply Voltage 3.0 ± 0.3V or 5.0 ± 0.5V
5.0 ± 0.5V
Version
Program and Erase Endurance 100 times
I/O
I/O Withstand Voltage
5.0V
Characteristics Output Current
5mA
Operating Ambient Temperature
-40 to 85°C
T version: -40 to 85°C
V version: -40 to 125°C (option)
Device Configuration
CMOS high performance silicon gate
Package
100-pin plastic mold QFP, LQFP
NOTES:
1. I2C-bus is a registered trademark of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V.
2. IEBus is a registered trademark of NEC Electronics Corporation.
option: All options are on request basis.
Item
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 2 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
1.3 Block Diagram
Figure 1.1 shows a block diagram of M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4).
8
Port P0
8
8
Port P1
Port P3
Three-phase motor
control circuit
CRC arithmetic circuit (CCITT)
(Polynomial: X16+X12+X5+1)
Watchdog timer
(15 bits)
Memory
SB
ROM (1)
R0L
R1L
page 3 of 376
RAM (2)
INTB
PC
FLG
Multiplier
8
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
ISP
Port P10
A0
A1
FB
USP
8
R2
R3
NOTES:
1: ROM size depends on microcomputer type.
2: RAM size depends on microcomputer type.
Figure 1.1 Block Diagram
CAN module
(2 channels)
Port P9
D/A converter
(8 bits ✕ 2 channels)
Clock synchronous serial I/O
(8 bits ✕ 1 channel)
M16C/60 series CPU core
R0H
R1H
DMAC
(2 channels)
XIN-XOUT
XCIN-XCOUT
PLL frequency synthesizer
On-chip oscillator
7
UART or
Clock synchronous serial I/O
(3 channels)
System clock generating circuit
Port P6
Port P8_5
Output (timer A): 5
Input (timer B): 6
Port P5
8
8
Timer (16 bits)
Port P4
8
Port P8
A/D converter
(10 bits ✕ 8 channels
Expandable up to 26 channels)
8
Port P7
Internal peripheral functions
Port P2
8
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
1.4 Product List
Table 1.2 lists the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) products and Figure 1.2 shows the type numbers, memory
sizes and packages.
Table 1.2 Product List
Type No.
ROM Capacity RAM Capacity Package Type
M306N4FCFP
(D) 128 K + 4 Kbytes 5 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FCGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4FGFP
(D) 256 K + 4 Kbytes 10 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FGGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4FCTFP
128 K + 4 Kbytes 5 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FCTGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4FGTFP
256 K + 4 Kbytes 10 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FGTGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4FCVFP
128 K + 4 Kbytes 5 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FCVGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4FGVFP
256 K + 4 Kbytes 10 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4FGVGP
(D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MC-XXXGP (D) 128 Kbytes
5 Kbytes
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MG-XXXGP (D) 256 Kbytes
10 Kbytes
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MCT-XXXFP
128 Kbytes
5 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4MCT-XXXGP (D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MGT-XXXFP
256 Kbytes
10 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4MGT-XXXGP (D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MCV-XXXFP
128 Kbytes
5 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4MCV-XXXGP (D)
PLQP0100KB-A
M306N4MGV-XXXFP (D) 256 Kbytes
10 Kbytes
PRQP0100JB-A
M306N4MGV-XXXGP (D)
PLQP0100KB-A
(D): Under development
NOTE:
1. In the flash memory version, there is 4-Kbyte space (block A).
As of Oct. 2005
Remarks
Flash
Normal-ver.
memory
version (1)
T-ver.
V-ver.
Mask
ROM
version
Type No. M30 6N 4 M C T - XXX FP
Package type:
FP : Package PRQP0100JB-A
GP: Package PLQP0100KB-A
ROM No.
Omitted on flash memory version
Characteristics
(no) : Normal-ver.
T : T-ver. (Automotive 85°C version)
V : V-ver. (Automotive 125°C version)
ROM capacity:
C : 128 Kbytes
G: 256 Kbytes
Memory type:
M: Mask ROM version
F : Flash memory version
Shows the number of CAN module, pin count, etc.
6N Group
M16C Family
Figure 1.2 Type No., Memory Size, and Package
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 4 of 376
Normal-ver.
T-ver.
V-ver.
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
1.5 Pin Configuration
Figures 1.3 and 1.4 show the pin configuration (top view). Tables 1.3 and 1.4 list the pin characteristics.
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
P1_0/D8
P1_1/D9
P1_2/D10
P1_3/D11
P1_4/D12
P1_5/D13/INT3
P1_6/D14/INT4
P1_7/D15/INT5
P2_0/AN2_0/A0(/D0/-)
P2_1/AN2_1/A1(/D1/D0)
P2_2/AN2_2/A2(/D2/D1)
P2_3/AN2_3/A3(/D3/D2)
P2_4/AN2_4/A4(/D4/D3)
P2_5/AN2_5/A5(/D5/D4)
P2_6/AN2_6/A6(/D6/D5)
P2_7/AN2_7/A7(/D7/D6)
VSS
P3_0/A8(/-/D7)
VCC2
P3_1/A9
P3_2/A10
P3_3/A11
P3_4/A12
P3_5/A13
P3_6/A14
P3_7/A15
P4_0/A16
P4_1/A17
P4_2/A18
P4_3/A19
PIN CONFIGURATION (top view)
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
M16C/6N Group
(M16C/6N4)
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
P4_4/CS0
P4_5/CS1
P4_6/CS2
P4_7/CS3
P5_0/WRL/WR
P5_1/WRH/BHE
P5_2/RD
P5_3/BCLK
P5_4/HLDA
P5_5/HOLD
P5_6/ALE
P5_7/RDY/CLKOUT
P6_0/CTS0/RTS0
P6_1/CLK0
P6_2/RXD0/SCL0
P6_3/TXD0/SDA0
P6_4/CTS1/RTS1/CTS0/CLKS1
P6_5/CLK1
P6_6/RXD1/SCL1
P6_7/TXD1/SDA1
P9_6/ANEX1/CTX0
P9_5/ANEX0/CRX0
P9_4/DA1/TB4IN
P9_3/DA0/TB3IN
P9_2/TB2IN/SOUT3
(1) P9_1/TB1IN/SIN3
P9_0/TB0IN/CLK3
BYTE
CNVSS
P8_7/XCIN
P8_6/XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC1
P8_5/NMI
P8_4/INT2/ZP
P8_3/INT1
P8_2/INT0
P8_1/TA4IN/U
P8_0/TA4OUT/U
P7_7/TA3IN/CRX1
P7_6/TA3OUT/CTX1
P7_5/TA2IN/W
P7_4/TA2OUT/W
P7_3/CTS2/RTS2/TA1IN/V
P7_2/CLK2/TA1OUT/V
(1) P7_1/RXD2/SCL2/TA0IN/TB5IN
P7_0/TXD2/SDA2/TA0OUT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
P0_7/AN0_7/D7
P0_6/AN0_6/D6
P0_5/AN0_5/D5
P0_4/AN0_4/D4
P0_3/AN0_3/D3
P0_2/AN0_2/D2
P0_1/AN0_1/D1
P0_0/AN0_0/D0
P10_7/AN7/KI3
P10_6/AN6/KI2
P10_5/AN5/KI1
P10_4/AN4/KI0
P10_3/AN3
P10_2/AN2
P10_1/AN1
AVSS
P10_0/AN0
VREF
AVCC
P9_7/ADTRG
NOTE:
1. P7_1 and P9_1 are N channel open-drain pins.
Figure 1.3 Pin Configuration (Top View) (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 5 of 376
Package: PRQP0100JB-A
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
P1_3/D11
P1_4/D12
P1_5/D13/INT3
P1_6/D14/INT4
P1_7/D15/INT5
P2_0/AN2_0/A0(/D0/-)
P2_1/AN2_1/A1(/D1/D0)
P2_2/AN2_2/A2(/D2/D1)
P2_3/AN2_3/A3(/D3/D2)
P2_4/AN2_4/A4(/D4/D3)
P2_5/AN2_5/A5(/D5/D4)
P2_6/AN2_6/A6(/D6/D5)
P2_7/AN2_7/A7(/D7/D6)
VSS
P3_0/A8(/-/D7)
VCC2
P3_1/A9
P3_2/A10
P3_3/A11
P3_4/A12
P3_5/A13
P3_6/A14
P3_7/A15
P4_0/A16
P4_1/A17
PIN CONFIGURATION (top view)
75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
P1_2/D10
P1_1/D9
P1_0/D8
P0_7/AN0_7/D7
P0_6/AN0_6/D6
P0_5/AN0_5/D5
P0_4/AN0_4/D4
P0_3/AN0_3/D3
P0_2/AN0_2/D2
P0_1/AN0_1/D1
P0_0/AN0_0/D0
P10_7/AN7/KI3
P10_6/AN6/KI2
P10_5/AN5/KI1
P10_4/AN4/KI0
P10_3/AN3
P10_2/AN2
P10_1/AN1
AVSS
P10_0/AN0
VREF
AVCC
P9_7/ADTRG
P9_6/ANEX1/CTX0
P9_5/ANEX0/CRX0
76
77
78
79
80
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
M16C/6N Group
(M16C/6N4)
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
100
3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
P9_4/DA1/TB4IN
P9_3/DA0/TB3IN
P9_2/TB2IN/SOUT3
(1) P9_1/TB1IN/SIN3
P9_0/TB0IN/CLK3
BYTE
CNVSS
P8_7/XCIN
P8_6/XCOUT
RESET
XOUT
VSS
XIN
VCC1
P8_5/NMI
P8_4/INT2/ZP
P8_3/INT1
P8_2/INT0
P8_1/TA4IN/U
P8_0/TA4OUT/U
P7_7/TA3IN/CRX1
P7_6/TA3OUT/CTX1
P7_5/TA2IN/W
P7_4/TA2OUT/W
P7_3/CTS2/RTS2/TA1IN/V
1 2
P4_2/A18
P4_3/A19
P4_4/CS0
P4_5/CS1
P4_6/CS2
P4_7/CS3
P5_0/WRL/WR
P5_1/WRH/BHE
P5_2/RD
P5_3/BCLK
P5_4/HLDA
P5_5/HOLD
P5_6/ALE
P5_7/RDY/CLKOUT
P6_0/CTS0/RTS0
P6_1/CLK0
P6_2/RXD0/SCL0
P6_3/TXD0/SDA0
P6_4/CTS1/RTS1/CTS0/CLKS1
P6_5/CLK1
P6_6/RXD1/SCL1
P6_7/TXD1/SDA1
P7_0/TXD2/SDA2/TA0OUT
P7_1/RXD2/SCL2/TA0IN/TB5IN (1)
P7_2/CLK2/TA1OUT/V
NOTE:
1. P7_1 and P9_1 are N channel open-drain pins.
Figure 1.4 Pin Configuration (Top View) (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 6 of 376
Package: PLQP0100KB-A
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
Table 1.3 Pin Characteristics (1)
Pin No. Control
FP GP
Pin
1 99
2 100
3
1
4
2
5
3
6
4
7
5
8
6 BYTE
9
7 CNVSS
10 8 XCIN
11 9 XCOUT
____________
12 10 RESET
13 11 XOUT
14 12 VSS
15 13 XIN
16 14 VCC1
17 15
18 16
19 17
20 18
21 19
22 20
23 21
24 22
25 23
26 24
27 25
28 26
29 27
30 28
31 29
32 30
33 31
34 32
35 33
36 34
37 35
38 36
39 37
40 38
41 39
42 40
43 41
44 42
45 43
46 44
47 45
48 46
49 47
50 48
Port
Interrupt
Pin
P9_6
P9_5
P9_4
P9_3
P9_2
P9_1
P9_0
Timer Pin
UART Pin
Analog CAN Module
Bus Control Pin
Pin
Pin
ANEX1
ANEX0
DA1
DA0
TB4IN
TB3IN
TB2IN
TB1IN
TB0IN
CTX0
CRX0
SOUT3
SIN3
CLK3
P8_7
P8_6
_______
P8_5
P8_4
P8_3
P8_2
P8_1
P8_0
P7_7
P7_6
P7_5
P7_4
P7_3
P7_2
P7_1
P7_0
P6_7
P6_6
P6_5
P6_4
P6_3
P6_2
P6_1
P6_0
P5_7
P5_6
P5_5
P5_4
P5_3
P5_2
P5_1
P5_0
P4_7
P4_6
P4_5
P4_4
NMI
________
INT2
INT1
INT0
ZP
___
TA4IN/U
TA4OUT/U
TA3IN
TA3OUT
____
TA2IN/W
TA2OUT/W
___
TA1IN/V
TA1OUT/V
TA0IN/TB5IN
TA0OUT
FP: PRQP0100JB-A, GP: PLQP0100KB-A
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 7 of 376
CRX1
CTX1
__________ __________
CTS2/RTS2
CLK2
RXD2/SCL2
TXD2/SDA2
TXD1/SDA1
RXD1/SCL1
CLK1
_________ _________ _________
CTS1/RTS1/CTS0/CLKS1
TXD0/SDA0
RXD0/SCL0
CLK0
__________ __________
CTS0/RTS0
________
RDY/CLKOUT
ALE
__________
HOLD
__________
HLDA
BCLK
_____
RD
_________ ________
WRH/BHE
________ ______
WRL/WR
_______
CS3
_______
CS2
_______
CS1
_______
CS0
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
Table 1.4 Pin Characteristics (2)
Pin No. Control
FP GP
Pin
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
Port
Interrupt
Pin
Timer Pin
UART Pin
Analog CAN Module
Bus Control Pin
Pin
Pin
P4_3
P4_2
P4_1
P4_0
P3_7
P3_6
P3_5
P3_4
P3_3
P3_2
P3_1
A19
A18
A17
A16
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
P3_0
A8(/-/D7)
VCC2
VSS
P2_7
P2_6
P2_5
P2_4
P2_3
P2_2
P2_1
P2_0
P1_7
P1_6
P1_5
P1_4
P1_3
P1_2
P1_1
P1_0
P0_7
P0_6
P0_5
P0_4
P0_3
P0_2
P0_1
P0_0
P10_7
P10_6
P10_5
P10_4
P10_3
P10_2
P10_1
________
AN2_7
AN2_6
AN2_5
AN2_4
AN2_3
AN2_2
AN2_1
AN2_0
INT5
________
INT4
________
INT3
______
KI3
______
KI2
______
KI1
______
KI0
AN0_7
AN0_6
AN0_5
AN0_4
AN0_3
AN0_2
AN0_1
AN0_0
AN7
AN6
AN5
AN4
AN3
AN2
AN1
AVSS
P10_0
VREF
AVCC
AN0
_____________
P9_7
FP: PRQP0100JB-A, GP: PLQP0100KB-A
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 8 of 376
ADTRG
A7(/D7/D6)
A6(/D6/D5)
A5(/D5/D4)
A4(/D4/D3)
A3(/D3/D2)
A2(/D2/D1)
A1(/D1/D0)
A0(/D0/-)
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
1.6 Pin Description
Tables 1.5 to 1.7 list the pin descriptions.
Table 1.5 Pin Description (1)
Signal Name
Power supply
input
Pin Name
VCC1, VCC2,
VSS
I/O Type
Description
I
Apply 4.2 to 5.5V (T/V-ver.), 3.0 to 5.5V (Normal-ver.) to the VCC1
Analog power
supply input
Reset input
CNVSS
AVCC, AVSS
RESET
CNVSS
I
I
External data
bus width
select input
BYTE
I
Bus control
pins
D0 to D7
I/O
D8 to D15
I/O
A0 to A19
A0/D0 to A7/D7
O
I/O
A1/D0 to A8/D7
I/O
I
_____________
_______
_______
O
CS0 to CS3
_________ ______
WRL/WR
_________
________
WRH/BHE
______
RD
O
ALE
__________
HOLD
O
I
__________
O
I
HLDA
________
RDY
I: Input
O: Output
and VCC2 pins and 0V to the VSS pin. The VCC apply condition is
that VCC2 = VCC1 (1).
Applies the power supply for the A/D converter. Connect the AVCC
pin to VCC1. Connect the AVSS pin to VSS.
The microcomputer is in a reset state when applying “L” to the this pin.
Switches processor mode. Connect this pin to VSS to when after
a reset to start up in single-chip mode. Connect this pin to VCC1
to start up in microprocessor mode.
Switches the data bus in external memory space. The data bus
is 16-bit long when the this pin is held “L” and 8-bit long when
the this pin is held “H”. Set it to either one. Connect this pin to
VSS when an single-chip mode.
Inputs and outputs data (D0 to D7) when these pins are set as
the separate bus.
Inputs and outputs data (D8 to D15) when external 16-bit data
bus is set as the separate bus.
Output address bits (A0 to A19).
Input and output data (D0 to D7) and output address bits (A0 to
A7) by time-sharing when external 8-bit data bus are set as the
multiplexed bus.
Input and output data (D0 to D7) and output address bits (A1 to
A8) by time-sharing when external 16-bit data bus are set as the
multiplexed
bus.
_______
_______
_______
_______
Output CS0 to CS3 signals. CS0 to CS3 are chip-select signals
to specify
an external______
space.
________ _________
________
_____
________
_________
Output
WRL,
WRH,
(WR,
BHE), RD signals. WRL and WRH or
________
______
BHE and WR can be switched by program.
________ _________
_____
• WRL,
WRH and RD are selected
________
The WRL signal becomes “L” by writing data to an even address
in an
external memory space.
_________
The WRH signal becomes “L” by writing data to an odd address
in an_____
external memory space.
The RD pin signal becomes “L” by reading data in an external
memory
space._____
______ ________
• WR, ______
BHE and RD are selected
The WR signal becomes “L” by writing data in an external
memory space.
_____
The RD signal becomes “L” by reading data in an external
memory
space.
________
The BHE
signal becomes
“L” by accessing an odd address.
______ ________
_____
Select WR, BHE and RD for an external 8-bit data bus.
ALE is a signal
to latch the address.
__________
While the HOLD pin is held “L”, the microcomputer is placed in
a hold state.
__________
In a hold state, HLDA outputs a “L” signal.
________
While applying a “L” signal to the RDY pin, the microcomputer
is placed in a wait state.
I/O: Input/Output
NOTE:
1. In this manual, hereafter, VCC refers to VCC1 unless otherwise noted.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 9 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
Table 1.6 Pin Description (2)
Signal Name
Main clock
input
Main clock
output
Sub clock
input
Sub clock
output
BCLK output
Clock output
INT
interrupt input
_______
NMI interrupt
input
Key input
interrupt input
Timer A
I/O Type
Description
XIN
Pin Name
I
XOUT
O
XCIN
I
XCOUT
O
BCLK
CLKOUT
________
________
INT0
to INT5
________
NMI
O
O
I
I
I/O pins for the main clock oscillation circuit. Connect a ceramic
resonator or crystal oscillator between XIN and XOUT (1).
To use the external clock, input the clock from XIN and leave
XOUT open.
I/O pins for a sub clock oscillation circuit. Connect a crystal
oscillator between XCIN and XCOUT (1).
To use the external clock, input the clock from XCIN and leave
XCOUT open.
Outputs the BCLK signal.
The clock of the same
cycle as fC, f8, or f32 is output.
______
Input pins for the_______
INT interrupt.
Input pin for the NMI interrupt.
I
Input pins for the key input interrupt.
______
______
KI0 to KI3
TA0OUT to TA4OUT
TA0IN to TA4IN
ZP
Timer B
TB0IN
to___TB5IN
___
____
Three-phase motor U, U, V, V, W, W
control output
__________
__________
Serial interface CTS0
to
CTS2
__________
__________
RTS0 to RTS2
CLK0 to CLK3
RXD0 to RXD2
SIN3
TXD0 to TXD2
SOUT3
CLKS1
I/O
I
I
I
O
These are timer A0 to timer A4 I/O pins.
These are timer A0 to timer A4 input pins.
Input pin for the Z-phase.
These are timer B0 to timer B5 input pins.
These are Three-phase motor control output pins.
I
O
I/O
I
I
O
O
O
I2C mode
SDA0 to SDA2
SCL0 to SCL2
I/O
I/O
Reference
VREF
These are send control input pins.
These are receive control output pins.
These are transfer clock I/O pins.
These are serial data input pins.
These are serial data input pins.
These are serial data output pins.
These are serial data output pins.
This is output pin for transfer clock output from multiple pins
function.
These are serial data I/O pins.
These are transfer clock I/O pins. (however, SCL2 for the
N-channel open drain output.)
Applies the reference voltage for the A/D converter and D/A
I
converter.
voltage input
I
Analog input pins for the A/D converter.
ADTRG
I
This is an A/D trigger input pin.
ANEX0
I/O
ANEX1
I
This is the extended analog input pin for the A/D converter.
D/A converter
DA0, DA1
O
These are the output pins for the D/A converter.
CAN module
CRX0, CRX1
I
These are the input pins for the CAN module.
A/D converter
AN0 to AN7
AN0_0 to AN0_7
AN2_0
to AN2_7
_____________
This is the extended analog input pin for the A/D converter,
and is the output in external op-amp connection mode.
I: Input
These are the output pins for the CAN module.
CTX0, CTX1
O
O: Output
I/O: Input/Output
NOTE:
1. Ask the oscillator maker the oscillation characteristic.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 10 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
1. Overview
Table 1.7 Pin Description (3)
Signal Name
I/O port
Pin Name
P0_0 to P0_7
I/O Type
Description
8-bit I/O ports in CMOS, having a direction register to select
I/O
P1_0 to P1_7
an input or output.
P2_0 to P2_7
Each pin is set as an input port or output port. An input port
P3_0 to P3_7
P4_0 to P4_7
can be set for a pull-up or for no pull-up in 4-bit unit by
P5_0 to P5_7
(however, P7_1 and P9_1 for the N-channel open drain
P6_0 to P6_7
output.)
program.
P7_0 to P7_7
P8_0 to P8_4
P8_6, P8_7
P9_0 to P9_7
P10_0 to P10_7
Input port
P8_5
_______
I
Input pin for the NMI interrupt.
Pin states can be read by the P8_5 bit in the P8 register.
I: Input
O: Output
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
I/O: Input/Output
page 11 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
Figure 2.1 shows the CPU registers. The CPU has 13 registers. Of these, R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1 and FB
comprise a register bank. There are two register banks.
b31
b15
b8 b7
b0
R2
R0H (R0's high bits) R0L (R0's low bits)
R3
R1H (R1's high bits) R1L (R1's low bits)
Data Registers (1)
R2
R3
A0
Address Registers (1)
A1
FB
b19
Frame Base Registers (1)
b15
b0
INTBH
Interrupt Table Register
INTBL
The upper 4 bits of INTB are INTBH and the lower 16 bits of INTB are INTBL.
b19
b0
Program Counter
PC
b15
b0
USP
User Stack Pointer
ISP
Interrupt Stack Pointer
SB
Static Base Register
b15
b0
FLG
b15
Flag Register
b8 b7
IPL
U
b0
I
O B S
Z
D C
Carry Flag
Debug Flag
Zero Flag
Sign Flag
Register Bank Select Flag
Overflow Flag
Interrupt Enable Flag
Stack Pointer Select Flag
Reserved Area
Processor Interrupt Priority Level
Reserved Area
NOTE:
1. These registers comprise a register bank. There are two register banks.
Figure 2.1 CPU Registers
2.1 Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3)
The R0 register consists of 16 bits, and is used mainly for transfers and arithmetic/logic operations. R1 to
R3 are the same as R0.
The R0 register can be separated between high (R0H) and low (R0L) for use as two 8-bit data registers.
R1H and R1L are the same as R0H and R0L. Conversely R2 and R0 can be combined for use as a 32-bit
data register (R2R0). R3R1 is the same as R2R0.
2.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1)
The A0 register consists of 16 bits, and is used for address register indirect addressing and address
register relative addressing. They also are used for transfers and arithmetic/logic operations. A1 is the
same as A0.
In some instructions, A1 and A0 can be combined for use as a 32-bit address register (A1A0).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005 page 12 of 376
REJ09B0009-0230
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
2. Central Processing Unit (CPU)
2.3 Frame Base Register (FB)
FB is configured with 16 bits, and is used for FB relative addressing.
2.4 Interrupt Table Register (INTB)
INTB is configured with 20 bits, indicating the start address of an interrupt vector table.
2.5 Program Counter (PC)
PC is configured with 20 bits, indicating the address of an instruction to be executed.
2.6 User Stack Pointer (USP), Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP)
Stack pointer (SP) comes in two types: USP and ISP, each configured with 16 bits.
Your desired type of stack pointer (USP or ISP) can be selected by the U flag of FLG.
2.7 Static Base Register (SB)
SB is configured with 16 bits, and is used for SB relative addressing.
2.8 Flag Register (FLG)
FLG consists of 11 bits, indicating the CPU status.
2.8.1 Carry Flag (C Flag)
This flag retains a carry, borrow, or shift-out bit that has occurred in the arithmetic/logic unit.
2.8.2 Debug Flag (D Flag)
This flag is used exclusively for debugging purpose. During normal use, it must be set to “0”.
2.8.3 Zero Flag (Z Flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in 0; otherwise, it is “0”.
2.8.4 Sign Flag (S Flag)
This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in a negative value; otherwise, it is “0”.
2.8.5 Register Bank Select Flag (B Flag)
Register bank 0 is selected when this flag is “0” ; register bank 1 is selected when this flag is “1”.
2.8.6 Overflow Flag (O Flag)
This flag is set to “1” when the operation resulted in an overflow; otherwise, it is “0”.
2.8.7 Interrupt Enable Flag (I Flag)
This flag enables a maskable interrupt.
Maskable interrupts are disabled when the I flag is “0”, and are enabled when the I flag is “1”. The I flag is
set to “0” when the interrupt request is accepted.
2.8.8 Stack Pointer Select Flag (U Flag)
ISP is selected when the U flag is “0” ; USP is selected when the U flag is “1”.
The U flag is set to “0” when a hardware interrupt request is accepted or an INT instruction for software
interrupt Nos. 0 to 31 is executed.
2.8.9 Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL)
IPL is configured with three bits, for specification of up to eight processor interrupt priority levels from level
0 to level 7.
If a requested interrupt has priority greater than IPL, the interrupt request is enabled.
2.8.10 Reserved Area
When white to this bit, write “0”. When read, its content is indeterminate.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005 page 13 of 376
REJ09B0009-0230
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
3. Memory
3. Memory
Figure 3.1 shows a memory map of the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4). The address space extends the 1
Mbyte from address 00000h to FFFFFh.
The internal ROM is allocated in a lower address direction beginning with address FFFFFh. For example, a
128-Kbyte internal ROM is allocated to the addresses from E0000h to FFFFFh.
As for the flash memory version, 4-Kbyte space (block A) exists in 0F000h to 0FFFFh. 4-Kbyte space is
mainly for storing data. In addition to storing data, 4-Kbyte space also can store programs.
The fixed interrupt vector table is allocated to the addresses from FFFDCh to FFFFFh. Therefore, store the
start address of each interrupt routine here.
The internal RAM is allocated in an upper address direction beginning with address 00400h. For example, a
5-Kbyte internal RAM is allocated to the addresses from 00400h to 017FFh. In addition to storing data, the
internal RAM also stores the stack used when calling subroutines and when interrupts are generated.
The SFR is allocated to the addresses from 00000h to 003FFh. Peripheral function control registers are
located here. Of the SFR, any area which has no functions allocated is reserved for future use and cannot be
used by users.
The special page vector table is allocated to the addresses from FFE00h to FFFDBh. This vector is used by
the JMPS or JSRS instruction. For details, refer to M16C/60, M16C/20, M16C/Tiny Series Software Manual.
In memory expansion and microprocessor modes, some areas are reserved for future use and cannot be
used by users.
00000h
SFR
00400h
Internal RAM
XXXXXh
FFE00h
Reserved area (1)
0F000h
0FFFFh
10000h
Internal ROM
(data area) (3)
Special page
vector table
External area
27000h
Reserved area
FFFDCh
BRK instruction
Address match
Single step
External area
Internal ROM (3)
Internal RAM
Capacity
Address XXXXXh
Capacity
Address YYYYYh
5 Kbytes
017FFh
128 Kbytes
E0000h
10 Kbytes
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
C0000h
80000h
YYYYYh
FFFFFh
Undefined instruction
Overflow
28000h
Reserved area (2)
Oscillation stop and re-oscillation
detection / watchdog timer
Internal ROM
(program area) (4)
FFFFFh
DBC
NMI
Reset
NOTES:
1. During memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, cannot be used.
2. In memory expansion mode, cannot be used.
3. As for the flash memory version, 4-Kbyte space (block A) exists.
4. When using the masked ROM version, write nothing to internal ROM area.
5. Shown here is a memory map for the case where the PM10 bit in the PM1 register is "1" (block A enabled, addresses 10000h to
26FFFh for CS2 area) and the PM13 bit in the PM1 register is "1" (internal RAM area is expanded over 192 Kbytes).
Figure 3.1 Memory Map
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 14 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
SFR (Special Function Register) is the control register of peripheral functions.
Tables 4.1 to 4.16 list the SFR information.
Table 4.1 SFR Information (1)
Address
0000h
0001h
0002h
0003h
Register
Symbol
After Reset
00000000b (CNVSS pin is "L")
00000011b (CNVSS pin is "H")
00001000b
01001000b
00100000b
00000001b
XXXXXX00b
XX000000b
0004h
Processor Mode Register 0 (1)
PM0
0005h
0006h
0007h
0008h
0009h
000Ah
000Bh
000Ch
000Dh
000Eh
000Fh
0010h
0011h
0012h
0013h
0014h
0015h
0016h
0017h
0018h
0019h
001Ah
001Bh
001Ch
001Dh
001Eh
001Fh
0020h
0021h
0022h
0023h
0024h
0025h
0026h
0027h
0028h
0029h
002Ah
002Bh
002Ch
002Dh
002Eh
002Fh
0030h
0031h
0032h
0033h
0034h
0035h
0036h
0037h
0038h
0039h
003Ah
003Bh
003Ch
003Dh
003Eh
003Fh
Processor Mode Register 1
System Clock Control Register 0
System Clock Control Register 1
Chip Select Control Register
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
Protect Register
PM1
CM0
CM1
CSR
AIER
PRCR
Oscillation Stop Detection Register (2)
CM2
0X000000b
Watchdog Timer Start Register
Watchdog Timer Control Register
WDTS
WDC
Address Match Interrupt Register 0
RMAD0
XXh
00XXXXXXb
00h
00h
X0h
Address Match Interrupt Register 1
RMAD1
Chip Select Expansion Control Register
PLL Control Register 0
CSE
PLC0
00h
0001X010b
Processor Mode Register 2
PM2
XXX00000b
DMA0 Source Pointer
SAR0
XXh
XXh
XXh
DMA0 Destination Pointer
DAR0
XXh
XXh
XXh
DMA0 Transfer Counter
TCR0
XXh
XXh
DMA0 Control Register
DM0CON
DMA1 Source Pointer
SAR1
XXh
XXh
XXh
DMA1 Destination Pointer
DAR1
XXh
XXh
XXh
DMA1 Transfer Counter
TCR1
XXh
XXh
DMA1 Control Register
DM1CON
00h
00h
X0h
00000X00b
00000X00b
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. The PM00 and PM01 bits in the PM0 register do not change at software reset, watchdog timer reset and oscillation stop detection reset.
2. The CM20, CM21, and CM27 bits in the CM2 register do not change at oscillation stop detection reset.
3. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 15 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.2 SFR Information (2)
Address
0040h
0041h
0042h
0043h
0044h
0045h
0046h
0047h
0048h
0049h
004Ah
004Bh
004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
004Fh
0050h
0051h
0052h
0053h
0054h
0055h
0056h
0057h
0058h
0059h
005Ah
005Bh
005Ch
005Dh
005Eh
005Fh
0060h
0061h
0062h
0063h
0064h
0065h
0066h
0067h
0068h
0069h
006Ah
006Bh
006Ch
006Dh
006Eh
006Fh
0070h
0071h
0072h
0073h
0074h
0075h
0076h
0077h
0078h
0079h
007Ah
007Bh
007Ch
007Dh
007Eh
007Fh
Register
CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Control Register
CAN0 Successful Reception Interrupt Control Register
CAN0 Successful Transmission Interrupt Control Register
INT3 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B5 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B4 Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
Timer B3 Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
CAN1 Successful Reception Interrupt Control Register
INT5 Interrupt Control Register
CAN1 Successful Transmission Interrupt Control Register
SI/O3 Interrupt Control Register
INT4 Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Bus Collision Detection Interrupt Control Register
DMA0 Interrupt Control Register
DMA1 Interrupt Control Register
CAN0/1 Error Interrupt Control Register
A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register
Key Input Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART2 Receive Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Transmit Interrupt Control Register
UART1 Receive Interrupt Control Register
Timer A0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A1 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A2 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A3 Interrupt Control Register
Timer A4 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B0 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B1 Interrupt Control Register
Timer B2 Interrupt Control Register
INT0 Interrupt Control Register
INT1 Interrupt Control Register
INT2 Interrupt Control Register
CAN0 Message Box 0: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 0: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 0: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 1: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 1: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 1: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank area is reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 16 of 376
Symbol
C01WKIC
C0RECIC
C0TRMIC
INT3IC
TB5IC
TB4IC
U1BCNIC
TB3IC
U0BCNIC
C1RECIC
INT5IC
C1TRMIC
S3IC
INT4IC
U2BCNIC
DM0IC
DM1IC
C01ERRIC
ADIC
KUPIC
S2TIC
S2RIC
S0TIC
S0RIC
S1TIC
S1RIC
TA0IC
TA1IC
TA2IC
TA3IC
TA4IC
TB0IC
TB1IC
TB2IC
INT0IC
INT1IC
INT2IC
After Reset
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XX00X000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.3 SFR Information (3)
Address
0080h
0081h
0082h
0083h
0084h
0085h
0086h
0087h
0088h
0089h
008Ah
008Bh
008Ch
008Dh
008Eh
008Fh
0090h
0091h
0092h
0093h
0094h
0095h
0096h
0097h
0098h
0099h
009Ah
009Bh
009Ch
009Dh
009Eh
009Fh
00A0h
00A1h
00A2h
00A3h
00A4h
00A5h
00A6h
00A7h
00A8h
00A9h
00AAh
00ABh
00ACh
00ADh
00AEh
00AFh
00B0h
00B1h
00B2h
00B3h
00B4h
00B5h
00B6h
00B7h
00B8h
00B9h
00BAh
00BBh
00BCh
00BDh
00BEh
00BFh
Register
CAN0 Message Box 2: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 2: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 2: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 3: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 3: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 3: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 4: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 4: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 4: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 5: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 5: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 5: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 17 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.4 SFR Information (4)
Address
00C0h
00C1h
00C2h
00C3h
00C4h
00C5h
00C6h
00C7h
00C8h
00C9h
00CAh
00CBh
00CCh
00CDh
00CEh
00CFh
00D0h
00D1h
00D2h
00D3h
00D4h
00D5h
00D6h
00D7h
00D8h
00D9h
00DAh
00DBh
00DCh
00DDh
00DEh
00DFh
00E0h
00E1h
00E2h
00E3h
00E4h
00E5h
00E6h
00E7h
00E8h
00E9h
00EAh
00EBh
00ECh
00EDh
00EEh
00EFh
00F0h
00F1h
00F2h
00F3h
00F4h
00F5h
00F6h
00F7h
00F8h
00F9h
00FAh
00FBh
00FCh
00FDh
00FEh
00FFh
Register
CAN0 Message Box 6: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 6: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 6: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 7: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 7: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 7: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 8: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 8: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 8: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 9: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 9: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 9: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 18 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.5 SFR Information (5)
Address
0100h
0101h
0102h
0103h
0104h
0105h
0106h
0107h
0108h
0109h
010Ah
010Bh
010Ch
010Dh
010Eh
010Fh
0110h
0111h
0112h
0113h
0114h
0115h
0116h
0117h
0118h
0119h
011Ah
011Bh
011Ch
011Dh
011Eh
011Fh
0120h
0121h
0122h
0123h
0124h
0125h
0126h
0127h
0128h
0129h
012Ah
012Bh
012Ch
012Dh
012Eh
012Fh
0130h
0131h
0132h
0133h
0134h
0135h
0136h
0137h
0138h
0139h
013Ah
013Bh
013Ch
013Dh
013Eh
013Fh
Register
CAN0 Message Box 10: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 10: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 10: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 11: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 11: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 11: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 12: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 12: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 12: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 13: Identifier / DLC
CAN0 Message Box 13: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 13: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 19 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.6 SFR Information (6)
Address
0140h
0141h
0142h
0143h
0144h
0145h
0146h
0147h
0148h
0149h
014Ah
014Bh
014Ch
014Dh
014Eh
014Fh
0150h
0151h
0152h
0153h
0154h
0155h
0156h
0157h
0158h
0159h
015Ah
015Bh
015Ch
015Dh
015Eh
015Fh
0160h
0161h
0162h
0163h
0164h
0165h
0166h
0167h
0168h
0169h
016Ah
016Bh
016Ch
016Dh
016Eh
016Fh
0170h
0171h
0172h
0173h
0174h
0175h
0176h
0177h
0178h
0179h
017Ah
017Bh
017Ch
017Dh
017Eh
017Fh
Register
Symbol
CAN0 Message Box 14: Identifier /DLC
CAN0 Message Box 14: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 14: Time Stamp
CAN0 Message Box 15: Identifier /DLC
CAN0 Message Box 15: Data Field
CAN0 Message Box 15: Time Stamp
CAN0 Global Mask Register
C0GMR
CAN0 Local Mask A Register
C0LMAR
CAN0 Local Mask B Register
C0LMBR
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 20 of 376
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.7 SFR Information (7)
Address
0180h
0181h
0182h
0183h
0184h
0185h
0186h
0187h
0188h
0189h
018Ah
018Bh
018Ch
018Dh
018Eh
018Fh
0190h
0191h
0192h
0193h
0194h
0195h
0196h
0197h
0198h
0199h
019Ah
019Bh
019Ch
019Dh
019Eh
019Fh
01A0h
01A1h
01A2h
01A3h
01A4h
01A5h
01A6h
01A7h
01A8h
01A9h
01AAh
01ABh
01ACh
01ADh
01AEh
01AFh
01B0h
01B1h
01B2h
01B3h
01B4h
01B5h
01B6h
01B7h
01B8h
01B9h
01BAh
01BBh
01BCh
01BDh
01BEh
01BFh
Register
Symbol
After Reset
Flash Memory Control Register 1 (1)
FMR1
0X00XX0Xb
Flash Memory Control Register 0 (1)
FMR0
Address Match Interrupt Register 2
RMAD2
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register 2
AIER2
Address Match Interrupt Register 3
RMAD3
00000001b
00h
00h
X0h
XXXXXX00b
00h
00h
X0h
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. These registers are included in the flash memory version. Cannot be accessed by users in the mask ROM version.
2. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 21 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.8 SFR Information (8)
Address
01C0h
01C1h
01C2h
01C3h
01C4h
01C5h
01C6h
01C7h
01C8h
01C9h
01CAh
01CBh
01CCh
01CDh
01CEh
01CFh
01D0h
01D1h
01D2h
01D3h
01D4h
01D5h
01D6h
01D7h
01D8h
01D9h
01DAh
01DBh
01DCh
01DDh
01DEh
01DFh
01E0h
01E1h
01E2h
01E3h
01E4h
01E5h
01E6h
01E7h
01E8h
01E9h
01EAh
01EBh
01ECh
01EDh
01EEh
01EFh
01F0h
01F1h
01F2h
01F3h
01F4h
01F5h
01F6h
01F7h
01F8h
01F9h
01FAh
01FBh
01FCh
01FDh
01FEh
01FFh
Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Flag
Register
Symbol
TBSR
Timer A1-1 Register
TA11
Timer A2-1 Register
TA21
Timer A4-1 Register
TA41
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1
Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 0
Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 1
Dead Time Timer
Timer B2 Interrupt Occurrence Frequency Set Counter
INVC0
INVC1
IDB0
IDB1
DTT
ICTB2
Timer B3 Register
TB3
Timer B4 Register
TB4
Timer B5 Register
TB5
Timer B3 Mode Register
Timer B4 Mode Register
Timer B5 Mode Register
Interrupt Cause Select Register 0
Interrupt Cause Select Register 1
SI/O3 Transmit/Receive Register
TB3MR
TB4MR
TB5MR
IFSR0
IFSR1
S3TRR
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
00XXX000b
00h
XXh
SI/O3 Control Register
SI/O3 Bit Rate Generator
S3C
S3BRG
01000000b
XXh
UART0 Special Mode Register 4
UART0 Special Mode Register 3
UART0 Special Mode Register 2
UART0 Special Mode Register
UART1 Special Mode Register 4
UART1 Special Mode Register 3
UART1 Special Mode Register 2
UART1 Special Mode Register
UART2 Special Mode Register 4
UART2 Special Mode Register 3
UART2 Special Mode Register 2
UART2 Special Mode Register
UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART2 Bit Rate Generator
U0SMR4
U0SMR3
U0SMR2
U0SMR
U1SMR4
U1SMR3
U1SMR2
U1SMR
U2SMR4
U2SMR3
U2SMR2
U2SMR
U2MR
U2BRG
UART2 Transmit Buffer Register
U2TB
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
U2C0
U2C1
UART2 Receive Buffer Register
U2RB
00h
000X0X0Xb
X0000000b
X0000000b
00h
000X0X0Xb
X0000000b
X0000000b
00h
000X0X0Xb
X0000000b
X0000000b
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00001000b
00000010b
XXh
XXh
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 22 of 376
After Reset
000XXXXXb
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.9 SFR Information (9)
Address
0200h
0201h
0202h
0203h
0204h
0205h
0206h
0207h
0208h
0209h
020Ah
020Bh
020Ch
020Dh
020Eh
020Fh
0210h
0211h
0212h
0213h
0214h
0215h
0216h
0217h
0218h
0219h
021Ah
021Bh
021Ch
021Dh
021Eh
021Fh
0220h
0221h
0222h
0223h
0224h
0225h
0226h
0227h
0228h
0229h
022Ah
022Bh
022Ch
022Dh
022Eh
022Fh
0230h
0231h
0232h
0233h
0234h
0235h
0236h
0237h
0238h
0239h
023Ah
023Bh
023Ch
023Dh
023Eh
023Fh
CAN0 Message Control Register 0
CAN0 Message Control Register 1
CAN0 Message Control Register 2
CAN0 Message Control Register 3
CAN0 Message Control Register 4
CAN0 Message Control Register 5
CAN0 Message Control Register 6
CAN0 Message Control Register 7
CAN0 Message Control Register 8
CAN0 Message Control Register 9
CAN0 Message Control Register 10
CAN0 Message Control Register 11
CAN0 Message Control Register 12
CAN0 Message Control Register 13
CAN0 Message Control Register 14
CAN0 Message Control Register 15
Register
Symbol
C0MCTL0
C0MCTL1
C0MCTL2
C0MCTL3
C0MCTL4
C0MCTL5
C0MCTL6
C0MCTL7
C0MCTL8
C0MCTL9
C0MCTL10
C0MCTL11
C0MCTL12
C0MCTL13
C0MCTL14
C0MCTL15
CAN0 Control Register
C0CTLR
CAN0 Status Register
C0STR
CAN0 Slot Status Register
C0SSTR
CAN0 Interrupt Control Register
C0ICR
CAN0 Extended ID Register
C0IDR
CAN0 Configuration Register
C0CONR
CAN0 Receive Error Count Register
CAN0 Transmit Error Count Register
C0RECR
C0TECR
CAN0 Time Stamp Register
C0TSR
CAN1 Message Control Register 0
CAN1 Message Control Register 1
CAN1 Message Control Register 2
CAN1 Message Control Register 3
CAN1 Message Control Register 4
CAN1 Message Control Register 5
CAN1 Message Control Register 6
CAN1 Message Control Register 7
CAN1 Message Control Register 8
CAN1 Message Control Register 9
CAN1 Message Control Register 10
CAN1 Message Control Register 11
CAN1 Message Control Register 12
CAN1 Message Control Register 13
CAN1 Message Control Register 14
CAN1 Message Control Register 15
C1MCTL0
C1MCTL1
C1MCTL2
C1MCTL3
C1MCTL4
C1MCTL5
C1MCTL6
C1MCTL7
C1MCTL8
C1MCTL9
C1MCTL10
C1MCTL11
C1MCTL12
C1MCTL13
C1MCTL14
C1MCTL15
CAN1 Control Register
C1CTLR
CAN1 Status Register
C1STR
CAN1 Slot Status Register
C1SSTR
CAN1 Interrupt Control Register
C1ICR
CAN1 Extended ID Register
C1IDR
CAN1 Configuration Register
C1CONR
CAN1 Receive Error Count Register
CAN1 Transmit Error Count Register
C1RECR
C1TECR
CAN1 Time Stamp Register
C1TSR
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 23 of 376
After Reset
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
X0000001b
XX0X0000b
00h
X0000001b
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
X0000001b
XX0X0000b
00h
X0000001b
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
00h
00h
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.10 SFR Information (10)
Address
0240h
0241h
0242h
0243h
0244h
0245h
0246h
0247h
0248h
0249h
024Ah
024Bh
024Ch
024Dh
024Eh
024Fh
0250h
0251h
0252h
0253h
0254h
0255h
0256h
0257h
0258h
0259h
025Ah
025Bh
025Ch
025Dh
025Eh
025Fh
0260h
0261h
0262h
0263h
0264h
0265h
0266h
0267h
0268h
0269h
026Ah
026Bh
026Ch
026Dh
026Eh
026Fh
0270h
0271h
0272h
0273h
0274h
0275h
0276h
0277h
0278h
0279h
027Ah
027Bh
027Ch
027Dh
027Eh
027Fh
Register
Symbol
CAN0 Acceptance Filter Support Register
C0AFS
CAN1 Acceptance Filter Support Register
C1AFS
Peripheral Clock Select Register
CAN0/1 Clock Select Register
PCLKR
CCLKR
CAN1 Message Box 0: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 0: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 0:Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 1: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 1: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 1:Time Stamp
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 24 of 376
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.11 SFR Information (11)
Address
0280h
0281h
0282h
0283h
0284h
0285h
0286h
0287h
0288h
0289h
028Ah
028Bh
028Ch
028Dh
028Eh
028Fh
0290h
0291h
0292h
0293h
0294h
0295h
0296h
0297h
0298h
0299h
029Ah
029Bh
029Ch
029Dh
029Eh
029Fh
02A0h
02A1h
02A2h
02A3h
02A4h
02A5h
02A6h
02A7h
02A8h
02A9h
02AAh
02ABh
02ACh
02ADh
02AEh
02AFh
02B0h
02B1h
02B2h
02B3h
02B4h
02B5h
02B6h
02B7h
02B8h
02B9h
02BAh
02BBh
02BCh
02BDh
02BEh
02BFh
Register
CAN1 Message Box 2: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 2: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 2: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 3: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 3: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 3: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 4: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 4: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 4: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 5: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 5: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 5: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 25 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.12 SFR Information (12)
Address
02C0h
02C1h
02C2h
02C3h
02C4h
02C5h
02C6h
02C7h
02C8h
02C9h
02CAh
02CBh
02CCh
02CDh
02CEh
02CFh
02D0h
02D1h
02D2h
02D3h
02D4h
02D5h
02D6h
02D7h
02D8h
02D9h
02DAh
02DBh
02DCh
02DDh
02DEh
02DFh
02E0h
02E1h
02E2h
02E3h
02E4h
02E5h
02E6h
02E7h
02E8h
02E9h
02EAh
02EBh
02ECh
02EDh
02EEh
02EFh
02F0h
02F1h
02F2h
02F3h
02F4h
02F5h
02F6h
02F7h
02F8h
02F9h
02FAh
02FBh
02FCh
02FDh
02FEh
02FFh
Register
CAN1 Message Box 6: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 6: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 6: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 7: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 7: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 7: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 8: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 8: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 8: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 9: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 9: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 9: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 26 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.13 SFR Information (13)
Address
0300h
0301h
0302h
0303h
0304h
0305h
0306h
0307h
0308h
0309h
030Ah
030Bh
030Ch
030Dh
030Eh
030Fh
0310h
0311h
0312h
0313h
0314h
0315h
0316h
0317h
0318h
0319h
031Ah
031Bh
031Ch
031Dh
031Eh
031Fh
0320h
0321h
0322h
0323h
0324h
0325h
0326h
0327h
0328h
0329h
032Ah
032Bh
032Ch
032Dh
032Eh
032Fh
0330h
0331h
0332h
0333h
0334h
0335h
0336h
0337h
0338h
0339h
033Ah
033Bh
033Ch
033Dh
033Eh
033Fh
Register
CAN1 Message Box 10: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 10: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 10: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 11: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 11: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 11: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 12: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 12: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 12: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 13: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 13: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 13: Time Stamp
X: Undefined
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 27 of 376
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.14 SFR Information (14)
Address
0340h
0341h
0342h
0343h
0344h
0345h
0346h
0347h
0348h
0349h
034Ah
034Bh
034Ch
034Dh
034Eh
034Fh
0350h
0351h
0352h
0353h
0354h
0355h
0356h
0357h
0358h
0359h
035Ah
035Bh
035Ch
035Dh
035Eh
035Fh
0360h
0361h
0362h
0363h
0364h
0365h
0366h
0367h
0368h
0369h
036Ah
036Bh
036Ch
036Dh
036Eh
036Fh
0370h
0371h
0372h
0373h
0374h
0375h
0376h
0377h
0378h
0379h
037Ah
037Bh
037Ch
037Dh
037Eh
037Fh
Register
Symbol
CAN1 Message Box 14: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 14: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 14: Time Stamp
CAN1 Message Box 15: Identifier / DLC
CAN1 Message Box 15: Data Field
CAN1 Message Box 15: Time Stamp
CAN1 Global Mask Register
C1GMR
CAN1 Local Mask A Register
C1LMAR
CAN1 Local Mask B Register
C1LMBR
X: Undefined
NOTE:
1. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 28 of 376
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.15 SFR Information (15)
Address
0380h
0381h
0382h
0383h
0384h
0385h
0386h
0387h
0388h
0389h
038Ah
038Bh
038Ch
038Dh
038Eh
038Fh
0390h
0391h
0392h
0393h
0394h
0395h
0396h
0397h
0398h
0399h
039Ah
039Bh
039Ch
039Dh
039Eh
039Fh
03A0h
03A1h
03A2h
03A3h
03A4h
03A5h
03A6h
03A7h
03A8h
03A9h
03AAh
03ABh
03ACh
03ADh
03AEh
03AFh
03B0h
03B1h
03B2h
03B3h
03B4h
03B5h
03B6h
03B7h
03B8h
03B9h
03BAh
03BBh
03BCh
03BDh
03BEh
03BFh
Count Start Flag
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag
One-Shot Start Flag
Trigger Select Register
Up/Down Flag
Register
Symbol
TABSR
CPSRF
ONSF
TRGSR
UDF
After Reset
00h
0XXXXXXXb
00h
00h
00h (1)
Timer A0 Register
TA0
Timer A1 Register
TA1
Timer A2 Register
TA2
Timer A3 Register
TA3
Timer A4 Register
TA4
Timer B0 Register
TB0
Timer B1 Register
TB1
Timer B2 Register
TB2
Timer A0 Mode Register
Timer A1 Mode Register
Timer A2 Mode Register
Timer A3 Mode Register
Timer A4 Mode Register
Timer B0 Mode Register
Timer B1 Mode Register
Timer B2 Mode Register
Timer B2 Special Mode Register
TA0MR
TA1MR
TA2MR
TA3MR
TA4MR
TB0MR
TB1MR
TB2MR
TB2SC
UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART0 Bit Rate Generator
U0MR
U0BRG
UART0 Transmit Buffer Register
U0TB
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
U0C0
U0C1
UART0 Receive Buffer Register
U0RB
UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register
UART1 Bit Rate Generator
U1MR
U1BRG
UART1 Transmit Buffer Register
U1TB
UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0
UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
U1C0
U1C1
UART1 Receive Buffer Register
U1RB
UART Transmit/Receive Control Register 2
UCON
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00001000b
00XX0010b
XXh
XXh
00h
XXh
XXh
XXh
00001000b
00XX0010b
XXh
XXh
X0000000b
DMA0 Request Cause Select Register
DM0SL
00h
DMA1 Request Cause Select Register
DM1SL
00h
CRC Data Register
CRCD
CRC Input Register
CRCIN
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
00h
00h
00h
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
XXXXXX00b
XXh
XXh
XXh
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. The TA2P to TA4P bits in the UDF register are set to "0" after reset. However, the contents in these bits are indeterminate when read.
2. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 29 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4. Special Function Register (SFR)
Table 4.16 SFR Information (16)
Address
03C0h
03C1h
03C2h
03C3h
03C4h
03C5h
03C6h
03C7h
03C8h
03C9h
03CAh
03CBh
03CCh
03CDh
03CEh
03CFh
03D0h
03D1h
03D2h
03D3h
03D4h
03D5h
03D6h
03D7h
03D8h
03D9h
03DAh
03DBh
03DCh
03DDh
03DEh
03DFh
03E0h
03E1h
03E2h
03E3h
03E4h
03E5h
03E6h
03E7h
03E8h
03E9h
03EAh
03EBh
03ECh
03EDh
03EEh
03EFh
03F0h
03F1h
03F2h
03F3h
03F4h
03F5h
03F6h
03F7h
03F8h
03F9h
03FAh
03FBh
03FCh
Register
Symbol
After Reset
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
XXh
A/D Register 0
AD0
A/D Register 1
AD1
A/D Register 2
AD2
A/D Register 3
AD3
A/D Register 4
AD4
A/D Register 5
AD5
A/D Register 6
AD6
A/D Register 7
AD7
A/D Control Register 2
ADCON2
00h
A/D Control Register 0
A/D Control Register 1
D/A Register 0
ADCON0
ADCON1
DA0
00000XXXb
00h
00h
D/A Register 1
DA1
00h
D/A Control Register
DACON
00h
Port P0 Register
Port P1 Register
Port P0 Direction Register
Port P1 Direction Register
Port P2 Register
Port P3 Register
Port P2 Direction Register
Port P3 Direction Register
Port P4 Register
Port P5 Register
Port P4 Direction Register
Port P5 Direction Register
Port P6 Register
Port P7 Register
Port P6 Direction Register
Port P7 Direction Register
Port P8 Register
Port P9 Register
Port P8 Direction Register
Port P9 Direction Register
Port P10 Register
P0
P1
PD0
PD1
P2
P3
PD2
PD3
P4
P5
PD4
PD5
P6
P7
PD6
PD7
P8
P9
PD8
PD9
P10
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00h
00h
XXh
XXh
00X00000b
00h
XXh
Port P10 Direction Register
PD10
00h
Pull-up Control Register 0
PUR0
03FDh
Pull-up Control Register 1
PUR1
03FEh
03FFh
Pull-up Control Register 2
Port Control Register
PUR2
PCR
00h
00000000b (1)
00000010b
00h
00h
X: Undefined
NOTES:
1. At hardware reset, the register is as follows:
"00000000b" where "L" is input to the CNVSS pin
"00000010b" where "H" is input to the CNVSS pin
At software reset, watchdog timer reset and oscillation stop detection reset, the register is as follows:
"00000000b" where the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are "00b" (single-chip mode)
"00000010b" where the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are "01b" (memory expansion mode) or "11b" (microprocessor mode)
2. The blank areas are reserved and cannot be accessed by users.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 30 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
5. Reset
5. Reset
Hardware reset, software reset, watchdog timer reset and oscillation stop detection reset are available to
reset the microcomputer.
5.1 Hardware Reset
____________
The microcomputer resets pins, the CPU and SFR by setting the RESET pin. If the supply voltage meets
the recommended
operating conditions, the microcomputer
resets all pins when an “L” signal is applied to
___________
____________
the RESET pin (see Table 5.1 Pin Status When RESET Pin Level is “L”). The oscillation circuit is also
reset and the main
clock starts oscillation. The microcomputer resets the CPU and SFR when the signal
____________
applied to the RESET pin changes low (“L”) to high (“H”). The microcomputer executes the program in an
address indicated by the reset vector. The internal RAM is not reset. When an “L” signal is applied to the
____________
RESET pin while writing data to the internal RAM, the internal RAM is in an indeterminate state.
Figure 5.1 shows____________
an example of the reset circuit. Figure 5.2 shows a reset sequence. Table 5.1 lists pin
states while the RESET pin is held low (“L”).
5.1.1 Reset on a ____________
Stable Supply Voltage
(1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin
(2) Apply 20 or more____________
clock cycles to the XIN pin
(3) Apply “H” to the RESET pin
5.1.2 Power-on Reset
____________
(1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin
(2) Raise the supply voltage to the recommended operating level
(3) Insert td(P-R) ms as wait time for the internal voltage to stabilize
(4) Apply 20 or more____________
clock cycles to the XIN pin
(5) Apply “H” to the RESET pin
Recommended
operation
voltage
VCC
0V
RESET
VCC
RESET
0.2VCC or
below
0.2VCC or below
0V
Supply a clock with td(P-R) +20
or more cycles to the XIN pin
NOTE
1. Use the shortest possible wiring to connect external circuit.
Figure 5.1 Example Reset Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 31 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
5. Reset
VCC
XIN
td(P-R)
More than
20 cycles
are needed
RESET
BCLK
28cycles
BCLK
Microprocessor
mode BYTE = H
Content of reset vector
FFFFCh
Address
FFFFDh
FFFFEh
RD
WR
CS0
Microprocessor
mode BYTE = L
Content of reset vector
FFFFCh
Address
FFFFEh
RD
WR
CS0
Single-chip
mode
FFFFCh
Content of reset vector
FFFFEh
Address
Figure 5.2 Reset Sequence
____________
Table 5.1 Pin Status When RESET Pin Level is “L”
Status
Pin Name
CNVSS = VSS
P0
P1
P2, P3, P4_0 to P4_3
P4_4
P4_5 to P4_7
P5_0
P5_1
P5_2
P5_3
P5_4
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
P5_5
P5_6
P5_7
P6, P7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9, P10
Input port
Input port
Input port
Input port
CNVSS = VCC (1)
BYTE = VSS
BYTE = VCC
Data input
Data input
Data input
Input port
Address output (undefined) ______
Address output (undefined)
______
CS0 output (“H” is output)
CS0 output (“H” is output)
Input
port (Pulled high)
Input
port (Pulled high)
______
______
WR
output
(“H”
is
output)
WR
output
(“H” is output)
________
________
BHE
output (undefined)
BHE
output (undefined)
______
______
RD output (“H” is output)
RD output (“H” is output)
BCLK output
BCLK output
___________
___________
HLDA output
HLDA output
(The output value__________
depends on (The output value __________
depends on
the
input
to
the
HOLD
pin)
the
input
to
the
HOLD
pin)
__________
__________
HOLD input
HOLD input
ALE
output
(“L”
is
output)
ALE
output (“L” is output)
________
________
RDY input
RDY input
Input port
Input port
NOTE:
1. Shown here is the valid pin state when the internal power supply voltage has stabilized after power-on.
When CNVSS = VCC, the pin state is indeterminate until the internal power supply voltage stabilizes.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 32 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
5. Reset
5.2 Software Reset
The microcomputer resets pins, the CPU and SFR when the PM03 bit in the PM0 register is set to “1”
(microcomputer reset). Then the microcomputer executes the program in an address determined by the reset vector.
Set the PM03 bit to “1” while the main clock is selected as the CPU clock and the main clock oscillation is stable.
In the software reset, the microcomputer does not reset a part of the SFR. Refer to 4. Special Function
Register (SFR) for details.
Processor mode remains unchanged since the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are not reset.
5.3 Watchdog Timer Reset
The microcomputer resets pins, the CPU and SFR when the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to “1” (reset
when watchdog timer underflows) and the watchdog timer underflows. Then the microcomputer executes
the program in an address determined by the reset vector.
In the watchdog timer reset, the microcomputer does not reset a part of the SFR. Refer to 4. Special
Function Register (SFR) for details.
Processor mode remains unchanged since the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are not reset.
5.4 Oscillation Stop Detection Reset
The microcomputer resets and stops pins, the CPU and SFR when the CM27 bit in the CM2 register is “0”
(reset at oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection), if it detects main clock oscillation circuit stop. Refer to 8.5
Oscillation Stop and Re-Oscillation Detection Function for details.
In the oscillation stop detection reset, the microcomputer does not reset a part of the SFR. Refer to 4. Special
Function Register (SFR) for details.
Processor mode remains unchanged since the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are not reset.
5.5 Internal Space
Figure 5.3 shows CPU register status after reset. Refer to 4. Special Function Register (SFR) for SFR
states after reset.
b15
b0
0000h
Data Register (R0)
0000h
Data Register (R1)
0000h
Data Register (R2)
0000h
Data Register (R3)
0000h
Address Register (A0)
0000h
Address Register (A1)
0000h
Frame Base Register (FB)
b19
b0
Interrupt Table Register (INTB)
00000h
Content of addresses FFFFEh to FFFFCh
b15
b0
0000h
User Stack Pointer (USP)
0000h
Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP)
0000h
Static Base Register (SB)
b15
b0
0000h
b15
U
b0
I
O B S
Figure 5.3 CPU Register Status After Reset
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Flag Register (FLG)
b8 b7
IPL
page 33 of 376
Program Counter (PC)
Z
D C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
6. Processor Mode
6.1 Types of Processor Mode
Three processor modes are available to choose from: single-chip mode, memory expansion mode, and
microprocessor mode. Table 6.1 shows the features of these processor modes.
Table 6.1 Features of Processor Modes
Processor Mode
Access Space
Single-chip Mode
SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM
Memory Expansion Mode
Microprocessor Mode
NOTE:
1. Refer to 7. Bus.
SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM,
Pins Which are Assigned I/O Ports
All pins are I/O ports or
peripheral function I/O pins
Some pins serve as bus control pins (1)
external area (1)
SFR, internal RAM, external area (1)
Some pins serve as bus control pins (1)
6.2 Setting Processor Modes
Processor mode is set by using the CNVSS pin and the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register.
Table 6.2 shows the processor mode after hardware reset. Table 6.3 shows the PM01 to PM00 bits set
values and processor modes.
Table 6.2 Processor Mode After Hardware Reset
CNVSS Pin Input Level
Processor Mode
VSS
Single-chip mode
VCC (1) (2)
Microprocessor mode
NOTES:
1. If the microcomputer is reset in hardware by applying VCC to the CNVSS pin, the internal ROM
cannot be accessed regardless of PM01 to PM00 bits._____
2. The multiplexed bus cannot be assigned to the entire CS space.
Table 6.3 PM01 to PM00 Bits Set Values and Processor Modes
PM01 to PM 00 Bits
00b
01b
10b
11b
Processor Mode
Single-chip mode
Memory expansion mode
Do not set a value
Microprocessor mode
Rewriting the PM01 to PM00 bits places the microcomputer in the corresponding processor mode regardless of
whether the input level on the CNVSS pin is “H” or “L”. Note, however, that the PM01 to PM00 bits cannot
be rewritten to “01b” (memory expansion mode) or “11b” (microprocessor mode) at the same time the
PM07 to PM02 bits are rewritten. Note also that these bits cannot be rewritten to enter microprocessor
mode in the internal ROM, nor can they be rewritten to exit microprocessor mode in areas overlapping the
internal ROM.
If the microcomputer is reset in hardware by applying VCC to the CNVSS pin (hardware reset), the internal
ROM cannot be accessed regardless of PM01 to PM00 bits.
Figures 6.1 and 6.2 show the processor mode related registers.
Figure 6.3 shows the memory map in
_____
single-chip mode. Figures 6.4 to 6.7 show the memory map and CS area in memory expansion mode and
microprocessor mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 34 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
Processor Mode Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PM0
Bit symbol
Address
0004h
After reset (2)
00000000b (CNVSS pin = L)
00000011b (CNVSS pin = H)
Bit name
Function
RW
b1 b0
PM00
Processor Mode Bit (2)
PM01
0 0 : Single-chip mode
0 1 : Memory expansion mode
1 0 : Do not set a value
1 1 : Microprocessor mode
RW
RW
PM02
R/W Mode Select Bit (3)
0 : RD, BHE, WR
1 : RD, WRH, WRL
RW
PM03
Software Reset Bit
Setting this bit to "1" resets the
microcomputer. When read, its
.
content
is "0"
RW
b5 b4
0 0 : Multiplexed bus is unused
PM04
Multiplexed Bus Space
Select Bit (3)
PM05
PM06
PM07
RW
(Separate bus in the entire CS space)
0 1 : Allocated to CS2 space
1 0 : Allocated to CS1 space
RW
1 1 : Allocated to the entire CS space (4)
0 : Address output
Port P4_0 to P4_3 Function 1 : Port function
Select Bit (3)
(Address is not output)
0 : BCLK is output
BCLK Output Disable
1 : BCLK is not output
Bit (3)
(Pin is left high-impedance)
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. The PM01 to PM00 bits do not change at software reset, watchdog timer reset and oscillation stop detection reset.
3. Effective when the PM01 to PM00 bits are set to "01b" (memory expansion mode) or "11b" (microprocessor mode).
4. To set the PM01 to PM00 bits are "01b" and the PM05 to PM04 bits are "11b" (multiplexed bus assigned to
the entire CS space), apply an "H" signal to the BYTE pin (external data bus is 8-bit width).
While the CNVSS pin is held "H" (VCC), do not rewrite the PM05 to PM04 bits to "11b" after reset.
If the PM05 to PM04 bits are set to "11b" during memory expansion mode, P3_1 to P3_7 and P4_0 to P4_3
become I/O ports, in which case the accessible area for each CS is 256 bytes.
Figure 6.1 PM0 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 35 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
Processor Mode Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
0 0
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
PM1
Address
0005h
After reset
00001000b
Bit symbol
Bit name
PM10
CS2 Area Switch Bit
(Data Block Enable Bit) (2)
PM11
Port P3_7 to P3_4 Function 0 : Address output
1 : Port function
Select Bit (3)
PM12
Watchdog Timer Function
Select Bit
0 : Watchdog timer interrupt
1 : Watchdog timer reset (4)
RW
PM13
Internal Reserved Area
Expansion Bit (5)
Internal ROM area is:
0 : 192 Kbytes or smaller
1 : Expanded over 192 Kbytes
RW
(b6-b4)
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
PM17
Wait Bit (6)
0 : No wait state
1 : With wait state (1 wait)
RW
-
Function
RW
0 : 08000h to 26FFFh (Block A disable)
1 : 10000h to 26FFFh (Block A enable) RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. For the mask ROM version, this bit must be set to "0".
For the flash memory version, the PM10 bit also controls block A by enabling or disabling it. When the PM10
bit is set to "1", 0F000h to 0FFFFh (block A) can be used as internal ROM area.
In addition, the PM10 bit is automatically set to "1" when the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register is "1" (CPU rewrite
mode).
3. Effective when the PM01 to PM00 bits are set to "01b" (memory expansion mode) or "11b" (microprocessor mode).
4. The PM12 bit is set to "1" by writing a "1" in a program. (Writing a "0" has no effect.)
5. Be sure to set this bit to "0" except for products with internal ROM area over 192 Kbytes.
The PM13 bit is automatically set to "1" when the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register is "1" (CPU rewrite mode).
6. When the PM17 bit is set to "1" (with wait state), one wait state is inserted when accessing the internal RAM
or internal ROM.
When the PM17 bit is set to "1" and accesses an external area, set the CSiW bit (i = 0 to 3) in the CSR register
to "0" (with wait state).
Figure 6.2 PM1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 36 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
Single-chip mode
00000h
SFR
00400h
Internal RAM
XXXXXh
Cannot use
YYYYYh
Internal ROM
FFFFFh
PM13 bit in PM1 register = 0
Internal RAM
Internal ROM
Capacity Address XXXXXh Capacity Address YYYYYh
5 Kbytes
017FFh
128 Kbytes
E0000h
10 Kbytes
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
D0000h (1)
PM13 bit = 1
Internal RAM
Internal ROM
Capacity Address XXXXXh Capacity Address YYYYYh
5 Kbytes
017FFh
128 Kbytes
E0000h
10 Kbytes
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
C0000h
NOTES:
1. If the PM13 bit in the PM1 register is set to "0", 192 Kbytes of the internal ROM can be used.
2. For the mask ROM version, set the PM10 bit in the PM1 register to "0" (block A disabled,
addresses 08000h to 26FFFh for CS2 area).
Figure 6.3 Memory Map in Single-chip Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 37 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
When PM13 = 0 and PM10 = 0
Memory expansion mode
Microprocessor mode
00000h
SFR
SFR
Internal RAM
Internal RAM
Reserved area
Reserved area
00400h
XXXXXh
04000h
CS3 (16 Kbytes)
08000h
27000h
CS2 (124 Kbytes)
Reserved area
Reserved area
28000h
CS1 (32 Kbytes)
30000h
External area
External area
CS0
80000h
YYYYYh
Memory expansion mode: 320 Kbytes
Microprocessor mode: 832 Kbytes
Reserved area
Internal ROM
FFFFFh
Internal RAM
Capacity Address XXXXXh
Internal ROM
Capacity Address YYYYYh
128 Kbytes
E0000h
5 Kbytes
017FFh
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
D0000h (1)
10 Kbytes
NOTE:
1. If the PM13 bit in the PM1 register is set to "0", 192 Kbytes of the internal ROM can be used.
_____
Figure 6.4 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (1)
When PM13 = 1 and PM10 = 0
Memory expansion mode
Microprocessor mode
00000h
SFR
SFR
Internal RAM
Internal RAM
Reserved area
Reserved area
00400h
XXXXXh
08000h
27000h
CS2 (124 Kbytes)
Reserved area
Reserved area
28000h
CS1 (32 Kbytes)
30000h
External area
External area
CS0
80000h
YYYYYh
Memory expansion mode: 320 Kbytes
Microprocessor mode: 832 Kbytes
Reserved area
Internal ROM
FFFFFh
Internal RAM
Capacity Address XXXXXh
5 Kbytes
10 Kbytes
017FFh
02BFFh
Internal ROM
Capacity Address YYYYYh
128 Kbytes
256 Kbytes
E0000h
C0000h
_____
Figure 6.5 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 38 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
6. Processor Mode
When PM13 = 0 and PM10 = 1
Memory expansion mode
Microprocessor mode
00000h
SFR
SFR
Internal RAM
Internal RAM
Reserved area
Reserved area
08000h Reserved area (2)
10000h
Reserved area (2)
27000h Reserved area
28000h
Reserved area
00400h
XXXXXh
04000h
30000h
CS3 (16 Kbytes)
CS2 (92 Kbytes)
CS1 (32 Kbytes)
External area
External area
80000h
YYYYYh
CS0
Memory expansion mode: 320 Kbytes
Microprocessor mode: 832 Kbytes
Reserved area
Internal ROM
FFFFFh
Internal RAM
Capacity Address XXXXXh
Internal ROM
Capacity Address YYYYYh
128 Kbytes
E0000h
5 Kbytes
017FFh
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
D0000h (1)
10 Kbytes
NOTES:
1. If the PM13 bit in the PM1 register is set to "0", 192 Kbytes of the internal ROM can be used.
2. For the flash memory version, when the PM10 bit is set to "1", 0F000h to 0FFFFh (block A) can be
used as internal ROM area.
_____
Figure 6.6 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (3)
When PM13 = 1 and PM10 = 1
Memory expansion mode
Microprocessor mode
00000h
SFR
SFR
Internal RAM
Internal RAM
Reserved
area (1)
Reserved
area (1)
Reserved area
Reserved area
00400h
XXXXXh
10000h
27000h
CS2 (92 Kbytes)
28000h
CS1 (32 Kbytes)
30000h
External area
External area
CS0
80000h
YYYYYh
Reserved area
Memory expansion mode: 320 Kbytes
Microprocessor mode: 832 Kbytes
Internal ROM
FFFFFh
Internal RAM
Capacity Address XXXXXh
Internal ROM
Capacity Address YYYYYh
128 Kbytes
5 Kbytes
017FFh
E0000h
10 Kbytes
02BFFh
256 Kbytes
C0000h
NOTE:
1. For the flash memory version, when the PM10 bit is set to "1", 0F000h to 0FFFFh (block A)
can be used as internal ROM area.
_____
Figure 6.7 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 39 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
7. Bus
During memory expansion or microprocessor mode, some pins serve as the bus control pins to perform
data
_______
_______
input/output
to and from external devices.
These bus control pins include A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3,
_____ ________ ______ ________ ________
________ __________ _________
RD, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, ALE, RDY, HOLD, HLDA and BCLK.
7.1 Bus Mode
The bus mode, either multiplexed or separate, can be selected using the PM05 to PM04 bits in the PM0
register.
7.1.1 Separate Bus
In this bus mode, data and address are separate.
7.1.2 Multiplexed Bus
In this bus mode, data and address are multiplexed.
7.1.2.1 When the input level on BYTE pin is high (8-bit data bus)
D0 to D7 and A0 to A7 are multiplexed.
7.1.2.2 When the input level on BYTE pin is low (16-bit data bus)
D0 to D7 and A1 to A8 are multiplexed. D8 to D15 are not multiplexed. Do not use D8 to D15.
External devices connecting to a multiplexed bus are allocated to only the even addresses of the
microcomputer. Odd addresses cannot be accessed.
Table 7.1 shows the difference between a separate bus and multiplexed bus.
Table 7.1 Difference between Separate Bus and Multiplexed Bus
Pin Name
(1)
Separate Bus
Multiplexed Bus
BYTE = H
BYTE = L
P0_0 to P0_7/D0 to D7
D0 to D7
(NOTE 2)
(NOTE 2)
P1_0 to P1_7/D8 to D15
D8 to D15
I/O Port
P1_0 to P1_7
(NOTE 2)
P2_0/A0(/D0/-)
A0
P2_1 to P2_7/A1 to A7
(/D1 to D7/D0 to D6)
P3_0/A8(/-/D7)
A0
D0
A1 to A7
A1 to A7 D1 to D7
A8
A8
A0
A1 to A7 D0 to D6
A8
D7
NOTES :
1. See Table 7.6 Pin Functions for Each Processor Mode for bus control signals other than the above.
2. It changes with a setup of PM05 to PM04, and area to access. See Table 7.6 Pin Functions for Each
Processor Mode for details.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 40 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
7.2 Bus Control
The following describes the signals needed for accessing external devices and the functionality of software
wait.
Table 7.2 PM06 and PM11 Bits Set Value and
Address Bus Width
7.2.1 Address Bus
The address bus consists of 20 lines, A0 to A19.
The address bus width can be chosen to be 12,
16 or 20 bits by using the PM06 bit in the PM0
register and the PM11 bit in the PM1 register.
Table 7.2 shows the PM06 and PM11 bits set
values and address bus widths.
When processor mode is changed from single-chip
mode to memory expansion mode, the address
bus is indeterminate until any external area is
accessed.
Set Value
(1)
Pin Function Address Bus Width
PM11 = 1
PM06 = 1
P3_4 to P3_7 12 bits
P4_0 to P4_3
PM11 = 0
A12 to A15
PM06 = 1
P4_0 to P4_3
16 bits
PM11 = 0
A12 to A15
20 bits
PM06 = 0
A16 to A19
NOTE:
1. No values other than those shown above can
be set.
7.2.2 Data Bus
When input on the BYTE pin is high (data bus is an 8-bit width), 8 lines D0 to D7 comprise the data bus;
when input on the BYTE pin is low (data bus is a 16-bit width), 16 lines D0 to D15 comprise the data bus.
Do not change the input level on the BYTE pin while in operation.
7.2.3 Chip Select Signal
_____
______
The chip select (hereafter referred to as the CS) signals
are output from the CSi (i = 0 to 3) pins. These
_____
pins can be chosen to function as I/O ports or as CS by using the CSi bit in the CSR register.
Figure 7.1 shows the CSR register.
______
During 1 ______
Mbyte mode, the external area can be separated into up to 4 by the CSi signal which is output
from the CSi pin.
______
Figure 7.2 shows the example of address bus and CSi signal output.
Chip Select Control Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CSR
Bit Symbol
Address
0008h
Bit Name
CS0
CS0 Output Enable Bit
CS1
CS1 Output Enable Bit
CS2
CS3
CS2 Output Enable Bit
CS3 Output Enable Bit
CS0W
CS0 Wait Bit
CS1W
CS1 Wait Bit
CS2 Wait Bit
CS2W
After Reset
00000001b
Function
0 : Chip select output disabled
(functions as I/O port)
1 : Chip select output enabled
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
0 : With wait state
1 : Without wait state (1) (2) (3)
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Where the RDY signal is used in the area indicated by CSi (i = 0 to 3) or the multiplexed bus is used, set the
CSiW bit to "0" (Wait state).
2. If the PM17 bit in the PM1 register is set to "1" (with wait state), set the CSiW bit to "0" (with wait state).
3. When the CSiW bit = 0 (with wait state), the number of wait states (in terms of clock cycles) can be selected
using the CSEi1W to CSEi0W bits in the CSE register.
CS3W
Figure 7.1 CSR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 41 of 376
CS3 Wait Bit
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
Example 1
Example 2
To access the external area indicated by CSj in the next cycle
after accessing the external area indicated by CSi.
To access the internal ROM or internal RAM in the next cycle
after accessing the external area indicated by CSi.
The address bus and the chip select signal both change state
between these two cycles.
The chip s elect s ignal c hanges state but the address bus
does not change state.
Access to the external
area indicated by CSi
Access to the external
area indicated by CSi
Access to the external
area indicated by CSj
BCLK
BCLK
Read signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Data
Data bus
Data
Address Address
Address bus
Access to the internal
ROM or internal RAM
Data
Address
CSi
CSi
CSj
Example 3
Example 4
To a ccess the external area indicated by CSi in the next cycle
after accessing the external area indicated by the same CSi.
Not to access any area (nor instruction prefetch generated)
in the next cycle after accessing the external area indicated
by CSi.
The address bus changes state but t he c hip select signal
does not change state.
Neither the address bus nor the chip select signal changes
state between these two cycles.
Access to the external
area indicated by CSi
Access to the external
area indicated by CSi
Access to the same
external area
BCLK
BCLK
Read signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Data
Data bus
Data
Address Address
Address bus
CSi
No access
Data
Address
CSi
NOTE:
1. These examples show the address bus and chip select signal when accessing areas in two successive cycles. The chip select bus cycle may be
extended more than two cycles depending on a combination of these examples.
Shown above is the case where separate bus is selected and the area is accessed for read without wait states. i = 0 to 3, j = 0 to 3 (not including i, however)
______
Figure 7.2 Example of Address Bus and CSi Signal Output
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 42 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
7.2.4 Read and Write Signals
_____
When
the________
data bus is 16-bit width, _____
the read
and write
signals can be chosen to be a combination of RD,
______
________
________
WR and BHE or a combination of RD, WRL and _____
WRH
by using
the PM02 bit in the PM0 register. When
______
________
the data bus is 8-bit width, use a _____
combination
of_________
RD, WR and BHE.
________
_____ ______
Table
7.3
shows
the
operation
of
RD,
WRL,
and
WRH
signals.
Table
7.4
shows
the
operation
of
RD,
WR,
________
and BHE signals.
_____
________
_________
Table 7.3 Operation _____
of RD, WRL and
WRH Signals
________
_________
Data Bus Width
RD
WRL
WRH
16 Bits
L
H
H
(BYTE pin
H
L
H
input = L)
H
H
L
L
L
H
_____
______
Status of External Data Bus
Read data
Write 1 byte of data to an even address
Write 1 byte of data to an odd address
Write data to both even and odd addresses
________
Table 7.4 Operation
of RD, WR
and BHE
Signals
_____
______
________
Data Bus Width
RD
WR
BHE
A0
H
H
L
L
16 Bits
H
L
H
L
(BYTE pin
L
H
L
H
input = L)
L
L
H
H
L
H
L
L
L
L
L
H
8 Bits
H
to
L
H
L
Not used
(BYTE pin input = H)
L
H
Not used H to L
Status of External Data Bus
Write 1 byte of data to an odd address
Read 1 byte of data from an odd address
Write 1 byte of data to an even address
Read 1 byte of data from an even address
Write data to both even and odd addresses
Read data from both even and odd addresses
Write 1 byte of data
Read 1 byte of data
7.2.5 ALE Signal
The ALE signal latches the address when accessing the multiplexed bus space. Latch the address when
the ALE signal falls. Figure 7.3 shows the ALE signal, address bus and data bus.
When BYTE pin input = H
When BYTE pin input = L
ALE
A0/D0 to A7/D7
A8 to A19
ALE
Address
Data
Address (1)
Address
A0
A1/D0 to A8/D7
Address
A9 to A19
NOTE:
1. If the entire CS space is assigned a multiplexed bus, these pins function as I/O ports.
Figure 7.3 ALE Signal, Address Bus, Data Bus
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 43 of 376
Data
Address
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
________
7.2.6 RDY Signal
This________
signal is provided for accessing external devices which need to be accessed at low speed. If input on
the RDY pin is asserted low at the last falling edge of BCLK of the bus cycle, one wait state is inserted
in
________
the bus cycle. While in a wait state, the following signals retain the state in which they were when the RDY
signal was acknowledged.
_______
_______
_____
________
________
______
________
__________
A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL, WRH, WR, BHE, ALE, HLDA
________
Then, when the input on the RDY pin is detected high at the falling edge of BCLK, the remaining bus cycle
is
executed. Figure 7.4 ________
shows example in which the wait state was inserted into the read cycle by the
________
RDY signal. To use the RDY signal, set the________
corresponding bit
(CS3W to CS0W bits) in the CSR register
________
to “0” (with wait state). When not using the RDY signal, the RDY pin must be pulled-up.
In an instance of separate bus
BCLK
RD
CSi
(i=0 to 3)
RDY
tsu(RDY - BCLK)
Accept timing of RDY signal
In an instance of multiplexed bus
BCLK
RD
CSi
(i=0 to 3)
RDY
tsu(RDY - BCLK)
: Wait using RDY signal
Accept timing of RDY signal
: Wait using software
tsu(RDY-BCLK): RDY input setup time
Shown above is the case where CSEi1W to CSEi0W (i = 0 to 3) bits in the CSE register are
"00b" (one wait state).
________
Figure 7.4 Example in which Wait State was Inserted into Read Cycle by RDY Signal
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 44 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
__________
7.2.7 HOLD Signal
This__________
signal is used to transfer control of the bus from CPU or DMAC to an external circuit. When the input
on HOLD pin is pulled low, the microcomputer is placed in a hold state
after the bus access then in
__________
process finishes.
The microcomputer remains in a hold state while the HOLD pin is held low, during which
__________
time the HLDA pin outputs a low-level signal.
Table 7.5 shows the microcomputer
status in the hold state.
__________
Bus-using priorities are given to HOLD, DMAC, and CPU in order of decreasing precedence (see Figure
7.5 Bus-using Priorities). However, if the CPU is accessing an odd address in word units, the DMAC
cannot gain control of the bus during two separate accesses.
__________
HOLD > DMAC > CPU
Figure 7.5 Bus-using Priorities
Table 7.5 Microcomputer Status in Hold State
Item
BCLK
_______
_______ ______ _________ _________
A0
to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL, WRH,
______ ________
WR, BHE
I/O Ports
P0, P1, P3, P4 (1)
P6 to P10
__________
HLDA
Internal Peripheral Circuits
ALE Signal
Status
Output
High-impedance
High-impedance
Maintains status when hold signal is received
Output “L”
ON (but watchdog timer stops (2))
Undefined
NOTES:
1. When I/O port function is selected.
2. The watchdog timer does not stop when the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to “1” (the count source
for the watchdog timer is the on-chip oscillator clock).
7.2.8 BCLK Output
If the PM07 bit in the PM0 register is set to “0” (output enable), a clock with the same frequency as that
of the CPU clock is output as BCLK from the BCLK pin. Refer to 8.2 CPU Clock and Peripheral Function
Clock.
Table 7.6 shows the pin functions for each processor mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 45 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
Table 7.6 Pin Functions for Each Processor Mode
Processor Mode
Memory Expansion Mode or Microprocessor Mode
Memory Expansion Mode
_______
PM05 to PM04 Bits
00b (separate bus)
Data Bus Width
8 bits
BYTE Pin
P0_0 to P0_7
P1_0 to P1_7
P2_0
P2_1 to P2_7
“H”
D0 to D7
I/O ports
A0
A1 to A7
01b (CS2 is for multiplexed bus and
11b
others
_______ are for separate bus)
(multiplexed bus for
10b (CS1 is for multiplexed bus and
the entire space) (1)
others are for separate bus)
16 bits
“L”
D8 to D15
8 bits
“H”
D0 to D7
I/O ports
A0/D0 (2)
A1 to A7
/D1 to D7
P3_0
A8
P3_1 to P3_3
A9 to A11
P3_4
PM11 = 0 A12 to A15
to P3_7
P4_0
to P4_3
PM11 = 1 I/O ports
PM06 = 0 A16 to A19
PM06 = 1 I/O ports
P4_4
CS0 = 0
I/O
ports
_______
CS0 = 1
CS0
P4_6
CS1 = 0
CS1 = 1
CS2 = 0
I/O
ports
_______
CS1
I/O
ports
_______
P4_7
CS2 = 1
CS3 = 0
CS2
I/O
ports
_______
P4_5
P5_0
P5_1
P5_2
P5_3
P5_4
P5_5
P5_6
CS3 = 1 CS3
_______
PM02 = 0 WR
(3)
PM02 = 1 ________
PM02 = 0 BHE
(3)
PM02 = 1 _____
RD
BCLK
__________
HLDA
__________
HOLD
ALE
________
16 bits
8 bits
“L”
“H”
I/O ports
I/O ports
A0/D0
A1 to A7/D1 to D7
(4)
(2)
D8 to D15
A0
A1 to A7
(4)
/D0 to D6
A8/D7 (2)
(2)
A8
I/O ports
I/O ports
I/O ports
________
WRL
________
-
(3)
-
(3)
_________
WRH
WRL
-
(3)
-
(3)
_________
WRH
P5_7
RDY
I/O ports: Function as I/O ports or peripheral function I/O pins.
NOTES:
1. For setting the PM01 to PM00 bits to “01b” (memory
expansion mode) and the PM05 to PM04 bits to
_____
“11b” (multiplexed bus assigned to the entire CS space), apply “H” to the BYTE pin (external data bus is
an 8-bit width). While the CNVSS pin is held “H” (VCC), do not rewrite the PM05 to PM04 bits to “11b”
after reset. If the PM05 to PM04 bits are set to “11b” during memory expansion mode,
P3_1 to P3_7
_____
and P4_0 to P4_3 become I/O ports, in which case the accessible area for each CS is 256 bytes.
2. In separate bus mode, these pins serve as the address bus.
_____ ________ ______
3. If the data bus is 8-bit width, make sure the PM02 bit is set to “0” (RD, BHE, WR).
4. When accessing the area that uses a multiplexed bus, these pins output an indeterminate value during
a write.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 46 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
7.2.9 External Bus Status When Internal Area Accessed
Table 7.7 shows the external bus status when the internal area is accessed.
Table 7.7 External Bus Status When Internal Area Accessed
Item
SFR Accessed
Internal ROM, Internal RAM Accessed
A0 to A19
D0 to D15 When read High-impedance
Maintain status before accessed address
of external area or SFR
High-impedance
When write Output
data
_____ ______ ________ _________
_____ ______ _________ __________
RD,
WR,
WRL,
WRH
RD,
WR,
WRL, WRH output
________
________
BHE
BHE output
Undefined
Output “H”
Maintain status before accessed status of
_______
Address output
external area or SFR
Output “H”
Output “L”
_______
CS0 to CS3
ALE
Output “H”
Output “L”
7.2.10 Software Wait
Software wait states can be inserted by using the PM17 bit in the PM1 register, the CS0W to CS3W bits
in the CSR register, and the CSE register. The SFR area is unaffected by these control bits. This area is
always accessed in 2 BCLK or 3 BCLK cycles as determined by the PM20 bit in the PM2 register. See
Table 7.8 ________
Bit and Bus Cycle Related to Software Wait for details.
To use the RDY signal, set the corresponding CS3W to CS0W bit to “0” (with wait state). Figure 7.6 shows
the CSE register. Table 7.8 shows the software wait related bits and bus cycles. Figures 7.7 and 7.8 show
the typical bus timings using software wait.
Chip Select Expansion Control Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CSE
Bit Symbol
Address
001Bh
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
RW
b1 b0
CSE00W
CS0 Wait Expansion Bit (1)
CSE01W
0 0 : 1 wait
0 1 : 2 waits
1 0 : 3 waits
1 1 : Do not set a value
RW
RW
b3 b2
CSE10W
CS1 Wait Expansion Bit (1)
CSE11W
0 0 : 1 wait
0 1 : 2 waits
1 0 : 3 waits
1 1 : Do not set a value
RW
RW
b5 b4
CS20WE
CS2 Wait Expansion Bit
(1)
CSE21W
0 0 : 1 wait
0 1 : 2 waits
1 0 : 3 waits
1 1 : Do not set a value
RW
RW
b7 b6
CSE30W
CS3 Wait Expansion Bit
CSE31W
(1)
0 0 : 1 wait
0 1 : 2 waits
1 0 : 3 waits
1 1 : Do not set a value
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. Set the CSiW bit (i = 0 to 3) in the CSR register to "0" (with wait state) before writing to the CSEi1W to CSEi0W
bits. If the CSiW bit needs to be set to "1" (without wait state), set the CSEi1W to CSEi0W bits to "00b" before
setting it.
Figure 7.6 CSE Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 47 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
Table 7.8 Software Wait Related Bits and Bus Cycles
CSR Register CSE Register
Area
Bus Mode PM2 Register PM1 Register
(5)
PM20 Bit PM17 Bit
CS3W
CS2W
CS1W
CS0W
Bit
Bit
Bit
Bit
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
CS31W to CS30W Bits
CS21W to CS20W Bits Software
CS11W to CS10W Bits Wait
CS01W to CS00W Bits
Bus Cycle
SFR
-
0
-
-
-
1
-
-
0
-
Internal
-
-
-
ROM, RAM
-
-
1
-
0
1
00b
-
-
0
00b
1 wait
-
0
01b
-
-
0
10b
2 waits 3 BCLK cycles
3 waits 4 BCLK cycles
-
1
2 BCLK cycles
-
00b
00b
1 wait
-
0
0
1 wait
3 BCLK cycles
-
0
01b
2 waits 3 BCLK cycles
-
-
0
10b
3 waits 4 BCLK cycles
-
1
0
00b
1 wait
External Separate
Area
Bus
Multiplexed
Bus
(2)
-
3 BCLK cycles
(4)
2 BCLK cycles (4)
No wait 1 BCLK cycle (3)
1 wait
2 BCLK cycles
No wait 1 BCLK cycle (read)
2 BCLK cycles (write)
2 BCLK cycles
(3)
3 BCLK cycles
NOTES:
________
1. To use the RDY signal, set this bit to “0 ”.
2. To access in multiplexed bus mode, set the corresponding bit of CS0W to CS3W to “0” (with wait state).
3. After reset, the PM17 bit is set to “0” (without wait state), all of the CS0W_______
to CS3W
bits are set to “0”
_______
(with wait state), and the CSE register is set to “00h” (one wait state for CS0 to CS3). Therefore, the
internal RAM and internal ROM are accessed with no wait state, and all external areas are accessed
with one wait state.
4. When the selected CPU clock source is the PLL clock, the number of wait cycles can be altered by the
PM20 bit in the PM2 register. When using PLL clock over 16 MHz, be sure to set the PM20 bit to “0”
(2 wait cycles).
5. When the PM17 bit is set to “1” and access an external area, set the CSiW bits (i = 0 to 3) to “0” (with
wait sate).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 48 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
(1) Separate bus, No wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Output
Address
Input
Address
CS
(2) Separate bus, 1-wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Output
Input
Address
Address
CS
(3) Separate bus, 2-wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Data bus
Address bus
Output
Address
Input
Address
CS
NOTE:
1. These example timing charts indicate bus cycle length. After this bus cycle sometimes come read and
write cycles in succession.
Figure 7.7 Typical Bus Timings Using Software Wait (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 49 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
7. Bus
(1) Separate bus, 3-wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
Data bus
Input
Output
Address
Address bus
Address
CS
(2)Multiplexed bus, 1- or 2-wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
ALE
Address bus/
Data bus
Address
Address
Address bus
Address
Data output
Address
Input
CS
(3)Multiplexed bus, 3-wait setting
Bus cycle (1)
Bus cycle (1)
BCLK
Write signal
Read signal
ALE
Address bus
Address bus/
Data bus
Address
Address
Address
Data output
Address
Input
CS
NOTE:
1. These example timing charts indicate bus cycle length. After this bus cycle sometimes come read and
write cycles in succession.
Figure 7.8 Typical Bus Timings Using Software Wait (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 50 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.1 Types of Clock Generating Circuit
Four circuits are incorporated to generate the system clock signal:
• Main clock oscillation circuit
• Sub clock oscillation circuit
• On-chip oscillator
• PLL frequency synthesizer
Table 8.1 lists the clock generating circuit specifications. Figure 8.1 shows the clock generating circuit.
Figures 8.2 to 8.8 show the clock-related registers.
Table 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit Specifications
Main Clock
Oscillation Circuit
• CPU clock source
Sub Clock
Oscillation Circuit
• CPU clock source
Frequency
• CPU clock source
• Peripheral function
• Peripheral function
• Peripheral function • Clock source of Timer clock source
A, B
clock source
• CPU and peripheral clock source
function clock sources
when the main clock
stops oscillating
16 MHz, 20 MHz,
32.768
kHz
0 to 16 MHz
About 1 MHz
24 MHz (1)
Usable
•Ceramic oscillator
•Crystal oscillator
-
-
XCIN, XCOUT
-
-
Oscillation Stop Available
and Re-Oscillation
Detection Function
Available
Available
Available
Oscillation Status Oscillating
After Reset
Stopped
Stopped
Stopped
-
-
Item
Use of Clock
Clock
Oscillator
•Crystal oscillator
Pins to Connect XIN, XOUT
On-chip Oscillator
PLL Frequency
Synthesizer
• CPU clock source
Oscillator
Other
Externally derived clock can be input
NOTE:
1. 24 MHz is available Normal-ver. only.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 51 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Sub clock oscillation circuit
XCIN
I/O ports
XCOUT
CM04
CM01-CM00=00b
PM01-PM00=00b, CM01-CM00=01b
PM01-PM00=00b, CM01-CM00=10b
fC32
1/32
Sub clock
CLKOUT
PM01-PM00=00b,
CM01-CM00=11b
fC
fCAN0
Divider
By CCLK0,1 and 2
fCAN1
Divider
By CCLK4,5 and 6
f1
PCLK0=1
f2
PCLK0=0
f8
f32
On-chip
oscillator
CM21
On-chip oscillator
clock
PCLK0=1
fAD
PCLK0=0
f1SIO
Oscillation stop,
re-oscillation
detection circuit
CM10=1
(stop mode)
f2SIO
PCLK1=1
PCLK1=0
f8SIO
f32SIO
S Q
XIN
XOUT
PLL frequency
synthesizer
R
Main clock
CM05
PLL clock
b
a
CM21=1
c
d
CPU clock
fC
CM21=0
Main clock
oscillation circuit
CM07=0
e
Divider
1
0
BCLK
CM07=1
CM11
CM02
S Q
WAIT instruction
R
c
b
1/2
a
RESET
Software reset
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/4
d
1/2
1/8
1/2
NMI
CM06=0 CM06=1
CM06=0 CM17-CM16=10b
CM06=0 CM17-CM16=01b
CM17-CM16=00b
Interrupt request level
judgment output
PM00, PM01
CM00, CM01, CM02, CM04, CM05, CM06, CM07
CM10, CM11, CM16, CM17
PCLK0, PCLK1
CM21, CM27
CCLK0 to CCLK2, CCLK4 to CCLK6
: Bits in PM0 register
: BIts in CM0 register
: Bits in CM1 register
: Bits in PCLKR register
: Bits in CM2 register
: Bits in CCLKR register
1/32
1/16
CM06=0
CM17-CM16=11b
e
Details of divider
Oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection circuit
Main clock
Pulse generating circuit
for clock edge detection
and charge,
discharge control
Charge,
discharge
circuit
CM27 = 0 Reset
generating
circuit
Oscillation stop
detection reset
Oscillation stop,
CM27 = 1 re-oscillation detection
interrupt generating
circuit
Oscillation stop,
re-oscillation detection
interrupt signal
CM21 switch signal
PLL frequency synthesizer
Programmable
counter
Main clock
Phase
comparator
Charge
pump
Voltage
control
oscillator
(VCO)
Internal
lowpass filter
Figure 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 52 of 376
1/2
PLL clock
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
System Clock Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
CM0
0006h
01001000b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
b1 b0
Clock Output Function
Select Bit
(Valid only in single-chip
mode)
0 0 : I/O port P5_7
0 1 : fC output
1 0 : f8 output
1 1 : f32 output
CM02
WAIT Mode Peripheral
Function Clock Stop Bit
0 : Do not stop peripheral function
clock in wait mode
1 : Stop peripheral function clock
in wait mode (2)
RW
CM03
XCIN-XCOUT Drive
Capacity Select Bit (3)
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
RW
CM04
Port XC Select Bit (3)
0 : I/O port P8_6, P8_7
1 : XCIN-XCOUT generation
function (4)
RW
CM05
0 : On
Main Clock Stop Bit (5) (6) (7) 1 : Off (8) (9)
RW
CM06
Main Clock Division Select 0 : CM16 and CM17 valid
Bit 0 (7) (10) (12)
1 : Divide-by-8 mode
RW
CM07
System Clock Select
Bit (6) (11)
CM00
CM01
0 : Main clock, PLL clock,
or on-chip oscillator clock
1 : Sub clock
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. The fC32 clock does not stop. During low-speed or low power dissipation mode, do not set this bit to "1"
(peripheral clock turned off when in wait mode).
3. The CM03 bit is set to "1" (high) while the CM04 bit is set to "0" (I/O port) or when entered to stop mode.
4. To use a sub clock, set this bit to "1". Also make sure ports P8_6 and P8_7 are directed for input, with no
pull-ups.
5. This bit is provided to stop the main clock when the low power dissipation mode or on-chip oscillator low
power dissipation mode is selected. This bit cannot be used for detection as to whether the main clock stopped
or not. To stop the main clock, set bits in the following order.
(1) Set the CM07 bit to "1" (sub clock select) or the CM21 bit in the CM2 register to "1" (on-chip oscillator select)
with the sub clock stably oscillating.
(2) Set the CM20 bit in the CM2 register to "0" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function disabled).
(3) Set the CM05 bit to "1" (stop).
6. To use the main clock as the clock source for the CPU clock, set bits in the following order.
(1) Set the CM05 bit to "0" (oscillate)
(2) Wait until the main clock oscillation stabilizes.
(3) Set the CM11, CM21 and CM07 bits all to "0".
7. When the CM21 bit = 0 (on-chip oscillator turned off) and the CM05 bit = 1 (main clock turned off), the CM06
bit is fixed to "1" (divide-by-8 mode) and the CM15 bit is fixed to "1" (drive capability High).
8. During external clock input, set the CM05 bit to "0" (oscillate).
9. When the CM05 bit is set to "1", the XOUT pin goes "H". Furthermore, because the internal feedback resistor
remains connected, the XIN pin is pulled "H" to the same level as XOUT via the feedback resistor.
10. When entering stop mode from high- or medium-speed mode, on-chip oscillator mode or on-chip oscillator
low power dissipation mode, the CM06 bit is set to "1" (divide-by-8 mode).
11. After setting the CM04 bit to "1" (XCIN-XCOUT oscillator function), wait until the sub clock oscillates stably
before switching the CM07 bit from "0" to "1" (sub clock).
12. To return from on-chip oscillator mode to high-speed or medium-speed mode, set the CM06 and CM15 bits
both to "1".
Figure 8.2 CM0 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 53 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
System Clock Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
CM1
0007h
00100000b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
CM10
All Clock Stop Control
Bit (2) (3)
0 : Clock on
1 : All clocks off (stop mode)
RW
CM11
System Clock Select Bit 1 (4)
0 : Main clock
1 : PLL clock (5)
RW
(b4-b2)
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
CM15
XIN-XOUT Drive Capacity
Select Bit (6)
0 : LOW
1 : HIGH
RW
-
b7 b6
CM16
CM17
Main Clock Division
Select Bit 1 (7)
0 0 : No division mode
0 1 : Divide-by-2 mode
1 0 : Divide-by-4 mode
1 1 : Divide-by-16 mode
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable)
2. If the CM10 bit is "1" (stop mode), XOUT goes "H" and the internal feedback resistor is disconnected.
The XCIN and XCOUT pins are placed in the high-impedance state. When the CM11 bit is set to "1" (PLL
clock), or the CM20 bit in the CM2 register is set to "1" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function enabled),
do not set the CM10 bit to "1".
3. When the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to "1" (watchdog timer count source is on-chip oscillator clock),
writing to the CM10 bit has no effect.
4. Effective when the CM07 bit is "0" and the CM21 bit is "0".
5. After setting the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to "1" (PLL operation), wait until tsu(PLL) elapses before
setting the CM11 bit to "1" (PLL clock).
6. When entering stop mode from high- or medium-speed mode, or when the CM05 bit is set to "1" (main clock
turned off) in low-speed mode, the CM15 bit is set to "1" (drive capability high).
7. Effective when the CM06 bit is "0" (CM16 and CM17 bits enabled).
Figure 8.3 CM1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 54 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Oscillation Stop Detection Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
CM2
000Ch
0X000000b (2)
Bit Symbol
Function
Bit Name
RW
CM20
Oscillation Stop,
Re-Oscillation Detection
Enable Bit (2) (3) (4)
0 : Oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection function disabled
1 : Oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection function enabled
RW
CM21
System Clock Select
Bit 2 (2) (5) (6) (7) (8) (11)
0 : Main clock or PLL clock
1 : On-chip oscillator clock
(On-chip oscillator oscillating)
RW
CM22
Oscillation Stop,
Re-Oscillation Detection
Flag (9)
CM23
XIN Monitor Flag (10)
0 : Main clock stop, re-oscillation
not detected
1 : Main clock stop, re-oscillation
detected
0 : Main clock oscillating
1 : Main clock turned off
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
-
(b5-b4)
(b6)
CM27
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
0 : Oscillation stop detection reset
Operation Select Bit
(behavior if oscillation stop, 1 : Oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection interrupt
re-oscillation is detected) (2)
RW
RO
RW
-
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. The CM20, CM21 and CM27 bits do not change at oscillation stop detection reset.
3. Set the CM20 bit to "0" (disable) before entering stop mode. After exiting stop mode, set the CM20 bit back
to "1" (enable).
4. Set the CM20 bit to "0" (disable) before setting the CM05 bit in the CM0 register.
5. When the CM20 bit is "1" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function enabled), the CM27 bit is "1"
(oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt), and the CPU clock source is the main clock, the CM21 bit
is set to "1" (on-chip oscillator clock) if the main clock stop is detected.
6. If the CM20 bit is "1" and the CM23 bit is "1" (main clock turned off), do not set the CM21 bit to "0".
7. Effective when the CM07 bit in the CM0 register is "0".
8. Where the CM20 bit is "1" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function enabled), the CM27 bit is "1"
(oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt), and the CM11 bit is "1" (the CPU clock source is PLL clock),
the CM21 bit remains unchanged even when main clock stop is detected. If the CM22 bit is "0" under these
conditions, an oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt request is generated at main clock stop detection;
it is, therefore, necessary to set the CM21 bit to "1" (on-chip oscillator clock) inside the interrupt routine.
9. This bit is set to "1" when the main clock is detected to have stopped and when the main clock is detected to
have restarted oscillating. When this bit changes state from "0" to "1", an oscillation stop and re-oscillation
detection interrupt request is generated. Use this bit in an interrupt routine to discriminate the causes of
interrupts between the oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection interrupt and the watchdog timer interrupt.
This bit is set to "0" by writing "0" in a program. (Writing "1" has no effect. Nor is it set to "0" by an oscillation
stop and re-oscillation detection interrupt request acknowledged.)
If an oscillation stop or a re-oscillation is detected when the CM22 bit = 1, no oscillation stop and re-oscillation
detection interrupt requests are generated.
10. Read the CM23 bit in an oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection interrupt handling routine to determine
the main clock status.
11. When the CM21 bit = 0 (on-chip oscillator turned off) and the CM05 bit = 1 (main clock turned off), the CM06
bit is fixed to "1" (divide-by-8 mode) and the CM15 bit is fixed to "1" (drive capability High).
Figure 8.4 CM2 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 55 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Peripheral Clock Select Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PCLKR
0 0 0 0 0 0
Address
025Eh
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Bit Symbol
Function
RW
PCLK0
Timers A, B, and A/D Clock
0 : Divide-by-2 of fAD, f2
Select Bit
1 : fAD, f1
(Clock source for the timers A, B,
the dead time timer and A/D)
RW
PCLK1
0 : f2SIO
SI/O Clock Select Bit
(Clock source for UART0 to UART2, 1 : f1SIO
SI/O3)
RW
Set to "0"
RW
(b7-b2)
Reserved Bit
NOTE:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
Figure 8.5 PCLKR Register
CAN0/1 Clock Select Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
CCLKR
025Fh
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
CCLK0
CCLK1
CAN0 Clock Select Bits (2)
CCLK2
CCLK3
0 0 0 No division
0 0 1 : Divide-by-2
0 1 0 : Divide-by-4
0 1 1 : Divide-by-8
1 0 0: Divide-by-16
101:
110:
Do not set a value
111:
CAN0 CPU Interface
Sleep Bit (3)
0: CAN0 CPU interface operating
1: CAN0 CPU interface in sleep
CAN1 Clock Select Bits (2)
0 0 0 No division
0 0 1 : Divide-by-2
0 1 0 : Divide-by-4
0 1 1 : Divide-by-8
1 0 0 : Divide-by-16
101:
110:
Do not set a value
111:
RW
RW
RW
RW
b6 b5 b4
CCLK4
CCLK5
CCLK6
CCLK7
CAN1 CPU Interface
Sleep Bit (3)
0: CAN1 CPU interface operating
1: CAN1 CPU interface in sleep
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (Write enabled).
2. Set only when the Reset bit in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1) = 1 (Reset/Initialization mode).
3. Before setting this bit to "1", set the Sleep bit in the CiCTLR to "1" (Sleep mode enabled).
Figure 8.6 CCLKR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 56 of 376
RW
RW
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Processor Mode Register 2 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
0
b2
b1
Symbol
PM2
b0
0
Bit Symbol
PM20
(b1)
PM22
(b4-b3)
(b7-b5)
Address
001Eh
After Reset
XXX00000b
Bit Name
Function
RW
Specifying Wait when
Accessing SFR at PLL
Operation (2)
0 : 2 waits
1 : 1 wait
RW
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
WDT Count Source
Protective Bit (3) (4)
0 : CPU clock is used for the
watchdog timer count source
1 : On-chip oscillator clock is used for RW
the watchdog timer count source
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
-
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. The PM20 bit become effective when the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register is set to "1" (PLL on). Change the PM20
bit when the PLC07 bit is set to "0" (PLL off). Set the PM20 bit t "0" (2 waits) when PLL clock > 16MHz.
3. Once this bit is set to "1", it cannot be set to "0" in a program.
4. Setting the PM22 bit to "1" results in the following conditions:
The on-chip oscillator starts oscillating, and the on-chip oscillator clock becomes the watchdog timer count source.
The CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled against write. (Writing a "1" has no effect, nor is stop mode entered.)
The watchdog timer does not stop when in wait mode or hold state.
Figure 8.7 PM2 Register
PLL Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PLC0
0 0 1
Bit Symbol
Address
001Ch
After Reset
0001X010b
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
PLC00
PLC01
PLL Multiplying Factor
Select Bit (2)
PLC02
(b3)
-
0 0 0 : Do not set a value
0 0 1 : Multiply by 2
0 1 0 : Multiply by 4
0 1 1 : Multiply by 6 (4)
100:
101:
Do not set a value
110:
111:
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
RW
RW
RW
-
Reserved Bit
Set to "1"
RW
(b6-b5)
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
PLC07
Operation Enable Bit (3)
0 : PLL Off
1 : PLL On
RW
(b4)
-
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enable).
2. This bit can only be modified when the PLC07 bit = 0 (PLL turned off). The value once written to this bit
cannot be modified.
3. Before setting this bit to "1", set the CM07 bit in the CM0 register to "0" (main clock), set the CM17 to
CM16 bits in the CM1 register to "00b" (main clock undivided mode), and set the CM06 bit in the CM0
register to "0" (CM16 and CM17 bits enable).
4. Multiply by 6 is available Normal-ver. only.
Figure 8.8 PLC0 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 57 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
The following describes the clocks generated by the clock generating circuit.
8.1.1 Main Clock
The main clock is generated by the main clock oscillation circuit. This clock is used as the clock source for
the CPU and peripheral function clocks. The main clock oscillator circuit is configured by connecting a
resonator between the XIN and XOUT pins. The main clock oscillator circuit contains a feedback resistor,
which is disconnected from the oscillator circuit during stop mode in order to reduce the amount of power
consumed in the chip. The main clock oscillator circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally
generated clock to the XIN pin. Figure 8.9 shows the examples of main clock connection circuit.
After reset, the main clock divided by 8 is selected for the CPU clock.
The power consumption in the chip can be reduced by setting the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to “1”
(main clock oscillator circuit turned off) after switching the clock source for the CPU clock to a sub clock or
on-chip oscillator clock. In this case, XOUT goes “H”. Furthermore, because the internal feedback resistor remains on, XIN is pulled “H” to XOUT via the feedback resistor. Note, that if an externally generated
clock is fed into the XIN pin, the main clock cannot be turned off by setting the CM05 bit to “1” unless the
sub clock is selected as a CPU clock. If necessary, use an external circuit to turn off the clock.
During stop mode, all clocks including the main clock are turned off. Refer to 8.4 Power Control.
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
CIN
XIN
External clock
XIN
Oscillator
VCC
VSS
XOUT
Rd
(1)
COUT
VSS
XOUT
Open
NOTE:
1.Place a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator
and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by each oscillator
the oscillator manufacturer.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable.
Also, place a feedback resistor between XIN and XOUT if the oscillator manufacturer
recommends placing the resistor externally.
Figure 8.9 Examples of Main Clock Connection Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 58 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.1.2 Sub Clock
The sub clock is generated by the sub clock oscillation circuit. This clock is used as the clock source for
the CPU clock, as well as the timer A and timer B count sources. In addition, an fC clock with the same
frequency as that of the sub clock can be output from the CLKOUT pin.
The sub clock oscillator circuit is configured by connecting a crystal resonator between the XCIN and
XCOUT pins. The sub clock oscillator circuit contains a feedback resistor, which is disconnected from the
oscillator circuit during stop mode in order to reduce the amount of power consumed in the chip. The sub
clock oscillator circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally generated clock to the XCIN pin.
Figure 8.10 shows the examples of sub clock connection circuit.
After reset, the sub clock is turned off. At this time, the feedback resistor is disconnected from the oscillator circuit.
To use the sub clock for the CPU clock, set the CM07 bit in the CM0 register to “1 ” (sub clock) after the
sub clock becomes oscillating stably.
During stop mode, all clocks including the sub clock are turned off. Refer to 8.4 Power Control.
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
(Built-in feedback resistor)
(Built-in feedback resistor)
CCIN
XCIN
External clock
XCIN
Oscillator
VCC
VSS
XCOUT
RCd (1)
CCOUT
VSS
XCOUT
Open
NOTE:
1.Place a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator
and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by each oscillator
the oscillator manufacturer.
When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable.
Also, place a feedback resistor between XCIN and XCOUT if the oscillator manufacturer
recommends placing the resistor externally.
Figure 8.10 Examples of Sub Clock Connection Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 59 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.1.3 On-chip Oscillator Clock
This clock, approximately 1 MHz, is supplied by a on-chip oscillator. This clock is used as the clock
source for the CPU and peripheral function clocks. In addition, if the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is “1”
(on-chip oscillator clock for the watchdog timer count source), this clock is used as the count source for
the watchdog timer (refer to 11.1 Count Source Protective Mode).
After reset, the on-chip oscillator is turned off. It is turned on by setting the CM21 bit in the CM2 register
to “1” (on-chip oscillator clock), and is used as the clock source for the CPU and peripheral function
clocks, in place of the main clock. If the main clock stops oscillating when the CM20 bit in the CM2 register
is “1” (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function enabled) and the CM27 bit is “1” (oscillation stop,
re-oscillation detection interrupt), the on-chip oscillator automatically starts operating, supplying the necessary clock for the microcomputer.
8.1.4 PLL Clock
The PLL clock is generated by a PLL frequency synthesizer. This clock is used as the clock source for the
CPU and peripheral function clocks. After reset, the PLL clock is turned off. The PLL frequency synthesizer is activated by setting the PLC07 bit to “1” (PLL operation). When the PLL clock is used as the clock
source for the CPU clock, wait a fixed period of tsu(PLL) for the PLL clock to be stable, and then set the
CM11 bit in the CM1 register to “1”.
Before entering wait mode or stop mode, be sure to set the CM11 bit to “0” (CPU clock source is the main
clock). Furthermore, before entering stop mode, be sure to set the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to “0”
(PLL stops). Figure 8.11 shows the procedure for using the PLL clock as the clock source for the CPU.
The PLL clock frequency is determined by the equation below. When the PLL clock frequency is 16 MHz
or more, set the PM20 bit in the PM2 register to “0” (2 waits).
PLL clock frequency = f(XIN) ✕ (multiplying factor set by the PLC02 to PLC00 bits in the PLC0 register)
(However, PLL clock frequency = 16 MHz, 20 MHz or 24 MHz (1) )
NOTE:
1. 24 MHz is available Normal-ver. only.
The PLC02 to PLC00 bits can be set only once after reset. Table 8.2 shows the example for setting PLL
clock frequencies.
Table 8.2 Example for Setting PLL Clock Frequencies
XIN
Multiply PLL Clock
PLC02 PLC01 PLC00
Factor
(MHz)
(MHz) (1)
8
0
0
1
2
16
4
0
1
0
4
10
0
0
1
2
20
5
0
1
0
4
12
0
0
1
2
24 (2)
6
0
1
0
4
(3)
4
0
1
1
6
NOTES:
1. PLL clock frequency = 16 MHz , 20 MHz or 24 MHz
2. 24 MHz is available Normal-ver. only.
3. Multiply by 6 is available Normal-ver. only.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 60 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Using the PLL clock as the clock source for the CPU
Set the CM07 bit to "0" (main clock), the CM17 to CM16
bits to "00b" (main clock undivided), and the CM06 bit to "0"
(CM16 and CM17 bits enabled). (1)
Set the PLC02 to PLC00 bits (multiplying factor).
(When PLL clock > 16 MHz)
Set the PM20 bit to "0" (2-wait state).
Set the PLC07 bit to "1" (PLL operation).
Wait until the PLL clock becomes stable (tsu(PLL)).
Set the CM11 bit to "1" (PLL clock for the CPU clock source).
END
NOTE:
1. PLL operation mode can be entered from high-speed mode.
Figure 8.11 Procedure to Use PLL Clock as CPU Clock Source
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 61 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.2 CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock
Two type clocks: CPU clock to operate the CPU and peripheral function clocks to operate the peripheral
functions.
8.2.1 CPU Clock and BCLK
These are operating clocks for the CPU and watchdog timer.
The clock source for the CPU clock can be chosen to be the main clock, sub clock, on-chip oscillator clock
or the PLL clock.
If the main clock or on-chip oscillator clock is selected as the clock source for the CPU clock, the selected
clock source can be divided by 1 (undivided), 2, 4, 8 or 16 to produce the CPU clock. Use the CM06 bit in
the CM0 register and the CM17 to CM16 bits in the CM1 register to select the divide-by-n value.
When the PLL clock is selected as the clock source for the CPU clock, the CM06 bit should be set to “0”
and the CM17 to CM16 bits to “00b” (undivided).
After reset, the main clock divided by 8 provides the CPU clock.
During memory expansion or microprocessor mode, a BCLK signal with the same frequency as the CPU
clock can be output from the BCLK pin by setting the PM07 bit of PM0 register to “0” (output enabled).
Note that when entering stop mode from high- or medium-speed mode, on-chip oscillator mode or on-chip
oscillator low power dissipation mode, or when the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to “1” (main clock
turned off) in low-speed mode, the CM06 bit in the CM0 register is set to “1” (divide-by-8 mode).
8.2.2 Peripheral Function Clock (f1, f2, f8, f32, f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO, fAD, fCAN0, fCAN1, fC32)
These are operating clocks for the peripheral functions.
Two of these, fi (i = 1, 2, 8, 32) and fiSIO are derived from the main clock, PLL clock or on-chip oscillator
clock by dividing them by i. The clock fi is used for timers A and B, and fiSIO is used for serial interface.
The f8 and f32 clocks can be output from the CLKOUT pin.
The fAD clock is produced from the main clock, PLL clock or on-chip oscillator clock, and is used for the
A/D converter.
The fCANi (i =0, 1) clock is derived from the main clock, PLL clock or on-chip oscillator clock by dividing
them by 1 (undivided), 2, 4, 8 or 16, and is used for the CAN module.
When the WAIT instruction is executed after setting the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to “1” (peripheral
function clock turned off during wait mode), or when the microcomputer is in low power dissipation mode,
the fi, fiSIO, fAD, fCAN0 and fCAN1 clocks are turned off (1).
The fC32 clock is derived from the sub clock, and is used for timers A and B. This clock can be used when
the sub clock is activated.
NOTE:
1. fCAN0 and fCAN1 clocks stop at “H” in CAN0, 1 sleep mode.
8.3 Clock Output Function
During single-chip mode, the f8, f32 or fC clock can be output from the CLKOUT pin. Use the CM01 to
CM00 bits in the CM0 register to select.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 62 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.4 Power Control
Normal operation mode, wait mode and stop mode are provided as the power consumption control.
All mode states, except wait mode and stop mode, are called normal operation mode in this document.
8.4.1 Normal Operation Mode
Normal operation mode is further classified into seven sub modes.
In normal operation mode, because the CPU clock and the peripheral function clocks both are on, the
CPU and the peripheral functions are operating. Power control is exercised by controlling the CPU clock
frequency. The higher the CPU clock frequency, the greater the processing capability. The lower the CPU
clock frequency, the smaller the power consumption in the chip. If the unnecessary oscillator circuits are
turned off, the power consumption is further reduced.
Before the clock sources for the CPU clock can be switched over, the new clock source to which switched
must be oscillating stably. If the new clock source is the main clock, sub clock or PLL clock, allow a
sufficient wait time in a program until it becomes oscillating stably.
Note that operation modes cannot be changed directly from low speed or low power dissipation mode to
on-chip oscillator or on-chip oscillator low power dissipation mode. Nor can operation modes be changed
directly from on-chip oscillator or on-chip oscillator low power dissipation mode to low-speed or low power
dissipation mode. Where the CPU clock source is changed from the on-chip oscillator to the main clock,
change the operation mode to the medium-speed mode (divide-by-8 mode) after the clock was divided by
8 (the CM06 bit in the CM0 register was set to “1”) in the on-chip oscillator mode.
8.4.1.1 High-speed Mode
The main clock divided by 1 provides the CPU clock. If the sub clock is activated, fC32 can be used as
the count source for timers A and B.
8.4.1.2 PLL Operation Mode
The main clock multiplied by 2, 4 or 6 (1) provides the PLL clock, and this PLL clock serves as the CPU
clock. If the sub clock is activated, fC32 can be used as the count source for timers A and B. PLL
operation mode can be entered from high speed mode. If PLL operation mode is to be changed to wait
or stop mode, first go to high speed mode before changing.
NOTE:
1. The main clock multiplied by 6 is available Normal-ver. only.
8.4.1.3 Medium-speed Mode
The main clock divided by 2, 4, 8 or 16 provides the CPU clock. If the sub clock is activated, fC32 can be
used as the count source for timers A and B.
8.4.1.4 Low-speed Mode
The sub clock provides the CPU clock. The main clock is used as the clock source for the peripheral
function clock when the CM21 bit in the CM2 register is set to “0” (on-chip oscillator turned off), and the
on-chip oscillator clock is used when the CM21 bit is set to “1” (on-chip oscillator oscillating).
The fC32 clock can be used as the count source for timers A and B.
8.4.1.5 Low Power Dissipation Mode
In this mode, the main clock is turned off after being placed in low speed mode. The sub clock provides
the CPU clock. The fC32 clock can be used as the count source for timers A and B.
Simultaneously when this mode is selected, the CM06 bit in the CM0 register becomes “1” (divide-by-8
mode). In the low power dissipation mode, do not change the CM06 bit. Consequently, the medium
speed (divide-by-8) mode is to be selected when the main clock is operated next.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 63 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.4.1.6 On-chip Oscillator Mode
The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 1 (undivided), 2, 4, 8 or 16 provides the CPU clock. The on-chip
oscillator clock is also the clock source for the peripheral function clocks. If the sub clock is activated,
fC32 can be used as the count source for timers A and B. When the operation mode is returned to the
high- and medium-speed modes, set the CM06 bit in the CM0 register to “1” (divide-by-8 mode).
8.4.1.7 On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode
The main clock is turned off after being placed in on-chip oscillator mode. The CPU clock can be
selected like in the on-chip oscillator mode. The on-chip oscillator clock is the clock source for the
peripheral function clocks. If the sub clock is activated, fC32 can be used as the count source for timers
A and B.
Table 8.3 lists the setting clock related bit and modes.
Table 8.3 Setting Clock Related Bit and Modes
CM2 Register
CM21
PLL Operation Mode
0
High-Speed Mode
0
Modes
CM1 Register
CM11
CM17, CM16
1
00b
0
00b
CM07
0
0
CM0 Register
CM06
CM05
0
0
0
0
CM04
-
Medium- divided by 2
Speed divided by 4
0
0
0
0
01b
10b
0
0
0
0
0
0
-
Mode
0
0
-
0
1
0
-
divided by 16
Low-Speed Mode
Low Power
Dissipation Mode
On-chip divided by 1
0
0
0
0
0
11b
-
0
1
1
0
1 (1)
0
0
1 (1)
1
1
1
0
00b
0
0
0
-
Oscillator divided by 2
1
0
01b
0
0
0
-
divided by 4
divided by 8
1
1
0
0
10b
-
0
0
0
1
0
0
-
Mode
divided by 8
divided by 16
1
0
11b
0
0
0
On-chip Oscillator
1
0
(NOTE 2)
0
(NOTE 2)
1
Low power Dissipation
Mode
-: “0” or “1”
NOTES:
1. When the CM05 bit is set to “1” (main clock turned off) in low-speed mode, the mode goes to low power
dissipation mode and the CM06 bit is set to “1” (divide-by-8 mode) simultaneously.
2. The divide-by-n value can be selected the same way as in on-chip oscillator mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 64 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.4.2 Wait Mode
In wait mode, the CPU clock is turned off, so are the CPU (because operated by the CPU clock) and the
watchdog timer. However, if the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is “1” (on-chip oscillator clock for the watchdog
timer count source), the watchdog timer remains active. Because the main clock, sub clock and on-chip
oscillator clock all are on, the peripheral functions using these clocks keep operating.
8.4.2.1 Peripheral Function Clock Stop Function
If the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is “1” (peripheral function clocks turned off during wait mode), the f1,
f2, f8, f32, f1SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO, fAD, fCAN0 and fCAN1 clocks are turned off when in wait mode, with
the power consumption reduced that much. However, fC32 remains on.
8.4.2.2 Entering Wait Mode
The microcomputer is placed into wait mode by executing the WAIT instruction.
When the CM11 bit = 1 (CPU clock source is the PLL clock), be sure to set the CM11 bit in the CM1
register to “0” (CPU clock source is the main clock) before going to wait mode. The power consumption
of the chip can be reduced by setting the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to “0” (PLL stops).
8.4.2.3 Pin Status During Wait Mode
Table 8.4 lists the pin status during wait mode.
Table 8.4 Pin Status During Wait Mode
Pin
A0
to A19,
D0 to D15,
_______
_______ ________
CS0 to CS3, BHE
______ _______ _________ _________
RD, WR, WRL, WRH
___________
HLDA, BCLK
ALE
I/O ports
CLKOUT When fC selected
Memory Expansion Mode
Microprocessor Mode
Retains status before wait mode
Does not become a bus control pin
“H”
“H”
“L”
Retains status before wait mode
Does not become a CLKOUT pin
Retains status before wait mode
Does not stop
When f8, f32
selected
Single-chip Mode
•CM02 bit = 0: Does not stop
•CM02 bit = 1: Retains status before
wait mode
8.4.2.4 Exiting Wait Mode
______
The microcomputer is moved out of wait mode by a hardware reset, NMI interrupt or peripheral function
interrupt.
______
If the microcomputer is to be moved out of wait mode by a hardware reset or NMI interrupt, set the
peripheral function interrupt priority ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits to “000b” (interrupt disabled) before executing
the WAIT instruction.
The peripheral function interrupts are affected by the CM02 bit. If the CM02 bit is “0” (peripheral function
clocks not turned off during wait mode), peripheral function interrupts can be used to exit wait mode. If
the CM02 bit is “1” (peripheral function clocks turned off during wait mode), the peripheral functions
using the peripheral function clocks stop operating, so that only the peripheral functions clocked by
external signals can be used to exit wait mode.
Table 8.5 lists the interrupts to exit wait mode and use conditions.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 65 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Table 8.5 Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Use Conditions
Interrupt
CM02 Bit = 0
_______
NMI Interrupt
Can be used
Serial Interface Interrupt
Can be used when operating with
internal or external clock
Key Input Interrupt
Can be used
A/D Conversion Interrupt Can be used in one-shot mode or
single sweep mode
Timer A Interrupt
Can be used in all modes
Timer
B interrupt
______
INT Interrupt
Can be used
CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Can be used in CAN sleep mode
8. Clock Generating Circuit
CM02 Bit = 1
Can be used
Can be used when operating with
external clock
Can be used
- (Do not use)
Can be used in event counter mode
or when the count source is fc32
Can be used
Can be used in CAN sleep mode
If the microcomputer is to be moved out of wait mode by a peripheral function interrupt, set up the
following before executing the WAIT instruction.
(1) Set the ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in the interrupt control register, for peripheral function interrupts used to
exit wait mode.
The ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in all other interrupt control registers, for peripheral function interrupts not
used to exit wait mode, are set to “000b” (interrupt disable).
(2) Set the I flag to “1”.
(3) Start operating the peripheral functions used to exit wait mode.
When the peripheral function interrupt is used, an interrupt routine is performed as soon as an
interrupt request is acknowledged and the CPU clock is supplied again.
When the microcomputer exits wait mode by the peripheral function interrupt, the CPU clock is the same
clock as the CPU clock executing the WAIT instruction.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 66 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.4.3 Stop Mode
In stop mode, all oscillator circuits are turned off, so are the CPU clock and the peripheral function clocks.
Therefore, the CPU and the peripheral functions clocked by these clocks stop operating. The least
amount of power is consumed in this mode. If the voltage applied to VCC is VRAM or more, the internal
RAM is retained.
However, the peripheral functions clocked by external signals keep operating.
Table 8.6 lists the interrupts to stop mode and use conditions.
Table 8.6 Interrupts to Stop Mode and Use Conditions
Interrupt
Condition
_______
NMI Interrupt
Can be used
Key
Input Interrupt
Can be used
______
INT Interrupt
Can be used
Timer A Interrupt
Can be used
Timer B interrupt
(when counting external pulses in event counter mode)
Serial Interface Interrupt
Can be used (when external clock is selected)
CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Can be used (when CAN sleep mode is selected)
8.4.3.1 Entering Stop Mode
The microcomputer is placed into stop mode by setting the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to “1” (all clocks
turned off). At the same time, the CM06 bit in the CM0 register is set to “1” (divide-by-8 mode) and the
CM15 bit in the CM1 register is set to “1” (main clock oscillator circuit drive capability high).
Before entering stop mode, set the CM20 bit in the CM2 register to “0” (oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection function disabled).
Also, if the CM11 bit in the CM1 register is “1” (PLL clock for the CPU clock source), set the CM11 bit to
“0” (main clock for the CPU clock source) and the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to “0” (PLL turned off)
before entering stop mode.
8.4.3.2 Pin Status in Stop Mode
Table 8.7 lists the pin status in stop mode.
Table 8.7 Pin Status in Stop Mode
Pin
A0
to A19,
D0 to D15,
_______
_______ ________
CS0 to CS3, BHE
______ _______ _________ _________
RD, WR, WRL, WRH
___________
HLDA, BCLK
ALE
I/O ports
Memory Expansion Mode
Microprocessor Mode
Retains status before stop mode
Does not become a bus control pin
“H”
“H”
indeterminate
Retains status before stop mode
Retains status before stop mode
CLKOUT When fC selected Does not become a CLKOUT pin
When f8, f32
selected
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 67 of 376
Single-chip Mode
“H”
Retains status before stop mode
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.4.3.3 Exiting Stop Mode
_______
Stop mode is exited by a hardware
reset,
NMI interrupt or peripheral function interrupt.
_______
When the hardware reset or NMI interrupt is used to exit wait mode, set all ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in the
interrupt control registers for the peripheral function interrupt to “000b” (interrupt disabled) before setting
the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to “1”.
When the peripheral function interrupt is used to exit stop mode, set the CM10 bit to “1” after the following
settings are completed.
(1) The ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in the interrupt control registers, for the peripheral function interrupt used to
exit stop mode, must have larger value than that of the RLVL2 to RLVL0 bits.
The ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in all other interrupt control registers, for the peripheral function interrupts
which are not used to exit stop mode, must be set to “000b” (interrupt disabled).
(2) Set the I flag to “1”.
(3) Start operation of peripheral function being used to exit wait mode.
When exiting stop mode by the peripheral function interrupt, the interrupt routine is performed when
an interrupt request is generated and the CPU clock is supplied
again.
_______
When stop mode is exited by the peripheral function interrupt or NMI interrupt, the CPU clock source is
as follows, in accordance with the CPU clock source setting before the microcomputer had entered stop
mode.
• When the sub clock is the CPU clock before entering stop mode:
Sub clock
• When the main clock is the CPU clock source before entering stop mode: Main clock divided by 8
• When the on-chip oscillator clock is the CPU clock source before entering stop mode:
On-chip oscillator clock divided by 8
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 68 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Figure 8.12 shows the state transition from normal operation mode to stop mode and wait mode. Figure
8.13 shows the state transition in normal operation mode.
Table 8.8 shows a state transition matrix describing allowed transition and setting. The vertical line shows
current state and horizontal line show state after transition.
Reset
All oscillators stopped
WAIT
instruction
CM10 = 1 (5)
Stop Mode
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 1
CM05 = 0
CM11 = 0
CM10 = 1 (3)
Medium-Speed Mode
(divided-by-8 mode)
Interrupt
Interrupt
Interrupt
Stop Mode
CM10 = 1 (5)
When
lowspeed
mode
CM10 = 1 (5)
Wait Mode
Interrupt
(NOTES 1, 2)
PLL Operation Mode
Low-Speed Mode,
Low Power Dissipation Mode
Interrupt
Stop Mode
Wait Mode
WAIT
instruction
High-Speed Mode,
Medium-Speed Mode
CM10 = 1 (5)
When
low
power
dissipation
mode
Stop Mode
CPU operation stopped
WAIT
instruction
Wait Mode
Interrupt
On-chip Oscillator Mode,
On-chip Oscillator Dissipation Mode
Interrupt (4)
WAIT
instruction
Wait Mode
Interrupt
Normal Mode
CM05, CM06, CM07: Bits in CM0 register
CM10, CM11:
Bits in CM1 register
NOTES:
1. Do not go directly from PLL operation mode to wait or stop mode.
2.PLL operation mode can be entered from high-speed mode. Similarly, PLL operation mode can be changed back to high-speed mode.
3.Write to the CM0 and CM1 registers per 16 bits with the CM21bit in the CM2 register = 0 (on-chip oscillator stops).
Since the operation starts from the main clock after exiting stop mode, the time until the CPU operates can be reduced.
4.The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 provides the CPU clock.
5.Before entering stop mode, be sure to set the CM20 bit in the CM2 register to "0" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function disabled).
Figure 8.12 State Transition to Stop Mode and Wait Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 69 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Main Clock Oscillation
On-chip Oscillator
Clock Oscillation
PLL operation mode
CPU clock
: f(PLL)
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 0
High-Speed Mode
PLC07 = 1
CM11 = 1 (6)
PLC07 = 0
CM11 = 0
CPU clock
: f(XIN)
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 0
On-chip Oscillator
Mode
Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode
(divide by 2)
(divide by 4)
(divide by 8)
(divide by 16)
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/2
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 1
CM04 = 1 CM04 = 0
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/4
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 1
CM16 = 0
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/8
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 1
CM04 = 1
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/16
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 1
CM16 = 1
On-chip Oscillator
Low Power Dissipation Mode
CPU clock
CM21 = 0 (7)
CM21 = 1
f(Ring)
f(Ring)/2
f(Ring)/4
f(Ring)/8
f(Ring)/16
CPU clock
CM05 = 0
CM05 = 1 (1)
CM04 = 1
CM04 = 0
CM04 = 1
CM04 = 0
High-Speed mode
CPU clock
: f(PLL)
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 0
PLC07 = 1
CM11 = 1 (6)
PLC07 = 0
CM11 = 0
CPU clock
: f(XIN)
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 0
f(Ring)
f(Ring)/2
f(Ring)/4
f(Ring)/8
f(Ring)/16
CM04 = 0
Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode Medium-Speed Mode
(divide by 2)
(divide by 4)
(divide by 8)
(divide by 16)
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/2
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 0
CM16 = 1
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/4
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 1
CM16 = 0
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/8
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 1
CPU clock
: f(XIN)/16
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 0
CM17 = 1
CM16 = 1
PLL operation mode
CM07 =1 (3)
Low-Speed Mode
CM05 = 1 (1) (8)
CM21 = 1
f(Ring)
f(Ring)/2
f(Ring)/4
f(Ring)/8
f(Ring)/16
On-chip Oscillator
Mode
CM07 = 0 (2) (4)
CM21 = 0
CPU clock: f(XCIN)
CM07 = 0
CPU clock
CM21 = 0 (7)
CM21 = 1
CPU clock
CM05 = 0
CM05 = 1 (1)
f(Ring)
f(Ring)/2
f(Ring)/4
f(Ring)/8
f(Ring)/16
On-chip Oscillator
Low Power Dissipation Mode
Low-Speed Mode
CPU clock: f(XCIN)
CM07 = 0
CM05 = 0
Low Power Dissipation Mode
CPU clock: f(XCIN)
CM07 = 0
CM06 = 1
CM15 = 1
Sub clock oscillation
CM04, CM05, CM06, CM07: Bits in CM0 register
CM11, CM15, CM16, CM17: Bits in CM1 register
CM20, CM21
: Bits in CM2 register
PLC07
: Bit in PLC0 register
NOTES:
1. Avoid making a transition when the CM20 bit is set to "1" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function enabled).
Set the CM20 bit to "0" (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function disabled) before transiting.
2. Wait for the main clock oscillation stabilization time.
3. Switch clock after oscillation of sub clock is sufficiently stable.
4. Change the CM17 and CM16 bits before changing the CM06 bit.
5. Transit in accordance with arrow.
6. The PM20 bit in the PM2 register become effective when the PLC07 bit is set to "1" (PLL on). Change the PM20 bit when the PLC07 bit is
set to "0" (PLL off). Set the PM20 bit to "0" (2 waits) when PLL clock > 16 MHz.
PM20 bit to "0" (SFR accessed with two wait states) before setting the PLC07 bit to "1" (PLL operation).
7. Set the CM06 bit to "1" (divide-by-8 mode) before changing back the operation mode from on-chip oscillator mode to high- or middle-speed mode.
8. When the CM21 bit = 0 (on-chip oscillator turned off) and the CM05 bit = 1 (main clock turned off), the CM06 bit is fixed to "1" (divide-by-8 mode)
and the CM15 bit is fixed to "1" (drive capability High).
Figure 8.13 State Transition in Normal Operation Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 70 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
Table 8.8 Allowed Transition and Setting (9)
State after transition
High-Speed Mode, Low-Speed Low Power PLL Operation On-chip Oscillator On-chip Oscillator
Medium-Speed
Low Power
Mode (2) Dissipation Mode Mode (2)
Mode
Mode
Dissipation Mode
High-Speed Mode,
Medium-Speed Mode
Low-Speed
(NOTE 8)
Current state
Mode (2)
On-chip Oscillator
Mode
On-chip Oscillator Low
Power Dissipation Mode
Stop Mode
(7)
(8)
Mode (2)
Low Power
Dissipation Mode
PLL Operation
(9)
(11)
-
(1) (6)
(10)
-
(16)
(1)
(17)
-
-
-
(16)
(1)
(17)
-
-
-
(16)
(1)
(17)
-
-
-
(12)
(3)
-
-
(14)
(4)
-
-
-
(NOTE 8)
(11)
-
-
-
(10)
(NOTE 8)
(18)
(18)
-
(18)
(18)
(18)
-
(18)
(5)
(18)
Wait Mode
(18)
-: Cannot transit
NOTES:
1. Avoid making a transition when the CM20 bit = 1 (oscillation stop, reoscillation detection function enabled). Set the CM20 bit to “0” (oscillation
stop, re-oscillation detection function disabled) before transiting.
2. On-chip oscillator clock oscillates and stops in low-speed mode. In this
mode, the on-chip oscillator can be used as peripheral function clock. Sub
clock oscillates and stops in PLL operation mode. In this mode, sub clock
can be used as peripheral function clock.
3. PLL operation mode can only be entered from and changed to high-speed
mode.
4. Set the CM06 bit to “1” (divide-by-8 mode) before transiting from on-chip
oscillator mode to high- or medium-speed mode.
5. When exiting stop mode, the CM06 bit is set to “1” (divide-by-8 mode).
6. If the CM05 bit is set to “1” (main clock stop), then the CM06 bit is set to “1”
(divide-by-8 mode).
7. A transition can be made only when sub clock is oscillating.
8. State transitions within the same mode (divide-by-n values changed or sub
clock oscillation turned on or off) are shown in the table below.
Sub Clock Oscillating
Sub Clock Turned Off Sub Clock Oscillating
No Divide- Divide- Divide- Divide- No Divide- Divide- Divide- DivideDivision by-2 by-4 by-8 by-16 Division by-2 by-4 by-8 by-16
(5)
(5)
(4)
(7)
(7)
(6)
(6)
(1)
-
(1)
-
-
-
Divide-by-4 (3)
Divide-by-8 (3)
(4)
(4)
(7)
(6)
(6)
-
-
(1)
-
(1)
-
(5)
Divide-by-16 (3)
No Division (2)
(4)
-
(5)
-
(7)
-
-
(4)
(5)
(7)
(1)
(6)
-
Divide-by-2
Divide-by-4
-
(2)
-
(2)
-
-
(3)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(7)
(7)
(6)
(6)
Divide-by-8
-
-
-
(2)
-
(3)
(4)
(5)
Divide-by-16
-
-
-
-
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
9. ( ):setting method. See right table.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 71 of 376
(5)
(18)
(18)
Setting
(1) CM04=0
(2) CM04=1
(3) CM06=0
CM17=0
CM16=0
(4) CM06=0
CM17=0
CM16=1
(5) CM06=0
CM17=1
CM16=0
(6) CM06=0
CM17=1
CM16=1
(7) CM06=1
(8) CM07=0
Sub Clock Turned Off
No Division
Divide-by-2 (3)
(6)
(7)
Wait
Mode
(15)
(13)
(3)
Stop
Mode
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
CM07=1
CM05=0
CM05=1
PLC07=0
CM11=0
( 13) PLC07=1
CM11=1
(14) CM21=0
( 15) CM21=1
(1)
-
(16)
(1)
(17)
(16)
(1)
(17)
(5)
-
Operation
Sub clock turned off
Sub clock oscillating
CPU clock no division
mode
CPU clock divide-by-2
mode
CPU clock divide-by-4
mode
CPU clock divide-by-16
mode
CPU clock divide-by-8 mode
Main clock, PLL clock
or on-chip oscillator
clock selected
Sub clock selected
Main clock oscillating
Main clock turned off
Main clock selected
PLL clock selected
Main clock or
PLL clock selected
On-chip oscillator clock
selected
Transition to stop mode
Transition to wait mode
(16) CM10=1
(17) WAIT
instruction
(18) Hardware
Exit stop mode or wait
interrupt
mode
CM04, CM05, CM06, CM07: Bits in CM0 register
CM10, CM11, CM16, CM17: Bits in CM1 register
CM20, CM21
: Bits in CM2 register
PLC07
: Bit in PLC0 register
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.5 Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Function
The oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function is such that main clock oscillation circuit stop and
re-oscillation are detected. At oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection, reset or oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection interrupt request are generated. Which one is to be generated can be selected using the CM27 bit
in the CM2 register.
The oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function can be enabled or disabled using the CM20 bit in
the CM2 register.
Table 8.9 lists a specification overview of the oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function.
Table 8.9 Specification Overview of Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Function
Item
Specification
Oscillation Stop Detectable Clock and f(XIN) ≥ 2 MHz
Frequency Bandwidth
Enabling Condition for Oscillation Stop Set CM20 bit to “1” (enable)
and Re-oscillation Detection Function
Operation at Oscillation Stop,
•Reset occurs (when CM27 bit = 0)
Re-oscillation Detection
•Oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt occurs (when the CM27 bit =1)
8.5.1 Operation When CM27 Bit = 0 (Oscillation Stop Detection Reset)
Where main clock stop is detected when the CM20 bit is “1” (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection
function enabled), the microcomputer is initialized, coming to a halt (oscillation stop reset; refer to
4. Special Function Register (SFR), 5. Reset).
This status is reset with hardware reset. Also, even when re-oscillation is detected, the microcomputer
can be initialized and stopped; it is, however, necessary to avoid such usage (During main clock stop, do
not set the CM20 bit to “1” and the CM27 bit to “0”).
8.5.2 Operation When CM27 Bit = 1 (Oscillation Stop, Re-oscillation Detection Interrupt)
Where the main clock corresponds to the CPU clock source and the CM20 bit is “1” (oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection function enabled), the system is placed in the following state if the main clock comes to a halt:
• Oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt request is generated.
• The on-chip oscillator starts oscillation, and the on-chip oscillator clock becomes the clock source for
CPU clock and peripheral functions in place of the main clock.
• CM21 bit = 1 (on-chip oscillator clock is the clock source for CPU clock)
• CM22 bit = 1 (main clock stop detected)
• CM23 bit = 1 (main clock stopped)
Where the PLL clock corresponds to the CPU clock source and the CM20 bit is “1”, the system is placed
in the following state if the main clock comes to a halt: Since the CM21 bit remains unchanged, set it to “1”
(on-chip oscillator clock) inside the interrupt routine.
• Oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt request is generated.
• CM22 bit = 1 (main clock stop detected)
• CM23 bit = 1 (main clock stopped)
• CM21 bit remains unchanged
Where the CM20 bit is “1”, the system is placed in the following state if the main clock re-oscillates from
the stop condition:
• Oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt request is generated.
• CM22 bit = 1 (main clock re-oscillation detected)
• CM23 bit = 0 (main clock oscillation)
• CM21 bit remains unchanged
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 72 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
8. Clock Generating Circuit
8.5.3 How to Use Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Function
• The oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt shares the vector with the watchdog timer interrupt.
If the oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection and watchdog timer interrupts both are used, read the
CM22 bit in an interrupt routine to determine which interrupt source is requesting the interrupt.
• Where the main clock re-oscillated after oscillation stop, the clock source for CPU clock and peripheral
function must be switched to the main clock in the program. Figure 8.14 shows the procedure to switch
the clock source from the on-chip oscillator to the main clock.
• Simultaneously with oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt request occurrence, the CM22 bit
becomes “1”. When the CM22 bit is set at “1”, oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt are
disabled. By setting the CM22 bit to “0” in the program, oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection interrupt
are enabled.
• If the main clock stops during low speed mode where the CM20 bit is “1”, an oscillation stop, re-oscillation
detection interrupt request is generated. At the same time, the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. In this
case, although the CPU clock is derived from the sub clock as it was before the interrupt occurred, the
peripheral function clocks now are derived from the on-chip oscillator clock.
• To enter wait mode while using the oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function, set the CM02
bit to “0” (peripheral function clocks not turned off during wait mode).
• Since the oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function is provided in preparation for main clock
stop due to external factors, set the CM20 bit to “0” (oscillation stop, re-oscillation detection function
disabled) where the main clock is stopped or oscillated in the program, that is where the stop mode is
selected or the CM05 bit is altered.
• This function cannot be used if the main clock frequency is 2 MHz or less. In that case, set the CM20 bit to “0”.
Switch the main clock
NO
Determine several times
whether the CM23 bit is set to "0"
(main clock oscillates)
YES
Set the CM06 bit to "1" (divide-by-8)
Set the CM22 bit to "0" (main clock stop,
re-oscillation not detected)
Set the CM21 bit to "0"
(main clock for the CPU clock source) (1)
End
CM06 bit
: Bit in CM0 register
CM21, CM22, CM 23 bits : Bits in CM2 register
NOTE:
1. If the clock source for CPU clock is to be changed to PLL clock,
set to PLL operation mode after set to high-speed mode.
Figure 8.14 Procedure to Switch Clock Source from On-chip Oscillator to Main Clock
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 73 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
9. Protection
9. Protection
In the event that a program runs out of control, this function protects the important registers so that they will
not be rewritten easily. Figure 9.1 shows the PRCR register. The following lists the registers protected by the
PRCR register.
• The PRC0 bit protects the CM0, CM1, CM2, PLC0, PCLKR and CCLKR registers;
• The PRC1 bit protects the PM0, PM1, PM2, TB2SC, INVC0 and INVC1 registers;
• The PRC2 bit protects the PD7, PD9 and S3C registers.
Set the PRC2 bit to “1” (write enabled) and then write to any address, and the PRC2 bit will be set to “0” (write
protected). The registers protected by the PRC2 bit should be changed in the next instruction after setting
the PRC2 bit to “1”. Make sure no interrupts or DMA transfers will occur between the instruction in which the
PRC2 bit is set to “1” and the next instruction. The PRC0 and PRC1 bits are not automatically set to “0” by
writing to any address. They can only be set to “0” in a program.
Protect Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0 0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
PRCR
000Ah
XX000000b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
RW
Function
Enable write to CM0, CM1, CM2,
PLC0, PCLKR, CCLKR
registers
RW
0 : Write protected
1 : Write enabled
Enable write to PM0, PM1, PM2,
TB2SC, INVC0, INVC1
registers
RW
0 : Write protected
1 : Write enabled
Enable write to PD7, PD9, S3C
registers
RW
0 : Write protected
(1)
1 : Write enabled
PRC0
Protect Bit 0
PRC1
Protect Bit 1
PRC2
Protect Bit 2
(b5-b3)
Reserved Bit
(b7-b6)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
Set to "0"
RW
-
NOTE:
1. The PRC2 bit is set to "0" by writing to any address after setting it to "1". Other bits are not set to "0" by writing
to any address, and must therefore be set in a program.
Figure 9.1 PRCR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 74 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10. Interrupt
10.1 Type of Interrupts
Figure 10.1 shows the types of interrupts.












Hardware
Special
(Non-maskable interrupt)














Interrupt
Software
(Non-maskable interrupt)
Undefined instruction (UND instruction)
Overflow (INTO instruction)
BRK instruction
INT instruction
_______
NMI
DBC (2)
Oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection
Watchdog timer
Single step (2)
Address match
________
Peripheral function (1)
(Maskable interrupt)
NOTES:
1. The peripheral functions in the microcomputer are used to generate the peripheral interrupt.
2. Do not normally use this interrupt because it is provided exclusively for use by development
tools.
Figure 10.1 Interrupts
• Maskable Interrupt:
An interrupt which can be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority can be changed by priority level.
• Non-Maskable Interrupt: An interrupt which cannot be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag
(I flag) or whose interrupt priority cannot be changed by priority level.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 75 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.2 Software Interrupts
A software interrupt occurs when executing certain instructions. Software interrupts are non-maskable
interrupts.
10.2.1 Undefined Instruction Interrupt
An undefined instruction interrupt occurs when executing the UND instruction.
10.2.2 Overflow Interrupt
An overflow interrupt occurs when executing the INTO instruction with the O flag in the FLG register set to
“1” (the operation resulted in an overflow). The following are instructions whose O flag changes by arithmetic:
ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, SUB
10.2.3 BRK Interrupt
A BRK interrupt occurs when executing the BRK instruction.
10.2.4 INT Instruction Interrupt
An INT instruction interrupt occurs when executing the INT instruction. Software interrupt Nos. 0 to 63 can
be specified for the INT instruction. Because software interrupt Nos. 1 to 31 are assigned to peripheral
function interrupts, the same interrupt routine as for peripheral function interrupts can be executed by
executing the INT instruction.
In software interrupt Nos. 0 to 31, the U flag is saved to the stack during instruction execution and is set
to “0” (ISP selected) before executing an interrupt sequence. The U flag is restored from the stack when
returning from the interrupt routine. In software interrupt Nos. 32 to 63, the U flag does not change state
during instruction execution, and the SP then selected is used.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 76 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.3 Hardware Interrupts
Hardware interrupts are classified into two types — special interrupts and peripheral function interrupts.
10.3.1 Special Interrupts
Special interrupts are non-maskable interrupts.
_______
10.3.1.1
NMI Interrupt
_______
_______
An NMI interrupt
is
generated
when
input
on
the
NMI pin changes state from high to low. For details,
_______
refer to 10.7 NMI Interrupt.
________
10.3.1.2 DBC Interrupt
Do not normally use this interrupt because it is provided exclusively for use by development tools.
10.3.1.3 Watchdog Timer Interrupt
Generated by the watchdog timer. Once a watchdog timer interrupt is generated, be sure to initialize the
watchdog timer. For details about the watchdog timer, refer to 11. Watchdog Timer.
10.3.1.4 Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection Interrupt
Generated by the oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection function. For details about the oscillation
stop and re-oscillation detection function, refer to 8. Clock Generating Circuit.
10.3.1.5 Single-Step Interrupt
Do not normally use this interrupt because it is provided exclusively for use by development tools.
10.3.1.6 Address Match Interrupt
An address match interrupt is generated immediately before executing the instruction at the address
indicated by the RMAD0 to RMAD3 registers that corresponds to one of the AIER0 or AIER1 bit in the
AIER register or the AIER20 or AIER21 bit in the AIER2 register which is “1” (address match interrupt
enabled). For details, refer to 10.10 Address Match Interrupt.
10.3.2 Peripheral Function Interrupts
The peripheral function interrupt occurs when a request from the peripheral functions in the microcomputer
is acknowledged. The peripheral function interrupt is a maskable interrupt. See Table 10.2 Relocatable
Vector Tables about how the peripheral function interrupt occurs. Refer to the descriptions of each
function for details.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 77 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.4 Interrupts and Interrupt Vector
One interrupt vector consists of 4 bytes. Set the start address of each interrupt routine in the respective
interrupt vectors. When an interrupt request is accepted, the CPU branches to the address set in the
corresponding interrupt vector. Figure 10.2 shows the interrupt vector.
MSB
Vector address (L)
LSB
Low-order address
Middle-order address
Vector address (H)
0000
High-order address
0000
0000
Figure 10.2 Interrupt Vector
10.4.1 Fixed Vector Tables
The fixed vector tables are allocated to the addresses from FFFDCh to FFFFFh. Table 10.1 lists the fixed
vector tables. In the flash memory version of microcomputer, the vector addresses (H) of fixed vectors are
used by the ID code check function. For details, refer to 21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from
Rewriting.
Table 10.1 Fixed Vector Tables
Interrupt Source
Undefined Instruction (UND instruction)
Overflow (INTO instruction)
BRK Instruction (2)
Address Match
Single Step (1)
Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection,
Watchdog
Timer
________
(1)
DBC
_______
NMI
Reset
Vector table Addresses
Address (L) to Address (H)
FFFDCh to
FFFE0h to
FFFE4h to
FFFE8h to
FFFECh to
FFFF0h to
FFFDFh
FFFE3h
FFFE7h
FFFEBh
FFFEFh
FFFF3h
Reference
M16C/60, M16C/20, M16C/Tiny
Series Software Manual
10.10 Address Match Interrupt
8. Clock Generating Circuit
11. Watchdog Timer
FFFF4h to FFFF7h
_______
FFFF8h to FFFFBh 10.7 NMI Interrupt
FFFFCh to FFFFFh 5. Reset
NOTES:
1. Do not normally use this interrupt because it is provided exclusively for use by development tools.
2. If the contents of address FFFE7h is FFh, program execution starts from the address shown by the
vector in the relocatable vector table.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 78 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.4.2 Relocatable Vector Tables
The 256 bytes beginning with the start address set in the INTB register comprise a relocatable vector
table area. Table 10.2 lists the relocatable vector tables. Setting an even address in the INTB register
results in the interrupt sequence being executed faster than in the case of odd addresses.
Table 10.2 Relocatable Vector Tables
Interrupt Source
BRK Instruction
(2)
CAN0/1 Wake-up (10)
CAN0 Successful Reception
CAN0
Successful Transmission
________
INT3
Timer B5
Timer B4, UART1 Bus Collision Detection (3) (9)
(4) (9)
Timer B3, UART0 Bus Collision Detection
________
(5)
CAN1 Successful Reception,INT5
________
SIO3, CAN1 Successful Transmission, INT4 (6)
UART2 Bus Collision Detection (9)
DMA0
DMA1
CAN0/1 Error (11)
A/D, Key Input (7)
UART2 Transmission, NACK2 (8)
UART2 Reception, ACK2 (8)
UART0 Transmission, NACK0 (8)
UART0 Reception, ACK0 (8)
UART1 Transmission, NACK1 (8)
UART1 Reception, ACK1 (8)
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
________
INT0
________
INT1
________
INT2
INT Instruction Interrupt (2)
Vector Address (1)
Address (L) to Address (H)
Software
Interrupt Number
+0 to +3 (0000h to 0003h)
0
+4 to +7 (0004h to 0007h)
+8 to +11 (0008h to 000Bh)
+12 to +15 (000Ch to 000Fh)
+16 to +19 (0010h to 0013h)
+20 to +23 (0014h to 0017h)
+24 to +27 (0018h to 001Bh)
+28 to +31 (001Ch to 001Fh)
+32 to +35 (0020h to 0023h)
+36 to +39 (0024h to 0027h)
+40 to +43 (0028h to 002Bh)
+44 to +47 (002Ch to 002Fh)
+48 to +51 (0030h to 0033h)
+52 to +55 (0034h to 0037h)
+56 to +59 (0038h to 003Bh)
+60 to +63 (003Ch to 003Fh)
+64 to +67 (0040h to 0043h)
+68 to +71 (0044h to 0047h)
+72 to +75 (0048h to 004Bh)
+76 to +79 (004Ch to 004Fh)
+80 to +83 (0050h to 0053h)
+84 to +87 (0054h to 0057h)
+88 to +91 (0058h to 005Bh)
+92 to +95 (005Ch to 005Fh)
+96 to +99 (0060h to 0063h)
+100 to +103 (0064h to 0067h)
+104 to +107 (0068h to 006Bh)
+108 to +111 (006Ch to 006Fh)
+112 to +115 (0070h to 0073h)
+116 to +119 (0074h to 0077h)
+120 to +123 (0078h to 007Bh)
+124 to +127 (007Ch to 007Fh)
+128 to +131 (0080h to 0083h)
to
+252 to + 255 (00FCh to 00FFh)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
to
63
Reference
M16C/60, M16C/20, M16C/Tiny
Series Software Manual
19. CAN Module
______
10.6 INT Interrupt
13. Timers
13. Timers
15. Serial Interface
______
19. CAN Module, 10.6 INT Interrupt
______
15. Serial Interface, 19. CAN Module, 10.6 INT Interrupt
15. Serial Interface
12. DMAC
19. CAN Module
16. A/D Convertor, 10.8 Key Input Interrupt
15. Serial Interface
13. Timers
______
10.6 INT Interrupt
M16C/60, M16C/20, M16C/Tiny
Series Software Manual
NOTES:
1. Address relative to address in INTB.
2. These interrupts cannot be disabled using the I flag.
3. Use the IFSR07 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
4. Use the IFSR06 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
5. Use the IFSR17 bit in the IFSR1 register to select.
6. Use the IFSR16 bit in the IFSR1 register to select.
Furthermore, use the IFSR00 bit in the IFSR0 register to select, when selecting SI/O3 or CAN1 successful transmission.
7. Use the IFSR01 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
2
8. During I C mode, NACK and ACK interrupts comprise the interrupt source.
9. Bus collision detection: During IE mode, this bus collision detection constitutes the cause of an interrupt.
During I2C mode, a start condition or a stop condition detection constitutes the cause of an interrupt.
10. Use the IFSR02 bit in the IFSR0 register to select. When the IFSR02 bit = 0, CAN0/1 wake-up is selected. When the
IFSR02 bit = 1, CAN0 wake-up/error is selected.
11. Use the IFSR02 bit in the IFSR0 register to select. When the IFSR02 bit = 0, CAN0/1 error is selected. When the IFSR02
bit = 1, CAN1 wake-up/error is selected.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 79 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5 Interrupt Control
The following describes how to enable/disable the maskable interrupts, and how to set the priority in which
order they are accepted. What is explained here does not apply to non-maskable interrupts.
Use the I flag in the FLG register, IPL, and the ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in the each interrupt control register to
enable/disable the maskable interrupts. Whether an interrupt is requested is indicated by the IR bit in the
each interrupt control register.
Figures 10.3 and 10.4 show the interrupt control registers.
Interrupt Control Register (1)
Symbol
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
C01WKIC (5)
C0RECIC
C0TRMIC
TB5IC
TB4IC/U1BCNIC (2)
TB3IC/U0BCNIC (3)
U2BCNIC
DM0IC, DM1IC
C01ERRIC (6)
ADIC/KUPIC (7)
S0TIC to S2TIC
S0RIC to S2RIC
TA0IC to TA4IC
TB0IC to TB2IC
b0
Bit Symbol
Address
After Reset
0041h
0042h
0043h
0045h
0046h
0047h
004Ah
004Bh, 004Ch
004Dh
004Eh
0051h, 0053h, 004Fh
0052h, 0054h, 0050h
0055h to 0059h
005Ah to 005Ch
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
XXXXX000b
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
ILVL0
ILVL1
Interrupt Priority Level
Select Bit
ILVL2
000:
001:
010:
011:
100:
101:
110:
111:
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 4
Level 5
Level 6
Level 7
0 : Interrupt not requested
1 : Interrupt requested
IR
Interrupt Request Bit
-
Noting is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
(b7-b4)
RW
RW
RW
RW (4)
-
NOTES:
1. To rewrite the interrupt control registers, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that
register. For details, refer to 23.5 Interrupt.
2. Use the IFSR07 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
3. Use the IFSR06 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
4. This bit can only be reset by writing "0" (Do not write "1").
5. When the IFSR02 bit in the IFSR0 register = 0 (CAN0/1 wake-up or error), CAN0/1 wake-up is selected.
When the IFSR02 bit = 1 (CAN0 wake-up/error or CAN1 wake-up/error), CAN0 wake-up/error is selected.
6. When the IFSR02 bit = 0, CAN0/1 error is selected. When the IFSR02 bit = 1, CAN1 wake-up/error is selected.
7. Use the IFSR01 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
Figure 10.3 Interrupt Control Registers (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 80 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
Interrupt Control Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
Symbol
Address
After Reset
INT3IC
C1RECIC/INT5IC (2) (6)
C1TRMIC/S3IC/INT4IC (2) (7)
INT0IC to INT2IC
0044h
0048h
0049h
005Dh to 005Fh
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
XX00X000b
(2)
b0
0
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
ILVL0
ILVL1
Interrupt Priority Level
Select Bit
ILVL2
IR
POL
(b5)
(b7-b6)
000:
001:
010:
011:
100:
101:
110:
111:
Level 0 (interrupt disabled)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 4
Level 5
Level 6
Level 7
RW
RW
RW
Interrupt Request Bit
0 : Interrupt not requested
1 : Interrupt requested
Polarity Select Bit
0 : Selects falling edge (4) (5)
1 : Selects rising edge
RW
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
RW (3)
-
NOTES:
1. To rewrite the interrupt control registers, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that
register. For details, refer to 23.5 Interrupt.
2. When the BYTE pin is low and the processor mode is memory expansion or microprocessor mode, set the
ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits in the INT5IC to INT3IC registers to "000b" (interrupt disabled).
3. This bit can only be reset by writing "0" (Do not write "1").
4. If the IFSR10 to IFSR15 bits in the IFSR1 register are "1" (both edges), set the POL bit in the INT0IC to INT5IC
register to "0" (falling edge).
5. Set the POL bit in the S3IC register to "0" (falling edge) when the IFSR00 bit in the IFSR0 register = 1 and the
IFSR16 bit in the IFSR1 register = 0 (SI/O3 selected).
6. Use the IFSR17 bit in the IFSR1 register to select.
7. Use the IFSR16 bit in the IFSR1 register and the IFSR00 bit in the IFSR0 register to select.
Figure 10.4 Interrupt Control Registers (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 81 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5.1 I Flag
The I flag enables or disables the maskable interrupt. Setting the I flag to “1” (enabled) enables the
maskable interrupt. Setting the I flag to “0” (disabled) disables all maskable interrupts.
10.5.2 IR Bit
The IR bit is set to “1” (interrupt requested) when an interrupt request is generated. Then, when the
interrupt request is accepted and the CPU branches to the corresponding interrupt vector, the IR bit is set
to “0” (interrupt not requested).
The IR bit can be set to “0” in a program. Note that do not write “1” to this bit.
10.5.3 ILVL2 to ILVL0 Bits and IPL
Interrupt priority levels can be set using the ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits.
Table 10.3 shows the settings of interrupt priority levels and Table 10.4 shows the interrupt priority levels
enabled by the IPL.
The following are conditions under which an interrupt is accepted:
· I flag = 1
· IR bit = 1
· interrupt priority level > IPL
The I flag, IR bit, ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits and IPL are independent of each other. In no case do they affect one
another.
Table 10.3 Settings of Interrupt Priority Levels
ILVL2 to ILVL0 Bits Interrupt Priority Level Priority Order
000b
Level 0 (Interrupt disabled)
001b
Level 1
Low
010b
Level 2
011b
Level 3
100b
Level 4
101b
Level 5
110b
Level 6
111b
Level 7
High
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 82 of 376
Table 10.4 Interrupt Priority Levels Enabled by IPL
IPL
Enabled Interrupt Priority Levels
000b
Interrupt levels 1 and above are enabled
001b
Interrupt levels 2 and above are enabled
010b
Interrupt levels 3 and above are enabled
011b
Interrupt levels 5 and above are enabled
100b
Interrupt levels 5 and above are enabled
101b
Interrupt levels 6 and above are enabled
110b
Interrupt levels 7 and above are enabled
111b
All maskable interrupts are disabled
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5.4 Interrupt Sequence
An interrupt sequence — what are performed over a period from the instant an interrupt is accepted to the
instant the interrupt routine is executed — is described here.
If an interrupt request is generated during execution of an instruction, the processor determines its priority
when the execution of the instruction is completed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence from
the next cycle. If an interrupt request is generated during execution of either the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR
or RMPA instruction, the processor temporarily suspends the instruction being executed, and transfers
control to the interrupt sequence.
The CPU behavior during the interrupt sequence is described below. Figure 10.5 shows time required for
executing the interrupt sequence.
(1) The CPU obtains interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading
address 000000h. Then, the IR bit applicable to the interrupt information is set to “0” (interrupt
requested).
(2) The FLG register, prior to an interrupt sequence, is saved to a temporary register (1) within the CPU.
(3) The I, D and U flags in the FLG register become as follows:
• The I flag is set to “0” (interrupt disabled)
• The D flag is set to “0” (single-step interrupt disabled)
• The U flag is set to “0” (ISP selected)
However, the U flag does not change state if an INT instruction for software interrupt Nos. 32 to 63 is
executed.
(4) The temporary register within the CPU is saved to the stack.
(5) The PC is saved to the stack.
(6) The interrupt priority level of the acknowledged interrupt in IPL is set.
(7) The start address of the relevant interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector is stored in the PC.
After the interrupt sequence is completed, an instruction is executed from the starting address of the
interrupt routine.
NOTE:
1. Temporary register cannot be modified by users.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
CPU clock
Address bus
Data bus
Address
0000h
Interrupt
information
RD
Indeterminate (1)
Indeterminate (1)
SP-2
SP-2
contents
SP-4
SP-4
contents
vec
vec
contents
vec+2
vec+2
contents
Indeterminate (1)
WR (2)
NOTES:
1. The indeterminate state depends on the instruction queue buffer.
A read cycle occurs when the instruction queue buffer is ready to accept instructions.
2. The WR signal timing shown here is for the case where the stack is located in the internal RAM.
Figure 10.5 Time Required for Executing Interrupt Sequence
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 83 of 376
PC
18
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5.5 Interrupt Response Time
Figure 10.6 shows the interrupt response time. The interrupt response or interrupt acknowledge time
denotes a time from when an interrupt request is generated till when the first instruction in the interrupt
routine is executed. Specifically, it consists of a time from when an interrupt request is generated till when
the instruction then executing is completed ((a) on Figure 10.6) and a time during which the interrupt
sequence is executed ((b) on Figure 10.6).
Interrupt request generated
Interrupt request acknowledged
Time
Instruction
Instruction in
interrupt routine
Interrupt sequence
(a)
(b)
Interrupt response time
(a) A time from when an interrupt request is generated till when the instruction then
executing is completed. The length of this time varies with the instruction being
executed. The DIVX instruction requires the longest time, which is equal to 30 cycles
(without wait state, the divisor being a register).
(b) A time during which the interrupt sequence is executed. For details, see the table
below. Note, however, that the values in this table must be increased 2 cycles for the
DBC interrupt and 1 cycle for the address match and single-step interrupts.
Interrupt Vector Address
SP Value
16-bit Bus, without Wait
8-bit Bus, without Wait
Even
Even
18 cycles
20 cycles
Odd
19 cycles
Even
19 cycles
Odd
20 cycles
Odd
Figure 10.6 Interrupt response time
10.5.6 Variation of IPL when Interrupt Request is Accepted
When a maskable interrupt request is accepted, the interrupt priority level of the accepted interrupt is set
in the IPL.
When a software interrupt or special interrupt request is accepted, one of the interrupt priority levels listed
in Table 10.5 is set in the IPL. Table 10.5 shows the IPL values of software and special interrupts when
they are accepted.
Table 10.5 IPL Level that is Set to IPL When A Software or Special Interrupt is Accepted
Interrupt Sources
_______
Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection, Watchdog Timer, NMI
Value that is Set to IPL
7
_________
Software, Address Match, DBC, Single-Step
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 84 of 376
Not changed
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5.7 Saving Registers
In the interrupt sequence, the FLG register and PC are saved to the stack.
At this time, the 4 high-order bits of the PC and the 4 high-order (IPL) and 8 low-order bits in the FLG
register, 16 bits in total, are saved to the stack first. Next, the 16 low-order bits of the PC are saved. Figure
10.7 shows the stack status before and after an interrupt request is accepted.
The other necessary registers must be saved in a program at the beginning of the interrupt routine. Use
the PUSHM instruction, and all registers except SP can be saved with a single instruction.
Stack
MSB
Stack
LSB
MSB
LSB
Address
Address
m-4
m-4
m-3
m-3
PCM
m-2
m-2
FLGL
m-1
m-1
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
[SP]
SP value before
interrupt request
is accepted.
Stack status before interrupt request is acknowledged
[SP]
New SP value
PCL
FLGH
PCH
m
Content of previous stack
m+1
Content of previous stack
Stack status after interrupt request is acknowledged
PCL : 8 low-order bit of PC
PCM : 8 middle-order bits of PC
PCH : 4 high-order bits of PC
FLGL : 8 low-order bits of FLG
FLGH: 4 high-order bits of FLG
Figure 10.7 Stack Status Before and After Acceptance of Interrupt Request
The operation of saving registers carried out in the interrupt sequence is dependent on whether the SP (1),
at the time of acceptance of an interrupt request, is even or odd. If the SP (Note) is even, the FLG register
and the PC are saved, 16 bits at a time. If odd, they are saved in two steps, 8 bits at a time. Figure 10.8
shows the operation of the saving registers.
NOTE:
1. When any INT instruction in software numbers 32 to 63 has been executed, this is the SP indicated
by the U flag. Otherwise, it is the ISP.
(1)SP contains even number
Address
(2)SP contains odd number
Stack
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
[SP] - 5 (Odd)
PCL
[SP] - 3 (Odd)
PCM
[SP] - 2 (Even)
FLGL
[SP]
Stack
Sequence in which order
registers are saved
[SP] - 5 (Even)
[SP] - 4 (Even)
[SP] - 1 (Odd)
Address
FLGH
PCH
(Even)
(2) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
[SP] - 4 (Odd)
PCL
(3)
[SP] - 3 (Even)
PCM
(4)
(1) Saved simultaneously,
all 16 bits
[SP] - 2 (Odd)
FLGL
(1)
Finished saving registers
in two operations.
[SP] - 1 (Even)
[SP]
(Odd)
FLGH
PCH
Saved,8 bits
at a time
(2)
Finished saving registers
in four operations.
PCL : 8 low-order bit of PC
PCM : 8 middle-order bits of PC
PCH : 4 high-order bits of PC
FLGL : 8 low-order bits of FLG
FLGH: 4 high-order bits of FLG
NOTE:
1. [SP] denotes the initial value of the SP when interrupt request is acknowledged. After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4.
Figure 10.8 Operation of Saving Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 85 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.5.8 Returning from an Interrupt Routine
The FLG register and PC in the state in which they were immediately before entering the interrupt
sequence are restored from the stack by executing the REIT instruction at the end of the interrupt routine.
Thereafter the CPU returns to the program which was being executed before accepting the interrupt
request.
Return the other registers saved by a program within the interrupt routine using the POPM or similar
instruction before executing the REIT instruction.
Register bank is switched back to the bank used prior to the interrupt sequence by the REIT instruction.
10.5.9 Interrupt Priority
If two or more interrupt requests are sampled at the same sampling points (a timing to detect whether an
interrupt request is generated or not), the interrupt request that has the highest priority is accepted.
For maskable interrupts (peripheral functions interrupt), any desired priority level can be selected using
the ILVL2 to ILVL0 bits. However, if two or more maskable interrupts have the same priority level, their
interrupt priority is resolved by hardware, with the highest priority interrupt accepted.
The watchdog timer and other special interrupts have their priority levels set in hardware. Figure 10.9
shows the priorities of hardware interrupts.
Software interrupts are not affected by the interrupt priority. If an instruction is executed, control branches
invariably to the interrupt routine.
Reset
High
NMI
DBC
Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection
Watchdog Timer
Peripheral Function
Single Step
Address Match
Low
Figure 10.9 Hardware Interrupt Priority
10.5.10 Interrupt Priority Resolution Circuit
The interrupt priority level select circuit selects the highest priority interrupt when two or more interrupt
requests are sampled at the same sampling point.
Figure 10.10 shows the circuit that judges the interrupt priority level.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 86 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Priority level of each interrupt
10. Interrupt
Level 0
(initial value)
Highest
INT1
Timer B2
Timer B0
Timer A3
Timer A1
UART1 Reception, ACK1
UART0 Reception, ACK0
UART2 Reception, ACK2
INT2
INT0
Timer B1
Timer A4
Timer A2
Timer A0
UART1 Transmission, NACK1
UART0 Transmission, NACK0
A/D Conversion, Key Input
DMA1
Priority of peripheral function interrupts
(if priority levels are same)
UART2 Bus Collision Detection
CAN1 Successful Reception, INT5
Timer B4, UART1 Bus Collision Detection
INT3
CAN0 Successful Reception
UART2 Transmission, NACK2
CAN0/1 Error
DMA0
SI/O3, CAN1 Successful Transmission, INT4
Timer B3, UART0 Bus Collision Detection
Timer B5
CAN0 Successful Transmission
CAN0/1 Wake-up
Lowest
IPL
Interrupt request level resolution output to clock generating circuit
(Figure 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit)
I Flag
Address Match
Oscillation Stop and Re-oscillation Detection
Watchdog Timer
DBC
NMI
Figure 10.10 Interrupts Priority Select Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 87 of 376
Interrupt request accepted
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
______
10.6
INT Interrupt
_______
INTi interrupt (i = 0 to 5) is triggered by the edges of external inputs. The edge polarity is selected using the
IFSR10
to IFSR15 bits in the IFSR1 register.
________
INT4
share the interrupt vector and interrupt control register with CAN1 successful transmission and SI/O3.
________
INT5
share the interrupt vector and interrupt control register with
CAN1 successful________
reception. To use the
________
________
INT4 interrupt, set the IFSR16 bit of the
IFSR1
register
to
“1”
(INT4).
To
use
the
INT5
interrupt, set the
________
IFSR17 bit of the IFSR1 register to “1” (INT5).
After modifying the IFSR16 or IFSR17 bit, set the corresponding IR bit to “0” (interrupt not requested)
before enabling the interrupt.
Figure 10.11 shows the IFSR0 and IFSR1 registers.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 88 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
Interrupt Request Cause Select Register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR0
Address
01DEh
Bit Name
After Reset
00XXX000h
Function
RW
IFSR00
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit
0 : CAN1 successful transission
1 : SI/O3
RW
IFSR01
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit
0 : A/D conversion
1 : Key input
RW
IFSR02
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit (3)
0 : CAN0/1 wake-up or error
1 : CAN0 wake-up/error or
CAN1 wake-up/error
RW
Bit Symbol
(b5-b3)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
RW
IFSR06
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit (1)
0 : Timer B3
1 : UART0 bus collision detection
RW
IFSR07
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit (2)
0 : Timer B4
1 : UART1 bus collision detection
RW
NOTES:
1.Timer B3 and UART0 bus collision detection share the vector and interrupt control register.
When using the timer B3 interrupt, set the IFSR06 bit to "0" (Tmer B3).
When using UART0 bus collision detection, set the IFSR06 bit to "1" (UART0 bus collision detection).
2.Timer B4 and UART1 bus collision detection share the vector and interrupt control register.
When using the timer B4 interrupt, set the IFSR07 bit to "0" (Timer B4).
When using UART1 bus collision detection, set the IFSR07 bit to "1" (UART1 bus collision detection).
3.If this bit is set to "0", the software interrupt number 1 is selected CAN0/1 wake-up and the interrupt
number 13 is selected CAN0/1 error. If this bit is set to "1", the interrupt number 1 is selected CAN0
wake-up/error and the interrupt number 13 is selected CAN1 wake-up/error.
Interrupt Request Cause Select Register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IFSR1
Bit Symbol
Address
01DFh
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
IFSR10
INT0 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR11
INT1 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR12
INT2 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR13
INT3 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR14
INT4 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR15
INT5 Interrupt Polarity
Switching Bit
0 : One edge
1 : Both edges (1)
RW
IFSR16
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit (2)
0 : SI/O3/CAN1 successful transmission (3)
1 : INT4
RW
IFSR17
Interrupt Request Cause
Select Bit (2)
0 : CAN1 successful reception
1 : INT5
RW
NOTES:
1.When setting this bit to "1" (both edges), make sure the POL bit in the INT0IC to INT5IC register is set
to "0" (falling edge).
2.During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, when the data bus is 16-bit width (BYTE pin is
"L"), set this bit to "0".
3.When setting this bit to "0" (SI/O3, CAN1 successful transmission), make sure the IFSR00 bit in the
IFSR0 register is set to "0" (CAN1 successful transmission) or "1" (SI/O3).
And, make sure the POL bit in the S3IC and C1TRMIC registers are set to "0" (falling edge).
Figure 10.11 IFSR0, IFSR1 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 89 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
______
10.7_______
NMI Interrupt
_______
______
An NMI interrupt request is generated when input on the NMI pin changes state from high to low. The NMI
interrupt is a non-maskable
interrupt.
_______
The input level of this NMI interrupt input pin can be read by accessing the P8_5 bit in the P8 register.
This pin cannot be used as an input port.
10.8 Key Input Interrupt
Of P10_4 to P10_7, a key input interrupt request is generated when input on any of the P10_4 to P10_7
pins which has had the PD10_4 to PD10_7 bits in the PD10 register set to “0” (input) goes low. Key input
interrupts can be used as a key-on wake up function, the function which gets the microcomputer out of wait
or stop mode. However, if you intend to use the key input interrupt, do not use P10_4 to P10_7 as analog
input ports. Figure 10.12 shows the block diagram of the key input interrupt. Note, however, that while input
on any pin which has had the PD10_4 to PD10_7 bits set to “0” (input mode) is pulled low, inputs on all other
pins of the port are not detected as interrupts.
PU25 bit in PUR2 register
Pull-up
transistor
KUPIC register
PD10_7 bit in PD10 register
PD10_7 bit in PD10 register
KI3
PD10_6 bit in
PD10 register
Pull-up
transistor
Interrupt control circuit
KI2
Pull-up
transistor
PD10_5 bit in
PD10 register
Pull-up
transistor
PD10_4 bit in
PD10 register
Key input interrupt
request
KI1
KI0
Figure 10.12 Key Input Interrupt Block Diagram
10.9 CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt
CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt request is generated when a falling edge is input to CRX0 or CRX1. One interrupt
is allocated to CAN0/1. The CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt is enabled only when the PortEn bit = 1 (CTX/CRX
function) and Sleep bit = 1 (Sleep mode enabled) in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1). Figure 10.13 shows the
block diagram of the CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt. Please note that the wake-up message will be lost.
Sleep bit in C0CTLR register
PortEn bit in C0CTLR register
C01WKIC register
CRX0
Sleep bit in C1CTLR register
PortEn bit in C1CTLR register
CRX1
Figure 10.13 CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 90 of 376
Interrupt control
circuit
CAN0/1 wake-up
interrupt request
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
10.10 Address Match Interrupt
An address match interrupt request is generated immediately before executing the instruction at the address indicated by the RMADi register (i = 0 to 3). Set the start address of any instruction in the RMADi
register. Use the AIER0 and AIER1 bits in the AIER register and the AIER20 and AIER21 bits in the AIER2
register to enable or disable the interrupt. Note that the address match interrupt is unaffected by the I flag
and IPL. For address match interrupts, the value of the PC that is saved to the stack area varies depending
on the instruction being executed (refer to 10.5.7 Saving Registers). (The value of the PC that is saved to
the stack area is not the correct return address.) Therefore, follow one of the methods described below to
return from the address match interrupt.
• Rewrite the content of the stack and then use the REIT instruction to return.
• Restore the stack to its previous state before the interrupt request was accepted by using the POP or
similar other instruction and then use a jump instruction to return.
Table 10.6 shows the value of the PC that is saved to the stack area when an address match interrupt
request is accepted. Table 10.7 shows the relationship between address match interrupt sources and
associated registers.
Note that when using the external bus in 8-bit width, no address match interrupts can be used for external
areas.
Figure 10.14 shows the AIER, AIER2, and RMAD0 to RMAD3 registers.
Table 10.6 Value of PC That is Saved to Stack Area When Address Match Interrupt Request is Accepted
Instruction at Address Indicated by RMADi Register
Value of PC that is Saved to Stack Area
• 16-bit operation code
Address indicated by RMADi
register + 2
• Instruction shown below among 8-bit operation code instructions
ADD.B:S
#IMM8,dest
SUB.B:S
#IMM8,dest
AND.B:S
#IMM8,dest
OR.B:S
#IMM8,dest
MOV.B:S
#IMM8,dest
STZ.B:S
#IMM8,dest
STNZ.B:S
#IMM8,dest
STZX.B:S
#IMM81,#IMM82,dest
CMP.B:S
#IMM8,dest
PUSHM
src
JMPS
#IMM8
JSRS
#IMM8
MOV.B:S
#IMM,dest (However, dest = A0 or A1)
POPM dest
Address indicated by RMADi
register + 1
Value of PC that is saved to stack area: Refer to 10.5.7 Saving Registers.
Instructions other than the above
Table 10.7 Relationship Between Address Match Interrupt Sources and Associated Registers
Address Match Interrupt Sources
Address Match Interrupt 0
Address Match Interrupt 1
Address Match Interrupt 2
Address Match Interrupt 3
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Address Match Interrupt Enable Bit Address Match Interrupt Register
AIER0
RMAD0
AIER1
RMAD1
AIER20
RMAD2
AIER21
RMAD3
page 91 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
10. Interrupt
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
AIER
Address
0009h
After Reset
XXXXXX00b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
AIER0
AIER1
-
Function
RW
Address Match Interrupt 0
Enable Bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
Address Match Interrupt 1
Enable Bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
(b7-b2)
-
Address Match Interrupt Enable Register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
AIER2
Address
01BBh
After Reset
XXXXXX00b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
AIER20
Address Match Interrupt 2
Enable Bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
AIER21
Address Match Interrupt 3
Enable Bit
0 : Interrupt disabled
1 : Interrupt enabled
RW
-
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
(b7-b2)
Address Match Interrupt Register i (i = 0 to 3)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
Bit Symbol
(b19-b0)
(b23-b20)
b0
Symbol
RMAD0
RMAD1
RMAD2
RMAD3
Address
0012h to 0010h
0016h to 0014h
01BAh to 01B8h
01BEh to 01BCh
Function
Address setting register for address
match interrupt
-
Setting Range
00000h to FFFFFh
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
Figure 10.14 AIER Register, AIER2 Register and RMAD0 to RMAD3 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 92 of 376
After Reset
X00000h
X00000h
X00000h
X00000h
RW
RW
-
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
11. Watchdog Timer
11. Watchdog Timer
The watchdog timer is the function of detecting when the program is out of control. Therefore, we recommend
using the watchdog timer to improve reliability of a system. The watchdog timer contains a 15-bit counter
which counts down the clock derived by dividing the CPU clock using the prescaler. Whether to generate a
watchdog timer interrupt request or apply a watchdog timer reset as an operation to be performed when the
watchdog timer underflows after reaching the terminal count can be selected using the PM12 bit in the PM1
register. The PM12 bit can only be set to “1” (watchdog timer reset). Once this bit is set to “1”, it cannot be set
to “0” (watchdog timer interrupt) in a program. Refer to 5.3 Watchdog Timer Reset for details about watchdog
timer reset.
When the main clock, on-chip oscillator clock or PLL clock is selected for CPU clock, the divide-by-n value for
the prescaler can be selected to be 16 or 128. If a sub clock is selected for CPU clock, the divide-by-n value
for the prescaler is always 2 no matter how the WDC7 bit is set. The period of watchdog timer can be
calculated as given below. The period of watchdog timer is, however, subject to an error due to the prescaler.
With main clock, on-chip oscillator clock or PLL clock selected for CPU clock
Watchdog timer period =
Prescaler dividing (16 or 128) ✕ Watchdog timer count (32768)
CPU clock
With sub clock selected for CPU clock
Watchdog timer period =
Prescaler dividing (2) ✕ Watchdog timer count (32768)
CPU clock
For example, when CPU clock = 16 MHz and the divide-by-n value for the prescaler = 16, the watchdog timer
period is approx. 32.8 ms.
The watchdog timer is initialized by writing to the WDTS register. The prescaler is initialized after reset. Note
that the watchdog timer and the prescaler both are inactive after reset, so that the watchdog timer is
activated to start counting by writing to the WDTS register.
In stop mode, wait mode and hold state, the watchdog timer and prescaler are stopped. Counting is
resumed from the held value when the modes or state are released.
Figure 11.1 shows the block diagram of the watchdog timer. Figure 11.2 shows the watchdog timer-related
registers.
Prescaler
1/16
CPU clock
HOLD
1/128
1/2
CM07 = 0
WDC7 = 0
CM07 = 0
WDC7 = 1
PM22 = 0
CM07 = 1
PM12 = 0
Watchdog timer
Interrupt request
Watchdog timer
PM22 = 1
On-chip oscillator clock
Write to WDTS register
Internal RESET signal
("L" active)
CM07 : Bit in CM0 register
WDC7 : Bit in WDC register
PM12 : Bit in PM1 register
PM22 : Bit in PM2 register
Figure 11.1 Watchdog Timer Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 93 of 376
Set to
"7FFFh"
PM12 = 1
Watchdog timer
Reset
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
11. Watchdog Timer
Watchdog Timer Control Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
WDC
Address
000Fh
Bit Symbol
After Reset
00XXXXXXb
Function
Bit Name
RW
(b4-b0)
High-order Bit of Watchdog Timer
RO
(b6-b5)
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
WDC7
Prescaler Select Bit
0 : Divided by 16
1 : Divided by 128
RW
Watchdog Timer Start Register (1)
b7
b0
Symbol
WDTS
Address
000Eh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Function
RW
The watchdog timer is initialized and starts counting after a write instruction to
this register. The watchdog timer value is always initialized to "7FFFh" regardless WO
of whatever value is written.
NOTE
1. Write to the WDTS register after the watchdog timer interrupt request is generated.
Figure 11.2 WDC Register and WDTS Register
11.1 Count Source Protective Mode
In this mode, a on-chip oscillator clock is used for the watchdog timer count source. The watchdog timer
can be kept being clocked even when CPU clock stops as a result of runaway.
Before this mode can be used, the following register settings are required:
(1) Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to “1” (enable writes to the PM1 and PM2 registers).
(2) Set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to “1” (reset when the watchdog timer underflows).
(3) Set the PM22 bit in the PM2 register to “1” (on-chip oscillator clock used for the watchdog timer count source).
(4) Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to “0” (disable writes to the PM1 and PM2 registers).
(5) Write to the WDTS register (watchdog timer starts counting).
Setting the PM22 bit to “1” results in the following conditions:
• The on-chip oscillator starts oscillating, and the on-chip oscillator clock becomes the watchdog timer
count source.
Watchdog timer count (32768)
Watchdog timer period =
on-chip oscillator clock
• The CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled against write. (Writing a “1” has no effect, nor is stop mode entered.)
• The watchdog timer does not stop when in wait mode or hold state.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 94 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
12. DMAC
The DMAC (Direct Memory Access Controller) allows data to be transferred without the CPU intervention.
Two DMAC channels are included. Each time a DMA request occurs, the DMAC transfers one (8- or 16-bit)
data from the source address to the destination address. The DMAC uses the same data bus as used by the
CPU. Because the DMAC has higher priority of bus control than the CPU and because it makes use of a
cycle steal method, it can transfer one word (16 bits) or one byte (8 bits) of data within a very short time after
a DMA request is generated. Figure 12.1 shows the block diagram of the DMAC. Table 12.1 shows the
DMAC specifications. Figures 12.2 to 12.4 show the DMAC related-registers.
Address bus
DMA0 source pointer SAR0
DMA0 destination pointer DAR0
DMA0 forward address pointer (1)
DMA0 transfer counter reload register TCR0
DMA1 source pointer SAR1
DMA0 transfer counter TCR0
DMA1 destination pointer DAR1
DMA1 transfer counter reload register TCR1
DMA1 forward address pointer (1)
DMA1 transfer counter TCR1
DMA latch high-order bits
DMA latch low-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Data bus high-order bits
NOTE:
1.Pointer is incremented by a DMA request.
Figure 12.1 DMAC Block Diagram
A DMA request is generated by a write to the DSR bit in the DMiSL register (i = 0, 1), as well as by an
interrupt request which is generated by any function specified by the DMS and DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits in the
DMiSL register. However, unlike in the case of interrupt requests, DMA requests are not affected by the I flag
and the interrupt control register, so that even when interrupt requests are disabled and no interrupt request
can be accepted, DMA requests are always accepted. Furthermore, because the DMAC does not affect
interrupts, the IR bit in the interrupt control register does not change state due to a DMA transfer.
A data transfer is initiated each time a DMA request is generated when the DMAE bit in the DMiCON register
= 1 (DMA enabled). However, if the cycle in which a DMA request is generated is faster than the DMA
transfer cycle, the number of transfer requests generated and the number of times data is transferred may
not match. For details, refer to 12.4 DMA Request.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 95 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
Table 12.1 DMAC Specifications
Item
Specification
No. of Channels
2 (cycle steal method)
Transfer Memory Space
• From any address in the 1-Mbyte space to a fixed address
• From a fixed address to any address in the 1-Mbyte space
• From a fixed address to a fixed address
Maximum No. of Bytes Transferred 128 Kbytes (with
16-bit ________
transfer) or 64 Kbytes (with 8-bit transfer)
________
(1) (2)
DMA Request Factors
Falling edge of INT0 or INT1
________
________
Both edge of INT0 or INT1
Timer A0 to timer A4 interrupt requests
Timer B0 to timer B5 interrupt requests
UART0 transfer, UART0 reception interrupt requests
UART1 transfer, UART1 reception interrupt requests
UART2 transfer, UART2 reception interrupt requests
SI/O3 interrupt request
Channel Priority
Transfer Unit
Transfer Address Direction
Transfer Mode Single Transfer
A/D conversion interrupt requests
Software triggers
DMA0 > DMA1 (DMA0 takes precedence)
8 bits or 16 bits
forward or fixed (The source and destination addresses cannot both be
in the forward direction.)
Transfer is completed when the DMAi transfer counter underflows
after reaching the terminal count.
Repeat Transfer When the DMAi transfer counter underflows, it is reloaded with the value
of the DMAi transfer counter reload register and a DMA transfer is
DMA Interrupt Request
Generation Timing
DMA Start Up
continued with it.
When the DMAi transfer counter underflowed
Data transfer is initiated each time a DMA request is generated when the
The DMAE bit in the DMAiCON register = 1 (enabled).
DMA Shutdown Single Transfer • When the DMAE bit is set to “0” (disabled)
• After the DMAi transfer counter underflows
Repeat Transfer
Reload Timing for Forward
Address Pointer and Transfer
Counter
DMA Transfer Cycles
When the DMAE bit is set to “0” (disabled)
When a data transfer is started after setting the DMAE bit to “1” (enabled),
the forward address pointer is reloaded with the value of the SARi or the
DARi pointer whichever is specified to be in the forward direction and the
DMAi transfer counter is reloaded with the value of the DMAi transfer
counter reload register.
Minimum 3 cycles between SFR and internal RAM
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. DMA transfer is not effective to any interrupt. DMA transfer is affected neither by the I flag nor by the
interrupt control register.
2. The selectable causes of DMA requests differ with each channel.
3. Make sure that no DMAC-related registers (addresses 0020h to 003Fh) are accessed by the DMAC.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 96 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
DMA0 Request Cause Select Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DM0SL
Bit Symbol
Address
03B8h
After Reset
00h
Function
Bit Name
DSEL0
DSEL1
DSEL2
RW
DMA Request Cause
Select Bit
See NOTE 1
-
RW
RW
DSEL3
(b5-b4)
RW
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
-
DMS
DMA Request Cause
Expansion Select Bit
0 : Basic cause of request
1 : Extended cause of request
RW
DSR
Software DMA
Request Bit
A DMA request is generated by setting
this bit to "1" when the DMS bit is "0"
(basic cause) and the DSEL3 to DSEL0
bits are "0001b" (software trigger).
The value of this bit when read is "0".
RW
NOTE:
1. The causes of DMA0 requests can be selected by a combination of the DMS bit and the DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits
in the manner described below.
DSEL3 to DSEL0 Bits
0000b
0001b
0010b
0011b
0100b
0101b
0110b
0111b
1000b
1001b
1010b
1011b
1100b
1101b
1110b
1111b
DMS = 0 (basic cause of request)
Falling edge of INT0 pin
Software trigger
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
UART0 transmit
UART0 receive
UART2 transmit
UART2 receive
A/D conversion
UART1 transmit
Figure 12.2 DM0SL Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 97 of 376
DMS = 1 (extended cause of request)
—
—
—
—
—
—
Two edges of INT0 pin
Timer B3
Timer B4
Timer B5
—
—
—
—
—
—
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
DMA1 Request Cause Select Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DM1SL
Bit Symbol
Address
03BAh
After Reset
00h
Function
Bit Name
DSEL0
DSEL1
DSEL2
RW
DMA Request Cause
Select Bit
RW
See NOTE 1
RW
DSEL3
(b5-b4)
RW
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
-
DMS
DMA Request Cause
Expansion Select Bit
0 : Basic cause of request
1 : Extended cause of request
RW
DSR
Software DMA
Request Bit
A DMA request is generated by setting
this bit to "1" when the DMS bit is "0"
(basic cause) and the DSEL3 to DSEL0
bits are "0001b" (software trigger).
The value of this bit when read is "0".
RW
NOTE:
1. The causes of DMA1 requests can be selected by a combination of the DMS bit and the DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits
in the manner described below.
DSEL3 to DSEL0 Bits
0000b
0001b
0010b
0011b
0100b
0101b
0110b
0111b
1000b
1001b
1010b
1011b
1100b
1101b
1110b
1111b
DMS = 0 (basic cause of request)
Falling edge of INT1 pin
Software trigger
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
UART0 transmit
UART0 receive/ACK0
UART2 transmit
UART2 receive/ACK2
A/D conversion
UART1 transmit/ACK1
DMS = 1 (extended cause of request)
—
—
—
—
—
SI/O3
—
Two edges of INT1 pin
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DMAi Control Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
DM0CON
DM1CON
Bit Symbol
Address
002Ch
003Ch
After Reset
00000X00b
00000X00b
Function
Bit Name
RW
DMBIT
Transfer Unit Bit
Select Bit
0 : 16 bits
1 : 8 bits
RW
DMASL
Repeat Transfer Mode
Select Bit
0 : Single transfer
1 : Repeat transfer
RW
DMAS
DMA Request Bit
0 : DMA not requested
1 : DMA requested
DMAE
DMA Enable Bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
RW
DSD
Source Address Direction
Select Bit (2)
0 : Fixed
1 : Forward
RW
DAD
Destination Address
Direction Select Bit (2)
0 : Fixed
1 : Forward
RW
(b7-b6)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
RW (1)
-
NOTES:
1. The DMAS bit can be set to "0" by writing "0" in a program. (This bit remains unchanged even if "1" is written.)
2. At least one of the DAD and DSD bits must be "0" (address direction fixed).
Figure 12.3 DM1SL Register, DM0CON and DM1CON Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 98 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
DMAi Source Pointer (i = 0, 1) (1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
SAR0
SAR1
Address
0022h to 0020h
0032h to 0030h
Function
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
00000h to FFFFFh
Set the source address of transfer
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
RW
RW
-
NOTE:
1. If the DSD bit in the DMiCON register is "0" (fixed), this register can only be written to when the DMAE bit in the
DMiCON register is "0" (DMA disabled).
If the DSD bit is "1" (forward direction), this register can be written to at any time.
If the DSD bit is "1" and the DMAE bit is "1" (DMA enabled), the DMAi forward address pointer can be read from
this register. Otherwise, the value written to it can be read.
DMAi Destination Pointer (i = 0, 1) (1)
(b23)
b7
(b19)
b3
(b16)(b15)
b0 b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
DAR0
DAR1
Address
0026h to 0024h
0036h to 0034h
Function
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
00000h to FFFFFh
Set the destination address of transfer
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
RW
RW
-
NOTE:
1. If the DAD bit in the DMiCON register is "0" (fixed), this register can only be written to when the DMAE bit in the
DMiCON register is "0" (DMA disabled).
If the DAD bit is "1" (forward direction), this register can be written to at any time.
If the DAD bit is "1" and the DMAE bit is "1" (DMA enabled), the DMAi forward address pointer can be read from
this register. Otherwise, the value written to it can be read.
DMAi Transfer Counter (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
TCR0
TCR1
Address
0029h, 0028h
0039h, 0038h
Function
Set the transfer count minus 1.
The written value is stored in the DMAi transfer counter
reload register, and when the DMAE bit in the DMiCON
register is set to "1" (DMA enabled) or the DMAi transfer
counter underflows when the DMASL bit in the DMiCON
register is "1" (repeat transfer), the value of the DMAi
transfer counter reload register is transferred to the DMAi
transfer counter.
When read, the DMAi transfer counter is read.
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
Figure 12.4 SAR0 and SAR1 Registers, DAR0 and DAR1 Registers, TCR0 and TCR1 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 99 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
12.1 Transfer Cycle
The transfer cycle consists of a memory or SFR read (source read) bus cycle and a write (destination write)
bus cycle. The number of read and write bus cycles is affected by the source and destination addresses of
transfer. During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, it ________
is also affected by the BYTE pin level.
Furthermore, the bus cycle itself is extended by a software wait or RDY signal.
12.1.1 Effect of Source and Destination Addresses
If the transfer unit and data bus both are 16 bits and the source address of transfer begins with an odd
address, the source read cycle consists of one more bus cycle than when the source address of transfer
begins with an even address.
Similarly, if the transfer unit and data bus both are 16 bits and the destination address of transfer begins
with an odd address, the destination write cycle consists of one more bus cycle than when the destination
address of transfer begins with an even address.
12.1.2 Effect of BYTE Pin Level
During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, if 16 bits of data are to be transferred on an 8-bit
data bus (input on the BYTE pin = high), the operation is accomplished by transferring 8 bits of data twice.
Therefore, this operation requires two bus cycles to read data and two bus cycles to write data.
Furthermore, if the DMAC is to access the internal area (internal ROM, internal RAM, or SFR), unlike in
the case of the CPU, the DMAC does it through the data bus width selected by the BYTE pin.
12.1.3 Effect of Software Wait
For memory or SFR accesses in which one or more software wait states are inserted, the number of bus
cycles required for that access increases by an amount equal to software wait states.
Figure 12.5 shows the example of the transfer cycles for a source read. For convenience, the destination
write cycle is shown as one cycle and the source read cycles for the different conditions are shown. In
reality, the destination write cycle is subject to the same conditions as the source read cycle, with the
transfer cycle changing accordingly. When calculating transfer cycles, take into consideration each
condition for the source read and the destination write cycle, respectively. For example, when data is
transferred in 16-bit unit using an 8-bit bus ((2) on Figure 12.5), two source read bus cycles and two
destination write bus cycles are required.
________
12.1.4 Effect of RDY Signal
During memory________
expansion and microprocessor
modes, DMA transfers to and from an external area are
________
affected by the RDY signal. Refer to 7.2.6 RDY Signal.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 100 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
(1) When the transfer unit is 8 or 16 bits and the source of transfer is an even address
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Dummy
cycle
Destination
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Dummy
cycle
Destination
CPU use
(2) When the transfer unit is 16 bits and the source address of transfer is an odd address, or when the
transfer unit is 16 bits and an 8-bit bus is used
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(3) When the source read cycle under condition (1) has one wait state inserted
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
(4) When the source read cycle under condition (2) has one wait state inserted
BCLK
Address
bus
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
RD signal
WR signal
Data
bus
CPU use
Source
Source + 1
Destination
Dummy
cycle
CPU use
NOTE:
1. The same timing changes occur with the respective conditions at the destination as at the source.
Figure 12.5 Transfer Cycles for Source Read
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 101 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
12.2 DMA Transfer Cycles
Any combination of even or odd transfer read and write addresses is possible.
Table 12.2 shows the number of DMA transfer cycles. Table 12.3 shows the coefficient j, k.
The number of DMAC transfer cycles can be calculated as follows:
No. of transfer cycles per transfer unit = No. of read cycles ✕ j + No. of write cycles ✕ k
Table 12.2 DMA Transfer Cycles
Single-chip Mode
Transfer Unit
Bus Width
Access Address
Memory Expansion Mode
Microprocessor Mode
No. of Read No. of Write No. of Read No. of Write
Cycles
Cycles
Cycles
Cycles
8-bit Transfer
(DMBIT =1)
16-bit Transfer
(DMBIT = 0)
16 bits
Even
1
1
1
1
(BYTE = L)
8 bits
Odd
Even
1
-
1
-
1
1
1
1
(BYTE= H)
16 bits
Odd
Even
1
1
1
1
1
1
(BYTE =L)
Odd
2
2
2
2
8 bits
Even
-
-
2
2
(BYTE = H)
Odd
-
-
2
2
-: This condition does not exist.
Table 12.3 Coefficient j, k
Internal Area
Internal ROM, RAM
SFR
External Area
Separate Bus
Multiplexed Bus
(2)
No Wait With Wait 1 Wait (1) 2 Waits (1) No Wait
j
1
2
2
3
1
k
1
2
2
3
2
With Wait (2)
With Wait
1 Wait 2 Waits 3 Waits 1 Wait 2 Waits 3 Waits
2
3
4
3
3
4
2
3
NOTES:
1. Depends on the set value of the PM20 bit in the PM2 register.
2. Depends on the set value of the CSE register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 102 of 376
4
3
3
4
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
12.3 DMA Enable
When a data transfer starts after setting the DMAE bit in the DMiCON register (i = 0, 1) to “1” (enabled), the
DMAC operates as follows:
(1) Reload the forward address pointer with the SARi register value when the DSD bit in the DMiCON register
is “1” (forward) or the DARi register value when the DAD bit in the DMiCON register is “1” (forward).
(2) Reload the DMAi transfer counter with the DMAi transfer counter reload register value.
If the DMAE bit is set to “1” again while it remains set, the DMAC performs the above operation.
However, if a DMA request may occur simultaneously when the DMAE bit is being written, follow the steps
below.
Step 1: Write “1” to the DMAE bit and DMAS bit in the DMiCON register simultaneously.
Step 2: Make sure that the DMAi is in an initial state as described above (1) and (2) in a program.
If the DMAi is not in an initial state, the above steps should be repeated.
12.4 DMA Request
The DMAC can generate a DMA request as triggered by the cause of request that is selected with the DMS
and DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits in the DMiSL register (i = 0, 1) on either channel. Table 12.4 shows the timing at
which the DMAS bit changes state.
Whenever a DMA request is generated, the DMAS bit is set to “1” (DMA requested) regardless of whether
or not the DMAE bit is set. If the DMAE bit was set to “1” (enabled) when this occurred, the DMAS bit is set
to “0” (DMA not requested) immediately before a data transfer starts. This bit cannot be set to “1” in a
program (it can only be set to “0”).
The DMAS bit may be set to “1” when the DMS or the DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits change state. Therefore,
always be sure to set the DMAS bit to “0” after changing the DMS or the DSEL3 to DSEL0 bits.
Because if the DMAE bit is “1”, a data transfer starts immediately after a DMA request is generated, the
DMAS bit in almost all cases is “0” when read in a program. Read the DMAE bit to determine whether the
DMAC is enabled.
Table 12.4 Timing at Which DMAS bit Changes State
DMAS Bit in DMiCON Register
DMA Factor
Timing at which the bit is set to “1”
Timing at which the bit is set to “0”
Software Trigger
Peripheral Function
When the DSR bit in the DMiSL register • Immediately before a data transfer starts
is set to “1”
• When set by writing “0” in a program
When the interrupt control register for
the peripheral function that is selected
by the DSEL3 to DSEL0 and DMS bits
in the DMiSL register has its IR bit set to “1”.
i = 0, 1
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 103 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
12. DMAC
12.5 Channel Priority and DMA Transfer Timing
If both DMA0 and DMA1 are enabled and DMA transfer request signals from DMA0 and DMA1 are
detected active in the same sampling period (one period from a falling edge to the next falling edge of
BCLK), the DMAS bit on each channel is set to “1” (DMA requested) at the same time. In this case, the DMA
requests are arbitrated according to the channel priority, DMA0 > DMA1.
The following describes DMAC operation when DMA0 and DMA1 requests are detected active in the same
sampling period.
Figure 12.6 shows an example of DMA transfer effected by external factors.
In Figure 12.6, DMA0 request having priority is received first to start a transfer when a DMA0 request and
DMA1 request are generated simultaneously. After one DMA0 transfer is completed, a bus arbitration is
returned to the CPU. When the CPU has completed one bus access, a DMA1 transfer starts. After one
DMA1 transfer is completed, the bus arbitration is again returned to the CPU.
In addition, DMA requests cannot be counted up since each channel has one DMAS bit. Therefore, when
DMA requests, as DMA1 in Figure 12.6, occurs more than one time, the DMAS bit is set to “0” as soon as
getting the bus __________
arbitration. The bus arbitration is returned to the CPU when one transfer is completed.
Refer to 7.2.7 HOLD Signal for details about bus arbitration between the CPU and DMA.
An example where DMA requests for external causes are detected active at the same time,
a DMA transfer is executed in the shortest cycle.
BCLK
DMA0
DMA1
Bus arbitration
CPU
INT0
DMA0
request bit
INT1
DMA1
request bit
Figure 12.6 DMA Transfer by External Factors
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 104 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13. Timers
Eleven 16-bit timers, each capable of operating independently of the others, can be classified by function as
either timer A (five) and timer B (six). The count source for each timer acts as a clock, to control such timer
operations as counting, reloading, etc.
Figures 13.1 and 13.2 show block diagrams of Timer A and Timer B configuration, respectively.
1/2
Main clock
f1
PLL clock
On-chip
oscillator clock
f2
PCLK0 = 0
Clock prescaler
f1 or f2
f8
1/4
1/32
XCIN
PCLK0 = 1
1/8
f32
Set the CPSR bit in the
CPSRF register to "1"
(prescaler reset)
fC32
Reset
f1 or f2 f8 f32 fC32
00
01
10
11
10
Noise
filter
TA0IN
00
01
10
11
00
01
10
11
00
01
10
11
00
01
10
11
01: Event counter mode
11 TA0TGH to TA0TGL
TMOD1 to TMOD0 00: Timer mode
10 : One-shot timer mode
11 : PWM mode
Timer A1
01
00
Timer A1 interrupt
01: Event counter mode
11 TA1TGH t0 TA1TGL
10
TMOD1 to TMOD0 00: Timer mode
10 : One-shot timer mode
11 : PWM mode
Timer A2
01
00
Timer A2 interrupt
01: Event counter mode
11 TA2TGH to TA2TGL
TCK1 to TCK0
10
TMOD1 to TMOD0 00: Timer mode
10 : One-shot timer mode
11 : PWM mode
Timer A3 interrupt
Timer A3
01
00
01: Event counter mode
11 TA3TGH to TA3TGL
TCK1 to TCK0
10
Noise
filter
TMOD1 to TMOD0 00: Timer mode
10 : One-shot timer mode
11 : PWM mode
01
00
01: Event counter mode
11 TA4TGH to TA4TGL
Timer B2 overflow or underflow
PCLK0: Bit in PCLKR register
TCK1 to TCK0, TMOD1 to TMOD0: Bits in TAiMR register (i = 0 to 4)
TAiTGH to TAiTGL: Bits in ONSF register or TRGSR register
NOTE:
1. Be aware that TA0IN shares the pin with RXD2, SCL2 and TB5IN.
Figure 13.1 Timer A Configuration
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Timer A0 interrupt
TCK1 to TCK0
Noise
filter
TA3IN
Timer A0
01
00
10
Noise
filter
TA2IN
TMOD1 to TMOD0 00: Timer mode
10 : One-shot timer mode
11 : Pulse width measuring (PWM) mode
TCK1 to TCK0
Noise
filter
TA1IN
TA4IN
TCK1 to TCK0
page 105 of 376
Timer A4
Timer A4 interrupt
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
1/2
Main clock
f1
PLL clock
On-chip
oscillator clock
PCLK0 = 0
f2
Clock prescaler
f1 or f2
f8
1/8
1/4
f1 or f2 f8 f32 fC32
00
01
10
11
f32
Set the CPSR bit in the
CPSRF register to "1"
(prescaler reset)
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
1
00
01
10
11
0
Timer B0
TCK1
TCK1 to TCK0
00
01
10
11
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
Timer B1 interrupt
0
Timer B1
TCK1
TCK1 to TCK0
01: Event counter mode
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
Timer B2 interrupt
1
Noise
filter
TB2IN
00
01
10
11
0
Timer B2
TCK1
TCK1 to TCK0
01: Event counter mode
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
Timer B3 interrupt
1
Noise
filter
TB3IN
00
01
10
11
0
Timer B3
TCK1
TCK1 to TCK0
01: Event counter mode
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
Timer B4 interrupt
1
Noise
filter
TB4IN
00
01
10
11
0
Timer B4
TCK1
TCK1 to TCK0
01: Event counter mode
TMOD1 to TMOD0
00: Timer mode
10: Pulse width / period measuring mode
Timer B5 interrupt
1
TB5IN
Noise
filter
0
Timer B5
TCK1
01: Event counter mode
PCLK0: Bit in PCLKR register
TCK1 to TCK0, TMOD1 to TMOD0: Bits in TBiMR register (i = 0 to 5)
NOTE:
1. Be aware that TB5IN shares the pin with RXD2, SCL2 and TA0IN.
Figure 13.2 Timer B Configuration
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 106 of 376
Timer B0 interrupt
01: Event counter mode
1
Noise
filter
TB1IN
fC32
Reset
Timer B2 overflow or underflow (to a count source of theTimer A)
TCK1 to TCK0
Noise
filter
TB0IN
1/32
XCIN
PCLK0 = 1
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1 Timer A
Figure 13.3 shows a block diagram of the timer A. Figures 13.4 to 13.6 show the timer A-related registers.
The timer A supports the following four modes. Except in event counter mode, timers A0 to A4 all have the
same function. Use the TMOD1 to TMOD0 bits in the TAiMR register (i = 0 to 4) to select the desired mode.
• Timer mode:
The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode:
The timer counts pulses from an external device or overflows and
underflows of other timers.
• One-shot timer mode:
The timer outputs a pulse only once before it reaches the minimum count “0000h.”
• Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode: The timer outputs pulses in a given width successively.
Select clock
High-order Bits of Data Bus
Select Clock source
00
f1 or f2
01
f8
10
f32
11
fC32
TAiIN
TCK1 to TCK0
: TMOD1 to TMOD0 = 00, MR2 = 0
TMOD1 to TMOD0,
: TMOD1 to TMOD0 = 10
MR2
Pulse width modulation : TMOD1 to TMOD0 = 11
Low-order Bits of Data Bus
Timer
One shot
Timer (gate function)
: TMOD1 to TMOD0 = 00, MR2 = 1
Event counter
: TMOD1 to TMOD0 = 01
Low-order
8 bits
High-order
8 bits
Reload Register
Polarity
selection
Counter
TAiS
00
01
TB2 overflow (1)
10
TAj overflow (1)
11
TAk overflow (1)
To external trigger circuit
Decrement
TAiTGH to TAiTGL
Increment/Decrement
Always counts down except
in event counter mode
00
10
11
01
TAiUD
TMOD1 to TMOD0
0
1
MR2
Pulse output
Toggle Flip-Flop
TAiOUT
TCK1 to TCK0, TMOD1 to TMOD0, MR2 to MR1: Bits in TAiMR register
TAiTGH to TAiTGL: Bits in ONSF register If i = 0, bits in TRGSR register if i = 1 to 4
TAiS: Bit in TABSR register
TAiUD: Bit in UDF register
i = 0 to 4
j = i - 1except j = 4 when i = 0
k = i + 1 except k = 0 when i = 4
NOTE:
1. Overflow or underflow
Figure 13.3 Timer A Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 107 of 376
TAi
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Addresses
0387h - 0386h
0389h - 0388h
038Bh- 038Ah
038Dh- 038Ch
038Fh- 038Eh
TAj
Timer A4
Timer A0
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
TAk
Timer A1
Timer A2
Timer A3
Timer A4
Timer A0
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TA0MR to TA4MR
Bit Symbol
Address
0396h to 039Ah
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
RW
b1 b0
TMOD0
0 0 : Timer mode
RW
Operation Mode Select Bit 0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : One-shot timer mode
1 1 : Pulse width modulation mode RW
TMOD1
MR0
RW
MR1
MR2
RW
Function varies with each operation mode
RW
MR3
RW
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
Function varies with each
operation mode
RW
RW
Timer Ai Register (i = 0 to 4) (1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Mode
Timer
Mode
Event
Counter
Mode
Symbol
TA0
TA1
TA2
TA3
TA4
Address
0387h to 0386h
0389h to 0388h
038Bh to 038Ah
038Dh to 038Ch
038Fh to 038Eh
Function
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
RW
Divide the count source by n + 1 where n =
0000h to FFFFh
set value
RW
Divide the count source by FFFFh — n + 1
where n = set value when counting up or
by n + 1 when counting down (2)
RW
0000h to FFFFh
Divide the count source by n where n = set
One-shot
0000h to FFFFh (3) (4) WO
Timer Mode value and cause the timer to stop
Pulse Width Modify the pulse width as follows:
Modulation PWM period: (216 — 1) / fj
High level PWM pulse width: n / fj
Mode
(16-bit PWM ) where n = set value, fj = count source
frequency
0000h to FFFEh (4) (5) WO
Pulse Width Modify the pulse width as follows:
Modulation PWM period: ( 28 — 1) ✕ (m + 1)/ fj
Mode
High level PWM pulse width: (m + 1)n / fj
(8-bit PWM ) where n = high-order address set value,
m = low-order address set value, fj =
count source frequency
00h to FEh
(High-order address)
WO
00h to FFh
(Low-order address)
NOTES:
1.The register must be accessed in 16-bit unit.
2.The timer counts pulses from an external device or overflows or underflows in other timers.
3.If the TAi register is set to "0000h", the counter does not work and timer Ai interrupt requests are
not generated either. Furthermore, if "pulse output" is selected, no pulses are output from the
TAiOUT pin.
4.Use the MOV instruction to write to the TAi register.
5.If the TAi register is set to "0000h", the pulse width modulator does not work, the output level on
the TAiOUT pin remains low, and timer Ai interrupt requests are not generated either.
The same applies when the 8 high-order bits in the TAi register are set to "00h" while operating as
an 8-bit pulse width modulator.
Figure 13.4 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers and TA0 to TA4 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 108 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Count Start Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR
Bit Symbol
Address
0380h
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
RW
TA0S
Timer A0 Count Start Flag
TA1S
Timer A1 Count Start Flag
TA2S
Timer A2 Count Start Flag
RW
TA3S
Timer A3 Count Start Flag
RW
TA4S
Timer A4 Count Start Flag
RW
TB0S
Timer B0 Count Start Flag
RW
TB1S
Timer B1 Count Start Flag
RW
TB2S
Timer B2 Count Start Flag
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
RW
RW
Up/Down Flag (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UDF
Bit Symbol
Address
0384h
Bit Name
TA0UD
Timer A0 Up/Down Flag
TA1UD
Timer A1 Up/Down Flag
TA2UD
Timer A2 Up/Down Flag
TA3UD
Timer A3 Up/Down Flag
TA4UD
Timer A4 Up/Down Flag
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Down count
1 : Up count
TA3P
TA4P
Timer A4 Two-Phase Pulse
Signal Processing Select Bit
NOTES:
1.Use the MOV instruction to write to this register.
2.Make sure the port direction bits for the TA2IN to TA4IN and TA2OUT to TA4OUT pins are
set to "0" (input mode).
3.When not using the two-phase pulse signal processing function, set the corresponding bit to
timer A2 to timer A4 to "0".
Figure 13.5 TABSR Register and UDF Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 109 of 376
RW
RW
Enabled by setting the MR2 bit in RW
the TAiMR register to "0"
RW
(= switching source in UDF register)
during event counter mode.
RW
Timer A2 Two-Phase Pulse 0 : Two-phase pulse signal
processing disabled
Signal Processing Select Bit
1 : Two-phase pulse signal
Timer A3 Two-Phase Pulse
processing enabled (2) (3)
Signal Processing Select Bit
TA2P
RW
WO
WO
WO
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
One-Shot Start Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ONSF
After Reset
00h
Address
0382h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
TA0OS
Timer A0 One-Shot Start Flag
RW
TA1OS
Timer A1 One-Shot Start Flag
TA2OS
Timer A2 One-Shot Start Flag
TA3OS
Timer A3 One-Shot Start Flag
TA4OS
Timer A4 One-Shot Start Flag
The timer starts counting by setting
this bit to "1" while the TMOD1 to
TMOD0 bits in the TAiMR register (i =
0 to 4) = 10b (one-shot timer mode)
and the MR2 bit in the TAiMR register
= 0 (TAiOS bit enabled).
When read, its content is "0".
TAZIE
Z-phase Input Enable Bit
0 : Z-phase input disabled
1 : Z-phase input enabled
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
b7 b6
TA0TGL
TA0TGH
Timer A0 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
0 0 : Input on TA0IN is selected (1)
0 1 : TB2 is selected (2)
1 0 : TA4 is selected (2)
1 1 : TA1 is selected (2)
RW
RW
NOTES:
1.Make sure the PD7_1 bit in the PD7 register is set to "0" (input mode).
2.Over flow or under flow.
Trigger Select Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TRGSR
Bit Symbol
Address
0383h
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
RW
b1 b0
TA1TGL
TA1TGH
Timer A1 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
0 0 : Input on TA1IN is selected (1)
0 1 : TB2 is selected (2)
1 0 : TA0 is selected (2)
1 1 : TA2 is selected (2)
Timer A2 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
0 0 : Input on TA2IN is selected (1)
0 1 : TB2 is selected (2)
1 0 : TA1 is selected (2)
1 1 : TA3 is selected (2)
RW
RW
b3 b2
TA2TGL
TA2TGH
RW
RW
b5 b4
TA3TGL
TA3TGH
Timer A3 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
0 0 : Input on TA3IN is selected (1)
0 1 : TB2 is selected (2)
1 0 : TA2 is selected (2)
1 1 : TA4 is selected (2)
Timer A4 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
0 0 : Input on TA4IN is selected (1)
0 1 : TB2 is selected (2)
1 0 : TA3 is selected (2)
1 1 : TA0 is selected (2)
RW
RW
b7 b6
TA4TGL
TA4TGH
RW
RW
NOTES:
1.Make sure the port direction bits for the TA1IN to TA4IN pins are set to "0" (input mode).
2.Over flow or under flow.
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CPSRF
Bit Symbol
Address
0381h
After Reset
0XXXXXXXb
Bit Name
Function
(b6-b0)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
CPSR
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag
Setting this bit to "1" initializes the
prescaler for the timekeeping clock.
(When read, its content is "0".)
Figure 13.6 ONSF Register, TRGSR Register and CPSRF Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 110 of 376
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1.1 Timer Mode
In timer mode, the timer counts a count source generated internally. Table 13.1 lists specifications in
timer mode. Figure 13.7 shows TAiMR register in timer mode.
Table 13.1 Specifications in Timer Mode
Item
Specification
Count Source
f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Count Operation
• Down-count
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and continues counting
Divide Ratio
1/(n+1) n: set value of the TAi register
0000h to FFFFh
Count Start Condition
Set the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (start counting)
Count Stop Condition
Set the TAiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing Timer underflow
TAiIN Pin Function
I/O port or gate input
TAiOUT Pin Function
I/O port or pulse output
Read from Timer
Count value can be read by reading the TAi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TAi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TAi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
Select Function
• Gate function
Counting can be started and stopped by an input signal to TAiIN pin
• Pulse output function
Whenever the timer underflows, the output polarity of TAiOUT pin is inverted.
When TAiS bit is set to “0 ” (stop counting), the pin outputs a low.
i = 0 to 4
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
TA0MR to TA4MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
MR0
Address
0396h to 039Ah
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
b1 b0
Operation Mode
Select Bit
0 0 : Timer mode
Pulse Output Function
Select Bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
RW
RW
RW
RW
b4 b3
MR1
Gate Function Select Bit
MR2
MR3
0 0 : Gate function not available
0 1 : } (TAiIN pin functions as I/O port) RW
1 0 : Counts while input on the TAiIN pin
is low (1)
1 1 : Counts while input on the TAiIN pin RW
is high (1)
Set to "0" in timer mode
RW
b7 b6
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
0 0 : f1 or f2
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
NOTE:
1.The port direction bit for the TAiIN pin is set to "0" (input mode).
Figure 13.7 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in Timer Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 111 of 376
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1.2 Event Counter Mode
In event counter mode, the timer counts pulses from an external device or overflows and underflows of
other timers. Timers A2, A3 and A4 can count two-phase external signals. Table 13.2 lists specifications
in event counter mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal). Figure 13.8 shows TAiMR register
in event counter mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal). Table 13.3 lists specifications in
event counter mode (when processing two-phase pulse signal with the timers A2, A3 and A4). Figure
13.9 shows TA2MR to TA4MR registers in event counter mode (when processing two-phase pulse signal
with the timers A2, A3 and A4).
Table 13.2 Specifications in Event Counter Mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal)
Item
Count Source
Specification
• External signals input to TAiIN pin (effective edge can be selected in program)
• Timer B2 overflows or underflows,
Timer Aj overflows or underflows,
Timer Ak overflows or underflows
Count Operation
• Up-count or down-count can be selected by external signal or program
• When the timer overflows or underflows, it reloads the reload register
contents and continues counting. When operating in free-running mode,
the timer continues counting without reloading.
Divided Ratio
1/ (FFFFh - n + 1) for up-count
1/ (n + 1) for down-count
n : set value of the TAi register 0000h to FFFFh
Count Start Condition
Set the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (start counting)
Count Stop Condition
Set the TAiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing Timer overflow or underflow
TAiIN Pin Function
I/O port or count source input
TAiOUT Pin Function
I/O port, pulse output, or up/down-count select input
Read from Timer
Count value can be read by reading the TAi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TAi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TAi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
• Free-run count function
Select Function
Even when the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content
is not reloaded to it
• Pulse output function
Whenever the timer underflows or underflows, the output polarity of
TAiOUT pin is inverted.
When TAiS bit is set to “0” (stop counting), the pin outputs a low.
i = 0 to 4
j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0
k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 112 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)
(When not using two-phase pulse signal processing)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TA0MR to TA4MR
0 1
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
0396h to 039Ah
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
Function
b1 b0
Operation Mode Select Bit
RW
RW
0 1 : Event counter mode (1)
RW
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin functions as I/O port)
RW
1 : Pulse is output
(TAiOUT pin functions as pulse output pin)
MR0
Pulse Output Function
Select Bit
MR1
0 : Counts falling edge of external signal
Count Polarity Select Bit (2) 1 : Counts rising edge of external signal RW
MR2
Up/Down Switching
Cause Select Bit
MR3
Set to "0" in event counter mode
RW
TCK0
Count Operation Type
Select Bit
RW
TCK1
Can be "0" or "1" when not using two-phase pulse signal processing. RW
0 : UDF register
1 : Input signal to TAiOUT pin (3)
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
RW
NOTES:
1.During event counter mode, the count source can be selected using the ONSF and TRGSR registers.
2.Effective when the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the ONSF or TRGSR register are "00b" (TAiIN pin input).
3.Count down when input on TAiOUT pin is low or count up when input on that pin is high. The port direction
bit for TAiOUT pin is set to "0" (input mode).
Figure 13.8 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in Event Counter Mode (when not using two-phase pulse
signal processing)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 113 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Table 13.3 Specifications in Event Counter Mode (when processing two-phase pulse signal with timers A2, A3 and A4)
Item
Specification
Count Source
• Two-phase pulse signals input to TAiIN or TAiOUT pins
Count Operation
• Up-count or down-count can be selected by two-phase pulse signal
• When the timer overflows or underflows, it reloads the reload register
contents and continues counting. When operating in free-running mode,
the timer continues counting without reloading.
1/ (FFFFh - n + 1) for up-count
Divide Ratio
1/ (n + 1) for down-count
n : set value of the TAi register 0000h to FFFFh
Count Start Condition
Set the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (start counting)
Count Stop Condition
Set the TAiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing Timer overflow or underflow
TAiIN Pin Function
Two-phase pulse input
TAiOUT Pin Function
Two-phase pulse input
Read from Timer
Count value can be read by reading the TAi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to TAi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to TAi register is written to reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
Select Function
(1)
• Normal processing operation (timer A2 and timer A3)
The timer counts up rising edges or counts down falling edges on TAjIN
pin when input signals on TAjOUT pin is “H”.
TAjOUT
TAjIN
Upcount
Upcount
Upcount
Downcount
Downcount
Downcount
• Multiply-by-4 processing operation (timer A3 and timer A4)
If the phase relationship is such that TAkIN pin goes “H” when the input
signal on TAkOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts up rising and falling edges
on TAkOUT and TAkIN pins. If the phase relationship is such that TAkIN
pin goes “L” when the input signal on TAkOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts
down rising and falling edges on TAkOUT and TAkIN pins.
TAkOUT
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
TAkIN
Count up all edges
Count down all edges
• Counter initialization by Z-phase input (timer A3)
The timer count value is initialized to “0” by Z-phase input.
i = 2 to 4
j = 2, 3
k = 3, 4
NOTE:
1. Only timer A3 is selectable. Timer A2 is fixed to normal processing operation, and timer A4 is fixed
to multiply-by-4 processing operation.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 114 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 2 to 4)
(When using two-phase pulse signal processing)
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1 0 0 0 1
Symbol
TA2MR to TA4MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
0398h to 039Ah
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
Operation Mode Select Bit 0 1 : Event counter mode
RW
RW
b1 b0
RW
MR0
To use two-phase pulse signal processing, set this bit to "0".
MR1
RW
MR2
To use two-phase pulse signal processing, set this bit to "1" .
RW
MR3
To use two-phase pulse signal processing, set this bit to "0".
RW
TCK0
Count Operation Type
Select Bit
0 : Reload type
1 : Free-run type
RW
TCK1
Two-Phase Pulse Signal
Processing Operation
Select Bit (1) (2)
0 : Normal processing operation
1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation
RW
NOTES:
1. The TCK1 bit is valid for the TA3MR register. No matter how this bit is set, timers A2 and A4 always operate in normal
processing mode and x4 processing mode, respectively.
2. If two-phase pulse signal processing is desired, following register settings are required:
Set the TAiP bit in the UDF register to "1" (two-phase pulse signal processing function enabled).
Set the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the TRGSR register to "00b" (TAiIN pin input).
Set the port direction bits for TAiIN and TAiOUT to "0" (input mode).
Figure 13.9 TA2MR to TA4MR Registers in Event Counter Mode (when using two-phase pulse
signal processing with timer A2, A3 or A4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 115 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1.2.1 Counter Initialization by Two-Phase Pulse Signal Processing
This function initializes the timer count value to “0” by Z-phase (counter initialization) input during twophase pulse signal processing.
This function can only be used in timer A3 event counter mode during two-phase pulse signal processing,
free-running type, x4 processing, with Z-phase entered from the ZP pin.
Counter initialization by Z-phase input is enabled by writing “0000h” to the TA3 register and setting the
TAZIE bit in the ONSF register to “1” (Z-phase input enabled).
Counter initialization is accomplished by detecting Z-phase input edge. The active edge can be selected
to be the rising________
or falling edge by using the POL bit in the INT2IC register. The Z-phase pulse width
applied to the INT2 pin must be equal to or greater than one clock cycle of the timer A3 count source.
The counter is initialized at the next count timing after recognizing Z-phase input. Figure 13.10 shows
the relationship between the two-phase pulse (A phase and B phase) and the Z-phase.
If timer A3 overflow or underflow coincides with the counter initialization by Z-phase input, a timer A3
interrupt request is generated twice in succession. Do not use the timer A3 interrupt when using this
function.
T3OUT
(A phase)
TA3IN
(B phase)
Count source
ZP (1)
Input equal to or greater than one clock cycle
of count source
Timer A3
m
m+1
1
2
3
4
5
NOTE:
1. This timing diagram is for the case where the POL bit in the INT2IC register = 1 (rising edge).
Figure 13.10 Two-phase Pulse (A phase and B phase) and Z Phase
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 116 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1.3 One-shot Timer Mode
In one-shot timer mode, the timer is activated only once by one trigger. When the trigger occurs, the timer
starts up and continues operating for a given period. Table 13.4 lists specifications in one-shot timer
mode. Figure 13.11 shows the TAiMR register in the one-shot timer mode.
Table 13.4 Specifications in One-shot Timer Mode
Item
Count Source
f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Count Operation
• Down-count
Specification
• When the counter reaches 0000h, it stops counting after reloading a new value
• If a trigger occurs when counting, the timer reloads a new count and restarts counting
Divide Ratio
Count Start Condition
1/n
n : set value of the TAi register 0000h to FFFFh
However, the counter does not work if the divide-by-n value is set to 0000h.
The TAiS bit in the TABSR register = 1 (start counting) and one of the following
triggers occurs.
• External trigger input from the TAiIN pin
• Timer B2 overflow or underflow,
Timer Aj overflow or underflow,
Timer Ak overflow or underflow
• The TAiOS bit in the ONSF register is set to “1” (timer starts)
Count Stop Condition
• When the counter is reloaded after reaching “0000h”
• TAiS bit is set to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing When the counter reaches “0000h”
TAiIN Pin Function
I/O port or trigger input
TAiOUT Pin Function
I/O port or pulse output
Read from Timer
An indeterminate value is read by reading the TAi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TAi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TAi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
Select Function
• Pulse output function
The timer outputs a low when not counting and a high when counting.
i = 0 to 4
j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0
k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 117 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
TA0MR to TA4MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
0396h to 039Ah
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
b1 b0
Operation Mode Select Bit 1 0 : One-shot timer mode
RW
RW
RW
MR0
Pulse Output Function
Select Bit
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin functions as I/O port)
RW
1 : Pulse is output
(TAiOUT pin functions as a pulse output pin)
MR1
External Trigger Select
Bit (1)
0 : Falling edge of input signal to TAiIN pin (2)
1 : Rising edge of input signal to TAiIN pin (2) RW
MR2
Trigger Select Bit
0 : TAiOS bit is enabled
1 : Selected by TAiTGH to TAiTGL bits
MR3
Set to "0" in one-shot timer mode
RW
RW
b7 b6
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
0 0 : f1 or f2
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
RW
NOTES:
1.Effective when the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the ONSF or TRGSR register are "00b" (TAiIN pin input).
2.The port direction bit for the TAiIN pin is set to "0" (input mode).
Figure 13.11 TAiMR Register in One-shot Timer Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 118 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.1.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Mode
In pulse width modulation mode, the timer outputs pulses of a given width in succession. The counter
functions as either 16-bit pulse width modulator or 8-bit pulse width modulator.
Table 13.5 lists specifications in PWM mode. Figure 13.12 shows TAiMR register in PWM mode.
Figures 13.13 and 13.14 show examples of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates and how an 8-bit
pulse width modulator operates, respectively.
Table 13.5 Specifications in PWM Mode
Item
Specification
Count Source
f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Count Operation
• Down-count (operating as an 8-bit or a 16-bit pulse width modulator)
• The timer reloads a new value at a rising edge of PWM pulse and continues counting
• The timer is not affected by a trigger that occurs during counting
• High level width n / fj
n : set value of the TAi register
16
• Cycle time (2 -1) / fj fixed fj : count source frequency (f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32)
16-bit PWM
8-bit PWM
• High level width n ✕ (m+1) / fj n : set value of the TAi register high-order address
• Cycle time (28-1) ✕ (m+1) / fj m : set value of the TAi register low-order address
Count Start Condition
• The TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to “1” (start counting)
• The TAiS bit = 1 and external trigger input from the TAiIN pin
• The TAiS bit = 1 and one of the following external triggers occurs
Timer B2 overflow or underflow,
Timer Aj overflow or underflow,
Timer Ak overflow or underflow
Count Stop Condition
The TAiS bit is set to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing On the falling edge of the PWM pulse
TAiIN Pin Function
I/O port or trigger input
TAiOUT Pin Function
Pulse output
Read from Timer
An indeterminate value is read by reading the TAi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TAi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TAi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
i = 0 to 4
j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0
k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 119 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
TA0MR to TA4MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
0396h to 039Ah
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
b1 b0
RW
RW
Operation Mode
Select Bit
1 1 : PWM mode
MR0
Pulse Output Function
Select Bit (3)
0 : Pulse is not output
(TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin)
1 : Pulse is output
(TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin)
MR1
External Trigger Select
Bit (1)
0 : Falling edge of input signal to TAiIN pin (2)
1 : Rising edge of input signal to TAiIN pin (2) RW
MR2
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Write "1" to TAiS bit in the TABSR register
RW
1 : Selected by TAiTGH to TAiTGL bits
MR3
16/8-Bit PWM Mode
Select Bit
0 : Functions as a 16-bit pulse width modulator
RW
1 : Functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator
Count Source Select Bit
0 0 : f1 or f2
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
RW
b7 b6
TCK0
TCK1
RW
RW
NOTES:
1.Effective when the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the ONSF or TRGSR register are "00b" (TAiIN pin input).
2.The port direction bit for the TAiIN pin is set to "0" (input mode).
3.Set to "1" (pulse is output), PWM pulse is output.
Figure 13.12 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in PWM Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 120 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
1 / fi ✕ (216 — 1)
Count source
Input signal to
TAiIN pin
"H"
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
"H"
IR bit in TAiIC
register
"1"
"L"
Trigger is not generated by this signal
1 / fj ✕ n
"L"
"0"
Set to "0" upon accepting an interrupt request or by writing in program
i = 0 to 4
fj: Frequency of count source (f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32)
NOTES:
1. n = 0000h to FFFEh.
2. This timing diagram is the following case.
TAi register = 0003h
The TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the ONSF or TRGSR register = 00b (TAiIN pin input)
The MR1 bit in the TAiMR register = 1 (rising edge)
The MR2 bit in the TAiMR register = 1 (trigger selected by the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits)
Figure 13.13 Example of 16-bit Pulse Width Modulator Operation
1 / fj ✕ (m + 1) ✕ (2 8 — 1)
Count source (1)
Input signal to
TAiIN pin
"H"
Underflow signal of
8-bit prescaler (2)
"H"
"L"
1 / fj ✕ (m + 1)
"L"
1 / fj ✕ (m + 1) ✕ n
PWM pulse output
from TAiOUT pin
IR bit in TAiIC
register
"H"
"L"
"1"
"0"
Set to "0" upon accepting an interrupt request or by writing in program
i = 0 to 4
fj: Frequency of count source (f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32)
NOTES:
1. The 8-bit prescaler counts the count source.
2. The 8-bit pulse width modulator counts the output from the 8-bit prescaler underflow signal.
3. m = 00h to FFh; n = 00h to FEh.
4. This timing diagram is the following case.
TAi register = 0202h
The TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits in the ONSF or TRGSR register = 00b (TAiIN pin input)
The MR1 bit in the TAiMR register = 0 (falling edge)
The MR2 bit in the TAiMR register = 1 (trigger selected by the TAiTGH and TAiTGL bits)
Figure 13.14 Example of 8-bit Pulse Width Modulator Operation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 121 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.2 Timer B
Figure 13.15 shows a block diagram of the timer B. Figures 13.16 and 13.17 show the timer B-related
registers.
Timer B supports the following three modes. Use the TMOD1 and TMOD0 bits in the TBiMR register (i = 0
to 5) to select the desired mode.
• Timer mode
: The timer counts an internal count source.
• Event counter mode
: The timer counts pulses from an external device or over
flows or underflows of other timers.
• Pulse period/pulse width measuring mode : The timer measures pulse period or pulse width of an
external signal.
High-order Bits of Data Bus
Select clock source
f1 or f2
f8
f32
fC32
00
01
10
11
TCK1 to TCK0
pulse width measurement mode
1
TBj overflow (1)
TBiIN
00: Timer
10: Pulse period measurement mode,
Low-order Bits of Data Bus
TMOD1 to TMOD0
Low-order
8 bits
TCK1
Reload Register
01: Event counter
0
Polarity Switching
and Edge Pulse
Counter
TBiS
Counter Reset Circuit
TCK1 to TCK0, TMOD1 to TMOD0: Bits in TBiMR register
TBiS: Bit in TABSR register or TBSR register
i = 0 to 5
j = i - 1 except j = 2 when i = 0, j = 5 when i = 3
NOTE:
1. Overflow or underflow
Figure 13.15 Timer B Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 122 of 376
TBi
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B2
Timer B3
Timer B4
Timer B5
Addresses
0391h - 0390h
0393h - 0392h
0395h- 0394h
01D1h- 01D0h
01D3h- 01D2h
01D5h- 01D4h
TBj
Timer B2
Timer B0
Timer B1
Timer B5
Timer B3
Timer B4
High-order
8 bits
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TB0MR to TB2MR
TB3MR to TB5MR
Bit Symbol
Address
039Bh to 039Dh
01DBh to 01DDh
After Reset
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
Function
RW
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Event counter mode
1 0 : Pulse period measurement mode,
pulse width measurement mode
1 1 : Do not set a value
RW
Bit Name
b1 b0
TMOD0
Operation Mode Select Bit
TMOD1
RW
RW
MR0
MR1
MR2
RW
RW (1)
Function varies with each operation mode
- (2)
RO
MR3
TCK0
TCK1
Count Source Select Bit
Function varies with each operation
mode
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Timer B0, timer B3.
2. Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5.
Timer Bi Register (i = 0 to 5) (1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Mode
Symbol
TB0
TB1
TB2
TB3
TB4
TB5
Address
0391h, 0390h
0393h, 0392h
0395h, 0394h
01D1h, 01D0h
01D3h, 01D2h
01D5h, 01D4h
Function
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
RW
Timer Mode
Divide the count source by n + 1
where n = set value
0000h to FFFFh
RW
Event Counter
Mode
Divide the count source by n + 1
where n = set value (2)
0000h to FFFFh
RW
Pulse Period
Measures a pulse period or width
Modulation Mode,
Pulse Width
Modulation Mode
NOTES:
1.The register must be accessed in 16-bit unit.
2.The timer counts pulses from an external device or overflows or underflows of other timers.
Figure 13.16 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers and TB0 to TB5 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 123 of 376
RO
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Count Start Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR
Address
0380h
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Bit Symbol
Function
RW
TA0S
Timer A0 Count Start Flag
TA1S
Timer A1 Count Start Flag
TA2S
Timer A2 Count Start Flag
RW
TA3S
Timer A3 Count Start Flag
RW
TA4S
Timer A4 Count Start Flag
RW
TB0S
Timer B0 Count Start Flag
RW
TB1S
Timer B1 Count Start Flag
RW
TB2S
Timer B2 Count Start Flag
RW
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
RW
RW
Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TBSR
Bit Symbol
Address
01C0h
After Reset
000XXXXXb
Bit Name
Function
(b4-b0)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
TB3S
Timer B3 Count Start Flag
TB4S
Timer B4 Count Start Flag
TB5S
Timer B5 Count Start Flag
-
0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
RW
RW
RW
RW
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
CPSRF
Bit Symbol
(b6-b0)
CPSR
Address
0381h
After Reset
0XXXXXXXb
Bit Name
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
page 124 of 376
RW
-
Setting this bit to "1" initializes the
Clock Prescaler Reset Flag prescaler for the timekeeping clock. RW
(When read, the value of this bit is "0".)
Figure 13.17 TABSR Register, TBSR Register and CPSRF Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Function
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.2.1 Timer Mode
In timer mode, the timer counts a count source generated internally.
Table 13.6 lists specifications in timer mode. Figure 13.18 shows TBiMR register in timer mode.
Table 13.6 Specifications in Timer Mode
Item
Count Source
f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Count Operation
Specification
• Down-count
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and
continues counting
Divide Ratio
1/(n+1) n: set value of the TBi register
0000h to FFFFh
(1)
Count Start Condition
Set the TBiS bit to “1” (start counting)
Count Stop Condition
Set the TBiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing Timer underflow
TBiIN Pin Function
I/O port
Read from Timer
Count value can be read by reading the TBi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TBi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TBi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
i = 0 to 5
NOTE:
1. The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S
bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
TB0MR to TB2MR
TB3MR to TB5MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
MR0
MR1
Address
039Bh to 039Dh
01DBh to 01DDh
After Reset
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
Bit Name
Function
b1 b0
Operation Mode Select Bit 0 0 : Timer mode
MR3
RW
RW
Has no effect in timer mode
Can be set to "0" or "1"
RW
TB0MR, TB3MR registers
Set to "0" in timer mode
MR2
RW
RW
RW
TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, TB5MR register s
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
When write in timer mode, set to "0".
When read in timer mode, its content is indeterminate.
RO
b7 b6
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
Figure 13.18 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Timer Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 125 of 376
0 0 : f1 or f2
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.2.2 Event Counter Mode
In event counter mode, the timer counts pulses from an external device or overflows and underflows of
other timers. Table 13.7 lists specifications in event counter mode. Figure 13.19 shows TBiMR register in
event counter mode.
Table 13.7 Specifications in Event Counter Mode
Item
Specification
Count Source
• External signals input to TBiIN pin (effective edge can be selected in program)
• Timer Bj overflow or underflow
Count Operation
• Down-count
• When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and
continues counting
Divide Ratio
1/(n+1) n: set value of the TBi register
0000h to FFFFh
(1)
Count Start Condition
Set TBiS bit to “1” (start counting)
Count Stop Condition
Set TBiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
Interrupt Request Generation Timing Timer underflow
TBiIN Pin Function
Count source input
Read from Timer
Count value can be read by reading the TBi register
Write to Timer
• When not counting and until the 1st count source is input after counting start
Value written to the TBi register is written to both reload register and counter
• When counting (after 1st count source input)
Value written to the TBi register is written to only reload register
(Transferred to counter when reloaded next)
i = 0 to 5
j = i - 1, except j = 2 if i = 0, j = 5 if i = 3
NOTE:
1. The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S
bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
Timer Bi Mode Register (i= 0 to 5)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
TB0MR to TB2MR
TB3MR to TB5MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
039Bh to 039Dh
01DBh to 01DDh
After Reset
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
Bit Name
Function
b1 b0
Operation Mode Select Bit 0 1 : Event counter mode
RW
RW
RW
b3 b2
MR0
Count Polarity Select
Bit (1)
MR1
0 0 : Counts falling edge of external signal
0 1 : Counts rising edge of external signal
1 0 : Counts falling and rising edges of
external signal
1 1 : Do not set a value
TB0MR, TB3MR registers
Set to "0" in event counter mode
MR2
TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, TB5MR registers
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
RW
RW
RW
-
MR3
When write in event counter mode, set to "0".
When read in event counter mode, its content is indeterminate.
RO
TCK0
Has no effect in event counter mode.
Can be set to "0" or "1".
RW
TCK1
Event Clock Select Bit
0 : Input from TBiIN pin (2)
1 : TBj overflow or underflow
(j = i — 1, except j = 2 if i = 0,
j = 5 if i = 3)
RW
NOTES:
1. Effective when the TCK1 bit = 0 (input from TBiIN pin). If the TCK1 bit = 1 (TBj overflow or underflow), these bits can
be set to "0" or "1".
2. The port direction bit for the TBiIN pin must be set to "0" (input mode).
Figure 13.19 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Event Counter Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 126 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
13.2.3 Pulse Period and Pulse Width Measurement Mode
In pulse period and pulse width measurement mode, the timer measures pulse period or pulse width of an
external signal. Table 13.8 lists specifications in pulse period and pulse width measurement mode. Figure
13.20 shows TBiMR register in pulse period and pulse width measurement mode. Figure 13.21 shows
the operation timing when measuring a pulse period. Figure 13.22 shows the operation timing when
measuring a pulse width.
Table 13.8 Specifications in Pulse Period and Pulse Width Measurement Mode
Item
Specification
Count Source
f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Count Operation
Count Start Condition
Count Stop Condition
Interrupt Request Generation Timing
TBiIN Pin Function
Read from Timer
Write to Timer
• Up-count
• Counter value is transferred to reload register at an effective edge of
measurement pulse. The counter value is set to “0000h” to continue counting.
Set the TBiS bit (1) to “1” (start counting)
Set the TBiS bit to “0” (stop counting)
• When an effective edge of measurement pulse is input (2)
• Timer overflow. When an overflow occurs, the MR3 bit in the TBiMR
register is set to “1” (overflow) simultaneously. The MR3 bit is set to “0”
(no overflow) by writing to the TBiMR register at the next count timing or
later after the MR3 bit was set to “1”. At this time, make sure the TBiS bit
is set to “1” (start counting).
Measurement pulse input
Contents of the reload register (measurement result) can be read by reading
TBi register (3)
Value written to the TBi register is written to neither reload register nor counter
i = 0 to 5
NOTES:
1.The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S
bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
2. Interrupt request is not generated when the first effective edge is input after the timer started counting.
3. Value read from the TBi register is indeterminate until the second valid edge is input after the timer
starts counting.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 127 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
TB0MR to TB2MR
TB3MR to TB5MR
Bit Symbol
TMOD0
TMOD1
Address
039Bh to 039Dh
01DBh to 01DDh
Bit Name
Operation Mode
Select Bit
After Reset
00XX0000b
00XX0000b
Function
b1 b0
1 0 : Pulse period / pulse width
measurement mode
RW
RW
RW
b3 b2
MR0
Measurement Mode
Select Bit
MR1
0 0 : Pulse period measurement
(Measurement between a falling edge and the
next falling edge of measured pulse)
0 1 : Pulse period measurement
(Measurement between a rising edge and the next
rising edge of measured pulse)
1 0 : Pulse width measurement
(Measurement between a falling edge and the
next rising edge of measured pulse and between
a rising edge and the next falling edge)
1 1 : Do not set a value
TB0MR and TB3MR registers
Set to "0" in pulse period and pulse width measurement mode
MR2
MR3
TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, TB5MR registers
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content turns out to be indeterminate.
Timer Bi Overflow
0 : Timer did not overflow
Flag (1)
1 : Timer has overflown
RW
RW
RW
RO
b7 b6
TCK0
TCK1
Count Source
Select Bit
0 0 : f1 or f2
0 1 : f8
1 0 : f32
1 1 : fC32
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. This flag is indeterminate after reset. When the TBiS bit = 1 (start counting), the MR3 bit is set to "0" (no overflow) by writing to the
TBiMR register at the next count timing or later after the MR3 bit was set to "1" (overflow). The MR3 bit cannot be set to "1" in a
program. The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S bits are assigned
to the bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
Figure 13.20 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Pulse Period and Pulse Width Measurement Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 128 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
13. Timers
Count source
"H"
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
"L"
Transfer
(indeterminate value)
Transfer
(measured value)
counter
(NOTE 1)
(NOTE 1)
(NOTE 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches "0000h"
"1"
TBiS bit
"0"
IR bit in
TBiIC register
"1"
MR3 bit in
TBiMR register
"1"
"0"
Set to "0" upon accepting an interrupt request or by writing in program
"0"
The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S bits
are assigned to bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
i = 0 to 5
NOTES:
1. Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
2. Timer has overflown.
3. This timing diagram is for the case where the MR1 to MR0 bits in the TBiMR register are "00b" (measure the interval
from falling edge to falling edge of the measurement pulse).
Figure 13.21 Operation Timing When Measuring Pulse Period
Count source
Measurement pulse
Reload register
transfer timing
"H"
"L"
counter
Transfer
(indeterminate
value)
(NOTE 1)
Transfer
(measured value)
(NOTE 1)
Transfer
(measured
value)
Transfer
(measured value)
(NOTE 1) (NOTE 1)
(NOTE 2)
Timing at which counter
reaches "0000h"
"1"
TBiS bit
"0"
IR bit in
TBiIC register
MR3 bit in
TBiMR register
"1"
"0"
"1"
Set to "0" upon accepting an interrupt request or by
writing in program
"0"
The TB0S to TB2S bits are assigned to bit 5 to bit 7 in the TABSR register, and the TB3S to TB5S bits
are assigned to bit 5 to bit 7 in the TBSR register.
i = 0 to 5
NOTES:
1. Counter is initialized at completion of measurement.
2. Timer has overflown.
3. This timing diagram is for the case where the MR1 to MR0 bits in the TBiMR register are "10b" (measure the
interval from a falling edge to the next rising edge and the interval from a rising edge to the next falling edge
of the measurement pulse).
Figure 13.22 Operation Timing When Measuring Pulse Width
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 129 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Timers A1, A2, A4 and B2 can be used to output three-phase motor drive waveforms. Table 14.1 lists the
specifications of the three-phase motor control timer function. Figure 14.1 shows the block diagram for three-phase
motor control timer function. Also, the related registers are shown on Figures 14.2 to 14.8.
Table 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Specifications
Item
Specification
___
___
___
Three-Phase Waveform Output Pin
Six pins (U,_______
U, V, V, W, W)
Forced Cutoff Input (1)
Input “L” to NMI pin
Used Timers
Timer A4, A1, A2 (used
in the one-shot timer mode)
___
• Timer A4: U- and ___
U-phase waveform control
• Timer A1: V- and V-phase
waveform control
___
• Timer A2: W- and W-phase waveform control
Timer B2 (used in the timer mode)
• Carrier wave cycle control
Dead time timer (3 eight-bit timer and shared reload register)
• Dead time control
Output Waveform
Triangular wave modulation, Sawtooth wave modification
• Enable to output “H” or “L” for one cycle
• Enable to set positive-phase level and negative-phase level respectively
Carrier Wave Cycle
Triangular wave modulation: count source ✕ (m+1) ✕ 2
Sawtooth wave modulation: count source ✕ (m+1)
m: Setting value of the TB2 register, 0000h to FFFFh
Count source: f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Three-Phase PWM Output Width
Triangular wave modulation: count source ✕ n ✕ 2
Sawtooth wave modulation: count source ✕ n
n: Setting value of the TA4, TA1 and TA2 registers (of the TA4,
TA41, TA1, TA11, TA2 and TA21 registers when setting the
INV11 bit to “1”), 0001h to FFFFh
Count source: f1, f2, f8, f32, fC32
Dead Time
Count source ✕ p, or no dead time
p: Setting value of the DTT register, 01h to FFh
Count source: f1, f2, f1 divided by 2, f2 divided by 2
Active Level
Enable to select “H” or “L”
Positive and Negative-Phase Concurrent Positive and negative-phases concurrent active disable function
Active Disable Function
Positive and negative-phases concurrent active detect function
Interrupt Frequency
For Timer B2 interrupt, select a carrier wave cycle-to-cycle basis
through 15 times carrier wave cycle-to-cycle basis
NOTE:
_______
1. Forced cutoff with NMI input
is effective when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register
is set to “1” (three-phase
_______
_______
output forcible cutoff by NMI input enabled). If an “L” signal is applied to the NMI pin when the IVPCR1
bit is “1”, the related pins go to a high-impedance state regardless of which functions of those pins are
being used.
Related pins: • P7_2/CLK2/TA1OUT/V
_________ _________
___
• P7_3/CTS2/RTS2/TA1IN/V
• P7_4/TA2OUT/W
____
• P7_5/TA2IN/W
• P8_0/TA4OUT/U
___
• P8_1/TA4IN/U
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 130 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
INV00 to INV07: Bits in INVC0 register
INV10 to INV15: Bits in INVC1 register
DUi, DUBi: Bits in IDBi register (i = 0, 1)
TA1S to TA4S: Bits in TABSR register
PWCON: Bits in TB2SC register
INV03
INV13
1
0
ICTB2 Counter
n=1 to 15
PWCON
Timer B2 Underflow
f1 or f2
1/2
Timer B2
(Timer Mode)
Dead Time
Timer
n = 1 to 255
Transfer Trigger (1)
Trigger
TA41 Register
Reload
Reload Control
Signal for Timer A4
Trigger
DU1
bit
DU0
bit
TQ
INV11
Timer A4
One-Shot
Pulse
When setting the TA4S bit to "0",
signal is set to "0"
TA1 Register
TA11 Register
Reload
Reload Control
Signal for Timer A1
DQ
T
DQ
T
DUB1
bit
DUB0
bit
(One-Shot Timer Mode)
TQ
INV11
DQ
T
DQ
T
INV06
U-Phase
Output Signal
Timer A1
One-Shot
Pulse
TA21 Register
Reload
Reload Control
Signal for Timer A2
(One-Shot Timer Mode)
INV11
U
V-Phase Output
Control Circuit
V-Phase
Output Signal
V-Phase
Output Signal
INV06
Timer A2
One-Shot
Pulse
TQ
When setting the TA2S bit to "0",
signal is set to "0"
DQ
T
Inverse
Control
U
Inverse
Control
V
Inverse
Control
V
Inverse
Control
W
Inverse
Control
W
Dead Time
Timer
n = 1 to 255
DQ
T
DQ
T
Trigger
Dead Time
Timer
n = 1 to 255
Trigger
Trigger
Timer A2 Counter
Inverse
Control
Trigger
Trigger
When setting the TA1S bit to "0",
signal is set to "0"
TA2 Register
DQ
T
Three-Phase
Output
Shift Register
(U Phase)
Trigger
Timer A1 Counter
INV14
U-Phase
Output Signal
Timer A4 Counter
(One-Shot Timer Mode)
INV02
U-phase Output
Control Circuit
Start Trigger Signal for Timers A1, A2, A4
TA4 Register
T
R
RESET
Timer B2
NMI
Interrupt INV05
Request Bit
Reload Register
n = 1 to 255
Trigger
INV06
Write signal to
Timer B2
INV10
DQ
INV04
0
1
INV12
INV07
Value to be written to
INV03 bit
Write signal to INV03 bit
Circuit to set Interrupt
Generation Frequency
INV01
INV11
INV00
Reload Control Signal for Timer A1
ICTB2 Register n=1 to 15
W-Phase Output
Control Circuit
W-Phase
Output Signal
W-Phase
Output Signal
DQ
T
DQ
T
Switching to P8_0, P8_1 and P7_2 to P7_5 is not shown in this diagram.
NOTE:
1. Transfer trigger is generated only when the IDB0 and IDB1 registers are set and the first timer B2 underflows,
if the INV06 bit is set to "0" (triangular wave modulation mode).
Figure 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 131 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
INVC0
Bit
Symbol
Address
01C8h
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
INV00 Interrupt Enable Output
Polarity Select Bit
0: The ICTB2 counter is incremented by one on the
rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal
1: The ICTB2 counter is incremented by one on the
falling edge of the timer A1 reload control signal (2)
RW
Interrupt Enable Output
INV01 Specification Bit (3)
0: ICTB2 counter is incremented by one when
timer B2 underflows
1: Selected by the INV00 bit (2)
RW
INV02 Mode Select Bit (4)
0: No three-phase control timer functions
1: Three-phase control timer function (5)
RW
INV03 Output Control Bit
0: Disables three-phase control timer output (5)
1: Enables three-phase control timer output (6)
RW
Bit Name
Positive and Negative0: Enables concurrent active output
INV04 Phases Concurrent Active 1: Disables concurrent active output
Disable Function Enable Bit
RW
Positive and Negative0: Not detected
INV05 Phases Concurrent Active 1: Detected (7)
Output Detect Flag
RW
INV06
Modulation Mode
Select (8)
0: Triangular wave modulation mode
1: Sawtooth wave modulation mode (9)
RW
INV07
Software Trigger Select
Bit
Transfer trigger is generated when the INV07
bit is set to "1". Trigger to the dead time timer
is also generated when setting the INV06
bit to "1". Its value is "0" when read.
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the INVC0 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to "1" (write enable).
Rewrite the INV00 to INV02 and INV06 bits when the timers A1, A2, A4 and B2 stop.
2. The INV00 and INV01 bits are enabled only when the INV11 bit is set to "1" (three-phase mode 1). The ICTB2
counter is incremented by one every time the timer B2 underflows, regardless of INV00 and INV01 bit settings,
when the INV11 bit is set to "0" (three-phase mode 0).
When setting the INV01 bit to "1", set the timer A1 count start flag before the first timer B2 underflow.
When the INV00 bit is set to "1", the first interrupt is generated when the timer B2 underflows n-1 times, if n is
the value set in the ICTB2 counter. Subsequent interrupts are generated every n times the timer B2 underflows.
3. Set the INV01 bit to "1" after setting the ICTB2 register .
4. Set the INV02 bit to "1" to operate the dead time timer, U-, V-and W-phase output control circuits and ICTB2
counter.
5. When the INV03 bit is set to "1", the pins applied to U/V/W output three-phase PWM.
The U, U, V, V, W and W pins, including pins shared with other output functions, are all placed in high-impedance
states when the following conditions are all met.
The INV02 bit is set to "1" (three-phase control timer function)
The INV03 bit to "0" (three-phase control timer output disabled)
Direction registers of each port are set to "0" (input mode)
6. The INV03 bit is set to "0" when the following conditions are all met.
Reset
A concurrent active state occurs while INV04 bit is set to "1"
The INV03 bit is set to "0" by program
A signal applied to the NMI pin changes "H" to "L"
When both the INV04 and INV05 bits are set to "1", the INV03 bit is set to "0".
7. The INV05 bit cannot be set to "1" by program. Set the INV04 bit to "0", as well, when setting the INV05 bit to "0".
8. The following table describes how the INV06 bit works.
INV06 = 1
Item
INV06 = 0
Mode
Sawtooth wave modulation mode
Triangular wave modulation mode
Timing to Transfer from the IDB0 Transferred once by generating a
and IDB1 Registers to Three- transfer trigger after setting the IDB0
Phase Output Shift Register and IDB1 registers
Transferred every time a transfer trigger
is generated
Timing to Trigger the Dead Time On the falling edge of a one-shot pulse By a transfer trigger, or the falling edge of
Timer when the INV16 Bit=0 of the timer A1, A2 or A4
a one-shot pulse of the timer A1, A2 or A4
INV13 Bit
Enabled when the INV11 bit=1 and the Disabled
INV06 bit=0
Transfer trigger : Timer B2 underflows and write to the INV07 bit, or write to the TB2 register when INV10 = 1
9. When the INV06 bit is set to "1", set the INV11 bit to "0" (three-phase mode 0) and the PWCON bit in the TB2SC
register to "0" (reload timer B2 with timer B2 underflow).
Figure 14.2 INVC0 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 132 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1(1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
INVC1
0
Bit
Symbol
Address
01C9h
After Reset
00h
Function
Bit Name
RW
INV10
Timer A1, A2 and A4
Start Trigger Select Bit
0: Timer B2 underflow
1: Timer B2 underflow and write to
the timer B2
INV11
Timer A1-1, A2-1, A4-1
Control Bit (2)
0: Three-phase mode 0
1: Three-phase mode 1
INV12
Dead Time Timer
0 : f1 or f2
Count Source Select Bit 1 : f1 divided-by-2 or f2 divided-by-2
INV13
Carrier Wave Detect
Flag (4)
0: Timer A1 reload control signal is "0"
RO
1: Timer A1 reload control signal is "1"
INV14
Output Polarity Control
Bit
0 : Active "L" of an output waveform
1 : Active "H" of an output waveform
RW
INV15
Dead Time Disable Bit
0: Enables dead time
1: Disables dead time
RW
INV16
Dead Time Timer
Trigger Select Bit
0: Falling edge of a one-shot pulse of
the timer A1, A2, A4 (5)
1: Rising edge of the three-phase output RW
shift register (U-, V-, W-phase)
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
(b7)
RW
(3)
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Rewrite the INVC1 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to "1" (write enable).
The timers A1, A2, A4, and B2 must be stopped during rewrite.
2. The following table lists how the INV11 bit works.
Item
INV11 = 0
INV11 = 1
Mode
Three-phase mode 0
TA11, TA21 and TA41 Registers Not used
Three-phase mode 1
Used
INV00 and INV01 Bit
Disabled. The ICTB2 counter is
incremented whenever the timer B2 Enabled
underflows
INV13 Bit
Disabled
Enabled when INV11=1 and INV06=0
3. When the INV06 bit is set to "1" (sawtooth wave modulation mode), set the INV11 bit to "0" (three-phase
mode 0). Also, when the INV11 bit is set to "0", set the PWCON bit in the TB2SC register to "0" (timer B2
is reloaded when the timer B2 underflows).
4. The INV13 bit is enabled only when the INV06 bit is set to "0" (Triangular wave modulation mode) and the
INV11 bit to "1" (three-phase mode 1).
5. If the following conditions are all met, set the INV16 bit to "1" (rising edge of the three-phase output shift
register).
The INV15 bit is set to "0" (dead time timer enabled)
The Dij bit (i=U, V or W, j=0, 1) and DiBj bit always have different values when the INV03 bit
is set to "1". (The positive-phase and negative-phase always output opposite level signals.)
If above conditions are not met, set the INV16 bit to "0" (falling edge of a one-shot pulse of the timer A1,
A2, A4).
Figure 14.3 INVC1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 133 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Three-Phase Output Buffer Register i (i = 0, 1) (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
IDB0, IDB1
0 0
Bit
Symbol
DUi
DUBi
DVi
DVBi
DWi
DWBi
(b7-b6)
Address
01CAh, 01CBh
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
U-Phase Output Buffer i Write output level
U-Phase Output Buffer i 0: Active level
1: Inactive level
V-Phase Output Buffer i
RW
V-Phase Output Buffer i
When read, the value of the threeW-Phase Output Buffer i phase shift register is read.
RW
W-Phase Output Buffer i
RW
Reserved Bit
RW
RW
Set to "0"
RW
RO
NOTE:
1. Values of the IDB0 and IDB1 registers are transferred to the three-phase output shift register by a transfer
trigger.
After the transfer trigger occurs, the values written in the IDB0 register determine each phase output
signal first. Then the value written in the IDB1 register on the falling edge of timers A1, A2 and A4 one-shot
pulse determines each phase output signal.
Dead Time Timer (1) (2)
b7
b0
Symbol
DTT
Address
01CCh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Function
Setting Range
RW
If setting value is n, the timer stops when counting
n times a count source selected by the INV12 bit
in the INVC1 register after start trigger occurs.
Positive or negative phase, which changes from
inactive level to active level, shifts when the dead
time timer stops.
1 to 255
WO
NOTES:
1. Use the MOV instruction to set the DTT register.
2. The DTT register is enabled when the INV15 bit in the INVC1 register is set to "0" (dead time enabled).
No dead time can be set when the INV15 bit is set to "1" (dead time disabled). The INV06 bit in the INVC0
register determines start trigger of the DTT register.
Figure 14.4 IDB0 and IDB1 Registers and DTT Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 134 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Timer Ai, Ai-1 Register (i = 1, 2, 4) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
b15
b8 b7
b0
Symbol
TA1, TA2, TA4
TA11, TA21, TA41 (7)
Address
After Reset
0389h - 0388h, 038Bh - 038Ah, 038Fh - 038Eh Indeterminate
01C3h - 01C2h, 01C5h - 01C4h, 01C7h - 01C6h Indeterminate
Function
If setting value is n, the timer stops when the nth count
source is counted after a start trigger is generated.
Positive phase changes to negative phase, and vice
versa, when the timers A1, A2 and A4 stop.
Setting Range
RW
0000h to FFFFh
WO
NOTES:
1. Use a 16-bit data for read and write.
2. If the TAi or TAi1 register is set to "0000h", no counters start and no timer Ai interrupt is generated.
3. Use the MOV instruction to set the TAi and TAi1 registers.
4. When the INV15 bit in the INVC1 register is set to "0" (dead timer enabled), phase switches from an
inactive level to an active level when the dead time timer stops.
5. When the INV11 bit in the INVC1 register is set to "0" (three-phase mode 0), the value of the TAi register
is transferred to the reload register by a timer Ai start trigger.
When the INV11 bit is set to "1" (three-phase mode 1), the value of the TAi1 register is first transferred to
the reload register by a timer Ai start trigger. Then, the value of the TAi register is transferred by the next
trigger. The values of the TAi1 and TAi registers are transferred alternately to the reload register with every
timer Ai start trigger.
6. Do not write to these registers when the timer B2 underflows.
7. Follow the procedure below to set the TAi1 register.
(a) Write value to the TAi1 register,
(b) Wait one timer Ai count source cycle, and
(c) Write the same value as (a) to the TAi1 register.
Timer B2 Register (1)
b15
b8 b7
b0
Symbol
TB2
Address
0395h - 0394h
After Reset
Indeterminate
Setting Range
RW
If setting value is n, count source is divided by n+1.
0000h to FFFFh
The timers A1, A2 and A4 start every time an underflow occurs.
RW
Function
NOTE:
1. Use a 16-bit data for read and write.
Figure 14.5 TA1, TA2, TA4, TA11, TA21 and TA41 Registers, and TB2 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 135 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Timer B2 Interrupt Occurrence Frequency Set Counter (1) (2) (3)
b7
b0
Symbol
ICTB2
Address
01CDh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Function
Setting Range
RW
When the INV01 bit in the INVC0 register is set to "0"
(the ICTB2 counter increments whenever the timer B2
underflows) and the setting value is n, the timer B2 interrupt
is generated every nth time timer B2 underflow occurs.
When the INV01 bit is set to "1" (the INV00 bit selects
count timing of the ICTB2 counter) and setting value is
n, the timer B2 interrupt is generated every nth time
timer B2 underflow meeting the condition selected in
the INV00 bit occurs.
1 to 15
WO
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
NOTES:
1. Use the MOV instruction to set the ICTB2 register.
2. If the INV01 bit is set to "1", set the ICTB2 register when the TB2S bit is set to "0" (timer B2 counter stopped),
If the INV01 bit is set to "0" and the TB2S bit to "1" (timer B2 counter start), do not set the ICTB2 register
when the timer B2 underflows.
3. If the INV00 bit is set to "1", the first interrupt is generated when the timer B2 underflows n-1 times, n being
the value set in the ICTB2 counter. Subsequent interrupts are generated every n times the timer B2 underflows.
Timer B2 Special Mode Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TB2SC
Bit
Symbol
PWCON
Address
039Eh
Bit Name
After Reset
XXXXXX00b
Function
0 : Timer B2 underflow
Timer B2 Reload Timing
1 : Timer A output at odd-numbered
Switching Bit
occurrences (2)
RW
RW
0 : Three-phase output forcible cutoff
by NMI input (high-impedance)
disabled
Three-Phase Output Port
IVPCR1
RW
1 : Three-phase output forcible cutoff
NMI Control Bit 1 (3)
by NMI input (high-impedance)
enabled
(b7-b2)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
-
NOTES:
1. Write to this register after setting the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to "1" (write enabled).
2. If the INV11 bit in the INVC1 register is "0" (three-phase mode 0) or the INV06 bit in the INVC0 register
is "1" (sawtooth wave modulation mode), set this bit to "0" (timer B2 underflow).
3. Related pins are U(P8_0/TA4OUT), U(P8_1/TA4IN), V(P7_2/CLK2/TA1OUT), V(P7_3/CTS2/RTS2/TA1IN),
W(P7_4/TA2OUT), W(P7_5/TA2IN). If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI pin when the IVPCR1 bit
= 1, the target pins go to a high-impedance state regardless of which functions of those pins are being
used.
After forced interrupt (cutoff), input "H" to the NMI pin and set the IVPCR1 bit to "0": this forced cutoff will
be reset.
Figure 14.6 ICTB2 Register and TB2SC Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 136 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Trigger Select Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TRGSR
Bit
Symbol
Address
0383h
After Reset
00h
Function
Bit Name
RW
TA1TGL Timer A1 Event/Trigger
TA1TGH Select Bit
Set to "01b" (TB2 underflow) before
using a V-phase output control circuit
RW
TA2TGL Timer A2 Event/Trigger
TA2TGH Select Bit
Set to "01b" (TB2 underflow) before
using a W-phase output control circuit
RW
RW
RW
b5 b4
TA3TGL
Timer A3 Event/Trigger
Select Bit
TA3TGH
TA4TGL Timer A4 Event/Trigger
TA4TGH Select Bit
0
0
1
1
0 : Selects an input to the TA3IN pin (1) RW
1 : Selects TB2 (2)
0 : Selects TA2 (2)
RW
1 : Selects TA4 (2)
Set to "01b" (TB2 underflow) before
using a U-phase output control circuit
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Set the corresponding port direction bit to "0" (input mode).
2. Overflow or underflow.
Count Start Flag
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
TABSR
Bit
Symbol
Address
0380h
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
TA1S
Timer A0 Count Start Flag 0 : Stops counting
1 : Starts counting
Timer A1 Count Start Flag
TA2S
Timer A2 Count Start Flag
RW
TA3S
Timer A3 Count Start Flag
RW
TA4S
Timer A4 Count Start Flag
RW
TB0S
Timer B0 Count Start Flag
RW
TB1S
Timer B1 Count Start Flag
RW
TB2S
Timer B2 Count Start Flag
RW
TA0S
Figure 14.7 TRGSR Register and TRBSR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
After Reset
00h
page 137 of 376
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 1, 2, 4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
0
1 0
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
0
Symbol
TA1MR, TA2MR, TA4MR
Bit
Symbol
Address
0397h, 0398h, 039Ah
Bit Name
TMOD0 Operation Mode
TMOD1 Select Bit
After Reset
00h
Function
Set to "10b" (one-shot timer mode)
with the three-phase motor control
timer function
RW
RW
RW
MR0
Pulse Output Function
Select Bit
Set to "0" with the three-phase motor
RW
control timer function
MR1
External Trigger
Select Bit
Set to "0" with the three-phase motor RW
control timer function
MR2
Trigger Select Bit
Set to "1" (selected by the
TRGSR register) with the three-phase RW
motor control timer function
MR3
Set to "0" with the three-phase motor control timer function
RW
b7 b6
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
0
0
1
1
RW
0 : f1 or f2
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : fC32
RW
Timer B2 Mode Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
0
0
Symbol
TB2MR
Bit
Symbol
Address
039Dh
After Reset
00XX0000b
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
MR1
Set to "00b" (timer mode) when using
the three-phase motor control timer
function
Disabled when using the three-phase motor control timer function.
When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
MR2
Set to "0" when using three-phase motor control timer function
RW
MR3
When write in three-phase motor control timer function, set to "0".
When read in three-phase motor control timer function,
its content is indeterminate.
RO
TMOD0 Operation Mode
TMOD1 Select Bit
MR0
RW
RW
RW
b7 b6
TCK0
Count Source Select Bit
TCK1
0
0
1
1
0 : f1 or f2
1 : f8
0 : f32
1 : fC32
Figure 14.8 TA1MR, TA2MR and TA4MR Registers, and TB2MR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 138 of 376
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
The three-phase motor control timer function is enabled by setting the INV02 bit in the INVC0 register to “1”.
When this function is selected, timer B2 is used
to___
control the
carrier wave, and timers A4, A1 and A2 are
__
___
used to control three-phase PWM outputs (U, U, V, V, W and W). The dead time is controlled by a dedicated
dead-time timer. Figure 14.9 shows the example of triangular modulation waveform and Figure 14.10
shows the example of sawtooth modulation waveform.
Triangular waveform as a Carrier Wave
Triangular Wave
Signal Wave
TB2S bit in
TABSR register
Timer B2
Timer A1
reload control signal (1)
Timer A4
start trigger signal (1)
TA4 register (2)
m
n
p
q
r
TA4-1 register (2)
m
n
p
q
r
Reload register
(2)
m
Timer A4
one-shot pulse(1)
m
m
n
m
n
n
n
p
p
n
q
p
p
q
Rewrite the IDB0 and IDB1 registers
U-phase output
signal(1)
Transfer a counter
value to the three-phase
shift register
U-phase output
signal(1)
INV14 = 0
("L" active)
q
q
U-phase
U-phase
Dead time
INV14 = 1
("H" active)
U-phase
Dead time
U-phase
INV00, INV01: Bits in the INVC0 register
INV11, INV14: Bits in the INVC1 register
NOTES:
1.Internal signals. See Figure 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Functions Block Diagram.
2.Applies only when the INV11 bit is set to "1" (three-phase mode).
The above applies to INVC0 = 00XX11XXb and INVC1 = 010XXXX0b (X varies depending on each system.)
Examples of PWM output change are
(b) When INV11=0 (three-phase mode 0)
(a) When INV11=1 (three-phase mode 1)
- INV01=0, ICTB2=1h (The timer B2 interrupt is generated
- INV01=0 and ICTB2=2h (The timer B2 interrupt is
whenever the timer B2 underflows)
generated with every second timer B2 underflow) or
- Default value of the timer: TA4=m
INV01= 1, INV00=1 and ICTB2=1h (The timer B2 interrupt is
The TA4 register is changed whenever the timer B2
generated on the falling edge of the timer A reload control
interrupt is generated.
signal)
First time: TA4=m. Second time: TA4=n.
- Default value of the timer: TA41=m, TA4=m
Third time: TA4=n. Fourth time: TA=p.
The TA4 and TA41 registers are changed whenever the
Fifth time: TA4=p.
timer B2 interrupt is generated.
- Default value of the IDB0 and IDB1 registers:
First time: TA41=n, TA4=n.
DU0=1, DUB0=0, DU1=0, DUB1=1
Second time: TA41=p, TA4=p.
They are changed to DU0=1, DUB0=0, DU1=1, DUB1=0 by
- Default value of the IDB0 and IDB1 registers
the sixth timer B2 interrupt.
DU0=1, DUB0=0, DU1=0, DUB1=1
They are changed to DU0=1, DUB0=0, DU1=1, DUB1=0
by the third timer B2 interrupt.
Figure 14.9 Triangular Wave Modulation Operation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 139 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
14. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function
Sawtooth Waveform as a Carrier Wave
Sawtooth Wave
Signal Wave
Timer B2
Timer A4 Start
Trigger Signal(1)
Timer A4 One-Shot
Pulse(1)
Rewrite the IDB0
and IDB1 registers
Transfer the counter to the
three-phase shift register
U-Phase Output
(1)
Signal
U-Phase Output
(1)
Signal
U-Phase
INV14 = 0
("L" active)
Dead time
U-Phase
U-Phase
INV14 = 1
("H" active)
Dead time
U-Phase
INV14: Bits in the INVC1 register
NOTES:
1. Internal signals. See Figure 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Functions Block Diagram.
The above applies to INVC0 = 01XX110Xb and INVC1 = 010XXX00b (X varies depending on each system.)
The examples of PWM output change are
- Default value of the IDB0 and IDB1 registers: DU0=0, DUB0=1, DU1=1, DUB1=1
They are changed to DU0=1, DUB0=0, DU1=1, DUB1=1 by the timer B2 interrupt.
Figure 14.10 Sawtooth Wave Modulation Operation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 140 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15. Serial Interface
Serial interface is configured with 4 channels: UART0 to UART2 and SI/O3.
15.1 UARTi (i = 0 to 2)
UARTi each have an exclusive timer to generate a transfer clock, so they operate independently of each other.
Figures 15.1 to 15.3 show the block diagram of UARTi. Figure 15.4 shows the block diagram of the UARTi
transmit/receive.
UARTi has the following modes:
• Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
• Clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART mode).
• Special mode 1 (I2C mode)
• Special mode 2
• Special mode 3 (Bus collision detection function, IE mode)
• Special mode 4 (SIM mode) : UART2
Figures 15.5 to 15.10 show the UARTi-related registers.
Refer to tables listing each mode for register setting.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 141 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
1/2
Main clock, PLL clock, or on-chip oscillator clock
f2SIO
0
f1SIO
1
PCLK1
f1SIO or f2SIO
f8SIO
1/8
1/4
(UART0)
RXD polarity
reversing circuit
RXD0
1/16
Clock source selection
CLK1 to CLK0
f1SIO or f2SIO 00h
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous
type
001
CKDIR
Internal
01h
f8SIO
10h
f32SIO
UART reception SMD2 to SMD0
010, 100, 101, 110
f32SIO
Receive
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
TXD
polarity
reversing
circuit
TXD0
U0BRG
register
0
UART transmission
010, 100, 101, 110
Clock synchronous type
001
1 / (n0+1)
1/16
1
External
1/2
Transmission
control circuit
Transmit
clock
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
0
1
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CKPOL
CLK0
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
Clock synchronous
CKDIR
type
(when external clock
is selected)
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS selected
CTS0 /
RTS0
RTS0
1
VSS
CRS 0
RCSP
0
CTS0 from UART1
CTS/RTS disabled
1
1
0
CTS0
CRD
n0: Values set to the U0BRG register
PCLK1: Bit in PCLKR register
SMD2 to SMD0, CKDIR: Bits in U0MR register
CLK1 to CLK0, CKPOL, CRD, CRS: Bits in U0C0 register
RCSP: Bit in UCON register
Figure 15.1 UART0 Block Diagram
1/2
1/2
Main clock, PLL clock, or on-chip oscillator clock
f2SIO
0
f1SIO
1
PCLK1
f1SIO or f2SIO
f8SIO
1/8
f32SIO
1/4
(UART1)
RXD polarity reversing
circuit
RXD1
1/16
Clock source selection
f1SIO or f2SIO
f8SIO
f32SIO
CLK1 to CLK0
00
01
UART reception SMD2 to SMD0
010, 100, 101, 110
CKDIR
Internal
U1BRG
register
0
10
1 / (n1+1)
1/16
UART transmission
010, 100, 101, 110
External
1/2
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
0
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is selected))
CKPOL
CLK1
0
CLKMD0
Transmission
control circuit
Clock synchronous
type
001
1
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
Reception
control circuit
Clock synchronous
type
001
1
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CKDIR
1
CTS1 / RTS1/
CTS0 / CLKS1
Clock output
pin select
1
CTS/RTS selected CTS/RTS disabled
CRS
1
0
CLKMD1
RTS1
VSS
0
1
CTS/RTS disabled
0
0
1
CRD
n1: Values set to the U1BRG register
PCLK1: Bit in PCLKR register
SMD2 to SMD0, CKDIR: Bits in U1MR register
CLK1 to CLK0, CKPOL, CRD, CRS: Bits in U1C0 register
CLKMD0, CLKMD1, RCSP: Bits in UCON register
Figure 15.2 UART1 Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 142 of 376
RCSP
CTS1
CTS0 from UART0
Receive
clock
Transmit
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
TXD
polarity
reversing
circuit
TXD1
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
1/2
Main clock, PLL clock, or on-chip oscillator clock
f2SIO
0
f1SIO
1
PCLK1
f1SIO or f2SIO
f8SIO
1/8
1/4
(UART2)
RXD polarity reversing
circuit
RXD2
1/16
Clock source selection
f1SIO or f2SIO
f8SIO
f32SIO
CLK1 to CLK0
00
CKDIR
Internal
01
0
10
UART reception SMD2 to SMD0
010, 100, 101, 110
Clock synchronous
type
001
Reception
control circuit
UART transmission
1/16 010, 100, 101, 110
Clock synchronous
type
001
Transmission
control circuit
1 / (n2+1)
External
1/2
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
0
1
Clock synchronous type
(when external clock is selected) CKDIR
Clock synchronous type
(when internal clock is selected)
CLK2
CLK
polarity
reversing
circuit
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS/RTS selected
CTS2 /
RTS2
RTS2
1
CRS 0
VSS
1
0
CRD
PCLK1: Bit in PCLKR register
SMD2 to SMD0, CKDIR: Bits in U2MR register
CLK1 to CLK0, CKPOL, CRD, CRS: Bits in U2C0 register
Figure 15.3 UART2 Block Diagram
page 143 of 376
CTS/RTS disabled
CTS2
n2: Values set to the U2BRG register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Receive
clock
U2BRG
register
1
CKPOL
f32SIO
Transmit
clock
Transmit/
receive
unit
TXD
polarity
reversing
circuit (1)
TXD2
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
IOPOL
No reverse
RXDi
0
RXD data
reverse circuit
1
Clock
synchronous type
Reverse
PRYE
STPS
Clock
synchronous
type
PAR
disabled
1SP
0
0
SP
SP
UART(7 bits)
0
UARTi receive register
0
0
PAR
1
1
1
1
SMD2 to SMD0 UART
(9 bits)
PAR
enabled
2SP
0
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
0
0
UART
0
0
0
0
1
Clock
synchronous type
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UiRB register
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
Data bus high-order bits
Data bus low-order bits
Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UiTB register
UART
(8 bits)
UART
(9 bits)
PRYE
STPS
PAR
enabled
2SP
1
1
SP
SP
SMD2 to SMD0 UART
UART
PAR
0
1SP
1
(9 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
1
1
0
0
0
0
PAR
disabled
Clock
synchronous
type
UART
(7 bits)
UART
(8 bits)
Clock
synchronous type
i = 0 to 2
UARTi transmit register
UART(7 bits)
Error signal output
disable
0
UiERE 1
SP: Stop bit
PAR: Parity bit
SMD2 to SMD0, STPS, PRYE, IOPOL, CKDIR: Bits in UiMR register
CLK1 to CLK0, CKPOL, CRD, CRS: Bits in UiC0 register
UiERE: Bit in UiC1 register
Figure 15.4 UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 144 of 376
Error signal
output circuit
Error signal output
enable
IOPOL
0
1
No reverse
TXD data
reverse circuit
Reverse
TXDi
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UARTi Transmit Buffer Register (i = 0 to 2) (1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
U0TB
U1TB
U2TB
03A3h to 03A2h
03ABh to 03AAh
01FBh to 01FAh
Bit
Symbol
(b8-b0)
(b15-b9)
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
RW
Function
Transmit data
WO
Nothing is assigned When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
-
NOTE:
1. Use the MOV instruction to write to this register.
UARTi Receive Buffer Register (i = 0 to 2)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Bit
Symbol
(b7-b0)
(b8)
-
Symbol
Address
U0RB
U1RB
U2RB
03A7h to 03A6h
03AFh to 03AEh
01FFh to 01FEh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
RW
-
Receive data (D7 to D0)
RO
-
Receive data (D8)
RO
Bit Name
Nothing is assigned When write, set to "0".
-
(b10-b9) When read, their contents are "0".
ABT
Arbitration Lost
Detecting Flag (1)
OER
Overrun Error Flag (2)
FER
Framing Error Flag (2)
PER
Parity Error Flag (2)
SUM
Error Sum Flag (2)
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
0 : No overrun error
1 : Overrun error found
0 : No framing error
1 : Framing error found
0 : No parity error
1 : Parity error found
0 : No error
1 : Error found
RW
RO
RO
RO
RO
NOTES:
1. The ABT bit is set to "0" by writing "0" in a program. (Writing "1" has no effect.)
2. When the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register = 000b (serial I/O disabled) or the RE bit in the UiC1 register = 0
(reception disabled), all of the SUM, PER, FER and OER bits are set to "0" (no error). The SUM bit is set to "0" (no error)
when all of the PER, FER and OER bits are = 0 (no error).
Also, the PER and FER bits are set to "0" by reading the lower byte of the UiRB register.
UARTi Bit Rate Generator Register (i = 0 to 2) (1) (2) (3)
b7
b0
Bit
Symbol
(b7-b0)
Symbol
Address
U0BRG
U1BRG
U2BRG
03A1h
03A9h
01F9h
Function
Assuming that set value = n, UiBRG
divides the count source by n + 1
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Range
00h to FFh
RW
WO
NOTES:
1. Write to this register while serial I/O is neither transmitting nor receiving.
2. Use the MOV instruction to write to this register.
3. Write to this register after setting the CLK1 to CLK0 bits in the UiC0 register.
Figure 15.5 U0TB to U2TB Registers, U0RB to U2RB Registers, and U0BRG to U2BRG Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 145 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UARTi Transmit/Receive Mode Register (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0MR to U2MR
Bit
Symbol
Address
03A0h, 03A8h, 01F8h
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
RW
Function
b2 b1 b0
: Serial interface disabled
: Clock synchronous serial I/O mode
: I2C mode (2)
SMD1
: UART mode transfer data 7-bit long
: UART mode transfer data 8-bit long
: UART mode transfer data 9-bit long
SMD2
Do not set a value except above
Internal/External Clock 0 : Internal clock
CKDIR Select Bit
1 : External clock (3)
0 : 1 stop bit
Stop Bit Length
STPS Select Bit
1 : 2 stop bits
Effective when the PRYE bit = 1
Odd/Even Parity
0 : Odd parity
PRY
Select Bit
1 : Even parity
SMD0
PRYE
IOPOL
000
001
Serial Interface Mode 0 1 0
Select Bit (1)
100
101
110
0 : Parity disabled
1 : Parity enabled
TXD, RXD I/O Polarity 0 : No reverse
Reverse Bit
1 : Reverse
Parity Enable Bit
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. To receive data, set the corresponding port direction bit for each RXDi pin to "0" (input mode).
2. Set the corresponding port direction bit for SCL and SDA pins to "0" (input mode).
3. Set the corresponding port direction bit for each CLKi pin to "0" (input mode).
UARTi Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0C0 to U2C0
Bit
Symbol
Address
03A4h, 03ACh, 01FCh
Bit Name
After Reset
00001000b
Function
RW
b1 b0
CLK0
CLK1
CRS
BRG Count Source
Select Bit (5)
CTS/RTS Function
Select Bit (1)
Transmit Register
TXEPT Empty Flag
CRD
CTS/RTS Disable Bit
NCH
Data Output
Select Bit (3)
CKPOL
CLK Polarity
Select Bit
UFORM
Transfer Format
Select Bit (4)
0 0 : f1SIO or f2SIO is selected
0 1 : f8SIO is selected
1 0 : f32SIO is selected
1 1 : Do not set a value
Effective when CRD = 0
0 : CTS function is selected (2)
1 : RTS function is selected
0 : Data present in transmit register
(during transmission)
1 : No data present in transmit register
(transmission completed)
RW
RW
RW
RO
0 : CTS/RTS function enabled
1 : CTS/RTS function disabled
RW
(P6_0, P6_4, P7_3 can be used as I/O ports)
0 : TXDi/SDAi and SCLi pins are CMOS output
1 : TXDi/SDAi and SCLi pins are
RW
N channel open-drain output
0 : Transmit data is output at falling edge
of transfer clock and receive data is
input at rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge RW
of transfer clock and receive data is
input at falling edge
0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
RW
NOTES:
1. CTS1/RTS1 can be used when the CLKMD1 bit in the UCON register = 0 (only CLK1 output) and the
RCSP bit in the UCON register = 0 (CTS0/RTS0 not separated).
2. Set the corresponding port direction bit for each CTSi pin to "0" (input mode)
3. SCL2/P7_1 is N channel open-drain output. The NCH bit in the U2C0 register is N channel open-drain
output regardless of the NCH bit.
4. The UFORM bit is enabled when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register are set to "001b" (clock
synchronous serial I/O mode), or "101b" (UART mode, 8-bit transfer data).
Set this bit to "1" when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits are set to "010b" (I2C mode), and to "0" when the SMD2
to SMD0 bits are set to "100b" (UART mode, 7-bit transfer data) or "110b" (UART mode, 9-bit transfer data).
5. When changing the CLK1 to CLK0 bits, set the UiBRG register.
Figure 15.6 U0MR to U2MR Registers and U0C0 to U2C0 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 146 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UARTj Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 (j = 0, 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0C1, U1C1
Bit
Bit Name
Symbol
TE
TI
RE
RI
(b5-b4)
UjLCH
UjERE
Address
03A5h, 03ADh
After Reset
00XX0010b
RW
Function
0 : Transmission disabled
Transmit Enable Bit
1 : Transmission enabled
Transmit Buffer
0 : Data present in the UjTB register
Empty Flag
1 : No data present in the UjTB register
0 : Reception disabled
Receive Enable Bit
1 : Reception enabled
0 : No data present in the UjRB register
Receive Complete
1 : Data present in the UjRB register
Flag
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
Data Logic
0 : No reverse
Select Bit (1)
1 : Reverse
0 : Output disabled
Error Signal Output
1 : Output enabled
Enable Bit
RW
RO
RW
RO
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. The UjLCH bit is enabled when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UjMR register are set to "001b" (clock
synchronous serial I/O mode), "100b" (UART mode, 7-bit transfer data) or "101b" (UART mode, 8-bit
transfer data).
Set this bit to "0" when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits are set to "010b" (I2C mode) or "110b" (UART mode, 9-bit
transfer data).
UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U2C1
Bit
Symbol
Address
01FDh
Bit Name
TE
Transmit Enable Bit
TI
Transmit Buffer
Empty Flag
RE
Receive Enable Bit
RI
Receive Complete
Flag
After Reset
00000010b
Function
0 : Transmission disabled
1 : Transmission enabled
0 : Data present in U2TB register
1 : No data present in U2TB register
0 : Reception disabled
1 : Reception enabled
0 : No data present in U2RB register
1 : Data present in U2RB register
RW
RO
RW
RO
0 : Transmit buffer empty (TI bit = 1)
1 : Transmit is completed (TXEPT bit = 1) RW
UART2 Transmit Interrupt
Cause Select Bit
UART2 Continuous
U2RRM Receive Mode Enable Bit
0 : Continuous receive mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive mode enabled
Data Logic
U2LCH Select Bit (1)
Error Signal Output
U2ERE Enable Bit
0 : No reverse
1 : Reverse
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
U2IRS
RW
RW
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. The U2LCH bit is enabled when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the U2MR register are set to "001b" (clock
synchronous serial I/O mode), "100b" (UART mode, 7-bit transfer data) or "101b" (UART mode, 8-bit
transfer data).
Set this bit to "0" when the SMD2 to SMD0 bits are set to "010b" (I2C mode) or "110b" (UART mode, 9-bit
transfer data) .
Figure 15.7 U0C1, U1C1 Registers and U2C1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 147 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UART Transmit/Receive Control Register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
UCON
Bit
Symbol
Address
03B0h
Bit Name
After Reset
X0000000b
RW
Function
UART0 Transmit Interrupt
U0IRS
Cause Select Bit
UART1 Transmit Interrupt
U1IRS Cause Select Bit
UART0 Continuous
U0RRM Receive Mode Enable Bit
UART1 Continuous
U1RRM Receive Mode Enable Bit
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl bit = 1)
1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT bit = 1)
0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl bit = 1)
1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT bit = 1)
0 : Continuous receive mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive mode enabled
0 : Continuous receive mode disabled
1 : Continuous receive mode enabled
Effective when the CLKMD1 bit = 1
UART1 CLK/CLKS
0 : Clock output from CLK1
CLKMD0
Select Bit 0
1 : Clock output from CLKS1
0 : CLK output is only CLK1
UART1 CLK/CLKS
1 : Transfer clock output from multiple
CLKMD1 Select Bit 1 (1)
pins function selected
0 : CTS/RTS shared pin
Separate UART0
1 : CTS/RTS separated
RCSP CTS/RTS Bit
(CTS0 supplied from the P6_4 pin)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
(b7)
When read, its content is indeterminate.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
-
NOTE:
1. When using multiple transfer clock output pins, make sure the following conditions are met:
The CKDIR bit in the U1MR register = 0 (internal clock)
UARTi Special Mode Register (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
0
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0SMR to U2SMR
Bit
Symbol
IICM
ABC
BBS
(b3)
Address
01EFh, 01F3h, 01F7h
Bit Name
After Reset
X0000000b
Function
I 2C
0 : Other than
mode
1 : I2C mode
Arbitration Lost Detecting 0 : Update per bit
1 : Update per byte
Flag Control Bit
0 : STOP condition detected
Bus Busy Flag
1 : START condition detected (busy)
I2C Mode Select Bit
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
Bus Collision Detect 0 : Rising edge of transfer clock
ABSCS Sampling Clock Select Bit 1 : Underflow signal of timer Aj (2)
Auto Clear Function
0 : No auto clear function
ACSE Select Bit of Transmit 1 : Auto clear at occurrence of bus
Enable Bit
collision
Transmit Start Condition 0 : Not synchronized to RXDi
SSS
Select Bit
1 : Synchronized to RXDi (3)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
(b7)
When read, its content is indeterminate.
RW
RW
RW
RW (1)
RW
RW
RW
RW
-
NOTES:
1. The BBS bit is set to "0" by writing "0" in a program. (Writing "1" has no effect.).
2. Underflow signal of timer A3 in UART0, underflow signal of timer A4 in UART1, underflow signal of timer
A0 in UART2.
3. When a transfer begins, the SSS bit is set to "0" (not synchronized to RXDi).
Figure 15.8 UCON Register and U0SMR to U2SMR Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 148 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UARTi Special Mode Register 2 (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0SMR2 to U2SMR2
Bit
Symbol
Address
01EEh, 01F2h, 01F6h
Bit Name
After Reset
X0000000b
RW
Function
IICM2
I2C Mode Select Bit 2 See Table 15.12 I2C Mode Functions RW
CSC
Clock-Synchronous
Bit
SWC
ALS
STAC
SWC2
SDHI
(b7)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
0 : Disabled
SCL Wait Output Bit
1 : Enabled
0 : Disabled
SDA Output Stop Bit 1 : Enabled
UARTi Initialization
0 : Disabled
Bit
1 : Enabled
SCL Wait Output
0: Transfer clock
Bit 2
1: "L" output
SDA Output Disable 0: Enabled
Bit
1: Disabled (high-impedance)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
-
UARTi Special Mode Register 3 (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0SMR3 to U2SMR3
Bit
Symbol
(b0)
CKPH
(b2)
NODC
(b4)
Address
01EDh, 01F1h, 01F5h
Bit Name
After Reset
000X0X0Xb
Function
RW
Nothing is assigned When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
0 : Without clock delay
Clock Phase Set Bit
RW
1 : With clock delay
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
0 : CLKi is CMOS output
Clock Output Select
RW
1 : CLKi is N channel open-drain output
Bit
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
b7 b6 b5
DL0
DL1
DL2
SDAi Digital Delay
Setup Bit (1) (2)
0 0 0 : Without delay
RW
0 0 1 : 1 to 2 cycle(s) of UiBRG count source
0 1 0 : 2 to 3 cycles of UiBRG count source
0 1 1 : 3 to 4 cycles of UiBRG count source RW
1 0 0 : 4 to 5 cycles of UiBRG count source
1 0 1 : 5 to 6 cycles of UiBRG count source
1 1 0 : 6 to 7 cycles of UiBRG count source RW
1 1 1 : 7 to 8 cycles of UiBRG count source
NOTES:
1. The DL2 to DL0 bits are used to generate a delay in SDAi output by digital means during I2C mode.
In other than I2C mode, set these bits to "000b" (no delay).
2. The amount of delay varies with the load on SCLi and SDAi pins. Also, when using an external clock,
the amount of delay increases by about 100 ns.
Figure 15.9 U0SMR2 to U2SMR2 Registers and U0SMR3 to U2SMR3 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 149 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
UARTi Special Mode Register 4 (i = 0 to 2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
U0SMR4 to U2SMR4
Bit
Symbol
STAREQ
RSTAREQ
STPREQ
STSPSEL
ACKD
ACKC
SCLHI
SWC9
Bit Name
Start Condition
Generate Bit (1)
Restart Condition
Generate Bit (1)
Stop Condition
Generate Bit (1)
SCL,SDA Output
Select Bit
ACK Data Bit
ACK Data Output
Enable Bit
SCL Output Stop
Enable Bit
SCL Wait Bit 3
NOTE:
1. Set to "0" when each condition is generated.
Figure 15.10 U0SMR4 to U2SMR4 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 150 of 376
Address
01ECh, 01F0h, 01F4h
After Reset
00h
Function
0 : Clear
1 : Start
0 : Clear
1 : Start
0 : Clear
1 : Start
0 : Start and stop conditions not output
1 : Start and stop conditions output
0 : ACK
1 : NACK
0 : Serial interface data output
1 : ACK data output
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
0 : SCL "L" hold disabled
1 : SCL "L" hold enabled
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
The clock synchronous serial I/O mode uses a transfer clock to transmit and receive data. Table 15.1 lists
the specifications of the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Table 15.2 lists the registers used in clock
synchronous serial I/O mode and the register values set.
Table 15.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Specifications
Item
Transfer Data Format
Transfer Clock
Specification
Transfer data length: 8 bits
The CKDIR bit in the UiMR register = 0 (internal clock) : fj/ 2(n+1)
• fj = f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n: Setting value of the UiBRG register 00h to FFh
The CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock) : Input from CLKi pin
_______
_______
_______ _______
Transmission, Reception Control Selectable from CTS function, RTS function or CTS/RTS function disabled
Transmission Start Condition Before transmission can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
_______
_______
• If CTS function is selected, input on the CTSi pin = L
Reception Start Condition
Before reception can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The RE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
Interrupt Request
For transmission, one of the following conditions can be selected
Generation Timing
• The UiIRS bit (2) = 0 (transmit buffer empty): when transferring data from the
UiTB register to the UARTi transmit register (at start of transmission)
• The UiIRS bit =1 (transfer completed): when the serial I/O finished sending data from
the UARTi transmit register
For reception
• When transferring data from the UARTi receive register to the UiRB register (at
completion of reception)
Error Detection
Overrun error (3)
This error occurs if the serial I/O started receiving the next data before reading the
UiRB register and received the 7th bit of the next data
Select Function
• CLK polarity selection
Transfer data input/output can be selected to occur synchronously with the rising or
the falling edge of the transfer clock
• LSB first, MSB first selection
Whether to start sending/receiving data beginning with bit 0 or beginning with bit 7
can be selected
• Continuous receive mode selection
Reception is enabled immediately by reading the UiRB register
• Switching serial data logic
This function reverses the logic value of the transmit/receive data
• Transfer clock output from multiple pins selection (UART1)
The output pin can be selected in a program from two UART1 transfer clock pins that
have been set
_______ _______
• Separate CTS/RTS pins (UART0)
_________
_________
CTS0 and RTS0 are input/output from separate pins
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. When an external clock is selected, the conditions must be met while if the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 0
(transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive data taken in at the rising edge of the transfer clock), the
external clock is in the high state; if the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 1 (transmit data output at the rising edge
and the receive data taken in at the falling edge of the transfer clock), the external clock is in the low state.
2. The U0IRS and U1IRS bits respectively are bits 0 and 1 in the UCON register; the U2IRS bit is bit 4 in the U2C1 register.
3. If an overrun error occurs, the value of UiRB register will be indeterminate. The IR bit in the SiRIC register does not
change.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 151 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.2 Registers to Be Used and Settings in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
Register
Bit
Function
UiTB (1)
0 to 7
Set transmission data
UiRB (1)
0 to 7
Reception data can be read
OER
Overrun error flag
UiBRG
0 to 7
Set a transfer rate
UiMR (1)
SMD2 to SMD0
Set to “001b”
CKDIR
Select the internal clock or external clock
IOPOL
Set to “0”
UiC0
CLK1 to CLK0
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
CRS
Select CTS or RTS to use
TXEPT
Transmit register empty flag
CRD
Enable or disable the CTS or RTS function
NCH
Select TXDi pin output mode
CKPOL
Select the transfer clock polarity
UFORM
Select the LSB first or MSB first
TE
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission/reception
_______
_______
_______
UiC1
_______
TI
Transmit buffer empty flag
RE
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
RI
Reception complete flag
U2IRS (2)
Select the source of UART2 transmit interrupt
U2RRM (2)
Set this bit to “1” to use continuous receive mode
UiLCH
Set this bit to “1” to use inverted data logic
UiERE
Set to “0”
UiSMR
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR2
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR3
0 to 2
Set to “0”
NODC
Select clock output mode
4 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR4
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UCON
U0IRS, U1IRS
Select the source of UART0/UART1 transmit interrupt
U0RRM, U1RRM
Set this bit to “1” to use continuous receive mode
CLKMD0
Select the transfer clock output pin when the CLKMD1 bit = 1
CLKMD1
Set this bit to “1” to output UART1 transfer clock from two pins
RCSP
Set this bit to “1” to accept as input the UART0 CTS0 signal from the P6_4 pin
7
Set to “0”
_________
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. Not all register bits are described above. Set those bits to “0” when writing to the registers in clock
synchronous serial I/O mode.
2. Set the bit 4 and bit 5 in the U0C1 and U1C1 registers to “0”. The U0IRS, U1IRS, U0RRM and
U1RRM bits are in the UCON register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 152 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.3 lists the functions of the input/output pins during clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Table
15.3 shows pin functions for the case where the multiple transfer clock output pin select function is
deselected. Table 15.4 lists the P6_4 pin functions during clock synchronous serial I/O mode.
Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TXDi
pin outputs an “H”.
Figure 15.11 shows the transmit/receive timings during clock synchronous serial I/O mode.
Table 15.3 Pin Functions (When Not Select Multiple Transfer Clock Output Pin Function)
Pin Name
TXDi
Function
Serial Data Output
Method of Selection
(Outputs dummy data when performing reception only)
(P6_3, P6_7, P7_0)
RXDi
Serial Data Input
(P6_2, P6_6, P7_1)
PD6_2 and PD6_6 bits in PD6 register = 0
PD7_1 bit in PD7 register = 0
(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only)
CLKi
Transfer Clock Output CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 0
(P6_1, P6_5, P7_2) Transfer Clock Input CKDIR bit = 1
PD6_1 and PD6_5 bits in PD6 register = 0
_________ ________
________
CTSi/RTSi
CTS Input
(P6_0, P6_4, P7_3)
PD7_2 bit in PD7 register = 0
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0
CRS bit in UiC0 register = 0
________
RTS Output
PD6_0 and PD6_4 bits in PD6 register = 0
PD7_3 bit in PD7 register = 0
CRD bit = 0
CRS bit = 1
I/O Port
CRD bit = 1
i = 0 to 2
Table 15.4 P6_4 Pin Functions
Bit set Value
Pin Function
U1C0 Register
CRD bit
CRS bit
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
-
RCSP
0
0
0
1
-
UCON Register
bit CLKMD1 bit CLKMD0 bit
0
0
0
0
(2)
1
1
PD6 Register
PD6_4 bit
Input: 0, Output: 1
0
0
-
P6_4
_________
CTS1
_________
RTS1
_________
CTS0 (1)
CLKS1
-: “0” or “1”
NOTES:
__________ __________
1. In addition to this, set the CRD
bit
in
the
U0C0
register
to
“0”
(CTS0/RTS0
enabled) and the CRS
__________
bit in the U0C0 register to “1” (RTS0 selected).
2. When the CLKMD1 bit = 1 and the CLKMD0 bit = 0, the following logic levels are output:
• High if the CLKPOL bit in the U1C0 register = 0
• Low if the CLKPOL bit = 1
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 153 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
(1) Example of Transmit Timing (when internal clock is selected)
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
TI bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
"0"
Write data to the UiTB register
"0"
Transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit register
"H"
CTSi
TCLK
"L"
Stopped pulsing because CTSi = H
Stopped pulsing because the TE bit = 0
CLKi
TXDi
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
"1"
IR bit in
SiTIC register
"1"
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
"0"
"0"
Set to "0" when interrupt request is accepted, or set to "0" in a program
TC = TCLK= 2(n + 1) / fj
fj: frequency of UiBRG count source (f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO)
n: value set to the UiBRG register
i = 0 to 2
The above timing diagram applies to the case where the register bits are set as follows:
CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 0 (internal clock)
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0 (CTS/RTS enabled), CRS bit in UiC0 register = 0 (CTS selected)
CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data taken in at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
UiRS bit = 0 (an interrupt request occurs when the transmit buffer becomes empty):
U0IRS bit is bit 0 in UCON register
U1IRS bit is bit 1 in UCON register
U2IRS bit is bit 4 in U2C1 register
(2) Example of Receive Timing (when external clock is selected)
"1"
RE bit in
UiC1 register
"0"
TE bit in
UiC1 register
"0"
TI bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
"0"
"H"
RTSi
Write dummy data to the UiTB register
"1"
Transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit register
"L"
Even if the reception is completed, the RTS
does not change. The RTS becomes "L"
when the RI bit changes to "0" from "1".
1 / fEXT
CLKi
Receive data is taken in
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
RXDi
RI bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
IR bit in
SiRIC register
"1"
Transferred from UARTi receive register
to the UiRB register
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5
Read out from the UiRB register
"0"
"0"
Set to "0" when interrupt request is
accepted, or set to "0" in a program
The above timing diagram applies to the case where the register bits are set
as follows:
CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 1 (external clock)
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0 (CTS/RTS enabled), CRS bit = 1 (RTS selected)
CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive
data taken in at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
fEXT: frequency of external clock
Figure 15.11 Transmit and Receive Operation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 154 of 376
Make sure the following conditions are met when input
to the CLKi pin before receiving data is high:
TE bit in UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
RE bit in UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
Write dummy data to the UiTB register
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.1.1 Counter Measure for Communication Error Occurs
If a communication error occurs while transmitting or receiving in clock synchronous serial I/O mode,
follow the procedures below.
• Resetting the UiRB register (i = 0 to 2)
(1) Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to “0” (reception disabled)
(2) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “000b” (serial interface disabled)
(3) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “001b” (clock synchronous serial I/O mode)
(4) Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to “1” (reception enabled)
• Resetting the UiTB register (i = 0 to 2)
(1) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “000b” (serial interface disabled)
(2) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “001b” (clock synchronous serial I/O mode)
(3) “1” (transmission enabled) is written to the TE bit in the UiC1 register, regardless of the TE bit
15.1.1.2 CLK Polarity Select Function
Use the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 2) to select the transfer clock polarity. Figure 15.12
shows the polarity of the transfer clock.
(1) When the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling
edge and the receive data taken in at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
CLKi
(NOTE 1)
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
(2) When the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 1 (transmit data output at the rising
edge and the receive data taken in at the falling edge of the transfer clock)
CLKi
(NOTE 2)
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
i = 0 to 2
* This applies to the case where the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register = 0
(LSB first) and the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (no reverse).
NOTES:
1. When not transferring, the CLKi pin outputs a high signal.
2. When not transferring, the CLKi pin outputs a low signal.
Figure 15.12 Transfer Clock Polarity
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 155 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.1.3 LSB First/MSB First Select Function
Use the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 2) to select the transfer format.
Figure 15.13 shows the transfer format.
(1) When the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register = 0 (LSB first)
CLKi
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
RXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
(2) When the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register = 1 (MSB first)
CLKi
TXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RXDi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
i = 0 to 2
* This applies to the case where the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 0
(transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive data taken in at
the rising edge of the transfer clock) and the UiLCH bit in the UiC1
register = 0 (no reverse).
Figure 15.13 Transfer Format
15.1.1.4 Continuous Receive Mode
In continuous receive mode, receive operation becomes enable when the receive buffer register is read.
It is not necessary to write dummy data into the transmit buffer register to enable receive operation in
this mode. However, a dummy read of the receive buffer register is required when starting the operation
mode.
When the UiRRM bit (i = 0 to 2) = 1 (continuous receive mode), the TI bit in the UiC1 register is set to “0”
(data present in UiTB register) by reading the UiRB register. In this case, i.e., UiRRM bit = 1, do not write
dummy data to the UiTB register in a program. The U0RRM and U1RRM bits are bit 2 and bit 3 in the
UCON register, respectively, and the U2RRM bit is bit 5 in the U2C1 register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 156 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.1.5 Serial Data Logic Switching Function
When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 2) = 1 (reverse), the data written to the UiTB register has
its logic reversed before being transmitted. Similarly, the received data has its logic reversed when read
from the UiRB register. Figure 15.14 shows serial data logic.
(1) When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (no reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(no reverse) "L"
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
(2) When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(reverse)
"L"
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
i = 0 to 2
* This applies to the case where the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register = 0
(transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive data taken in
at the rising edge of the transfer clock) and the UFORM bit = 0 (LSB first).
Figure 15.14 Serial Data Logic Switching
15.1.1.6 Transfer Clock Output From Multiple Pins (UART1)
Use the CLKMD1 to CLKMD0 bits in the UCON register to select one of the two transfer clock output
pins. Figure 15.15 shows the transfer clock output from the multiple pins function usage. This function
can be used when the selected transfer clock for UART1 is an internal clock.
Microcomputer
TXD1(P6_7)
CLKS1(P6_4)
CLK1(P6_5)
IN
IN
CLK
CLK
Transfer enabled when
the CLKMD0 bit in the
UCON register = 0
Transfer enabled when
the CLKMD0 bit = 1
* This applies to the case where the CKDIR bit in the U1MR register
= 0 (internal clock) and the CLKMD1 bit in the UCON register = 1
(transfer clock output from multiple pins).
Figure 15.15 Transfer Clock Output From Multiple Pins
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 157 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
_______ _______
15.1.1.7 CTS/RTS
Function
_______
________ ________
When the CTS function is used transmit and receive operation start
when
“L”
is
applied
to
the
CTSi/RTSi
________ ________
(i = 0 to 2) pin. Transmit and receive operation begins when the CTSi/RTSi pin is held “L”. If the “L” signal
is switched_______
to “H” during a transmit or________
receive
operation, the operation stops before the next data.
________
When the RTS function is used, the CTSi/RTSi pin outputs on “L” signal when the microcomputer is
ready to receive. The output level
becomes “H” on the first falling
edge of the CLKi pin.
_______ _______
________ ________
• CRD bit in UiC0 register = 1 ( CTS/RTS function
disabled)
CTSi/RTSi
pin is programmable
I/O function
_______
________ ________
_______
• CRD bit = 0, CRS bit in UiC0
register = 0 (CTS function is selected) CTSi/RTSi
pin is CTS
function
_______
________ ________
_______
• CRD bit = 0, CRS bit = 1 (RTS function is selected)
CTSi/RTSi pin is RTS function
_______ _______
15.1.1.8 CTS/RTS Separate
Function
(UART0)
_______
_______
_______
_______
This function separates CTS0/RTS0, outputs RTS0 from the P6_0 pin, and accepts as input the CTS0
from the P6_4 pin. To use this function, set the register
bits as shown below.
_______ _______
• CRD bit in U0C0 register = 0 (enables UART0_______
CTS/RTS)
• CRS bit in U0C0 register = 1 (outputs UART0 RTS)
_______ _______
• CRD bit in U1C0 register = 0 (enables UART1
CTS/RTS)
_______
• CRS bit in U1C0 register = 0 (inputs UART1
CTS)
_______
• RCSP bit in UCON register = 1 (inputs CTS0 from the P6_4 pin)
• CLKMD1 bit in UCON register
= 0 (CLKS1 not used)
_______ _______
_______ _______
Note that when using the CTS/RTS separate function, UART1 CTS/RTS separate function cannot be
used.
_______ _______
Figure 15.16 shows CTS/RTS separate function usage.
IC
Microcomputer
TXD0(P6_3)
RXD0(P6_2)
IN
OUT
CLK0(P6_1)
CLK
RTS0(P6_0)
CTS
CTS0(P6_4)
RTS
_______ _______
Figure 15.16 CTS/RTS Separate Function
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 158 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.2 Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode
The UART mode allows transmitting and receiving data after setting the desired transfer rate and transfer
data format. Table 15.5 lists the specifications of the UART mode. Table 15.6 lists the registers used in
UART mode and the register values set.
Table 15.5 UART Mode Specifications
Item
Transfer Data Format
Specification
•
•
•
•
•
Character bit (transfer data): Selectable from 7, 8 or 9 bits
Start bit: 1 bit
Parity bit: Selectable from odd, even, or none
Stop bit: Selectable from 1 or 2 bits
Transfer Clock
CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 0 (internal clock) : fj/ 16(n+1)
fj = f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n: Setting value of the UiBRG register 00h to FFh
• The CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock) : fEXT/16(n+1)
fEXT: Input from_______
CLKi pin. n :Setting
value of the _______
UiBRG
register 00h to FFh
_______
_______
Transmission, Reception Control Selectable from CTS function, RTS function or CTS/RTS function disabled
Transmission Start Condition Before transmission can start, the following requirements must be met
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The
TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present
in UiTB register)
_______
________
• If CTS function is selected, input on the CTSi pin = L
Reception Start Condition
Before reception can start, the following requirements must be met
• The RE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• Start bit detection
Interrupt Request
For transmission, one of the following conditions can be selected
Generation Timing
• The UiIRS bit (1) = 0 (transmit buffer empty): when transferring data from the UiTB register
to the UARTi transmit register (at start of transmission)
• The UiIRS bit =1 (transfer completed): when the serial I/O finished sending data
from the UARTi transmit register
For reception
• When transferring data from the UARTi receive register to the UiRB register
(at completion of reception)
(2)
Error Detection
• Overrun error
This error occurs if the serial I/O started receiving the next data before reading the
UiRB register and received the bit one before the last stop bit of the next data
• Framing error (3)
This error occurs when the number of stop bits set is not detected
• Parity error (3)
This error occurs when if parity is enabled, the number of 1’s in parity and character
bits does not match the number of 1’s set
• Error sum flag
This flag is set to “1” when any of the overrun, framing, or parity errors occur
Select Function
• LSB first, MSB first selection
Whether to start sending/receiving data beginning with bit 0 or beginning with bit 7 can
be selected
• Serial data logic switch
This function reverses the logic of the transmit/receive data. The start and stop bits are not reversed.
• TXD, RXD I/O polarity switch
This function reverses the polarities of the TXD pin output and RXD pin input.
The logic _______
levels_______
of all I/O data is reversed.
CTS/RTS
pins (UART0)
• Separate
_________
_________
CTS0 and RTS0 are input/output from separate pins
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. The U0IRS and U1IRS bits are bits 0 and 1 in the UCON register. The U2IRS bit is bit 4 in the U2C1 register.
2. If an overrun error occurs, the value of the UiRB register will be indeterminate. The IR bit in the SiRIC register does not change.
3. The timing at which the framing error flag and the parity error flag are set is detected when data is transferred from the
UARTi receive register to the UiRB register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 159 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.6 Registers to Be Used and Settings in UART Mode
Register
Bit
Function
(1)
UiTB
0 to 8
Set transmission data
UiRB
0 to 8
Reception data can be read
(1)
OER,FER,PER,SUM Error flag
UiBRG
0 to 7
Set a transfer rate
UiMR
SMD2 to SMD0
Set these bits to “100b” when transfer data is 7-bit long
Set these bits to “101b” when transfer data is 8-bit long
Set these bits to “110b” when transfer data is 9-bit long
CKDIR
UiC0
Select the internal clock or external clock
STPS
Select the stop bit
PRY, PRYE
Select whether parity is included and whether odd or even
IOPOL
Select the TXD/RXD input/output polarity
CLK0, CLK1
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
CRS
Select CTS or RTS to use
TXEPT
Transmit register empty flag
CRD
Enable or disable the CTS or RTS function
NCH
Select TXDi pin output mode
CKPOL
Set to “0”
UFORM
LSB first or MSB first can be selected when transfer data is 8-bit long. Set this
_______
_______
_______
_______
bit to “0” when transfer data is 7- or 9-bit long.
UiC1
TE
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission
TI
Transmit buffer empty flag
RE
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
RI
U2IRS
Reception complete flag
(2)
U2RRM
Select the source of UART2 transmit interrupt
(2)
UiLCH
Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to use inverted data logic
UiERE
Set to “0”
UiSMR
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR2
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR3
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR4
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UCON
U0IRS, U1IRS
Select the source of UART0/UART1 transmit interrupt
U0RRM, U1RRM
Set to “0”
CLKMD0
Invalid because the CLKMD1 bit = 0
CLKMD1
Set to “0”
RCSP
Set this bit to “1” to accept as input the UART0 CTS0 signal from the P6_4 pin
7
Set to “0”
_________
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. The bits used for transmit/receive data are as follows:
• Bit 0 to bit 6 when transfer data is 7-bit long
• Bit 0 to bit 7 when transfer data is 8-bit long
• Bit 0 to bit 8 when transfer data is 9-bit long.
2. Set bit 4 to bit 5 in the U0C1 and U1C1 registers to “0”. The U0IRS, U1IRS, U0RRM and U1RRM bits are included
in the UCON register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 160 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.7 lists the functions of the input/output pins during UART mode. Table 15.8 lists the P6_4 pin
functions during UART mode. Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to
when transfer starts, the TXDi pin outputs an “H”.
Figure 15.17 shows the typical transmit timings in UART mode. Figure 15.18 shows the typical receive
timing in UART mode.
Table 15.7 I/O Pin Functions
Pin Name
Function
TXDi
Serial Data Output
(P6_3, P6_7, P7_0)
RXDi
Serial Data Input
(P6_2, P6_6, P7_1)
Method of Selection
(Outputs “H” when performing reception only)
PD6_2 and PD6_6 bits in PD6 register = 0
PD7_1 bit in PD7 register = 0
(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only)
CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 0
CLKi
I/O Port
(P6_1, P6_5, P7_2) Transfer Clock Input CKDIR bit in UiMR register = 1
PD6_1 and PD6_5 bits in PD6 register = 0
________ ________
_______
CTSi/RTSi
CTS Input
PD7_2 bit in PD7 register = 0
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0
(P6_0, P6_4, P7_3)
CRS bit in UiC0 register = 0
PD6_0 and PD6_4 bits in PD6 register = 0
PD7_3 bit in PD7 register = 0
________
CRD bit = 0
RTS Output
CRS bit = 1
CRD bit = 1
I/O Port
i = 0 to 2
Table 15.8 P6_4 Pin Functions
Bit set Value
Pin Function
P6_4
_________
CTS1
_________
RTS1
_________
CTS0
(1)
U1C0 Register
CRD bit
1
0
0
0
CRS bit
0
1
0
UCON Register
PD6 Register
RCSP bit CLKMD1 bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
PD6_4 bit
Input: 0, Output: 1
0
0
-: “0” or “1”
NOTE:
__________ _________
1. In addition to this, set the CRD
bit
in
the
U0C0
register
to
“0”
(CTS0/RTS0
enabled) and the CRS
_________
bit in the U0C0 register to “1” (RTS0 selected).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 161 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
(1) Example of Transmit Timing when Transfer Data is 8-bit Long (parity enabled, one stop bit)
The transfer clock stops momentarily as CTSi is "H" when the stop bit is checked.
The transfer clock starts as the transfer starts immediately CTSi changes to "L".
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
TI bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
"0"
Write data to the UiTB register
"0"
Transferred from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register
"H"
CTSi
"L"
Start
bit
TXDi
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
"1"
IR bit in
SiTIC register
"1"
Stopped pulsing
because the TE bit
Parity Stop
bi t
bi t
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
=0
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
ST D0 D1
"0"
"0"
Set to "0" by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by program
The above timing diagram applies to the case where the register bits are set
TC = 16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
as follows:
fj : frequency of UiBRG count source (f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO)
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled)
fEXT : frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
n : value set to UiBRG
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0 (CTS/RTS enabled), and CRS bit = 0 (CTS selected)
UilRS bit = 1 (an interrupt request occurs when transmit completed):
i = 0 to 2
U0IRS bit is bit 0 in UCON register
U1IRS bit is bit 1 in UCON register
U2IRS bit is bit 4 in U2C1 register
(2) Example of Transmit Timing when Transfer Data is 9-bit Long (parity disabled, two stop bits)
TC
Transfer clock
TE bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
TI bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
Write data to the UiTB register
"0"
"0"
Start
bit
TXDi
Stop Stop
bi t bi t
ST D 0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP
TXEPT bit in
UiC0 register
"1"
IR bit in
SiTIC register
"1"
Transferred from UiTB register to UARTi
transmit register
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SPSP
ST D0 D1
"0"
"0"
Set to "0" by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by program
The above timing diagram applies to the case where the register bits are set
as follows:
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 0 (parity disabled)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 1 (2 stop bits)
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 1 (CTS/RTS disabled)
UilRS bit = 0 (an interrupt request occurs when transmit buffer becomes empty):
U0IRS bit is bit 0 in UCON register
U1IRS bit is bit 1 in UCON register
U2IRS bit is bit 4 in U2C1 register
Figure 15.17 Transmit Operation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 162 of 376
TC = 16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fj : frequency of UiBRG count source (f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO)
fEXT: frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock)
n : value set to UiBRG
i = 0 to 2
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
• Example of Receive Timing when Transfer Data is 8-bit Long (parity disabled, one stop bit)
UiBRG count
source
RE bit in
UiC1 register
"1"
"0"
Stop bit
Start bit
RXDi
D1
D0
D7
Sampled "L"
Receive data taken in
Transfer clock
RI bit in
UiC1 register
RTSi
IR bit in
SiRIC register
Reception triggered when transfer clock
"1" is generated by falling edge of start bit
Transferred from UARTi receive
register to UiRB register
"0"
"H"
"L"
"1"
"0"
i = 0 to 2
Set to "0" by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by program
The above timing diagram applies to the case where the register bits are set as follows:
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 0 (parity disabled)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
CRD bit in UiC0 register = 0 (CTSi/RTSi enabled) and CRS bit = 1 (RTSi selected)
Figure 15.18 Receive Operation
15.1.2.1 Bit Rates
In UART mode, the frequency set by the UiBRG register (i = 0 to 2) divided by 16 become the bit rates.
Table 15.9 lists example of bit rates and settings.
Table 15.9 Example of Bit Rates and Settings
Bit-rate
(bps)
1200
2400
4800
9600
14400
19200
28800
31250
38400
51200
Peripheral Function Clock: 16MHz Peripheral Function Clock: 20MHz Peripheral Function Clock: 24MHz (1)
Count Source
Set Value of Actual Time Set Value of Actual Time Set Value of Actual Time
of BRG
BRG: n
(bps)
BRG: n
(bps)
BRG: n
(bps)
f8
f8
f8
f1
f1
f1
f1
f1
f1
f1
103 (67h)
51 (33h)
25 (19h)
103 (67h)
68 (44h)
51 (33h)
34 (22h)
31 (1Fh)
25 (19h)
19 (13h)
1202
2404
4808
9615
14493
19231
28571
31250
38462
50000
NOTE:
1. 24 MHz is available Normal-ver. only.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 163 of 376
129 (81h)
64 (40h)
32 (20h)
129 (81h)
86 (56h)
64 (40h)
42 (2Ah)
39 (27h)
32 (20h)
23 (17h)
1202
2404
4735
9615
14368
19231
29070
31250
37879
52083
155 (9Bh)
77 (4Dh)
38 (26h)
155 (9Bh)
103 (67h)
77 (4Dh)
51 (33h)
47 (2Fh)
38 (26h)
28 (1Ch)
1202
2404
4808
9615
14423
19231
28846
31250
38462
51724
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.2.2 Counter Measure for Communication Error Occurs
If a communication error occurs while transmitting or receiving in UART mode, follow the procedures
below.
• Resetting the UiRB register (i = 0 to 2)
(1) Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to “0” (reception disabled)
(2) Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to “1” (reception enabled)
• Resetting the UiTB register (i = 0 to 2)
(1) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “000b” (serial interface disabled)
(2) Set the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register to “001b”, “101b”, “110b”
(3) “1” (transmission enabled) is written to the TE bit in the UiC1 register, regardless of the TE bit
15.1.2.3 LSB First/MSB First Select Function
As shown in Figure 15.19, use the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register to select the transfer format. This
function is valid when transfer data is 8-bit long.
(1) When the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register = 0 (LSB first)
CLKi
TXDi
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
RXDi
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
(2) When the UFORM bit = 1 (MSB first)
CLKi
TXDi
ST
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
P
SP
RXDi
ST
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
P
SP
i = 0 to 2
ST: Start bit
P: Parity bit
SP: Stop bit
NOTE:
1. This applies to the case where the register bits are set as follows:
CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive
data taken in at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
UiLCH bit in UiC1 register = 0 (no reverse)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled)
Figure 15.19 Transfer Format
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 164 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.2.4 Serial Data Logic Switching Function
The data written to the UiTB register has its logic reversed before being transmitted. Similarly, the
received data has its logic reversed when read from the UiRB register. Figure 15.20 shows serial data logic.
(1) When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (no reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(no reverse)
"L"
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
(2) When the UiLCH bit = 1 (reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(reverse)
"L"
ST
D0
D1
i = 0 to 2
ST: Start bit
P: Parity bit
SP: Stop bit
NOTE:
1. This applies to the case where the register bit are set as follows:
CKPOL bit in UiC0 register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge of the transfer clock)
UFORM bit in UiC0 register = 0 (LSB first)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled)
Figure 15.20 Serial Data Logic Switching
15.1.2.5 TXD and RXD I/O Polarity Inverse Function
This function inverses the polarities of the TXDi pin output and RXDi pin input. The logic levels of all input/output
data (including the start, stop and parity bits) are inversed. Figure 15.21 shows the TXD and RXD input/output
polarity inverse.
(1) When the IOPOL bit in the UiMR register = 0 (no reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(no reverse) "L"
RXDi
"H"
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
(no reverse) "L"
(2) When the IOPOL bit = 1 (reverse)
Transfer clock
"H"
"L"
TXDi
"H"
(reverse) "L"
RXDi
(reverse)
"H"
"L"
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
i = 0 to 2
ST: Start bit
P: Parity bit
SP: Stop bit
NOTE:
1. This applies to the case where the register bits are set as follows:
UFORM bit in UiC0 register = 0 (LSB first)
STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled)
Figure 15.21 TXD and RXD I/O Polarity Inverse
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 165 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
_______ _______
15.1.2.6 CTS/RTS
Function
_______
________ ________
When the CTS function is used transmit operation
start
when
“L”
is
applied
to
the
CTSi/RTSi (i = 0 to 2)
________ ________
pin. Transmit operation begins when the CTSi/RTSi pin is held “L”. If the “L” signal is switched to “H”
during a transmit
operation, the operation
stops before the next data.
_______
________ ________
When the RTS function is used, the CTSi/RTSi pin outputs on “L” signal when the microcomputer is
ready to receive. The output level becomes_______
“H” _______
on the first falling
edge of the CLKi pin.
________ ________
• CRD bit in UiC0 register = 1 (disables UART0_______
CTS/RTS function) CTSi/RTSi
pin is programmable
I/O function
________ ________
_______
• CRD bit = 0, CRS bit in UiC0
register= 0 (CTS function is selected) CTSi/RTSi
pin is CTS
function
_______
________ ________
_______
• CRD bit = 0, CRS bit = 1 (RTS function is selected)
CTSi/RTSi pin is RTS function
_______ _______
15.1.2.7 CTS/RTS Separate
Function (UART0)
_________ _________
________
_________
This function separates CTS0/RTS0, outputs RTS0 from the P6_0 pin, and accepts as input the CTS0
from the P6_4 pin. To use this function, set the register
bits as shown below.
_______ _______
• CRD bit in U0C0 register = 0 (enables UART0_______
CTS/RTS)
• CRS bit in U0C0 register = 1 (outputs UART0 RTS)
_______ _______
• CRD bit in U1C0 register = 0 (enables UART1
CTS/RTS)
_______
• CRS bit in U1C0 register = 0 (inputs UART1
CTS)
_______
• RCSP bit in UCON register = 1 (inputs CTS0 from the P6_4 pin)
• CLKMD1 bit in UCON register
= 0 (CLKS1 not used)
_______ _______
_______ _______
Note that when using _______
the CTS/RTS
separate function, UART1 CTS/RTS separate function cannot be used.
_______
Figure 15.22 shows CTS/RTS separate function usage.
IC
Microcomputer
RXD0(P6_2)
IN
OUT
RTS0(P6_0)
CTS
CTS0(P6_4)
RTS
TXD0(P6_3)
_______ _______
Figure 15.22 CTS/RTS Separate Function
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 166 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.3 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode)
I2C mode is provided for use as a simplified I2C interface compatible mode. Table 15.10 lists the specifications
of the I2C mode. Figure 15.23 shows the block diagram for I2C mode. Table 15.11 lists the registers used
in the I2C mode and the register values set. Table 15.12 lists the functions in I2C mode. Figure 15.24
shows the transfer to the UiRB register and interrupt timing.
As shown in Table 15.12, the microcomputer is placed in I2C mode by setting the SMD2 to SMD0 bits to
“010b” and the IICM bit to “1”. Because SDAi transmit output has a delay circuit attached, SDAi output
does not change state until SCLi goes low and remains stably low.
Table 15.10 I2C Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Transfer Data Format
Transfer Clock
Transfer data length: 8 bits
• During master
The CKDIR bit in the UiMR register = 0 (internal clock) : fj/ 2(n+1)
fj = f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n: Setting value of the UiBRG register 00h to FFh
• During slave
The CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock) : Input from SCLi pin
Transmission Start Condition Before transmission can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
Reception Start Condition
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
Before reception can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The RE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
Interrupt Request
Generation Timing
Error Detection
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
When start or stop condition is detected, acknowledge undetected, and acknowledge
detected
Overrun error (2)
This error occurs if the serial I/O started receiving the next data before reading the
UiRB register and received the 8th bit of the next data
Select Function
• Arbitration lost
Timing at which the ABT bit in the UiRB register is updated can be selected
• SDAi digital delay
No digital delay or a delay of 2 to 8 UiBRG count source clock cycles selectable
• Clock phase setting
With or without clock delay selectable
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. When an external clock is selected, the conditions must be met while the external clock is in the high state.
2. If an overrun error occurs, the value of UiRB register will be indeterminate. The IR bit in the SiRIC
register does not change.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 167 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Start and stop condition generation block
SDAi
STSPSEL=1
Delay
circuit
ACKC=1
SDA(STSP)
SCL(STSP)
STSPSEL=0
IICM2=1
Transmission
register
ACKC=0
IICM=1 and
IICM2=0
UARTi
SDHI
ACKD bit
D
DMA0
(UART0, UART2)
Arbitration
Q
IICM2=1
Reception register
UARTi
IICM=1 and
IICM2=0
Start condition
detection
S
R
Q
NACK
D
IICM=0
R
Noise
Filter
D Q
T
Port register (1)
ACK
9th bit
Q
STSPSEL=0
IICM=1 UARTi
Q
T
Falling edge
detection
I/O port
UARTi receive,
ACK interrupt request,
DMA1 request
Bus
busy
Stop condition
detection
SCLi
UARTi transmit,
NACK interrupt
request
ALS
T
Noise
Filter
DMA0, DMA1 request
(UART1: DMA0 only)
Internal clock
SWC2
STSPSEL=1 External
clock
Start/stop condition
detection
interrupt request
CLK
control
UARTi
R
S
9th bit falling edge
SWC
This diagram applies to the case where the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register = 010b and the IICM bit in the UiSMR register = 1.
i = 0 to 2
IICM: Bit in UiSMR register
IICM2, SWC, ALS, SWC2, SDHI: Bits in UiSMR2 register
STSPSEL, ACKD, ACKC: Bits in UiSMR4 register
NOTE:
1. If the IICM bit =1, the pins can be read even when the PD6_2, PD6_6 or PD7_1 bit = 1 (output mode).
Figure 15.23 I2C Mode Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 168 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.11 Registers to Be Used and Settings in I2C Mode
Register
UiTB (1)
UiRB (1)
UiBRG
UiMR (1)
UiC0
UiC1
UiSMR
UiSMR2
0 to 7
0 to 7
8
ABT
OER
0 to 7
SMD2 to SMD0
CKDIR
IOPOL
CLK1, CLK0
CRS
TXEPT
CRD
NCH
CKPOL
UFORM
TE
TI
RE
RI
U2IRS (2)
U2RRM (2),
UiLCH, UiERE
IICM
ABC
BBS
3 to 7
IICM2
CSC
SWC
ALS
STAC
UiSMR3
UiSMR4
SWC2
SDHI
7
0, 2, 4 and NODC
CKPH
DL2 to DL0
STAREQ
RSTAREQ
STPREQ
STSPSEL
ACKD
ACKC
SCLHI
SWC9
IFSR0
UCON
Function
Bit
IFSR06, ISFR07
U0IRS, U1IRS
2 to 7
Master
Set transmission data
Reception data can be read
ACK or NACK is set in this bit
Arbitration lost detection flag
Overrun error flag
Set a transfer rate
Set to “010b”
Set to “0”
Set to “0”
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
Invalid because the CRD bit = 1
Transmit register empty flag
Set to “1”
Set to “1”
Set to “0”
Set to “1”
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission
Transmit buffer empty flag
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
Reception complete flag
Invalid
Set to “0”
Slave
Invalid
Invalid
Set to “1”
Invalid
Set to “1”
Select the timing at which arbitration-lost Invalid
is detected
Bus busy flag
Set to “0”
See Table 15.12 I2C Mode Functions
Set this bit to “1” to enable clock synchronization Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to have SCLi output fixed to “L” at the falling edge of the 9th bit of clock
Set this bit to “1” to have SDAi output
Set to “0”
stopped when arbitration-lost is detected
Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to initialize UARTi at
start condition detection
Set this bit to “1” to have SCLi output forcibly pulled low
Set this bit to “1” to disable SDAi output
Set to “0”
Set to “0”
See Table 15.12 I2C Mode Functions
Set the amount of SDAi digital delay
Set this bit to “1” to generate start condition
Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to generate restart condition Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to generate stop condition
Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to output each condition
Set to “0”
Select ACK or NACK
Set this bit to “1” to output ACK data
Set this bit to “1” to have SCLi output
Set to “0”
stopped when stop condition is detected
Set this bit to “1” to set the SCLi to “L” hold
Set to “0”
at the falling edge of the 9th bit of clock
Set to “1”
Invalid
Set to “0”
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. Not all register bits are described above. Set those bits to “0” when writing to the registers in I2C mode.
2. Set the bit 4 and bit 5 in the U0C1 and U1C1 registers to “0”. The U0IRS, U1IRS, U0RRM and U1RRM bits are in the UCON
register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 169 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.12 I2C Mode Functions
Function
Factor of Interrupt
Number 6, 7 and
10 (1) (5) (7)
Factor of Interrupt
Number 15, 17 and
19 (1) (6)
I2C Mode (SMD2 to SMD0 = 010b, IICM = 1)
Clock
IICM2 = 0
IICM2 = 1
Synchronous
(UART transmit/receive interrupt)
(NACK/ACK interrupt)
Serial I/O Mode
(SMD2 to SMD0 =
CKPH = 1
CKPH = 0
CKPH = 0
CKPH = 1
001b, IICM = 0) (No clock delay)
(Clock delay)
(No clock delay)
(Clock delay)
Start condition detection or stop condition detection
(See Table 15.13 STSPSEL Bit Functions)
-
UARTi transmission
Transmission started
or completed
(selected by UiIRS)
Factor of Interrupt UARTi reception
Number 16, 18 and When 8th bit received
20 (1) (6)
CKPOL = 0 (rising edge)
CKPOL = 1 (falling edge)
Timing for Transferring CKPOL = 0 (rising edge)
Data from UART
CKPOL = 1 (falling edge)
Reception Shift Register
to UiRB Register
UARTi Transmission Not delayed
Output Delay
Functions of P6_3, TXDi output
P6_7 and P7_0 Pins
Functions of P6_2, RXDi input
P6_6 and P7_1 Pins
Functions of P6_1, CLKi input or
P6_5 and P7_2 Pins output selected
Noise Filter Width 15 ns
Read RXDi and
Possible when the
SCLi Pins Levels
corresponding port
direction bit = 0
Initial Value of TXDi CKPOL = 0 (H)
and SDAi Outputs CKPOL = 1 (L)
Initial and End
Value of SCLi
DMA1 Factor (6)
UARTi reception
UARTi transmission
Falling edge of
SCLi next to the
9th bit
No acknowledgment detection
(NACK)
Rising edge of SCLi 9th bit
UARTi transmission
Rising edge of
SCLi 9th bit
Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
Rising edge of SCLi 9th bit
UARTi reception
Falling edge of SCLi 9th bit
Rising edge of SCLi 9th bit
Falling edge of
SCLi 9th bit
Falling and rising
edges of SCLi 9th
bit
Delayed
SDAi input/output
SCLi input/output
- (Cannot be used in I2C mode)
200 ns
Always possible no matter how the corresponding port direction bit is set
The value set in the port register before setting I2C mode
H
L
Acknowledgment detection (ACK)
Store Received
Data
1st to 8th bits of the received data are stored into bit
7 to bit 0 in the UiRB register
Read Received
Data
The UiRB register status is read
H
(2)
L
UARTi reception
Falling edge of SCLi 9th bit
1st to 7th bits of the received data are stored into
bit 6 to bit 0 in the UiRB 1st to 8th bits are
register, 8th bit is stored into stored into bit 7 to bit
bit 8 in the UiRB register 0 in UiRB register (3)
Bit 6 to bit 0 in the UiRB
register (4) are read as bit
7 to bit 1. Bit 8 in the UiRB
register is read as bit 0.
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. If the source or cause of any interrupt is changed, the IR bit in the interrupt control register for the changed interrupt may
inadvertently be set to “1” (interrupt requested). (Refer to 23.5 Interrupts.)
If one of the bits shown below is changed, the interrupt source, the interrupt timing, etc. change. Therefore, always be sure to set
the IR bit to “0” (interrupt not requested) after changing those bits.
• SMD2 to SMD0 bits in UiMR register
• IICM bit in UiSMR register
• IICM2 bit in UiSMR2 register
• CKPH bit in UiSMR3 register
2. Set the initial value of SDAi output while the SMD2 to SMD0 bits in the UiMR register = 000b (serial interface disabled).
3. Second data transfer to the UiRB register (rising edge of SCLi 9th bit)
4. First data transfer to the UiRB register (falling edge of SCLi 9th bit)
5. See Figure 15.26 STSPSEL Bit Functions.
6. See Figure 15.24 Transfer to UiRB Register and Interrupt Timing.
7. When using UART0, be sure to set the IFSR06 bit in the IFSR0 register to “1” (cause of interrupt: UART0 bus collision detection).
When using UART1, be sure to set the IFSR07 bit in the IFSR0 register to “1” (cause of interrupt: UART1 bus collision detection).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 170 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
(1) IICM2 = 0 (ACK and NACK interrupts), CKPH = 0 (no clock delay)
1st bit
2nd bit
3rd bit
4th bit
5th bit
6th bit
7th bit
8th bit
9th bit
SCLi
D7
SDAi
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
D8(ACK, NACK)
ACK interrupt (DMA1 request),
NACK interrupt
Transfer to UiRB register
b15
b9
b8
b7
D8
D7
b0
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
D1
D0
UiRB register
(2) IICM2 = 0, CKPH = 1 (clock delay)
1st bit
2nd bit
3rd bit
4th bit
5th bit
6th bit
7th bit
8th bit
9th bit
SCLi
SDAi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D8(ACK, NACK)
D0
ACK interrupt (DMA1 request),
NACK interrupt
Transfer to UiRB register
b15
b9
b8
b7
D8
D7
b0
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
UiRB register
(3) IICM2 = 1 (UART transmit/receive interrupt), CKPH = 0
1st bit
2nd bit
3rd bit
4th bit
5th bit
6th bit
7th bit
8th bit
9th bit
SCLi
SDAi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
D8(ACK, NACK)
Receive interrupt
(DMA1 request)
Transmit interrupt
Transfer to UiRB register
b15
b9
b8
b7
b0
D0
(4) IICM2 = 1, CKPH = 1
1st bit
2nd bit
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
UiRB register
3rd bit
4th bit
5th bit
6th bit
7th bit
8th bit
9th bit
SCLi
SDAi
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
D8 (ACK, NACK)
Receive interrupt
(DMA1 request)
Transfer to UiRB register
b15
b9
b8
D0
b7
b0
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
Transmit interrupt
Transfer to UiRB register
b15
b9
D1
UiRB register
i = 0 to 2
This diagram applies to the case where the following condition is met.
The CKDIR bit in the UiMR register = 0 (slave selected)
Figure 15.24 Transfer to UiRB Register and Interrupt Timing
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 171 of 376
b8
b7
D8
D7
b0
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
UiRB register
D1
D0
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.3.1 Detection of Start and Stop Condition
Whether a start or a stop condition has been detected is determined.
A start condition-detected interrupt request is generated when the SDAi pin changes state from high to
low while the SCLi pin is in the high state. A stop condition-detected interrupt request is generated when
the SDAi pin changes state from low to high while the SCLi pin is in the high state.
Figure 15.25 shows the detection of start and stop condition.
Because the start and stop condition-detected interrupts share the interrupt control register and vector,
check the BBS bit in the UiSMR register to determine which interrupt source is requesting the interrupt.
3 to 6 cycles < duration for setting-up (1)
3 to 6 cycles < duration for holding (1)
Duration for
setting-up
Duration for
holding
SCLi
SDAi
(Start condition)
SDA i
(Stop condition)
i = 0 to 2
NOTE:
1.When the PCLK1 bit in the PCLKR register = 1, this is the cycle number
of f1SIO, and when the PCLK1 bit = 0, this is the cycle number of f2SIO.
Figure 15.25 Detection of Start and Stop Condition
15.1.3.2 Output of Start and Stop Condition
A start condition is generated by setting the STAREQ bit in the UiSMR4 register (i = 0 to 2) to “1” (start).
A restart condition is generated by setting the RSTAREQ bit in the UiSMR4 register to “1” (start).
A stop condition is generated by setting the STPREQ bit in the UiSMR4 register to “1” (start).
The output procedure is described below.
(1) Set the STAREQ bit, RSTAREQ bit or STPREQ bit to “1” (start).
(2) Set the STSPSEL bit in the UiSMR4 register to “1” (output).
Table 15.13 and Figure 15.26 show the functions of the STSPSEL bit.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 172 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.13 STSPSEL Bit Functions
STSPSEL Bit = 0
Output of transfer clock and
data
Output of start/stop condition is
accomplished by a program
using ports (not automatically
generated in hardware)
Start/stop condition detection
Function
Output of SCLi and SDAi Pins
Start/Stop Condition Interrupt
Request Generation Timing
STSPSEL Bit = 1
Output of a start/stop condition
according to the STAREQ,
RSTAREQ and STPREQ bits
Finish generating start/stop condition
(1) When slave
CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock)
STSPSEL bit 0
1st 2nd 3rd 4th
5th
6th 7th
8th
9th bit
SCLi
SDAi
Start condition
detection interrupt
Stop condition
detection interrupt
(2) When master
CKDIR bit = 0 (internal clock), CKPH bit = 1 (clock delayed)
STSPSEL bit
Set to "1" in
a program
Set to "0" in
a program
1st 2nd 3rd 4th
SCLi
Set to "1" in
a program
5th
6th 7th
8th
Set to "0" in
a program
9th bit
SDAi
Set STAREQ bit
= 1 (start)
Start condition
detection interrupt
Set STPREQ bit
Stop condition
= 1 (start)
detection interrupt
Figure 15.26 STSPSEL Bit Functions
15.1.3.3 Arbitration
Unmatching of the transmit data and SDAi pin input data is checked synchronously with the rising edge
of SCLi. Use the ABC bit in the UiSMR register to select the timing at which the ABT bit in the UiRB
register is updated. If the ABC bit = 0 (updated per bit), the ABT bit is set to “1” at the same time
unmatching is detected during check, and is set to “0” when not detected. In cases when the ABC bit is
set to “1”, if unmatching is detected even once during check, the ABT bit is set to “1” (unmatching
detected) at the falling edge of the clock pulse of 9th bit. If the ABT bit needs to be updated per byte, set
the ABT bit to “0” (undetected) after detecting acknowledge in the first byte, before transferring the next
byte.
Setting the ALS bit in the UiSMR2 register to “1” (SDA output stop enabled) causes arbitration-lost to
occur, in which case the SDAi pin is placed in the high-impedance state at the same time the ABT bit is
set to “1” (unmatching detected).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 173 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.3.4 Transfer Clock
Data is transmitted/received using a transfer clock like the one shown in Figure 15.24.
The CSC bit in the UiSMR2 register is used to synchronize the internally generated clock (internal SCLi)
and an external clock supplied to the SCLi pin. In cases when the CSC bit is set to “1” (clock synchronization
enabled), if a falling edge on the SCLi pin is detected while the internal SCLi is high, the internal SCLi
goes low, at which time the value of the UiBRG register is reloaded with and starts counting in the
low-level interval. If the internal SCLi changes state from low to high while the SCLi pin is low, counting
stops, and when the SCLi pin goes high, counting restarts.
In this way, the UARTi transfer clock is comprised of the logical product of the internal SCLi and SCLi pin
signal. The transfer clock works from a half period before the falling edge of the internal SCLi 1st bit to
the rising edge of the 9th bit. To use this function, select an internal clock for the transfer clock.
The SWC bit in the UiSMR2 register allows to select whether the SCLi pin should be fixed to or freed
from low-level output at the falling edge of the 9th clock pulse.
If the SCLHI bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to “1” (enabled), SCLi output is turned off (placed in the
high-impedance state) when a stop condition is detected.
Setting the SWC2 bit in the UiSMR2 register = 1 (0 output) makes it possible to forcibly output a lowlevel signal from the SCLi pin even while sending or receiving data. Setting the SWC2 bit to “0” (transfer
clock) allows the transfer clock to be output from or supplied to the SCLi pin, instead of outputting a lowlevel signal.
If the SWC9 bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to “1” (SCL hold low enabled) when the CKPH bit in the
UiSMR3 register = 1, the SCLi pin is fixed to low-level output at the falling edge of the clock pulse next
to the ninth. Setting the SWC9 bit = 0 (SCL hold low disabled) frees the SCLi pin from low-level output.
15.1.3.5 SDA Output
The data written to bit 7 to bit 0 (D7 to D0) in the UiTB register is sequentially output beginning with D7.
The ninth bit (D8) is ACK or NACK.
The initial value of SDAi transmit output can only be set when IICM = 1 (I2C mode) and the SMD2 to
SMD0 bits in the UiMR register = 000b (serial interface disabled).
The DL2 to DL0 bits in the UiSMR3 register allow to add no delays or a delay of 2 to 8 UiBRG count
source clock cycles to SDAi output.
Setting the SDHI bit in the UiSMR2 register = 1 (SDA output disabled) forcibly places the SDAi pin in the
high-impedance state. Do not write to the SDHI bit synchronously with the rising edge of the UARTi
transfer clock. This is because the ABT bit may inadvertently be set to “1” (detected).
15.1.3.6 SDA Input
When the IICM2 bit = 0, the 1st to 8th bits (D7 to D0) of received data are stored in the bit 7 to bit 0 in the
UiRB register. The 9th bit (D8) is ACK or NACK.
When the IICM2 bit = 1, the 1st to 7th bits (D7 to D1) of received data are stored in the bit 6 to bit 0 in the
UiRB register and the 8th bit (D0) is stored in the bit 8 in the UiRB register. Even when the IICM2 bit = 1,
providing the CKPH bit = 1, the same data as when the IICM2 bit = 0 can be read out by reading the
UiRB register after the rising edge of the corresponding clock pulse of 9th bit.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 174 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.3.7 ACK and NACK
If the STSPSEL bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to “0” (start and stop conditions not generated) and the
ACKC bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to “1” (ACK data output), the value of the ACKD bit in the UiSMR4
register is output from the SDAi pin.
If the IICM2 bit = 0, a NACK interrupt request is generated if the SDAi pin remains high at the rising edge
of the 9th bit of transmit clock pulse. An ACK interrupt request is generated if the SDAi pin is low at the
rising edge of the 9th bit of transmit clock pulse.
If ACKi is selected for the cause of DMA1 request, a DMA transfer can be activated by detection of an
acknowledge.
15.1.3.8 Initialization of Transmission/Reception
If a start condition is detected while the STAC bit = 1 (UARTi initialization enabled), the serial I/O operates
as described below.
• The transmit shift register is initialized, and the content of the UiTB register is transferred to the transmit shift register. In this way, the serial I/O starts sending data synchronously with the next clock pulse
applied. However, the UARTi output value does not change state and remains the same as when a
start condition was detected until the first bit of data is output synchronously with the input clock.
• The receive shift register is initialized, and the serial I/O starts receiving data synchronously with the
next clock pulse applied.
• The SWC bit is set to “1” (SCL wait output enabled). Consequently, the SCLi pin is pulled low at the
falling edge of the ninth clock pulse.
Note that when UARTi transmission/reception is started using this function, the TI bit does not change
state. Note also that when using this function, the selected transfer clock should be an external clock.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 175 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.4 Special Mode 2
Multiple slaves can be serially communicated from one master. Transfer clock polarity and phase are
selectable. Table 15.14 lists the specifications of Special Mode 2. Figure 15.27 shows communication
control example for Special Mode 2. Table 15.15 lists the registers used in Special Mode 2 and the
register values set.
Table 15.14 Special Mode 2 Specifications
Item
Specification
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Transfer data length: 8 bits
• Master mode
The CKDIR bit in the UiMR register = 0 (internal clock) : fj/ 2(n+1)
fj = f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n: Setting value of the UiBRG register 00h to FFh
• Slave mode
The CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock selected) : Input from CLKi pin
Transmit/receive control
Transmission start condition
Controlled by input/output ports
Before transmission can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
Reception start condition
Before reception can start, the following requirements must be met (1)
• The RE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
Interrupt Request
For transmission, one of the following conditions can be selected
Generation Timing
• The UiIRS bit (2) = 0 (transmit buffer empty): when transferring data from the UiTB
register to the UARTi transmit register (at start of transmission)
• The UiIRS bit =1 (transfer completed): when the serial I/O finished sending data from
the UARTi transmit register
For reception
• When transferring data from the UARTi receive register to the UiRB register (at
Error detection
completion of reception)
Overrun error (3)
This error occurs if the serial I/O started receiving the next data before reading the
UiRB register and received the 7th bit of the next data
Select function
Clock phase setting
Selectable from four combinations of transfer clock polarities and phases
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. When an external clock is selected, the conditions must be met while if the CKPOL bit in the UiC0
register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive data taken in at the rising edge of
the transfer clock), the external clock is in the high state; if the CKPOL bit = 1 (transmit data output at
the rising edge and the receive data taken in at the falling edge of the transfer clock), the external clock
is in the low state.
2. The U0IRS and U1IRS bits respectively are bits 0 and 1 in the UCON register ; the U2IRS bit is bit 4 in the
U2C1 register.
3. If an overrun error occurs, the value of UiRB register will be indeterminate. The IR bit in SiRIC register
does not change.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 176 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
P1_3
P1_2
P7_2(CLK2)
P7_1(RXD2)
P7_0(TXD2)
Microcomputer
(Master)
P9_3
P7_2(CLK2)
P7_1(RXD2)
P7_0(TXD2)
Microcomputer
(Slave)
P9_3
P7_2(CLK2)
P7_1(RXD2)
P7_0(TXD2)
Microcomputer
(Slave)
Figure 15.27 Serial Bus Communication Control Example (UART2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 177 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.15 Registers to Be Used and Settings in Special Mode 2
Register
(1)
UiTB
UiRB (1)
0 to 7
0 to 7
Set transmission data
Reception data can be read
UiBRG
OER
0 to 7
Overrun error flag
Set a transfer rate
SMD2 to SMD0
CKDIR
Set to “001b”
Set this bit to “0” for master mode or “1” for slave mode
IOPOL
CLK1, CLK0
Set to “0”
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
CRS
TXEPT
Invalid because the CRD bit = 1
Transmit register empty flag
CRD
NCH
Set to “1”
Select TXDi pin output format
CKPOL
UFORM
Clock phases can be set in combination with the CKPH bit in the UiSMR3 register
Set to “0”
TE
TI
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission
Transmit buffer empty flag
RE
RI
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
Reception complete flag
UiMR
(1)
UiC0
UiC1
Bit
(2)
U2IRS
U2RRM
(2)
,
Function
Select UART2 transmit interrupt cause
Set to “0”
UiSMR
UiLCH, UiERE
0 to 7
Set to “0”
UiSMR2
UiSMR3
0 to 7
CKPH
Set to “0”
Clock phases can be set in combination with the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register
NODC
0, 2, 4 to 7
Set to “0”
Set to “0”
0 to 7
U0IRS, U1IRS
Set to “0”
Select UART0 and UART1 transmit interrupt cause
U0RRM, U1RRM
CLKMD0
Set to “0”
Invalid because the CLKMD1 bit = 0
UiSMR4
UCON
CLKMD1, RCSP, 7 Set to “0”
i = 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. Not all register bits are described above. Set those bits to “0” when writing to the registers in Special
Mode 2.
2. Set the bit 4 and bit 5 in the U0C1 and U1C1 registers to “0”. The U0IRS, U1IRS, U0RRM and U1RRM
bits are in the UCON register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 178 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.4.1 Clock Phase Setting Function
One of four combinations of transfer clock phases and polarities can be selected using the CKPH bit in
the UiSMR3 register and the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register.
Make sure the transfer clock polarity and phase are the same for the master and salves to be communicated.
Figure 15.28 shows the transmission and reception timing in master (internal clock).
Figure 15.29 shows the transmission and reception timing (CKPH = 0) in slave (external clock).
Figure 15.30 shows the transmission and reception timing (CKPH = 1) in slave (external clock).
Clock output
(CKPOL = 0, CKPH = 0)
"H"
Clock output
(CKPOL = 1, CKPH = 0)
"H"
Clock output
(CKPOL = 0, CKPH = 1)
"L"
"L"
"H"
"L"
Clock output
(CKPOL = 1, CKPH = 1)
"H"
Data output timing
"H"
"L"
"L"
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Data input timing
Figure 15.28 Transmission and Reception Timing in Master Mode (Internal Clock)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 179 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
"H"
Slave control input
"L"
Clock input "H"
(CKPOL= 0, CKPH = 0) "L"
Clock input "H"
(CKPOL = 1, CKPH = 0) "L"
Data output timing
"H"
D0
"L"
Data input timing
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Indeterminate
Figure 15.29 Transmission and Reception Timing (CKPH = 0) in Slave Mode (External Clock)
"H"
Slave control input
"L"
Clock input "H"
(CKPOL = 0, CKPH = 1) "L"
Clock input "H"
(CKPOL = 1, CKPH = 1) "L"
Data output timing
"H"
"L"
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Data input timing
Figure 15.30 Transmission and Reception Timing (CKPH = 1) in Slave Mode (External Clock)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 180 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.5 Special Mode 3 (IE Mode)
In this mode, one bit of IEBus is approximated with one byte of UART mode waveform.
Table 15.16 lists the registers used in IE mode and the register values set. Figure 15.31 shows the
functions of bus collision detect function related bits.
If the TXDi pin (i = 0 to 2) output level and RXDi pin input level do not match, a UARTi bus collision detect
interrupt request is generated.
Use the IFSR06 and IFSR07 bits in the IFSR0 register to enable the UART0/UART1 bus collision detect function.
Table 15.16 Registers to Be Used and Settings in IE Mode
Register
UiTB
UiRB
(1)
UiBRG
UiMR
UiC0
UiC1
Bit
Function
0 to 8
0 to 8
Set transmission data
Reception data can be read
OER,FER,PER,SUM
0 to 7
Error flag
Set a transfer rate
SMD2 to SMD0
CKDIR
Set to “110b”
Select the internal clock or external clock
STPS
PRY
Set to “0”
Invalid because the PRYE bit = 0
PRYE
IOPOL
Set to “0”
Select the TXD/RXD input/output polarity
CLK1, CLK0
CRS
Select the count source for the UiBRG register
Invalid because the CRD bit = 1
TXEPT
CRD
Transmit register empty flag
Set to “1”
NCH
CKPOL
Select TXDi pin output mode
Set to “0”
UFORM
TE
Set to “0”
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission
TI
RE
Transmit buffer empty flag
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
RI
U2IRS
Reception complete flag
Select the source of UART2 transmit interrupt
(2)
(2)
U2RRM ,
UiLCH, UiERE
Set to “0”
0 to 3, 7
ABSCS
Set to “0”
Select the sampling timing at which to detect a bus collision
ACSE
SSS
Set this bit to “1” to use the auto clear function of transmit enable bit
Select the transmit start condition
UiSMR2
UiSMR3
0 to 7
0 to 7
Set to “0”
Set to “0”
UiSMR4
IFSR0
0 to 7
IFSR06, IFSR07
Set to “0”
Set to “1”
UCON
U0IRS, U1IRS
U0RRM, U1RRM
Select the source of UART0/UART1 transmit interrupt
Set to “0”
CLKMD0
CLKMD1, RCSP, 7
Invalid because the CLKMD1 bit = 0
Set to “0”
UiSMR
i= 0 to 2
NOTES:
1. Not all register bits are described above. Set those bits to “0” when writing to the registers in IE mode.
2. Set the bit 4 and bit 5 in the U0C1 and U1C1 registers to “0”. The U0IRS, U1IRS, U0RRM and U1RRM
bits are in the UCON register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 181 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
(1) ABSCS Bit in UiSMR Register (bus collision detect sampling clock select)
If ABSCS bit = 0, bus collision is determined at the rising edge of the transfer clock
Transfer clock
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP
TXDi
RXDi
Input to TAjIN
Timer Aj
If ABSCS bit = 1, bus collision is determined when timer
Aj (one-shot timer mode) underflows.
Timer Aj: timer A3 when UART0; timer A4 when UART1; timer A0 when UART2
(2) ACSE Bit in UiSMR Register (auto clear of transmit enable bit)
Transfer clock
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP
TXDi
RXDi
IR bit in
UiBCNIC register
If the ACSE bit = 1 (automatically
clear when bus collision occurs),
the TE bit is set to "0"
(transmission disabled) when
the IR bit in the UiBCNIC register = 1
(unmatching detected).
TE bit in
UiC1 register
(3) SSS Bit in UiSMR Register (transmit start condition select)
If SSS bit = 0, the serial I/O starts sending data one transfer clock cycle after the transmission enable condition is met.
Transfer clock
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP
D5
D6
D7
D8
SP
TXDi
Transmission enable condition is met
If SSS bit = 1, the serial I/O starts sending data at the rising edge (1) of RXDi
CLKi
ST
TXDi
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
(NOTE 2)
RXDi
NOTES:
1.The falling edge of RXDi when IOPOL bit = 0; the rising edge of RXDi when IOPOL bit = 1.
2.The transmit condition must be met before the falling edge (1) of RXDi.
i = 0 to 2
This diagram applies to the case where IOPOL bit =1 (reversed)
Figure 15.31 Bus Collision Detect Function-Related Bits
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 182 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.6 Special Mode 4 (SIM Mode) (UART2)
Based on UART mode, this is an SIM interface compatible mode. Direct and inverse formats can be
implemented, and this mode allows to output a low from the TXD2 pin when a parity error is detected.
Table 15.17 lists the specifications of SIM mode. Table 15.18 lists the registers used in the SIM mode and
the register values set. Figure 15.32 shows the typical transmit/receive timing in SIM mode.
Table 15.17 SIM Mode Specifications
Item
Transfer data format
Transfer clock
Transmission start condition
Reception start condition
Interrupt request
generation timing
(2)
Error detection
Specification
• Direct format
• Inverse format
• The CKDIR bit in the U2MR register = 0 (internal clock) : fi/ 16(n+1)
fi = f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n: Setting value of the U2BRG register 00h to FFh
• The CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock) : fEXT/16(n+1)
fEXT: Input from CLK2 pin. n: Setting value of the U2BRG register
00h to FFh
Before transmission can start, the following requirements must be met
• The TE bit in the U2C1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the U2C1 register = 0 (data present in the U2TB register)
Before reception can start, the following requirements must be met
• The RE bit in the U2C1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• Start bit detection
• For transmission
When the serial I/O finished sending data from the U2TB transfer register (U2IRS bit = 1)
• For reception
When transferring data from the UART2 receive register to the U2RB register (at
completion of reception)
• Overrun error (1)
This error occurs if the serial I/O started receiving the next data before reading the
U2RB register and received the bit one before the last stop bit of the next data
• Framing error (3)
This error occurs when the number of stop bits set is not detected
• Parity error (3)
During reception, if a parity error is detected, parity error signal is output from the
TXD2 pin.
During transmission, a parity error is detected by the level of input to the RXD2 pin
when a transmission interrupt occurs
• Error sum flag
This flag is set to “1” when any of the overrun, framing, and parity errors is encountered
NOTES:
1. If an overrun error occurs, the value of the U2RB register will be indeterminate. The IR bit in the S2RIC
register does not change.
2. A transmit interrupt request is generated by setting the U2IRS bit in the U2C1 register to “1” (transmit is
completed) and U2ERE bit to “1” (error signal output) after reset. Therefore, when using SIM mode, set
the IR bit to “0” (interrupt not requested) after setting these bits.
3. The timing at which the framing error flag and the parity error flag are set is detected when data is
transferred from the UARTi receive register to the UiRB register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 183 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.18 Registers to Be Used and Settings in SIM Mode
Register
Bit
Function
(1)
U2TB
0 to 7
Set transmission data
(1)
U2RB
0 to 7
Reception data can be read
OER,FER,PER,SUM Error flag
U2BRG
0 to 7
Set a transfer rate
U2MR
SMD2 to SMD0
Set to “101b”
CKDIR
Select the internal clock or external clock
STPS
Set to “0”
PRY
Set this bit to “1” for direct format or “0” for inverse format
PRYE
Set to “1”
IOPOL
Set to “0”
U2C0
CLK1, CLK0
Select the count source for the U2BRG register
CRS
Invalid because the CRD bit = 1
TXEPT
Transmit register empty flag
CRD
Set to “1”
NCH
Set to “0”
CKPOL
Set to “0”
UFORM
Set this bit to “0” for direct format or “1” for inverse format
U2C1
TE
Set this bit to “1” to enable transmission
TI
Transmit buffer empty flag
RE
Set this bit to “1” to enable reception
RI
Reception complete flag
U2IRS
Set to “1”
U2RRM
Set to “0”
U2LCH
Set this bit to “0” for direct format or “1” for inverse format
U2ERE
Set to “1”
(1)
U2SMR
0 to 3
Set to “0”
U2SMR2
0 to 7
Set to “0”
U2SMR3
0 to 7
Set to “0”
U2SMR4
0 to 7
Set to “0”
NOTE:
1. Not all register bits are described above. Set those bits to “0” when writing to the registers in SIM mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 184 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
TC
(1) Transmission
Transfer clock
TE bit in
U2C1 register
"1"
TI bit in
U2C1 register
"1"
Write data to U2TB register
"0"
"0"
Transferred from U2TB register to UART2 transmit register
Parity Stop
bit
bit
Start
bit
TXD2
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
Parity error signal sent
back from receiving end
RXD2 pin level
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
An "L" level returns due to the
occurrence of a parity error.
(1)
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
The level is detected by the
interrupt routine.
TXEPT bit in
U2C0 register
"1"
IR bit in
S2TIC register
"1"
SP
The level is
detected by the
interrupt routine.
"0"
The IR bit is set to "1" at the
falling edge of transfer clock
"0"
The above timing diagram applies to the case where data is
transferred in the direct format.
STPS bit in U2MR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
PRY bit in U2MR register = 1 (even parity)
UFORM bit in U2C0 register = 0 (LSB first)
U2LCH bit in U2C1 register = 0 (no reverse)
U2IRS bit in U2C1 register = 1 (transmit is completed)
Set to "0" by an interrupt request acknowledgement or a program
TC = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of U2BRG count source (f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO)
fEXT : frequency of U2BRG count source (external clock)
n : value set to U2BRG
NOTE:
1. Because TXD2 and RXD2 are connected, a composite waveform, consisting of the TXD2 output and the parity error signal sent back
from receiving end, is generated.
(2) Reception
TC
Transfer clock
RE bit in "1"
U2C1 register "0"
Start
bit
Transmit waveform
from transmitting end
Parity Stop
bit
bit
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
TXD2
An "L" level is output from TXD2 due to
the occurrence of a parity error
RXD2 pin level (1)
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
SP
RI bit in "1"
U2C0 register "0"
Read the U2RB register
IR bit in "1"
S2RIC register
Read the U2RB register
"0"
The above timing diagram applies to the case where data is
received in the direct format.
STPS bit in U2MR register = 0 (1 stop bit)
PRY bit in U2MR register = 1 (even parity)
UFORM bit in U2C0 register = 0 (LSB first)
U2LCH bit in U2C1 register = 0 (no reverse)
U2IRS bit in U2C1 register = 1 (transmit is completed)
Set to "0" by an interrupt request acknowledgement or a program
TC = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT
fi : frequency of U2BRG count source (f1SIO, f2SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO)
fEXT : frequency of U2BRG count source (external clock)
n : value set to U2BRG
NOTE:
1. Because TXD2 and RXD2 are connected, a composite waveform, consisting of transmit waveform from the transmitting end and
parity error signal from receiving end, is generated.
Figure 15.32 Transmit and Receive Timing in SIM Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 185 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Figure 15.33 shows the example of connecting the SIM interface. Connect TXD2 and RXD2 and apply pull-up.
Microcomputer
SIM card
TXD2
RXD2
Figure 15.33 SIM Interface Connection
15.1.6.1 Parity Error Signal Output
The parity error signal is enabled by setting the U2ERE bit in the U2C1 register to “1”.
The parity error signal is output when a parity error is detected while receiving data. This is achieved by
pulling the TXD2 output low with the timing shown in Figure 15.32. If the R2RB register is read while
outputting a parity error signal, the PER bit is set to “0” and at the same time the TXD2 output is returned
high.
When transmitting, a transmission-finished interrupt request is generated at the falling edge of the transfer
clock pulse that immediately follows the stop bit. Therefore, whether a parity signal has been returned
can be determined by reading the port that shares the RXD2 pin in a transmission-finished interrupt
service routine.
Figure 15.34 shows the output timing of the parity error signal
Transfer
clock
"H"
RXD2
"H"
TXD2
"H"
RI bit in
U2C1 register
"L"
ST
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
SP
"L"
"L"
(NOTE 1)
"1"
"0"
This timing diagram applies to the case where the direct format is
implemented.
ST: Start bit
P: Even Parity
SP: Stop bit
NOTE:
1: The output of microcomputer is in the high-impedance state (pulled up externally).
Figure 15.34 Parity Error Signal Output Timing
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 186 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.1.6.2 Format
When direct format, set the PRY bit in the U2MR register to “1”, the UFORM bit in the U2C0 register to
“0” and the U2LCH bit in the U2C1 register to “0”.
When inverse format, set the PRY bit to “0”, UFORM bit to “1” and U2LCH bit to “1”.
Figure 15.35 shows the SIM interface format.
(1) Direct format
Transfer
clock
"H"
TXD2
"H"
"L"
"L"
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
P : Even parity
(2) Inverse format
Transfer
clock
TXD2
"H"
"L"
"H"
"L"
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
P
P : Odd parity
Figure 15.35 SIM Interface Format
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 187 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.2 SI/O3
SI/O3 is exclusive clock-synchronous serial I/Os.
Figure 15.36 shows the block diagram of SI/O3, and Figure 15.37 shows the SI/O3-related registers. Table
15.19 lists the specifications of SI/O3.
Main clock,
PLL clock,
or on-chip oscillator clock
1/2
f2SIO PCLK1=0
f1SIO
1/8
PCLK1=1
1/4
Clock source select
SM31 to SM30
00b
f8SIO
01b
f32SIO
10b
Synchronous
circuit
SM34
CLK3
SM33
SM36
Data bus
1/(n+1)
1/2
S3BRG register
SM36
CLK polarity
reversing
circuit
SI/O counter 3
SM32
SM33
SOUT3
SIN3
SM35 LSB
MSB
S3TRR register
8
n = A value set in the S3BRG register.
Figure 15.36 SI/O3 Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 188 of 376
SI/O3
interrupt
request
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
SI/O3 Control Register (1)
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Symbol
S3C
Bit
Symbol
SM30
Address
01E2h
After Reset
01000000b
Description
Bit Name
b1 b0
RW
RW
Internal Synchronous
Clock Select Bit (5)
0 0 : Selecting f1SIO or f2SIO
0 1 : Selecting f8SIO
1 0 : Selecting f32SIO
1 1 : Do not set a value
SM32
SOUT3 Output Disable
Bit (2)
0 : SOUT3 output
1 : SOUT3 output disabled (high-impedance)
RW
SM33
SI/O3 Port Select Bit
0 : Input/output port
1 : SOUT3 output, CLK3 function
RW
SM34
CLK Polarity Select Bit
0 : Transmit data is output at falling edge of
transfer clock and receive data is input
at rising edge
1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge of
transfer clock and receive data is input
at falling edge
RW
SM35
Transfer Direction Select
Bit
0 : LSB first
1 : MSB first
RW
SM36
Synchronous Clock
Select Bit
0 : External clock (3)
1 : Internal clock (4)
RW
SM37
Effective when the SM33 bit = 0
SOUT3 Initial Value Set Bit 0 : "L" output
1 : "H" output
SM31
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. Make sure this register is written to by the next instruction after setting the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register to "1"
(write enabled).
2. When the SM32 bit = 1, the corresponding pin is placed in the high-impedance state regardless of which functions
of those pins are being used.
3. Set the SM33 bit to "1" (SOUT3 output, CLK3 function) and the corresponding port direction bit to "0" (input mode).
4. Set the SM33 bit to "1" (SOUT3 output, CLK3 function).
5. When changing the SM31 to SM30 bits, set the S3BRG register.
SI/O3 Bit Rate Generator (1) (2) (3)
b7
b0
Symbol
S3BRG
Address
01E3h
After Reset
Indeterminate
Description
Setting Range
RW
Assuming that set value = n, S3BRG divides the count
source by n + 1
00h to FFh
WO
NOTES:
1. Write to this register while serial I/O is neither transmitting nor receiving.
2. Use the MOV instruction to write to this register.
3. Write to this register after setting the SM31 to SM30 bits in the S3C register.
SI/O3 Transmit/Receive Register (1) (2)
b7
b0
Symbol
S3TRR
Address
01E0h
After Reset
Indeterminate
Description
RW
Transmission/reception starts by writing transmit data to this register.
After transmission/reception finishes, reception data can be read by reading this register.
RW
NOTES:
1. Write to this register while serial I/O is neither transmitting nor receiving.
2. To receive data, set the corresponding port direction bit for SIN3 to "0" (input mode).
Figure 15.37 S3C Register, S3BRG Register, and S3TRR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 189 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
Table 15.19 SI/O3 Specifications
Item
Specification
Transfer Data Format
Transfer data length: 8 bits
Transfer clock
• SM36 bit in S3C register = 1 (internal clock) : fj/ 2(n+1)
Transmission/Reception
fj = f1SIO, f8SIO, f32SIO. n = Setting value of S3BRG register 00h to FFh
(1)
• SM36 bit = 0 (external clock) : Input from CLK3 pin
Before transmission/reception can start, the following requirements must be met
Start Condition
Interrupt Request
Generation Timing
Write transmit data to the S3TRR register
• When SM34 bit in S3C register = 0
The rising edge of the last transfer clock pulse
CLK3 Pin Function
SOUT3 Pin Function
SIN3 Pin Function
• When SM34 bit = 1
The falling edge of the last transfer clock pulse (4)
I/O port, transfer clock input, transfer clock output
I/O port, transmit data output, high-impedance
I/O port, receive data input
Select Function
(2) (3)
(4)
• LSB first or MSB first selection
Whether to start sending/receiving data beginning with bit 0 or beginning
with bit 7 can be selected
• Function for setting an SOUT3 initial value set function
When the SM36 bit in the S3C register = 0 (external clock), the SOUT3 pin
output level while not transmitting can be selected.
• CLK polarity selection
Whether transmit data is output/input timing at the rising edge or falling
edge of transfer clock can be selected.
NOTES:
1. To set the SM36 bit in the S3C register to “0” (external clock), follow the procedure described below.
• If the SM34 bit in the S3C register = 0, write transmit data to the S3TRR register while input on the
CLK3 pin is high. The same applies when rewriting the SM37 bit in the S3C register.
• If the SM34 bit = 1, write transmit data to the S3TRR register while input on the CLK3 pin is low. The
same applies when rewriting the SM37 bit.
• Because shift operation continues as long as the transfer clock is supplied to the SI/O3 circuit, stop
the transfer clock after supplying eight pulses. If the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), the transfer clock
automatically stops.
2. Unlike UART0 to UART2, SI/O3 is not separated between the transfer register and buffer. Therefore,
do not write the next transmit data to the S3TRR register during transmission.
3. When the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), SOUT3 retains the last data for a 1/2 transfer clock period after
completion of transfer and, thereafter, goes to a high-impedance state. However, if transmit data is
written to the S3TRR register during this period, SOUT3 immediately goes to a high-impedance state,
with the data hold time thereby reduced.
4. When the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), the transfer clock stops in the high state if the SM34 bit = 0, or
stops in the low state if the SM34 bit = 1.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 190 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.2.1 SI/O3 Operation Timing
Figure 15.38 shows the SI/O3 operation timing.
1.5 cycle (max.) (1)
SI/O3 internal clock
"H"
"L"
CLK3 output
"H"
"L"
Signal written to the
S3TRR register
"H"
"L"
SOUT3 output
"H"
"L"
SIN3 input
"H"
"L"
IR bit in S3IC register
"1"
"0"
(NOTE 2)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
* This diagram applies to the case where the bits in the S3C register are set as follows:
SM32 = 0 (SOUT3 output)
SM33 = 1 (SOUT3 output, CLK3 function)
SM34 = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data input at the rising edge of the transfer clock)
SM35 = 0 (LSB first)
SM36 = 1 (internal clock)
NOTES:
1. If the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), the serial I/O starts sending or receiving data a maximum of 1.5 transfer clock cycles after writing to the
S3TRR register.
2. When the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), the SOUT3 pin is placed in the high-impedance state after the transfer finishes.
Figure 15.38 SI/O3 Operation Timing
15.2.2 CLK Polarity Selection
The SM34 bit in the S3C register allows selection of the polarity of the transfer clock.
Figure 15.39 shows the polarity of the transfer clock.
(1) When SM34 bit in S3C register = 0
CLK3
(NOTE 1)
SOUT3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
SIN3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
(2) When SM34 bit in S3C register = 1
(NOTE 2)
CLK3
SOUT3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
SIN3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
*This diagram applies to the case where the bits in the S3C register are set as follows:
SM35 = 0 (LSB first)
SM36 = 1 (internal clock)
NOTES:
1. When the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), a high level is output from the CLK3 pin if not
transferring data.
2. When the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock), a low level is output from the CLK3 pin if not
transferring data.
Figure 15.39 Polarity of Transfer Clock
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 191 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
15. Serial Interface
15.2.3 Functions for Setting an SOUT3 Initial Value
If the SM36 bit in the S3C register = 0 (external clock), the SOUT3 pin output can be fixed high or low
when not transferring. Figure 15.40 shows the timing chart for setting an SOUT3 initial value and how to
set it.
(Example) When "H" selected for SOUT3 initial value
Setting of the initial value of SOUT3
output and starting of
transmission/reception
Signal written to
S3TRR register
SM37 bit
Set the SM33 bit to "0"
(SOUT3 pin functions as an I/O port)
SM33 bit
D0
SOUT3 (internal)
SOUT3 output
D0
Port output
Initial value = H
(1)
Setting the SOUT3 Port selection switching
initial value to "H" (2) (I/O port
SOUT3)
Set the SM37 bit to "1"
(SOUT3 initial value = H)
Set the SM33 bit to "1"
(SOUT3 pin functions as SOUT3 output)
"H" level is output
from the SOUT3 pin
Write to the S3TRR register
* This diagram applies to the case where the bits in the S3C register are set as follows:
SM32 = 0 (SOUTi output)
SM35 = 0 (LSB first)
SM36 = 0 (external clock)
NOTES:
1.If the SM36 bit = 1 (internal clock) or if the SM32 bit = 1 (SOUT3 output disabled), this output
goes to the high-impedance state.
2.SOUT3 can only be initialized when input on the CLK3 pin is in the high state if the SM34 bit in
the S3C register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge of the transfer clock) or in the low
state if the SM34 bit = 1 (transmit data output at the rising edge of the transfer clock).
Figure 15.40 SOUT3’s Initial Value Setting
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 192 of 376
Serial transmit/reception starts
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16. A/D Converter
The microcomputer contains one A/D converter circuit based on 10-bit successive approximation method
configured with a capacitive-coupling amplifier. The analog
inputs share the pins with P10_0 to P10_7,
_____________
P9_5, P9_6, P0_0 to P0_7, and P2_0 to P2_7. Similarly, ADTRG input shares the pin with P9_7. Therefore,
when using these inputs, make sure the corresponding port direction bits are set to “0” (input mode).
When not using the A/D converter, set the VCUT bit to “0” (VREF unconnected), so that no current will flow
from the VREF pin into the resistor ladder, helping to reduce the power consumption of the chip.
The A/D conversion result is stored in the ADi register’s bits for ANi, AN0_i, and AN2_i pins (i = 0 to 7).
Table 16.1 shows the performance of the A/D converter. Figure 16.1 shows the block diagram of the A/D
converter, and Figures 16.2 and 16.3 show the A/D converter-related registers.
Table 16.1 A/D Converter Performance
Item
Performance
Method of A/D Conversion Successive approximation (capacitive coupling amplifier)
(1)
Analog Input Voltage
0V to AVCC (VCC)
Operating Clock φAD (2)
fAD, divide-by-2 of fAD, divide-by-3 of fAD, divide-by-4 of fAD,
divide-by-6 of fAD, divide-by-12 of fAD
Resolution
8 bits or 10 bits (selectable)
Integral Nonlinearity Error When AVCC = VREF = 5 V
• With 8-bit resolution: ±2LSB
• With 10-bit resolution: ±3LSB
When external operation amp connection mode is selected: ±7LSB
When AVCC = VREF = 3.3 V
• With 8-bit resolution: ±2LSB
• With 10-bit resolution: ±5LSB
Analog Input Pins
When external operation amp connection mode is selected: ±7LSB
One-shot mode, repeat mode, single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0,
and repeat sweep mode 1
8 pins (AN0 to AN7) + 2 pins (ANEX0 and ANEX1) + 8 pins (AN0_0 to AN0_7)
A/D Conversion
Start Condition
+ 8 pins (AN2_0 to AN2_7)
• Software trigger
The ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
Operating Modes
• External trigger
(retriggerable)
_____________
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST bit
is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
Conversion Speed Per Pin • Without sample and hold
8-bit resolution: 49 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 59 φAD cycles
• With sample and hold
8-bit resolution: 28 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 33 φAD cycles
NOTES:
1. Does not depend on use of sample and hold.
2. φAD frequency must be 10 MHz or less.
When sample and hold is disabled, φAD frequency must be 250 kHz or more.
When sample and hold is enabled, φAD frequency must be 1 MHz or more.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 193 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D conversion rate selection
0
fAD
1/3
Software trigger
ADTRG
VREF
AVSS
1
CKS2
1/2
1
0
1/2
φAD
0
1
0
CKS1
CKS0
TRG
A/D trigger
1
VCUT
Resistor ladder
0
1
Successive conversion register
ADCON1 register
ADCON0 register
AD0 register
AD1 register
AD2 register
AD3 register
AD4 register
AD5 register
AD6 register
AD7 register
Decoder
for A/D register
Data bus high-order
ADCON2 register
Data bus low-order
(1)
PM00
PM01
VREF
Decoder
for channel
selection
VIN
Port P0 group
CH2 to CH0
=000b
=001b
=010b
=011b
=100b
=101b
=110b
=111b
AN0_0
AN0_1
AN0_2
AN0_3
AN0_4
AN0_5
AN0_6
AN0_7
CH2 to CH0
=000b
=001b
=010b
=011b
=100b
=101b
=110b
=111b
Port P2 group
AN2_0
AN2_1
AN2_2
AN2_3
AN2_4
AN2_5
AN2_6
AN2_7
Port P10 group
AN0
AN0
AN0
AN0
AN0
AN0
AN0
AN0
ANEX1
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=00b
OPA1 to OPA0=00b
(1)
PM01 to PM00=00b
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=10b
OPA1 to OPA0=00b
PM01 to PM00=00b
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=11b
OPA1 to OPA0=00b
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=00b
OPA1 to OPA0=11b
(1) PM01 to PM00=00b
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=10b
OPA1 to OPA0=11b
PM01 to PM00=00b
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0=11b
OPA1 to OPA0=11b
ANEX0
CH2 to CH0
=000b
=001b
=010b
=011b
=100b
=101b
=110b
=111b
Comparator
OPA0=1
OPA1 to OPA0
=01b
OPA1=1
OPA1=1
NOTE:
1. Port P0 group (AN0_0 to AN0_7) can be used as analog input pins even when PM01 to PM00 bits are set to "01b"
(memory expansion mode) and PM05 to PM04 bits are set to "11b" (multiplex bus allocated to the entire CS space).
Figure 16.1 A/D Converter Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 194 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
CH0
CH1
RW
RW
Function varies
Analog Input Pin Select Bit with each operation mode
RW
RW
CH2
b4 b3
MD0
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
MD1
0 0 : One-shot mode
0 1 : Repeat mode
1 0 : Single sweep mode
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0 or
Repeat sweep mode 1
RW
RW
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
NOTE:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit symbol
Bit name
SCAN0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
SCAN1
Function
Function varies
with each operation mode
RW
RW
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
0 : Any mode other than repeat
sweep mode 1
1 : Repeat sweep mode 1
RW
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (2)
0 : VREF not connected
1 : VREF connected
RW
OPA0
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
Function varies
with each operation mode
OPA1
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.2 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 195 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 2 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON2
03D4h
00h
Bit Symbol
SMP
Bit Name
Function
A/D Conversion Method
Select Bit
RW
0 : Without sample and hold
1 : With sample and hold
RW
b2 b1
ADGSEL0
ADGSEL1
(b3)
CKS2
(b7-b5)
0 0 : Port P10 group is selected
A/D Input Group Select Bit 0 1 : Do not set a value
1 0 : Port P0 group is selected
1 1 : Port P2 group is selected
Set to "0"
Reserved Bit
Frequency Select Bit 2
(2)
RW
RW
RW
0 : Selects fAD, divide-by-2 of fAD, or
divide-by-4 of fAD.
RW
1 : Selects divide-by-3 of fAD, divide-by-6
of fAD, or divide-by-12 of fAD.
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
-
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON2 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. The φAD frequency must be 10 MHz or less. The selected φAD frequency is determined by a combination of the
CKS0 bit in the ADCON0 register, the CKS1 bit in the ADCON1 register, and the CKS2 bit in the ADCON2 register.
φAD
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
Divide-by-4 of fAD
0
0
1
Divide-by-2 of fAD
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
Divide-by-12 of fAD
1
0
1
Divide-by-6 of fAD
1
1
0
1
1
1
fAD
Divide-by-3 of fAD
Symbol
A/D Register i (i = 0 to 7)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Address
03C1h
03C3h
03C5h
03C7h
03C9h
03CBh
03CDh
03CFh
AD0
AD1
AD2
AD3
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
03C0h
03C2h
03C4h
03C6h
03C8h
03CAh
03CCh
03CEh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
When BITS bit in ADCON1
register is "1" (10-bit mode)
When BITS bit is "0"
(8-bit mode)
Low-order 8 bits of
A/D conversion result
A/D conversion result
RO
High-order 2 bits of
A/D conversion result
When read, the content is
indeterminate.
RO
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
Figure 16.3 ADCON2 Register, and AD0 to AD7 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 196 of 376
RW
-
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.1 Mode Description
16.1.1 One-shot Mode
In one-shot mode, analog voltage applied to a selected pin is A/D converted once. Table 16.2 lists the
specifications of one-shot mode. Figure 16.4 shows the ADCON0 and ADCON1 registers in one-shot mode.
Table 16.2 One-shot Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The CH2 to CH0 bits in the ADCON0 register, the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register and the OPA1 to OPA0 bits in the ADCON1
register select a pin Analog voltage applied to the pin is converted to a
digital code once.
A/D Conversion
• When the TRG bit in the ADCON0 register is “0” (software trigger)
Start Condition
The ADST bit in the ADCON0
register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
_____________
A/D Conversion
Stop Condition
• When the TRG
bit is “1” (ADTRG trigger)
_____________
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST
bit is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
• Completion of A/D conversion (If a software trigger is selected, the ADST
bit is set to “0” (A/D conversion halted).)
Interrupt Request
• Set the ADST bit to “0”
Completion of A/D conversion
Generation Timing
Analog Input Pin
Select one pin from AN0 to AN7, AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7,
ANEX0 to ANEX1
Reading of Result of
Read one of the AD0 to AD7 registers that corresponds to the selected pin
A/D Converter
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 197 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
Analog Input Pin Select Bit 0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected (2) (3)
RW
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
0 0 : One-shot mode (3)
RW
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
CH0
CH1
CH2
MD0
MD1
b4 b3
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. AN0_0 to AN_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in same way as AN0 to AN7. Use the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register to select the desired pin.
3. After rewriting the MD1 to MD0 bits, set the CH2 to CH0 bits over again using another instruction.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
1
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
SCAN0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
Invalid in one-shot mode
SCAN1
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
Set to "0" when one-shot mode
is selected
RW
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (2)
1 : VREF connected
RW
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used RW
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A/D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A/D converted
RW
1 1 : External op-amp connection mode
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.4 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register in One-shot Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 198 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.1.2 Repeat Mode
In repeat mode, analog voltage applied to a selected pin is repeatedly converted to a digital code.
Table 16.3 lists the specifications of repeat mode. Figure 16.5 shows the ADCON0 and ADCON1 registers
in repeat mode.
Table 16.3 Repeat Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The CH2 to CH0 bits in the ADCON0 register, the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register and the OPA1 to OPA0 bits in the ADCON1
register select a pin. Analog voltage applied to this pin is repeatedly
converted to a digital code.
A/D Conversion
• When the TRG bit in the ADCON0 register is “0” (software trigger)
Start Condition
The ADST bit in the ADCON0
register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
_____________
• When the TRG
bit is “1” (ADTRG trigger)
_____________
A/D Conversion
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST
bit is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
Set the ADST bit to “0” (A/D conversion halted)
Stop Condition
Interrupt Request
None generated
Generation Timing
Analog Input Pin
Select one pin from AN0 to AN7, AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7,
ANEX0 to ANEX1
Reading of Result of
Read one of the AD0 to AD7 registers that corresponds to the selected pin
A/D Converter
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 199 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0 1
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : AN0 is selected
0 0 1 : AN1 is selected
0 1 0 : AN2 is selected
Analog Input Pin Select Bit 0 1 1 : AN3 is selected
1 0 0 : AN4 is selected
1 0 1 : AN5 is selected
1 1 0 : AN6 is selected
1 1 1 : AN7 is selected (2) (3)
RW
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
0 1 : Repeat mode (3)
RW
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
CH0
CH1
CH2
MD0
MD1
b4 b3
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. AN0_0 to AN_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in same way as AN0 to AN7. Use the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register to select the desired pin.
3. After rewriting the MD1 to MD0 bits, set the CH2 to CH0 bits over again using another instruction.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
1
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
SCAN0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
Invalid in repeat mode
SCAN1
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
Set to "0" when repeat mode is
selected
RW
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (2)
1 : VREF connected
RW
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used RW
0 1 : ANEX0 input is A/D converted
1 0 : ANEX1 input is A/D converted
RW
1 1 : External op-amp connection mode
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.5 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register in Repeat Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 200 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.1.3 Single Sweep Mode
In single sweep mode, analog voltage that is applied to selected pins is converted one-by-one to a digital
code. Table 16.4 lists the specifications of single sweep mode. Figure 16.6 shows the ADCON0 and
ADCON1 registers in single sweep mode.
Table 16.4 Single Sweep Mode Specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The SCAN1 to SCAN0 bits in the ADCON1 register and the ADGSEL1 to
ADGSEL0 bits in the ADCON2 register select pins. Analog voltage applied
to this pins is converted one-by-one to a digital code.
A/D Conversion
• When the TRG bit in the ADCON0 register is “0” (software trigger)
Start Condition
The ADST bit in the ADCON0
register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
_____________
• When the TRG
bit is “1” (ADTRG trigger)
_____________
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST
bit is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
A/D Conversion
Stop Condition
• Completion of A/D conversion (If a software trigger is selected, the ADST
bit is set to “0” (A/D conversion halted).)
Interrupt Request
Generation Timing
Analog Input Pin
Completion of A/D conversion
• Set the ADST bit to “0”
Reading of Result of
Select from AN0 to AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins),
(1)
AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Read one of the AD0 to AD7 registers that corresponds to the selected pin
A/D Converter
NOTE:
1. AN0_0 to AN0_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in the same way as AN0 to AN7.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 201 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
CH0
CH1
Analog Input Pin Select Bit Invalid in single sweep mode
RW
CH2
MD0
RW
RW
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
1 0 : Single sweep mode
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
MD1
b4 b3
RW
NOTE:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
1
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
When single sweep mode is selected
SCAN0
RW
b1 b0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
SCAN1
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
(2)
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
Set to "0" when single sweep mode
RW
is selected
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (3)
1 : VREF connected
RW
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used RW
0 1 : Do not set a value
1 0 : Do not set a value
RW
1 1 : External op-amp connection mode
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. AN0_0 to AN_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in same way as AN0 to AN7. Use the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register to select the desired pin.
3. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.6 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register in Single Sweep Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 202 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.1.4 Repeat Sweep Mode 0
In repeat sweep mode 0, analog voltage applied to selected pins is repeatedly converted to a digital code.
Table 16.5 lists the specifications of repeat sweep mode 0. Figure 16.7 shows the ADCON0 and
ADCON1 registers in repeat sweep mode 0.
Table 16.5 Repeat Sweep Mode 0 Specifications
Item
Specification
Function
The SCAN1 to SCAN0 bits in the ADCON1 register and the ADGSEL1 to
ADGSEL0 bits in the ADCON2 register select pins. Analog voltage applied
to the pins is repeatedly converted to a digital code.
A/D Conversion
• When the TRG bit in the ADCON0 register is “0” (software trigger)
Start Condition
The ADST bit in the ADCON0
register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
_____________
A/D Conversion
• When the TRG
bit is “1” (ADTRG trigger)
_____________
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST
bit is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
Set the ADST bit to “0” (A/D conversion halted)
Stop Condition
Interrupt Request
None generated
Generation Timing
Analog Input Pin
Reading of Result of
Select from AN0 to AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins),
(1)
AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
Read one of the AD0 to AD7 registers that corresponds to the selected pin
A/D Converter
NOTE:
1. AN0_0 to AN0_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in the same way as AN0 to AN7.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 203 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
RW
CH0
CH1
Analog Input Pin Select Bit Invalid in repeat sweep mode 0
RW
CH2
MD0
RW
b4 b3
RW
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0 or
Repeat sweep mode 1
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
MD1
RW
NOTE:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
1
b2
0
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
When repeat sweep mode 0 is selected
SCAN0
RW
b1 b0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
SCAN1
0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins)
(2)
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
Set to "0" when repeat sweep
mode 0 is selected
RW
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (3)
1 : VREF connected
RW
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used RW
0 1 : Do not set a value
1 0 : Do not set a value
RW
1 1 : External op-amp connection mode
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. AN0_0 to AN_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in same way as AN0 to AN7. Use the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register to select the desired pin.
3. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.7 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register in Repeat Sweep Mode 0
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 204 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.1.5 Repeat Sweep Mode 1
In repeat sweep mode 1, analog voltage selectively applied to all pins is repeatedly converted to a digital code.
Table 16.6 lists the specifications of repeat sweep mode 1. Figure 16.8 shows the ADCON0 and
ADCON1 registers in repeat sweep mode 1.
Table 16.6 Repeat Sweep Mode 1 Specifications
Item
Function
Specification
The input voltages on all pins selected by the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 bits
in the ADCON2 register are A/D converted repeatedly, with priority given
to pins selected by the SCAN1 to SCAN0 bits in the ADCON1 register and
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 bits.
Example : If AN0 selected, input voltages are A/D converted in order of
AN0
AN1
AN0
AN2
AN0
AN3, and so on.
A/D Conversion
Start Condition
• When the TRG bit in the ADCON0 register is “0” (software trigger)
The ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
_____________
• When the TRG
bit is “1” (ADTRG trigger)
_____________
Input on the ADTRG pin changes state from high to low after the ADST
A/D Conversion
Stop Condition
Interrupt Request
Generation Timing
bit is set to “1” (A/D conversion starts)
Set the ADST bit to “0” (A/D conversion halted)
None generated
Analog Input Pins to be Given Select from AN0 (1 pin), AN0 to AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN2 (3 pins),
(1)
Priority when A/D Converted AN0 to AN3 (4 pins)
Reading of Result of
Read one of the AD0 to AD7 registers that corresponds to the selected pin
A/D Converter
NOTE:
1. AN0_0 to AN0_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in the same way as AN0 to AN7.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 205 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
A/D Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
1 1
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON0
03D6h
00000XXXb
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
CH0
CH1
Analog Input Pin Select Bit Invalid in repeat sweep mode 1
RW
RW
CH2
MD0
RW
b4 b3
RW
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 0
1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0 or
Repeat sweep mode 1
TRG
Trigger Select Bit
0 : Software trigger
1 : ADTRG trigger
RW
ADST
A/D Conversion Start Flag
0 : A/D conversion disabled
1 : A/D conversion started
RW
CKS0
Frequency Select Bit 0
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
MD1
RW
NOTE:
1. If the ADCON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
A/D Control Register 1 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
1
b2
1
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
ADCON1
03D7h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected
SCAN0
b1 b0
A/D Sweep Pin Select Bit
SCAN1
0 0 : AN0 (1 pin)
0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins)
1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins)
1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) (2)
RW
RW
MD2
A/D Operation Mode
Select Bit 1
Set to "1" when repeat sweep
mode 1 is selected
RW
BITS
8/10-Bit Mode Select Bit
0 : 8-bit mode
1 : 10-bit mode
RW
CKS1
Frequency Select Bit 1
Refer to NOTE 2 for ADCON2
Register
RW
VCUT
VREF Connect Bit (3)
1 : VREF connected
RW
External Op-Amp
Connection Mode Bit
0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used RW
0 1 : Do not set a value
1 0 : Do not set a value
RW
1 1 : External op-amp connection mode
b7 b6
OPA0
OPA1
NOTES:
1. If the ADCON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be indeterminate.
2. AN0_0 to AN_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 can be used in same way as AN0 to AN7. Use the ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0
bits in the ADCON2 register to select the desired pin.
3. If the VCUT bit is reset from "0" (VREF unconnected) to "1" (VREF connected), wait for 1 µs or more before
starting A/D conversion.
Figure 16.8 ADCON0 Register and ADCON1 Register in Repeat Sweep Mode 1
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 206 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.2 Function
16.2.1 Resolution Select Function
The desired resolution can be selected using the BITS bit in the ADCON1 register. If the BITS bit is set to
“1” (10-bit conversion accuracy), the A/D conversion result is stored in the bit 0 to bit 9 in the ADi register
(i = 0 to 7). If the BITS bit is set to “0” (8-bit conversion accuracy), the A/D conversion result is stored in the
bit 0 to bit 7 in the ADi register.
16.2.2 Sample and Hold
If the SMP bit in the ADCON2 register is set to “1” (with sample-and-hold), the conversion speed per pin
is increased to 28 φAD cycles for 8-bit resolution or 33 φAD cycles for 10-bit resolution. Sample-and-hold
is effective in all operation modes. Select whether or not to use the sample and hold function before
starting A/D conversion.
16.2.3 Extended Analog Input Pins
In one-shot and repeat modes, the ANEX0 and ANEX1 pins can be used as analog input pins. Use the
OPA1 to OPA0 bits in the ADCON1 register to select whether or not use ANEX0 and ANEX1.
The A/D conversion results of ANEX0 and ANEX1 inputs are stored in the AD0 and AD1 registers,
respectively.
16.2.4 External Operation Amplifier (Op-Amp) Connection Mode
Multiple analog inputs can be amplified using a single external op-amp via the ANEX0 and ANEX1 pins.
Set the OPA1 to OPA0 bits in the ADCON1 register to “11b” (external op-amp connection mode). The
inputs from ANi (i = 0 to 7) (1) are output from the ANEX0 pin. Amplify this output with an external op-amp
before sending it back to the ANEX1 pin. The A/D conversion result is stored in the corresponding ADi
register. The A/D conversion speed depends on the response characteristics of the external op-amp.
Figure 16.9 shows an example of how to connect the pins in external operation amp.
NOTE:
1. AN0_i and AN2_i can be used the same as ANi.
Microcomputer
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 bits in ADCON2 register = 00b
AN0
AN1
AN2
AN3
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
Resistor ladder
Successive conversion
register
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 bits = 10b
AN0_0
AN0_1
AN0_2
AN0_3
AN0_4
AN0_5
AN0_6
AN0_7
ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 bits = 11b
AN2_0
AN2_1
AN2_2
AN2_3
AN2_4
AN2_5
AN2_6
AN2_7
ANEX0
ANEX1
External op-amp
Figure 16.9 External Op-Amp Connection
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 207 of 376
Comparator
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
16.2.5 Current Consumption Reducing Function
When not using the A/D converter, its resistor ladder and reference voltage input pin (VREF) can be
separated using the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register. When separated, no current will flow from the
VREF pin into the resistor ladder, helping to reduce the power consumption of the chip.
To use the A/D converter, set the VCUT bit to “1” (VREF connected) and then set the ADST bit in the
ADCON0 register to “1” (A/D conversion start). The VCUT and ADST bits cannot be set to “1” at the same time.
Nor can the VCUT bit be set to “0” (VREF unconnected) during A/D conversion.
Note that this does not affect VREF for the D/A converter (irrelevant).
16.2.6 Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion
To carry out A/D conversion properly, charging the internal capacitor C shown in Figure 16.10 has to be
completed within a specified period of time. T (sampling time) as the specified time. Let output impedance
of sensor equivalent circuit be R0, microcomputer’s internal resistance be R, precision (error) of the A/D
converter be X, and the resolution of A/D converter be Y (Y is 1024 in the 10-bit mode, and 256 in the 8-bit mode).
VC is generally VC = VIN {1 – e
And when t = T,
e
–
Hence, R0 = –
1
t
C (R0 + R)
}
X
X
VIN = VIN(1 –
)
Y
Y
VC=VIN –
–
–
1
T
C (R0 + R)
=
X
Y
1
X
T = ln
C (R0 + R)
Y
T
C • ln
X
Y
–R
Figure 16.10 shows analog input pin and external sensor equivalent circuit.
When the difference between VIN and VC becomes 0.1LSB, we find impedance R0 when voltage
between pins VC changes from 0 to VIN-(0.1/1024) VIN in time T. (0.1/1024) means that A/D precision
drop due to insufficient capacitor charge is held to 0.1LSB at time of A/D conversion in the 10-bit mode.
Actual error however is the value of absolute precision added to 0.1LSB.
When f(φAD) = 10 MHz, T = 0.3 µs in the A/D conversion mode with sample & hold. Output impedance R0
for sufficiently charging capacitor C within time T is determined as follows.
T = 0.3 µs, R = 7.8 kΩ, C = 1.5 pF, X = 0.1, and Y = 1024. Hence,
0.3 ✕ 10-6
R0 = –
1.5 ✕ 10 –12 • ln
0.1
–7.8 ✕103 = 13.9 ✕ 103
1024
Thus, the allowable output impedance of the sensor circuit capable of thoroughly driving the A/D converter
turns out to be approximately 13.9 kΩ.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 208 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
16. A/D Converter
Microcomputer
Sensor equivalent
circuit
R0
VIN
R (7.8 kΩ)
Sampling time
C (1.5 pF)
VC
Sample and hold enabled:
3
φAD
Sample and hold disabled:
2
φAD
Figure 16.10 Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 209 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
17. D/A Converter
17. D/A Converter
This is an 8-bit, R-2R type D/A converter. These are two independent D/A converters.
D/A conversion is performed by writing to the DAi register (i = 0, 1). To output the result of conversion, set the
DAiE bit in the DACON register to “1” (output enabled). Before D/A conversion can be used, the corresponding
port direction bit must be set to “0” (input mode). Setting the DAiE bit to “1” removes a pull-up from the
corresponding port.
Output analog voltage (V) is determined by a set value (n : decimal) in the DAi register.
V = VREF ✕ n/ 256 (n = 0 to 255)
VREF : reference voltage
Table 17.1 lists the performance of the D/A converter. Figure 17.1 shows the block diagram of the D/A
converter. Figure 17.2 shows the D/A converter-related registers. Figure 17.3 shows the D/A converter
equivalent circuit.
Table 17.1 D/A Converter Performance
Item
D/A conversion Method
R-2R method
Resolution
8 bits
Analog Output Pin
2 channels (DA0 and DA1)
Performance
Data bus low-order
DA0 register
0
R-2R resistor ladder
1
DA0
DA0E bit
DA1 register
0
R-2R resistor ladder
1
DA1E bit
Figure 17.1 D/A Converter Block Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 210 of 376
DA1
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
17. D/A Converter
D/A Control Register (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
DACON
03DCh
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
DA0E
D/A0 Output Enable Bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
DA1E
D/A1 Output Enable Bit
0 : Output disabled
1 : Output enabled
(b7-b2)
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
RW
RW
-
NOTE:
1. When not using the D/A converter, set the DAiE bit (i = 0, 1) to "0" (output disabled) to reduce the unnecessary
current consumption in the chip and set the DAi register to "00h" to prevent current from flowing into the R-2R
resistor ladder.
D/A Register i (i = 0, 1) (1)
b7
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
DA0
DA1
03D8h
03DAh
00h
00h
Function
Setting Range
Output value of D/A conversion
RW
RW
00h to FFh
NOTE:
1. When not using the D/A converter, set the DAiE bit (i = 0, 1) to "0" (output disabled) to reduce the unnecessary
current consumption in the chip and set the DAi register to "00h" to prevent current from flowing into the R-2R
resistor ladder.
Figure 17.2 DACON Register, DA0 and DA1 Registers
DAiE bit
r
"0"
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
2R
DAi
"1"
2R
2R
2R
2R
MSB
"1"
AVSS
VREF (2)
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. The above diagram shows an instance in which the DAi register is assigned "2Ah".
2. VREF is not related to VCUT bit setting in the ADCON1 register.
Figure 17.3 D/A Converter Equivalent Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
2R
2R
2R
LSB
DAi register
"0"
2R
page 211 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
18. CRC Calculation
18. CRC Calculation
The Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) operation detects an error in data blocks. The microcomputer uses a
generator polynomial of CRC-CCITT (X16 + X12 + X5 + 1) to generate CRC code.
The CRC code consists of 16 bits which are generated for each data block in given length, separated in 8-bit
unit. After the initial value is set in the CRCD register, the CRC code is set in that register each time one byte
of data is written to the CRCIN register. CRC code generation for one-byte data is finished in two cycles.
Figure 18.1 shows the block diagram of the CRC circuit. Figure 18.2 shows the CRC-related registers.
Figure 18.3 shows the calculation example using the CRC operation.
Data bus high-order
Data bus low-order
Low-order 8 bits
High-order 8 bits
CRCD register
CRC code generating circuit
x16 +x12 +x5 +1
CRCIN register
Figure 18.1 CRC Circuit Block Diagram
CRC Data Register
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
Address
CRCD
03BDh to 03BCh
Function
After Reset
Indeterminate
Setting Range
When data is written to the CRCIN register after setting
the initial value in the CRCD register, the CRC code can
be read out from the CRCD register.
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RW
CRC Input Register
b7
b0
Symbol
Address
CRCIN
03BEh
Function
Data input
Figure 18.2 CRCD Register and CRCIN Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 212 of 376
After Reset
Indeterminate
Setting Range
00h to FFh
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
18. CRC Calculation
Setup procedure and CRC operation when generating CRC code "80C4h"
CRC operation performed by the M16C
CRC code: Remainder of a division in which the value written to the CRCIN register with its bit positions reversed is
divided by the generator polynomial
Generator polynomial: X6 +X12 +X5+1(1 0001 0000 0010 0001b)
Setting procedure
(1) Reverse the bit positions of the value "80C4h" by program in 1-byte unit.
"80h" → "01h", "C4h" → "23h"
b15
b0
(2) Write 0000h (initial value)
CRCD register
b7
b0
CRCIN register
Two cycles later, the CRC code for "80h," i.e.,
9188h, has its bit positions reversed to become
"1189h" which is stored in the CRCD register.
(3) Write 01h
b0
b15
1189h
b7
CRCD register
b0
(4) Write 23h
CRCIN register
Two cycles later, the CRC code for "80C4h," i.e.,
8250h, has its bit positions reversed to become
"0A41h" which is stored in the CRCD register.
b0
b15
0A41h
CRCD register
Details of CRC operation
As shown in (3) above, bit position of "01h" (00000001b) written to the CRCIN register is inversed and becomes "10000000b".
Add "1000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000b", as "10000000b" plus 16 digits, to "0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000b", as
"0000 0000 0000 0000b" plus 8 digits as the default value of the CRCD register to perform the modulo-2 division.
1 0001 0000 0010 0001 1000 0000 0000 0000
1000 1000 0001 0000
Generator polynomial
1000 0001 0000
1000 1000 0001
1001 0001
CRC code
1000 1000
0000 0000
1
1000 0
0000 1
1000 1000
Data
Modulo-2 operation is
operation that complies
with the law given below.
0+0=0
0+1=1
1+0=1
1+1=0
-1 = 1
"0001 0001 1000 1001b (1189h)", the remainder "1001 0001 1000 1000b (9188h)" with inversed bit position, can be read
from the CRCD register.
When going on to (4) above, "23h (00100011b)" written in the CRCIN register is inversed and becomes "11000100b".
Add "1100 0100 0000 0000 0000 0000b", as "11000100b" plus 16 digits, to "1001 0001 1000 1000 0000 0000b", as
"1001 0001 1000 1000b" plus 8 digits as a remainder of (3) left in the CRCD register to perform the modulo-2 division.
"0000 1010 0100 0001b (0A41h)", the remainder with inversed bit position, can be read from CRCD register.
Figure 18.3 CRC Calculation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 213 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19. CAN Module
The CAN (Controller Area Network) module for the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) of microcomputers is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0B protocol. The M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) contains two
CAN modules which can transmit and receive messages in both standard (11-bit) ID and extended (29-bit)
ID formats.
Figure 19.1 shows a block diagram of the CAN module.
External CAN bus driver and receiver are required.
Data Bus
CiCONR Register
CiCTLR Register
CiGMR Register
CiIDR Register
CiLMAR Register
CiMCTLj Register
CiLMBR Register
CTX
Message Box
slots 0 to 15
Protocol
Controller
Acceptance Filter
slots 0 to 15
16 Bit Timer
CRX
CiTSR Register
Message ID
DLC
Message Data
Time Stamp
Wake-Up
Function
Interrupt
Generation
Function
CiRECR Register
CiTECR Register
CiSTR Register
CiSSTR Register
CiICR Register
CANi Successful Reception Int
CANi Successful Transmission Int
CAN0/1 Error Int
Data Bus
CAN0/1 Wake-Up Int
i = 0, 1
j = 0 to 15
Figure 19.1 CAN Module Block Diagram
CTX/CRX:
Protocol controller:
CAN I/O pins.
This controller handles the bus arbitration and the CAN protocol services, i.e. bit
timing, stuffing, error status etc.
Message box:
This memory block consists of 16 slots that can be configured either as transmitter
or receiver. Each slot contains an individual ID, data length code, a data field
(8 bytes) and a time stamp.
Acceptance filter:
This block performs filtering operation for received messages. For the filtering
operation, the CiGMR register (i = 0, 1), the CiLMAR register, or the CiLMBR
register is used.
16 bit timer:
Used for the time stamp function. When the received message is stored in the
message memory, the timer value is stored as a time stamp.
Wake-up function:
CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt request is generated by a message from the CAN bus.
Interrupt generation function: The interrupt requests are generated by the CAN module. CANi successful reception
interrupt, CANi successful transmission interrupt, CAN0/1 error interrupt and
CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 214 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.1 CAN Module-Related Registers
The CANi (i = 0, 1) module has the following registers.
19.1.1 CAN Message Box
A CAN module is equipped with 16 slots (16 bytes or 8 words each). Slots 14 and 15 can be used as
Basic CAN.
• Priority of the slots: The smaller the number of the slot, the higher the priority, in both transmission and
reception.
• A program can define whether a slot is defined as transmitter or receiver.
19.1.2 Acceptance Mask Registers
A CAN module is equipped with 3 masks for the acceptance filter.
• CANi global mask register (i = 0, 1) (CiGMR register: 6 bytes)
Configuration of the masking condition for acceptance filtering processing to slots 0 to 13
• CANi local mask A register (CiLMAR register: 6 bytes)
Configuration of the masking condition for acceptance filtering processing to slot 14
• CANi local mask B register (CiLMBR register: 6 bytes)
Configuration of the masking condition for acceptance filtering processing to slot 15
19.1.3 CAN SFR Registers
• CANi message control register j (i = 0, 1, j = 0 to 15) (CiMCTLj register: 8 bits ✕ 16)
Control of transmission and reception of a corresponding slot
• CANi control register (CiCTLR register: 16 bits)
Control of the CAN protocol
• CANi status register (CiSTR register: 16 bits)
Indication of the protocol status
• CANi slot status register (CiSSTR register: 16 bits)
Indication of the status of contents of each slot
• CANi interrupt control register (CiICR register: 16 bits)
Selection of “interrupt enabled or disabled” for each slot
• CANi extended ID register (CiIDR register: 16 bits)
Selection of ID format (standard or extended) for each slot
• CANi configuration register (CiCONR register: 16 bits)
Configuration of the bus timing
• CANi receive error count register (CiRECR register: 8 bits)
Indication of the error status of the CAN module in reception: the counter value is incremented or
decremented according to the error occurrence.
• CANi transmit error count register (CiTECR register: 8 bits)
Indication of the error status of the CAN module in transmission: the counter value is incremented or
decremented according to the error occurrence.
• CANi time stamp register (CiTSR register: 16 bits)
Indication of the value of the time stamp counter
• CANi acceptance filter support register (CiAFS register: 16 bits)
Decoding the received ID for use by the acceptance filter support unit
Explanation of each register is given below.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 215 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.2 CANi Message Box (i = 0, 1)
Table 19.1 shows the memory mapping of the CANi message box.
It is possible to access to the message box in byte or word.
Mapping of the message contents differs from byte access to word access. Byte access or word access can
be selected by the MsgOrder bit of the CiCTLR register.
Table 19.1 Memory Mapping of CANi Message Box
Address
Message Content (Memory mapping)
CAN0
CAN1
Byte access (8 bits)
Word access (16 bits)
0060h + n • 16 + 0 0260h + n • 16 + 0
SID10 to SID6
SID5 to SID0
0060h + n • 16 + 1 0260h + n • 16 + 1
SID5 to SID0
SID10 to SID6
0060h + n • 16 + 2 0260h + n • 16 + 2
EID17 to EID14
EID13 to EID6
0060h + n • 16 + 3 0260h + n • 16 + 3
EID13 to EID6
EID17 to EID14
0060h + n • 16 + 4 0260h + n • 16 + 4
EID5 to EID0
Data Length Code (DLC)
0060h + n • 16 + 5 0260h + n • 16 + 5
Data Length Code (DLC)
EID5 to EID0
0060h + n • 16 + 6 0260h + n • 16 + 6
Data byte 0
Data byte 1
0060h + n • 16 + 7 0260h + n • 16 + 7
Data byte 1
Data byte 0
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
0060h + n • 16 + 13 0260h + n • 16 + 13
Data byte 7
Data byte 6
0060h + n • 16 + 14 0260h + n • 16 + 14 Time stamp high-order byte Time stamp low-order byte
0060h + n • 16 + 15 0260h + n • 16 + 15 Time stamp low-order byte Time stamp high-order byte
i = 0, 1
n = 0 to 15: the number of the slot
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 216 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
Figures 19.2 and 19.3 show the bit mapping in each slot in byte access and word access. The content of
each slot remains unchanged unless transmission or reception of a new message is performed.
b7
b0
SID5
EID13
EID12
SID10
SID9
SID8
SID7
SID6
SID4
SID3
SID2
SID1
SID0
EID17
EID16
EID15
EID14
EID11
EID10
EID9
EID8
EID7
EID6
EID5
EID4
EID3
EID2
EID1
EID0
DLC3
DLC2
DLC1
DLC0
Data Byte 0
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 7
Time Stamp high-order byte
Time Stamp low-order byte
CAN Data Frame:
SID10 to 6
SID5 to 0
EID17 to 14 EID13 to 6
EID5 to 0
DLC3 to 0
Data Byte 0
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 7
NOTE:
1. When
is read, the value is the one written upon the transmission slot configuration.
The value is "0" when read on the reception slot configuration.
Figure 19.2 Bit Mapping in Byte Access
b15
b8
b7
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6
b0
SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0
EID17 EID16 EID15 EID14 EID13 EID12 EID11 EID10 EID9 EID8 EID7 EID6
EID5 EID4 EID3 EID2 EID1 EID0
DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0
Data Byte 0
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 2
Data Byte 3
Data Byte 4
Data Byte 5
Data Byte 6
Data Byte 7
Time Stamp high-order byte
Time Stamp low-order byte
CAN Data Frame:
SID10 to 6
SID5 to 0
EID17 to 14
EID13 to 6
EID5 to 0
DLC3 to 0
Data Byte 0
Data Byte 1
NOTE:
1. When
is read, the value is the one written upon the transmission slot configuration.
The value is "0" when read on the reception slot configuration.
Figure 19.3 Bit Mapping in Word Access
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 217 of 376
Data Byte 7
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.3 Acceptance Mask Registers
Figures 19.4 and 19.5 show the CiGMR register (i = 0, 1), the CiLMAR register, and the CiLMBR register, in
which bit mapping in byte access and word access are shown.
Addresses
b7
SID5
EID13
EID12
EID12
EID12
CAN1
SID10
SID9
SID8
SID7
SID6
0160h
0360h
SID4
SID3
SID2
SID1
SID0
0161h
0361h
EID17
EID16
EID15
EID14
0162h
0362h
EID10
EID9
EID8
EID7
EID6
0163h
0363h
EID5
EID4
EID3
EID2
EID1
EID0
0164h
0364h
SID10
SID9
SID8
SID7
SID6
0166h
0366h
SID4
SID3
SID2
SID1
SID0
0167h
0367h
EID17
EID16
EID15
EID14
0168h
0368h
CiGMR register
CiLMAR register
EID11
EID10
EID9
EID8
EID7
EID6
0169h
0369h
EID5
EID4
EID3
EID2
EID1
EID0
016Ah
036Ah
SID10
SID9
SID8
SID7
SID6
016Ch
036Ch
SID4
SID3
SID2
SID1
SID0
016Dh
036Dh
EID17
EID16
EID15
EID14
016Eh
036Eh
SID5
EID13
CAN0
EID11
SID5
EID13
b0
EID11
EID10
EID9
EID8
EID7
EID6
016Fh
036Fh
EID5
EID4
EID3
EID2
EID1
EID0
0170h
0370h
CiLMBR register
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1.
is undefined.
2. These registers can be written in CAN reset/initialization mode of the CAN module.
Figure 19.4 Bit Mapping of Mask Registers in Byte Access
Addresses
b15
b8
b7
b0
CAN0
CAN1
SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0
0160h
0360h
EID17 EID16 EID15 EID14 EID13 EID12 EID11 EID10 EID9 EID8 EID7 EID6
0162h
0362h
0164h
0364h
SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0
0166h
0366h
EID17 EID16 EID15 EID14 EID13 EID12 EID11 EID10 EID9 EID8 EID7 EID6
0168h
0368h
016Ah
036Ah
SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0
016Ch
036Ch
EID17 EID16 EID15 EID14 EID13 EID12 EID11 EID10 EID9 EID8 EID7 EID6
016Eh
036Eh
0170h
0370h
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6
EID5 EID4 EID3 EID2 EID1 EID0
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6
EID5 EID4 EID3 EID2 EID1 EID0
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6
EID5 EID4 EID3 EID2 EID1 EID0
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1.
is undefined.
2. These registers can be written in CAN reset/initialization mode of the CAN module.
Figure 19.5 Bit Mapping of Mask Registers in Word Access
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 218 of 376
CiGMR register
CiLMAR register
CiLMBR register
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.4 CAN SFR Registers
Figures 19.6 to 19.11 show the CAN SFR registers.
CANi Message Control Register j (i = 0, 1) ( j = 0 to 15) (4)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
C0MCTL0 to C0MCTL15
C1MCTL0 to C1MCTL15
Bit Symbol
Address
0200h to 020Fh
0220h to 022Fh
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
00h
Function
RW
RO (1)
RO (1)
NewData
Successful
Reception Flag
When set to reception slot
0: The content of the slot is read or still under
processing by the CPU.
1 The CAN module has stored new data in the slot.
SentData
Successful
Transmission Flag
When set to transmission slot
0: Transmission is not started or completed yet.
1: Transmission is successfully completed.
InvalData
"Under Reception"
Flag
When set to reception slot
0: The message is valid.
1: The message is invalid.
(The message is being updated.)
RO
TrmActive
"Under
Transmission"
Flag
When set to transmission slot
0: Waiting for bus idle or completion of arbitration.
1: Transmitting
RO
Overwrite Flag
When set to reception slot
0: No message has been overwritten in this slot.
(1)
1: This slot already contained a message, but it has RO
been overwritten by a new one.
MsgLost
Remote Frame
Transmission/
RemActive Reception Status
Flag (2)
0: Data frame transmission/reception status
1: Remote frame transmission/reception status
When set to reception remote frame slot
0: After a remote frame is received, it will be
answered automatically.
1: After a remote frame is received, no transmission
will be started as long as this bit is set to "1".
(Not responding)
RW
RspLock
Auto Response
Lock Mode
Select Bit
Remote
Remote Frame
Corresponding
Slot Select Bit
0: Slot not corresponding to remote frame
1: Slot corresponding to remote frame
RW
RecReq
Reception Slot
Request Bit (3)
0: Not reception slot
1: Reception slot
RW
TrmReq
Transmission
0: Not transmission slot
Slot Request Bit (3) 1: Transmission slot
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. As for write, only writing "0" is possible. The value of each bit is written when the CAN module enters the respective state.
2. In Basic CAN mode, slots 14 and 15 serve as data format identification flag.
The RemActive bit is set to "0" if the data frame is received and it is set to "1" if the remote frame is received.
3. One slot cannot be defined as reception slot and transmission slot at the same time.
4. This register cannot be set in CAN reset/initialization mode of the CAN module.
Figure 19.6 C0MCTLj and C1MCTLj Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 219 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
CANi Control Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
C0CTLR
C1CTLR
Address
0210h
0230h
Bit Symbol
After Reset
X0000001b
X0000001b
Bit Name
Function
RW
Reset
CAN Module
Reset Bit (1)
0: Operation mode
1: Reset/initialization mode
RW
LoopBack
Loop Back Mode
Select Bit (2)
0: Loop back mode disabled
1: Loop back mode enabled
RW
0: Word access
1: Byte access
RW
0: Basic CAN mode disabled
1: Basic CAN mode enabled
RW
0: Bus error interrupt disabled
1: Bus error interrupt enabled
RW
MsgOrder
BasicCAN
BusErrEn
Message Order
Select Bit (2)
Basic CAN Mode
Select Bit (2)
Bus Error Interrupt
Enable Bit (2)
Sleep
Select Bit (2) (3)
0: Sleep mode disabled
1: Sleep mode enabled; clock supply stopped
RW
PortEn
CAN Port Enable
Bit (2) (3)
0: I/O port function
1: CTX/CRX function
RW
(b7)
Sleep Mode
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
-
NOTES:
1. When the Reset bit is set to "1" (CAN reset/initialization mode), check that the State_Reset bit in the CiSTR register is set to
"1" (Reset mode).
2. Change this bit only in the CAN reset/initialization mode.
3. When using CAN0/1 wake-up interrupt, set these bits to "1".
(b15)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
(b8)
b0
Symbol
C0CTLR
C1CTLR
Address
0211h
0231h
Bit Symbol
After Reset
XX0X0000b
XX0X0000b
Bit Name
Function
RW
b1 b0
TSPreScale
TSReset
RetBusOff
(b4)
RXOnly
(b7-b6)
Time Stamp
Prescaler (3)
0 0: Period of 1 bit time
0 1: Period of 1/2 bit time
1 0: Period of 1/4 bit time
1 1: Period of 1/8 bit time
RW
Time Stamp Counter 0: Nothing is occurred.
1: Force reset of the time stamp counter
Reset Bit (1)
RW
Return From Bus Off 0: Nothing is occurred.
1: Force return from bus off
Command Bit (2)
RW
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
Listen-Only Mode
Select Bit (3)
0: Listen-only mode disabled
1: Listen-only mode enabled (4)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are indeterminate.
RW
-
NOTES:
1. When the TSReset bit = 1, the CiTSR register is set to "0000h". After this, the bit is automatically set to "0".
2. When the RetBusOff bit = 1, the CiRECR and CiTECR registers are set to "00h". After this, this bit is automatically set to "0".
3. Change this bit only in the CAN reset/initialization mode.
4. When the listen-only mode is selected, do not request the transmission.
Figure 19.7 C0CTLR and C1CTLR Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 220 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
CANi Status Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
C0STR
C1STR
Address
0212h
0232h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
After Reset
00h
00h
Function
RW
b3 b2 b1 b0
Active Slot Bits (1)
0 0 0 0 : Slot 0
0 0 0 1 : Slot 1
0 0. 1 0 : Slot 2
..
1 1 1 0 : Slot 14
1 1 1 1 : Slot 15
RO
TrmSucc
Successful
Transmission
Flag (1)
0: No [successful] transmission
1: The CAN module has transmitted a message
successfully.
RO
RecSucc
Successful
Reception Flag (1)
0: No [successful] reception
1: CAN module received a message successfully.
RO
TrmState
Transmission Flag
(Transmitter)
0: CAN module is idle or receiver.
1: CAN module is transmitter.
RO
RecState
Reception Flag
(Receiver)
0: CAN module is idle or transmitter.
1: CAN module is receiver.
RO
MBOX
NOTE:
1. These bits can be changed only when a slot which an interrupt is enabled by the CiICR register is transmitted or received
successfully.
(b15)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
(b8)
b0
Symbol
C0STR
C1STR
Address
0213h
0233h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
State_Reset Reset State Flag
RW
0: Operation mode
1: Reset mode
RO
Loop Back
State Flag
0: Not Loop back mode
1: Loop back mode
RO
State_
MsgOrder
Message Order
State Flag
0:Word access
1: Byte access
RO
State_
BasicCAN
Basic CAN Mode
State Flag
0: Not Basic CAN mode
1: Basic CAN mode
RO
State_
BusError
Bus Error
State Flag
0: No error has occurred.
1: A CAN bus error has occurred.
RO
State_
ErrPass
Error Passive
State Flag
0: CAN module is not in error passive state.
1: CAN module is in error passive state.
RO
State_
BusOff
Error Bus Off
State Flag
0: CAN module is not in error bus off state.
1: CAN module is in error bus off state.
RO
-
Figure 19.8 C0STR and C1STR Registers
page 221 of 376
Function
State_
LoopBack
(b7)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
After Reset
X0000001b
X0000001b
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
-
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
CANi Slot Status Register (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
C0SSTR
C1SSTR
Address
0215h, 0214h
0235h, 0234h
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Values
RW
0: Reception slot
The message has been read.
Transmission slot
Transmission is not completed.
1: Reception slot
The message has not been read.
Transmission slot
Transmission is completed.
RO
Function
Slot status bits
Each bit corresponds to the slot with the
same number.
CANi Interrupt Control Register (i = 0, 1) (1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
C0ICR
C1ICR
Address
0217h, 0216h
0237h, 0236h
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Values
Function
Interrupt enable bits:
0: Interrupt disabled
Each bit corresponds with a slot with the same 1: Interrupt enabled
number.
Enabled/disabled of successful transmission
interrupt or successful reception interrupt can
be selected.
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. This register cannot be set in CAN reset/initialization mode of the CAN module.
CANi Extended ID Register (i = 0, 1) (1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
C0IDR
C1IDR
Address
0219h, 0218h
0239h, 0238h
Function
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Setting Values
Extended ID bits:
0: Standard ID
Each bit corresponds with a slot with the same 1: Extended ID
number.
Selection of the ID format that each slot handles.
RW
RW
NOTE:
1. This register cannot be set in CAN reset/initialization mode of the CAN module.
Figure 19.9 C0SSTR, C1SSTR Registers, C0ICR, C1ICR Registers, and C0IDR, C1IDR Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 222 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
CANi Configuration Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
C0CONR
C1CONR
Bit Symbol
Address
021Ah
023Ah
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Bit Name
Function
RW
b3 b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 0 : Divide-by-1 of fCAN
0 0 0 1 : Divide-by-2 of fCAN
0 0 1 0 : Divide-by-3 of fCAN
.....
BRP
Prescaler Division
Ratio Select Bits
RW
1 1 1 0 : Divide-by-15 of fCAN
1 1 1 1 : Divide-by-16 of fCAN (1)
SAM
Sampling Control
Bit
0 : One time sampling
1 : Three times sampling
RW
b7 b6 b5
0 0 0 : 1Tq
0 0 1 : 2Tq
0 1 0 : 2Tq
RW
.....
PTS
Propagation Time
Segment Control
Bits
1 1 0 : 7Tq
1 1 1 : 8Tq
NOTE:
1. fCAN serves for the CAN clock. The period is decided by configuration of the CCLKi bit (i = 0 to 2, 4 to 6) in the CCLKR register.
(b15)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
(b8)
b0
Symbol
C0CONR
C1CONR
Bit Symbol
Address
021Bh
023Bh
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Bit Name
Function
RW
b2 b1b0
0 0 0 : Do not set a value
0 0 1 : 2Tq
0 1 0 : 3Tq
.....
PBS1
Phase Buffer
Segment 1
Control Bits
RW
1 1 0 : 7Tq
1 1 1 : 8Tq
b5 b4 b3
0 0 0 : Do not set a value
0 0 1 : 2Tq
0 1 0 : 3Tq
.....
PBS2
Phase Buffer
Segment 2
Control Bits
RW
1 1 0 : 7Tq
1 1 1 : 8Tq
b7 b6
SJW
Resynchronization
Jump Width
Control Bits
Figure 19.10 C0CONR and C1CONR Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 223 of 376
0
0
1
1
0 : 1Tq
1 : 2Tq
0 : 3Tq
1 : 4Tq
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
CANi Receive Error Count Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b0
Symbol
C0RECR
C1RECR
Address
021Ch
023Ch
After Reset
00h
00h
Counter Value
Function
Reception error counting function
The value is incremented or decremented
according to the CAN module’s error status.
00h to FFh (1)
RW
RO
NOTE:
1. The value is indeterminate in bus off state.
CANi Transmit Error Count Register (i = 0, 1)
b7
b0
Symbol
C0TECR
C1TECR
Address
021Dh
023Dh
After Reset
00h
00h
Counter Value
Function
Transmission error counting function
The value is incremented or decremented
according to the CAN module’s error status.
00h to FFh (1)
RW
RO
NOTE:
1. The value is indeterminate in bus off state.
CANi Time Stamp Register (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
C0TSR
C1TSR
Address
021Fh, 021Eh
023Fh, 023Eh
After Reset
0000h
0000h
Function
Counter Value
Time stamp function
0000h to FFFFh
RW
RO
CANi Acceptance Filter Support Register (i = 0, 1)
(b15)
b7
(b8)
b0 b7
b0
Symbol
C0AFS
C1AFS
Address
0243h, 0242h
0245h, 0244h
Function
Write the content equivalent to the standard frame
ID of the received message.
The value is "converted standard frame ID" when
read.
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Setting Values
Standard frame ID
RW
RW
Figure 19.11 C0RECR, C1RECR Registers, C0TECR, C1TECR Registers, C0TSR, C1TSR Registers,
and C0AFS, C1AFS Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 224 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.5 Operational Modes
The CAN module has the following four operational modes.
• CAN Reset/Initialization Mode
• CAN Operation Mode
• CAN Sleep Mode
• CAN Interface Sleep Mode
Figure 19.12 shows transition between operational modes.
MCU Reset
Reset = 0
CAN reset/initialization
mode
State_Reset = 1
Sleep = 0
and
Reset = 1
CCLK3 = 1 or
CCLK7 = 1
CAN interface
sleep mode
CAN operation mode
State_Reset = 0
Reset = 1
Sleep = 1
and
Reset = 0
CAN sleep mode
TEC > 255
Reset = 1
when 11 consecutive
recessive bits are
detected 128 times
or
RetBusOff = 1
Bus off state
State_BusOff = 1
CCLK3 = 0 or
CCLK7 = 0
CCLK3, CCLK7: Bits in CCLKR register
Reset, Sleep, RetBusOff: Bits in CiCTLR register ( i = 0, 1)
State_Reset, State_BusOff: Bits in CiSTR register
Figure 19.12 Transition Between Operational Modes
19.5.1 CAN Reset/Initialization Mode
The CAN reset/initialization mode is activated upon MCU reset or by setting the Reset bit in the CiCTLR
register ( i = 0, 1) to “1”. If the Reset bit is set to “1”, check that the State_Reset bit in the CiSTR register is
set to “1”.
Entering the CAN reset/initialization mode initiates the following functions by the module:
• CAN communication is impossible.
• When the CAN reset/initialization mode is activated during an ongoing transmission in operation
mode, the module suspends the mode transition until completion of the transmission (successful,
arbitration loss, or error detection). Then, the State_Reset bit is set to “1”, and the CAN reset/initialization
mode is activated.
• The CiMCTLj (j = 0 to 15), CiSTR, CiICR, CiIDR, CiRECR, CiTECR and CiTSR registers are initialized.
All these registers are locked to prevent CPU modification.
• The CiCTLR, CiCONR, CiGMR, CiLMAR and CiLMBR registers and the CANi message box retain their
contents and are available for CPU access.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 225 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.5.2 CAN Operation Mode
The CAN operation mode is activated by setting the Reset bit in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1) to “0”. If the
Reset bit is set to “0”, check that the State_Reset bit in the CiSTR register is set to “0”.
If 11 consecutive recessive bits are detected after entering the CAN operation mode, the module initiates
the following functions:
• The module's communication functions are released and it becomes an active node on the network
and may transmit and receive CAN messages.
• Release the internal fault confinement logic including receive and transmit error counters. The module
may leave the CAN operation mode depending on the error counts.
Within the CAN operation mode, the module may be in three different sub modes, depending on which
type of communication functions are performed:
• Module idle
: The modules receive and transmit sections are inactive.
• Module receives : The module receives a CAN message sent by another node.
• Module transmits : The module transmits a CAN message. The module may receive its own message
simultaneously when the LoopBack bit in the CiCTLR register = 1 (Loop back mode
enabled).
Figure 19.13 shows sub modes of the CAN operation mode.
Module idle
TrmState = 0
RecState = 0
Start
transmission
Finish
transmission
Finish
reception
Detect
an SOF
Module transmits
Module receives
TrmState = 1
RecState = 0
TrmState = 0
RecState = 1
Lost in arbitration
TrmState, RecState: Bits in CiSTR register (i = 0, 1)
Figure 19.13 Sub Modes of CAN Operation Mode
19.5.3 CAN Sleep Mode
The CAN sleep mode is activated by setting the Sleep bit to “1” and the Reset bit to “0” in the CiCTLR
register. It should never be activated from the CAN operation mode but only via the CAN reset/initialization
mode.
Entering the CAN sleep mode instantly stops the clock supply to the module and thereby reduces power
dissipation.
19.5.4 CAN Interface Sleep Mode
The CAN interface sleep mode is activated by setting the CCLK3 or CCLK7 bit in the CCLKR register to
“1”. It should never be activated but only via the CAN sleep mode.
Entering the CAN interface sleep mode instantly stops the clock supply to the CPU Interface in the module
and thereby reduces power dissipation.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 226 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.5.5 Bus Off State
The bus off state is entered according to the fault confinement rules of the CAN specification. When
returning to the CAN operation mode from the bus off state, the module has the following two cases.
In this time, the value of any CAN registers, except CiSTR, CiRECR and CiTECR registers, does not
change.
(1) When 11 consecutive recessive bits are detected 128 times
The module enters instantly into error active state and the CAN communication becomes possible
immediately.
(2) When the RetBusOff bit in the CiCTLR register = 1 (Force return from buss off)
The module enters instantly into error active state, and the CAN communication becomes possible
again after 11 consecutive recessive bits are detected.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 227 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.6 Configuration CAN Module System Clock
The M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) has a CAN module system clock select circuit.
Configuration of the CAN module system clock can be done through manipulating the CCLKR register and
the BRP bit in the CiCONR register (i = 0, 1).
For the CCLKR register, refer to 8. Clock Generating Circuit.
Figure 19.14 shows a block diagram of the clock generating circuit of the CAN module system.
f1
Divide-by-1 (undivided)
Divide-by-2
Divide-by-4
Divide-by-8
Value: 1, 2, 4, 8, 16 Divide-by-16
CAN module
system clock
divider
Prescaler
fCAN
1/2
CCLKR register
Baud rate
prescaler
division value
:P+1
fCANCLK
CAN module
fCAN
: CAN module system clock
P
: The value written in the BRP bit in the CiCONR register ( i = 0, 1). P = 0 to 15
fCANCLK : CAN communication clock fCANCLK = fCAN/2(P + 1)
Figure 19.14 Block Diagram of CAN Module System Clock Generating Circuit
19.7 Bit Timing Configuration
The bit time consists of the following four segments:
• Synchronization segment (SS)
This serves for monitoring a falling edge for synchronization.
• Propagation time segment (PTS)
This segment absorbs physical delay on the CAN network which amounts to double the total sum of
delay on the CAN bus, the input comparator delay, and the output driver delay.
• Phase buffer segment 1 (PBS1)
This serves for compensating the phase error. When the falling edge of the bit falls later than expected,
the segment can become longer by the maximum of the value defined in SJW.
• Phase buffer segment 2 (PBS2)
This segment has the same function as the phase buffer segment 1. When the falling edge of the bit
falls earlier than expected, the segment can become shorter by the maximum of the value defined in SJW.
Figure 19.15 shows the bit timing.
Bit time
SS
PTS
PBS2
PBS1
SJW
SJW
Sampling point
The range of each segment: Bit time = 8 to 25Tq
SS = 1Tq
PTS = 1Tq to 8Tq
PBS1 = 2Tq to 8Tq
PBS2 = 2Tq to 8Tq
SJW = 1Tq to 4Tq
Figure 19.15 Bit Timing
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 228 of 376
Configuration of PBS1 and PBS2: PBS1 ≥ PBS2
PBS1 ≥ SJW
PBS2 ≥ 2 when SJW = 1
PBS2 ≥ SJW when 2 ≤ SJW ≤ 4
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.8 Bit-rate
Bit-rate depends on f1, the division value of the CAN module system clock, the division value of the baud
rate prescaler, and the number of Tq of one bit.
Table 19.2 shows the examples of bit-rate.
Table 19.2 Examples of Bit-rate
Bit-rate
24MHz (2)
1Mbps
12Tq (1)
500kbps
12Tq (2)
24Tq (1)
125kbps
12Tq (8)
16Tq (6)
24Tq (4)
83.3kbps
12Tq (12)
16Tq (9)
24Tq (6)
33.3kbps
12Tq (30)
24Tq (15)
20MHz
10Tq (1)
10Tq (2)
20Tq (1)
10Tq (8)
20Tq (4)
10Tq (12)
20Tq (6)
10Tq (30)
20Tq (15)
16MHz
8Tq (1)
8Tq (2)
16Tq (1)
8Tq (8)
16Tq (4)
8Tq (12)
16Tq (6)
8Tq (30)
16Tq (15)
10MHz
10Tq (1)
10Tq (4)
20Tq (2)
10Tq (6)
20Tq (3)
10Tq (15)
-
8MHz
8Tq (1)
8Tq (4)
16Tq (2)
8Tq (6)
16Tq (3)
8Tq (15)
-
NOTES:
1. The number in ( ) indicates a value of “fCAN division value” multiplied by “baud rate prescaler division value”.
2. 24 MHz is available Normal-ver. only.
19.8.1 Calculation of Bit-rate
f1
2 ✕ “fCAN division value (1)” ✕ “baud rate prescaler division value (2)” ✕ “number of Tq of one bit”
NOTES:
1. fCAN division value = 1, 2, 4, 8, 16
fCAN division value: a value selected in the CCLKR register
2. Baud rate prescaler division value = P + 1 (P: 0 to 15)
P: a value selected in the BRP bit in the CiCONR register (i = 0, 1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 229 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.9 Acceptance Filtering Function and Masking Function
These functions serve the users to select and receive a facultative message. The CiGMR register (i = 0, 1),
the CiLMAR register, and the CiLMBR register can perform masking to the standard ID and the extended ID
of 29 bits. The CiGMR register corresponds to slots 0 to 13, the CiLMAR register corresponds to slot 14,
and the CiLMBR register corresponds to slot 15. The masking function becomes valid to 11 bits or 29 bits
of a received ID according to the value in the corresponding slot of the CiIDR register upon acceptance
filtering operation. When the masking function is employed, it is possible to receive a certain range of IDs.
Figure 19.16 shows correspondence of the mask registers and slots, Figure 19.17 shows the acceptance
function.
CiGMR register
Slot #0
Slot #1
Slot #2
Slot #3
Slot #4
Slot #5
Slot #6
Slot #7
Slot #8
Slot #9
Slot #10
Slot #11
Slot #12
Slot #13
CiLMAR register
CiLMBR register
Slot #14
Slot #15
i = 0, 1
Figure 19.16 Correspondence of Mask Registers to Slots
ID stored in
ID of the
the slot
received message
The value of the
mask register
Mask Bit Values
0: ID (to which the received message
corresponds) match is handled as
"Don’t care".
1: ID (to which the received message
corresponds) match is checked.
Acceptance Signal
Acceptance judge signal
0: The CAN module ignores the
current incoming message.
(Not stored in any slot)
1: The CAN module stores the
current incoming message in
a slot of which ID matches.
Figure 19.17 Acceptance Function
When using the acceptance function, note the following points.
(1) When one ID is defined in two slots, the one with a smaller number alone is valid.
(2) When it is configured that slots 14 and 15 receive all IDs with Basic CAN mode, slots 14 and 15 receive
all IDs which are not stored into slots 0 to 13.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 230 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.10 Acceptance Filter Support Unit (ASU)
The acceptance filter support unit has a function to judge valid/invalid of a received ID through table search.
The IDs to receive are registered in the data table; a received ID is stored in the CiAFS register ( i = 0, 1),
and table search is performed with a decoded received ID. The acceptance filter support unit can be used
for the IDs of the standard frame only.
The acceptance filter support unit is valid in the following cases.
• When the ID to receive cannot be masked by the acceptance filter.
(Example) IDs to receive: 078h, 087h, 111h
• When there are too many IDs to receive; it would take too much time to filter them by software.
Figure 19.18 shows the write and read of the CiAFS register in word access.
Addresses
CAN0 CAN1
b15
When write
b8
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6
b7
b0
SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0
242h
244h
b7
b0
SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6 SID5 SID4 SID3
242h
244h
3/8 Decoder
b15
b8
When read
Figure 19.18 Write/read of CiAFS Register in Word Access
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 231 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.11 Basic CAN Mode
When the BasicCAN bit in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1) is set to "1" (Basic CAN mode enabled), slots 14
and 15 correspond to Basic CAN mode. In normal operation mode, each slot can handle only one type
message at a time, either a data frame or a remote frame by setting CiMCTLj regisrer (j = 0 to 15).
However, in Basic CAN mode, slots 14 and 15 can receive both types of message at the same time.
When slots 14 and 15 are defined as reception slots in Basic CAN mode, received messages are stored in
slots 14 and 15 alternately.
Which type of message has been received can be checked by the RemActive bit in the CiMCTLj register.
Figure 19.19 shows the operation of slots 14 and 15 in Basic CAN mode.
Slot 14
Slot 15
Empty
Locked (empty)
Msg n
Msg n
Locked (empty)
Locked (Msg n)
Msg n + 1
Msg n+1
Msg n+2 (Msg n lost)
Locked (Msg n+1)
Msg n+2
Figure 19.19 Operation of Slots 14 and 15 in Basic CAN Mode
When using Basic CAN mode, note the following points.
(1) Setting of Basic CAN mode has to be done in CAN reset/initialization mode.
(2) Select the same ID for slots 14 and 15. Also, setting of the CiLMAR and CiLMBR register has to be the
same.
(3) Define slots 14 and 15 as reception slot only.
(4) There is no protection available against message overwrite. A message can be overwritten by a new
message.
(5) Slots 0 to 13 can be used in the same way as in normal CAN operation mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 232 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.12 Return from Bus Off Function
When the protocol controller enters bus off state, it is possible to make it forced return from bus off state by
setting the RetBusOff bit in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1) to “1” (Force return from bus off). At this time, the
error state changes from bus off state to error active state. If the RetBusOff bit is set to “1”, the CiRECR and
CiTECR registers are initialized and the State_BusOff bit in the CiSTR register is set to “0” (CAN module is
not in error bus off state). However, registers of the CAN module such as CiCONR register and the content
of each slot are not initialized.
19.13 Time Stamp Counter and Time Stamp Function
When the CiTSR register ( i = 0, 1) is read, the value of the time stamp counter at the moment is read. The
period of the time stamp counter reference clock is the same as that of 1 bit time that is configured by the
CiCONR register. The time stamp counter functions as a free run counter.
The 1 bit time period can be divided by 1 (undivided), 2, 4 or 8 to produce the time stamp counter reference
clock. Use the TSPreScale bit in the CiCTLR register to select the divide-by-n value.
The time stamp counter is equipped with a register that captures the counter value when the protocol
controller regards it as a successful reception. The captured value is stored when a time stamp value is
stored in a reception slot.
19.14 Listen-Only Mode
When the RXOnly bit in the CiCTLR register ( i = 0, 1) is set to "1", the module enters listen-only mode.
In listen-only mode, no transmission, such as data frames, error frames, and ACK response, is performed
to bus.
When listen-only mode is selected, do not request the transmission.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 233 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.15 Reception and Transmission
Table 19.3 shows configuration of CAN reception and transmission mode.
Table 19.3 Configuration of CAN Reception and Transmission Mode
TrmReq RecReq Remote RspLock
Communication Mode of Slot
0
0
Communication environment configuration mode:
configure the communication mode of the slot.
0
1
0
0
Configured as a reception slot for a data frame.
1
0
1
0
Configured as a transmission slot for a remote frame.
(At this time the RemActive = 1.)
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1/0
After completion of transmission, this functions as a reception
slot for a data frame. (At this time the RemActive = 0.)
However, when an ID that matches on the CAN bus is detected
before remote frame transmission, this immediately functions
as a reception slot for a data frame.
Configured as a transmission slot for a data frame.
Configured as a reception slot for a remote frame.
(At this time the RemActive = 1.)
After completion of reception, this functions as a transmission
slot for a data frame. (At this time the RemActive = 0.)
However, transmission does not start as long as RspLock bit
remains “1”; thus no automatic response.
Response (transmission) starts when the RspLock bit is set to “0”.
TrmReq, RecReq, Remote, RspLock, RemActive, RspLock: Bits in CiMCTLj register (i = 0, 1, j = 0 to 15)
When configuring a slot as a reception slot, note the following points.
(1) Before configuring a slot as a reception slot, be sure to set the CiMCTLj register to “00h”.
(2) A received message is stored in a slot that matches the condition first according to the result of reception
mode configuration and acceptance filtering operation. Upon deciding in which slot to store, the smaller
the number of the slot is, the higher priority it has.
(3) In normal CAN operation mode, when a CAN module transmits a message of which ID matches, the
CAN module never receives the transmitted data. In loop back mode, however, the CAN module
receives back the transmitted data. In this case, the module does not return ACK.
When configuring a slot as a transmission slot, note the following points.
(1) Before configuring a slot as a transmission slot, be sure to set the CiMCTLj registers to “00h”.
(2) Set the TrmReq bit in the CiMCTLj register to “0” (not transmission slot) before rewriting a transmission slot.
(3) A transmission slot should not be rewritten when the TrmActive bit in the CiMCTLj register is “1”
(transmitting).
If it is rewritten, an indeterminate data will be transmitted.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 234 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.15.1 Reception
Figure 19.20 shows the behavior of the module when receiving two consecutive CAN messages, that fit
into the slot of the shown CiMCTLj register (i = 0, 1, j = 0 to 15) and leads to losing/overwriting of the first
message.
SOF
ACK
EOF
IFS
SOF
ACK
IFS
EOF
CANbus
InvalData bit
(2)
NewData bit
(2)
(5)
(4)
(5)
MsgLost bit
CANi Successful
Reception Interrupt
(5)
(3)
(1)
RecSucc bit
MBOX bit
Receive slot No.
CiSTR register
RecState bit
CiMCTLj register
RecReq bit
i = 0, 1
j = 0 to 15
Figure 19.20 Timing of Receive Data Frame Sequence
(1) On monitoring a SOF on the CAN bus the RecState bit in the CiSTR register becomes “1” (CAN
module is receiver) immediately, given the module has no transmission pending.
(2) After successful reception of the message, the NewData bit in the CiMCTLj register of the receiving
slot becomes “1” (stored new data in slot). The InvalData bit in the CiMCTLj register becomes “1”
(message is being updated) at the same time and the InvalData bit becomes “0” (message is valid)
again after the complete message was transferred to the slot.
(3) When the interrupt enable bit in the CiICR register of the receiving slot = 1 (interrupt enabled), the
CANi successful reception interrupt request is generated and the MBOX bit in the CiSTR register is
changed. It shows the slot number where the message was stored and the RecSucc bit in the CiSTR
register is active.
(4) Read the message out of the slot after setting the New Data bit to “0” (the content of the slot is read or
still under processing by the CPU) by a program.
(5) When next CAN message is received before the the NewData bit is set to “0” by a program or a
receive request to a slot is canceled, the MsgLost bit in the CiMCTLj register is set to “1” (message
has been overwritten). The new received message is transferred to the slot. Generating of an interrupt
request and change of the CiSTR register are same as in 3).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 235 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.15.2 Transmission
Figure 19.21 shows the timing of the transmit sequence.
SOF
ACK
EOF
IFS
SOF
(1)
(4)
TrmActive bit
(1)
(2)
(3)
SentData bit
(3)
CANi Successful
Transmission Interrupt
(3)
TrmState bit
(1)
(2)
TrmSucc bit
MBOX bit
Transmission slot No.
CiSTR register
TrmReq bit
CiMCTLj register
CTX
i = 0, 1
j = 0 to 15
Figure 19.21 Timing of Transmit Sequence
(1) If the TrmReq bit in the CiMCTLj register (i = 0, 1, j = 0 to 15) is set to “1” (Transmission slot) in the bus
idle state, the TrmActive bit in the CiMCTLj register and the TrmState bit in the CiSTR register are set
to “1” (Transmitting/Transmitter), and CAN module starts the transmission.
(2) If the arbitration is lost after the CAN module starts the transmission, the TrmActive and TrmState bits
are set to “0”.
(3) If the transmission has been successful without lost in arbitration, the SentData bit in the CiMCTLj
register is set to “1” (Transmission is successfully completed) and TrmActive bit is set to “0” (Waiting
for bus idle or completion of arbitration). And when the interrupt enable bits in the CiICR register = 1
(Interrupt enabled), CANi successful transmission interrupt request is generated and the MBOX (the
slot number which transmitted the message) and TrmSucc bit in the CiSTR register are changed.
(4) When starting the next transmission, set the SentData and TrmReq bits to “0”. And set the TrmReq bit
to “1” after checking that the SentData and TrmReq bits are set to “0”.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 236 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
19. CAN Module
19.16 CAN Interrupt
The CAN module provides the following CAN interrupts.
• CANi Successful Reception Interrupt ( i = 0, 1)
• CANi Successful Transmission Interrupt
• CAN0/1 Error Interrupt: Error Passive State
Error BusOff State
Bus Error (this feature can be disabled separately)
• CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt
When the CPU detects the CANi successful reception/transmission interrupt request, the MBOX bit in the
CiSTR register must be read to determine which slot has generated the interrupt request.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 237 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
20. Programmable I/O Ports
The programmable input/output ports (hereafter referred to simply as I/O ports) consist of 87 lines P0 to P10
(except P8_5). Each port can be set for input or output every line by using a direction register, and can also
be chosen to be or not be pulled high every
4 lines. P8_5
is an input-only port and does not have a pull-up
_______
______
resistor. Port P8_5 shares the pin with NMI, so that the NMI input level can be read from the P8_5 bit in the
P8 register.
Figures 20.1 to 20.5 show the I/O ports. Figure 20.6 shows the I/O pins.
Each pin functions as an I/O port, a peripheral function input/output pin or a bus control pin.
For details on how to set peripheral functions, refer to each functional description in this manual. If any pin is
used as a peripheral function input or D/A converter output pin, set the direction bit for that pin to “0” (input
mode). Any pin used as an output pin for peripheral functions other than the D/A converter is directed for
output no matter how the corresponding direction bit is set.
When using any pin as a bus control pin, refer to 7.2 Bus Control.
20.1 PDi Register (i = 0 to 10)
Figure 20.7 shows the PDi register.
This register selects whether the I/O port is to be used for input or output. The bits in this register correspond
one for one to each port.
During memory expansion and microprocessor
modes, the PDi registers for the________
pins functioning
as bus
_______
_______ _____ ________ ______ _________ ________
__________ __________
control pins (A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, ALE, RDY, HOLD, HLDA, and
BCLK) cannot be modified.
No direction register bit for P8_5 is available.
20.2 Pi Register (i = 0 to 10)
Figure 20.8 shows the Pi register.
Data input/output to and from external devices are accomplished by reading and writing to the Pi register.
The Pi register consists of a port latch to hold the input/output data and a circuit to read the pin status. For
ports set for input mode, the input level of the pin can be read by reading the corresponding Pi register, and
data can be written to the port latch by writing to the Pi register.
For ports set for output mode, the port latch can be read by reading the corresponding Pi register, and data
can be written to the port latch by writing to the Pi register. The data written to the port latch is output from
the pin. The bits in the Pi register correspond one for one to each port.
During memory expansion and microprocessor
modes, the Pi registers for the ________
pins functioning
as bus
_______
_______ _____ ________ ______ _________ ________
__________ __________
control pins (A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, ALE, RDY, HOLD, HLDA, and
BCLK) cannot be modified.
20.3 PURj Register (j = 0 to 2)
Figure 20.9 shows the PURj register.
The PURj register bits can be used to select whether or not to pull the corresponding port high in 4-bit unit.
The port selected to be pulled high has a pull-up resistor connected to it when the direction bit is set for input
mode.
However, the pull-up control register has no effect on P0 to P3, P4_0 to P4_3, and P5 during memory
expansion and microprocessor modes. Although the register contents can be modified, no pull-up resistors are
connected.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 238 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
20.4 PCR Register
Figure 20.10 shows the PCR register.
When the P1 register is read after setting the PCR0 bit in the PCR register to “1”, the corresponding port
latch can be read no matter how the PD1 register is set.
Tables 20.1 and 20.2 list an example connection of unused pins. Figure 20.11 shows an example connection
of unused pins.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 239 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
P0_0 to P0 _7
P2_0 to P2_7
P3_0 to P3_7
P4_0 to P4_7
P5_0 to P5_4, P5_6
Direction register
(inside dotted-line
included)
Data bus
Port latch
(inside dotted-line
not included)
(NOTE 1)
Analog input
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P1_0 to P1 _4
Port P1 control register
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P1_5 to P1 _7
Port P1 control register
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
P5_7
P6_0, P6_4,
P7_3 to P7_6
P8_0, P8_1
P9_0, P9_2
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
NOTE:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
Figure 20.1 I/O Ports (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 240 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
Direction
register
P6_1, P6_5
P7_2
"1"
Output
Port latch
Data bus
Switching
between
CMOS and
Nch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P8_2 to P8_4
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P5_5
P7_7
P9_7
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
NOTE:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
Figure 20.2 I/O Ports (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 241 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P6_2, P6_6
Port latch
Data bus
(NOTE 1)
Switching
between
CMOS and Nch
Input to respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P6_3, P6_7
P7_0
"1"
Port latch
Data bus
Output
(NOTE 1)
Switching between CMOS and Nch
P8_5
Data bus
NMI interrupt input
(NOTE 1)
Direction register
P7_1, P9_1
"1"
Output
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 2)
Input to respective peripheral functions
NOTES:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
2.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Figure 20.3 I/O Ports (3)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 242 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P10_0 to P10_3 (inside dotted-line
not included)
P10_4 to P10_7 (inside dotted-line
Data bus
included)
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Analog input
Input to respective peripheral functions
Pull-up selection
D/A output enabled
Direction register
P9_3, P9_4
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
Analog output
D/A output enabled
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P9_6
"1"
Data bus
Port latch
Output
(NOTE 1)
Analog input
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P9_5
"1"
Data bus
Output
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
Input to respective peripheral functions
Analog input
NOTE:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
Figure 20.4 I/O Ports (4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 243 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up selection
Direction register
P8_7
Data bus
Port latch
(NOTE 1)
fC
Rf
Pull-up selection
Rd
Direction register
P8_6
"1"
Data bus
Port latch
Output
(NOTE 1)
NOTE:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
Figure 20.5 I/O Ports (5)
BYTE
BYTE signal input
(NOTE 1)
CNVSS
CNVSS signal input
(NOTE 1)
RESET
RESET signal input
(NOTE 1)
NOTE:
1.
Symbolizes a parasitic diode.
Make sure the input voltage on each port will not exceed VCC.
Figure 20.6 I/O Pins
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 244 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Port Pi Direction Register (i = 0 to 7, 9, 10) (1) (2)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PD0 to PD3
PD4 to PD7
PD9, PD10
Address
03E2h, 03E3h, 03E6h, 03E7h
03EAh, 03EBh, 03EEh, 03EFh
03F3h, 03F6h
After Reset
00h
00h
00h
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
PDi_0
Port Pi_0 Direction Bit
Function
PDi_1
Port Pi_1 Direction Bit
PDi_2
Port Pi_2 Direction Bit
PDi_3
Port Pi_3 Direction Bit
RW
PDi_4
Port Pi_4 Direction Bit
RW
PDi_5
Port Pi_5 Direction Bit
RW
PDi_6
Port Pi_6 Direction Bit
RW
0 : Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
RW
RW
RW
RW
PDi_7
Port Pi_7 Direction Bit
RW
NOTES:
1. Make sure the PD7 and PD9 registers are written to by the next instruction after setting the PRC2 bit in the
PRCR register to "1" (write enabled).
2. During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, the PD register for the pins functioning as bus control
pins (A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, ALE, RDY, HOLD, HLDA and BCLK)
cannot be modified.
Port P8 Direction Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PD8
After Reset
00X00000b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
PD8_0
Port P8_0 Direction Bit
PD8_1
Port P8_1 Direction Bit
PD8_2
Port P8_2 Direction Bit
PD8_3
Port P8_3 Direction Bit
RW
PD8_4
Port P8_4 Direction Bit
RW
(b5)
Port P8_6 Direction Bit
PD8_7
Port P8_7 Direction Bit
page 245 of 376
Function
0 : Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, its content is indeterminate.
PD8_6
Figure 20.7 PD0 to PD10 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Address
03F2h
0 : Input mode
(Functions as an input port)
1 : Output mode
(Functions as an output port)
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Port Pi Register (i = 0 to 7, 9, 10) (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P0 to P3
P4 to P7
P9, P10
Bit Symbol
Address
03E0h, 03E1h, 03E4h, 03E5h
03E8h, 03E9h, 03ECh, 03EDh
03F1h, 03F4h
Bit Name
Pi_0
Port Pi_0 Bit
Pi_1
Port Pi_1 Bit
Pi_2
Port Pi_2 Bit
Pi_3
Port Pi_3 Bit
Pi_4
Port Pi_4 Bit
Pi_5
Port Pi_5 Bit
Pi_6
Port Pi_6 Bit
After Reset
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Indeterminate
Function
RW
The pin level on any I/O port which is set
for input mode can be read by reading
the corresponding bit in this register.
The pin level on any I/O port which is
set for output mode can be controlled
by writing to the corresponding bit in
this register.
0 : "L" level
1 : "H" level (2)
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
Pi_7
Port Pi_7 Bit
RW
NOTES:
1. During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, the Pi register for the pins functioning as bus control
pins (A0 to A19, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, RD, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, ALE, RDY, HOLD, HLDA and BCLK)
cannot be modified.
2. Since P7_1 and P9_1 are N channel open-drain ports, the data is high-impedance.
Port P8 Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
P8
Bit symbol
Bit name
P8_0
Port P8 _0 Bit
P8_1
Port P8 _1 Bit
P8_2
Port P8 _2 Bit
P8_3
Port P8 _3 Bit
P8_4
Port P8 _4 Bit
P8_5
Port P8 _5 Bit
P8_6
Port P8 _6 Bit
P8_7
Port P8 _7 Bit
Figure 20.8 P0 to P10 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
Address
03F0h
page 246 of 376
After Reset
Indeterminate
Function
RW
The pin level on any I/O port which is set
for input mode can be read by reading
the corresponding bit in this register.
The pin level on any I/O port which is
set for output mode can be controlled
by writing to the corresponding bit in
this register. (Except for P8_5.)
0 : "L" level
1 : "H" level
RW
RW
RW
RW
RW
RO
RW
RW
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Pull-up Control Register 0 (1)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR0
Bit Symbol
Address
03FCh
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
RW
PU00
P0_0 to P0_3 Pull-Up
PU01
P0_4 to P0_7 Pull-Up
PU02
P1_0 to P1_3 Pull-Up
RW
PU03
P1_4 to P1_7 Pull-Up
RW
PU04
P2_0 to P2_3 Pull-Up
RW
PU05
P2_4 to P2_7 Pull-Up
RW
PU06
P3_0 to P3_3 Pull-Up
RW
PU07
P3_4 to P3_7 Pull-Up
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high (2)
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, the pins are not pulled high although their corresponding
register contents can be modified.
2. The pin for which this bit is "1" (pulled high) and the direction bit is "0" (input mode) is pulled high.
Pull-up Control Register 1
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR1
Bit Symbol
After Reset (1)
00000000b
00000010b
Address
03FDh
Bit Name
Function
RW
PU10
P4_0 to P4_3 Pull-Up (2)
PU11
P4_4 to P4_7 Pull-Up (3)
PU12
P5_0 to P5_3 Pull-Up (2)
RW
PU13
P5_4 to P5_7 Pull-Up (2)
RW
PU14
P6_0 to P6_3 Pull-Up
RW
PU15
P6_4 to P6_7 Pull-Up
RW
PU16
P7_0, P7_2 and P7_3 Pull-Up (4)
RW
PU17
P7_4 to P7_7 Pull-Up
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high (5)
RW
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The values after hardware reset is as follows:
00000000b when input on CNVSS pin is "L".
00000010b when input on CNVSS pin is "H".
The values after software reset, watchdog timer reset and oscillation stop detection reset are as follows:
00000000b when the PM 01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are "00b" (single-chip mode).
00000010b when the PM 01 to PM00 bits are "01b" (memory expansion mode) or "11b" (microprocessor mode).
2. During memory expansion and microprocessor modes, the pins are not pulled high although their corresponding
register contents can be modified.
3. If the PM01 to PM00 bits are set to "01b" (memory expansion mode) or "11b" (microprocessor mode) in a
program during single-chip mode, the PU11 bit becomes "1".
4. The P7_1 pin does not have pull-up.
5. The pin for which this bit is "1" (pulled high) and the direction bit is "0" (input mode) is pulled high.
Pull-up Control Register 2
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PUR2
Bit Symbol
Address
03FEh
After Reset
00h
Bit Name
Function
P8_0 to P8_3 Pull-Up
PU21
P8_4, P8_6 and P8_7 Pull-Up (1)
PU22
P9_0, P9_2 and P9_3 Pull-Up (2)
RW
PU23
P9_4 to P9_7 Pull-Up
RW
PU24
P10_0 to P10_3 Pull-Up
RW
PU25
-
P10_4 to P10_7 Pull-Up
RW
(b7-b6)
0 : Not pulled high
1 : Pulled high (3)
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
NOTES:
1. The P8_5 pin does not have pull-up.
2. The P9_1 pin does not have pull-up.
3. The pin for which this bit is "1" (pulled high) and the direction bit is "0" (input mode) is pulled high.
Figure 20.9 PUR0, PUR1 and PUR2 Registers
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
RW
PU20
page 247 of 376
RW
RW
-
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Port Control Register
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
PCR
Bit Symbol
PCR0
(b7-b1)
Figure 20.10 PCR Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 248 of 376
Address
03FFh
Bit Name
Port P1 Control Bit
After Reset
00h
Function
RW
Operation performed when the P1
register is read
0 : When the port is set for input, the
input levels of P1_0 to P1_7 pins
are read. When set for output, the RW
port latch is read.
1 : The port latch is read regardless of
whether the port is set for input or
output.
Nothing is assigned. When write, set to "0".
When read, their contents are "0".
-
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Table 20.2 Unassigned Pin Handling in Single-chip Mode
Pin Name
Connection
Ports P0 to P7, P8_0 to P8_4, After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS via a resistor (pull-down);
or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open. (1) (2) (3)
P8_6, P8_7, P9, P10
XOUT
(4)
Open
_______
NMI(P8_5)
Connect via resistor to VCC (pull-up)
AVCC
Connect to VCC
Connect to VSS
AVSS, VREF, BYTE
NOTES:
1. When setting the port for output mode and leave it open, be aware that the port remains in input mode until
it is switched to output mode in a program after reset. For this reason, the voltage level on the pin becomes
indeterminate, causing the power supply current to increase while the port remains in input mode.
Furthermore, by considering a possibility that the contents of the direction registers could be changed by
noise or noise-induced runaway, it is recommended that the contents of the direction registers be periodically
reset in software, for the increased reliability of the program.
2. Make sure the unused pins are processed with the shortest possible wiring from the microcomputer pins
(within 2 cm).
3. When the ports P7_1 and P9_1 are set for output mode, make sure a low-level signal is output from the pins.
The ports P7_1 and P9_1 are N-channel open-drain outputs.
4. With external clock input to XIN pin.
Table 20.3 Unassigned Pin Handling in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
Pin Name
Connection
Ports P0 to P7, P8_0 to P8_4, After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS via a resistor (pull-down);
or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open. (1) (2) (3) (4)
P8_6, P8_7, P9, P10
_______
_______
Connect to VCC via a resistor (pulled
high) by setting the PD4 register’s
_____
P4_5/CS1 to P4_7/CS3
________
corresponding
direction bit for CSi (i = 1 to 3) to “0” (input mode) and
_____
the CSi bit in the CSR register to “0” (chip select disabled).
__________
BHE, ALE, HLDA, XOUT
BCLK (6)
___________ ________
(5)
,
Open
_______
HOLD, RDY, NMI(P8_5)
AVCC
AVSS, VREF
NOTES:
Connect via resistor to VCC (pull-up)
Connect to VCC
Connect to VSS
1. When setting the port for output mode and leave it open, be aware that the port remains in input mode until
it is switched to output mode in a program after reset. For this reason, the voltage level on the pin becomes
indeterminate, causing the power supply current to increase while the port remains in input mode.
Furthermore, by considering a possibility that the contents of the direction registers could be changed by
noise or noise-induced runaway, it is recommended that the contents of the direction registers be periodically
reset in software, for the increased reliability of the program.
2. Make sure the unused pins are processed with the shortest possible wiring from the microcomputer pins
(within 2 cm).
3. If the CNVSS pin has the VSS level applied to it, these pins are set for input ports until the processor mode
is switched over in a program after reset. For this reason, the voltage levels on these pins become indeterminate,
causing the power supply current to increase while they remain set for input ports.
4. When the ports P7_1 and P9_1 are set for output mode, make sure a low-level signal is output from the pins.
The ports P7_1 and P9_1 are N-channel open-drain outputs.
5. With external clock input to XIN pin.
6. If the PM07 bit in the PM0 register is set to “1” (BCLK not output), connect this pin to VCC via a resistor
(pulled high).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 249 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
20. Programmable I/O Ports
Microcomputer
Microcomputer
Port P0 to P10 (Input mode)
(except for P8_5)
Port P6 to P10 (Input mode)
(except for P8_5)
(Input mode)
(Output mode)
(Input mode)
Open
VCC
VCC
Port P4_5/CS1
to P4_7/CS3
NMI
XOUT
(Output mode)
Open
NMI
BHE
HLDA
ALE
XOUT
VCC
VCC
Open
BCLK (1)
Open
VCC
AVCC
HOLD
BYTE
RDY
AVSS
AVCC
VREF
AVSS
VREF
VSS
VSS
In single-chip mode
In memory expansion mode or
in microprocessor mode
NOTE:
1.If the PM07 bit in the PM0 register is set to "1" (BCLK not output), connect this pin to VCC via a resistor. (pulled high).
Figure 20.11 Unassigned Pins Handling
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 250 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21. Flash Memory Version
Aside from the built-in flash memory, the flash memory version microcomputer has the same functions as the
masked ROM version.
In the flash memory version, the flash memory can perform in four rewrite mode: CPU rewrite mode, standard
serial I/O mode, parallel I/O mode and CAN I/O mode.
Table 21.1 lists the specifications of the flash memory version. See Table 1.1 Performance outline, for
the items not listed in Table 21.1). Table 21.2 shows the outline of flash memory rewrite mode.
Table 21.1 Flash Memory Version Specifications
Item
Specifications
Flash Memory Operating Mode
Erase Block
User ROM Area
Boot ROM Area
4 modes (CPU rewrite, standard serial I/O, parallel I/O, CAN I/O)
See Figure 21.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram
(1)
Program Method
1 block (4 Kbytes)
In units of word, in units of byte
Erase Method
Program and Erase Control Method
Collective erase, block erase
Program and erase controlled by software command
Protect Method
Number of Commands
Lock bit protects each block
8 commands
Program and Erase Endurance
(3)
ROM Code Protection
(2)
100 times
Parallel I/O , standard serial I/O and CAN I/O modes are supported.
NOTES:
1. The boot ROM area contains a standard serial I/O mode and CAN I/O mode rewrite control program which is stored in
it when shipped from the factory. This area can only be rewritten in parallel I/O mode.
2. Can be programmed in byte units in only parallel I/O mode.
3. Definition of program and erase endurance
The programming and erasure times are defined to be per-block erasure times. For example, assume a case where a 4K-byte
block A is programmed in 2,048 operations by writing one word at a time and erased thereafter. In this case, the block is
reckoned as having been programmed and erased once.
If a product is 100 times of programming and erasure, each block in it can be erased up to 100 times.
Table 21.2 Flash Memory Rewrite Modes Overview
Flash Memory
(1)
Rewrite Mode CPU Rewrite Mode
The user ROM area is
Function
rewritten when the CPU
executes software
commands.
EW0 mode:
Rewrite in areas other
than flash memory (2)
EW1 mode:
Can be rewritten in the
flash memory
Areas which
User ROM area
can be Rewritten
Operation
Single-chip mode
Mode
Memory expansion mode
(EW0 mode)
Boot mode (EW0 mode)
ROM Programmer None
Standard Serial I/O Mode
Parallel I/O Mode
CAN I/O Mode
The user ROM area is
rewritten using a
dedicated serial
programmer.
Standard serial I/O mode 1:
Clock synchronous
serial I/O
Standard serial I/O mode 2:
UART (3)
The boot ROM and user The user ROM area is
ROM areas are rewritten rewritten busing a dedicated
using a dedicated parallel
CAN programmer.
programmer.
User ROM area
User ROM area
Boot mode
User ROM area
Boot ROM area
Parallel I/O mode
Serial programmer
Parallel programmer
CAN programmer
Boot mode
NOTES:
1. The PM13 bit remains set to “1” while the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register = 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled). The PM13 bit
is reverted to its original value by setting the FMR01 bit to “0” (CPU rewrite mode disabled). However, if the PM13 bit is
changed during CPU rewrite mode, its changed value is not reflected until after the FMR01 bit is set to “0”.
2. When in CPU rewrite mode, the PM10 and PM13 bits in the PM1 register are set to “1”. The rewrite control program can
only be executed in the internal RAM or in an external area that is enabled for use when the PM13 bit = 1.
3. When using the standard serial I/O mode 2, make sure a main clock input oscillation frequency is set to 5 MHz, 10 MHz
or 16 MHz.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 251 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.1 Memory Map
The flash memory contains the user ROM area and a boot ROM area. The user ROM area has space to
store the microcomputer operating program in single-chip mode or memory expansion mode and a separate
4-Kbyte space as the block A.
Figure 21.1 shows the block diagram of flash memory.
The user ROM area is divided into several blocks, each of which can individually be protected (locked)
against programming or erasure. The user ROM area can be rewritten in all of CPU rewrite, standard serial
I/O mode, parallel I/O mode and CAN_______
I/O mode. Block A is enabled for use by setting the PM10 bit in the
PM1 register to “1” (block A enabled. CS2 area at addresses 10000h to 26FFFh).
The boot ROM area is located at the same addresses as the user ROM area. It can only be rewritten in
parallel I/O mode (refer to 21.1.1 Boot Mode). A program in the boot ROM area is executed after a hardware
reset occurs while an “H ” signal is applied to the CNVSS and P5_0 pins and an “L” signal is applied to the
P5_5 pin (refer to 21.1.1 Boot Mode). A program in the user ROM area is executed after a hardware reset
occurs while an “L” signal is applied to the CNVSS pin. However, the boot ROM area cannot be read.
00F000h
00FFFFh
Block A: 4 Kbytes (1)
0C0000h
Block 8: 64 Kbytes
0CFFFFh
0D0000h
0F0000h
Block 5: 32 Kbytes
Block 7: 64 Kbytes
0F7FFFh
0F8000h
0DFFFFh
0E0000h
Block 4: 8 Kbytes
Block 6: 64 Kbytes
0F9FFFh
0FA000h
Block 3: 8 Kbytes
0FBFFFh
0FC000h
0EFFFFh
0F0000h
Block 5 to 0
(32+8+8+8+4+4) Kbytes
0FFFFFh
Block 2: 8 Kbytes
0FDFFFh
0FE000h
0FEFFFh
0FF000h
0FFFFFh
Block 1: 4 Kbytes
Block 0: 4 Kbytes
User ROM area
0FF000h
0FFFFFh
4 Kbytes
Boot ROM area (2)
* Shown here is a block diagram during single-chip mode.
NOTES:
1. Block A can be made usable by setting the PM10 bit in the PM1 register to "1" (block A enabled, addresses
10000h to 26FFFh for CS2 area).
Block A cannot be erased by the erase all unlocked block command. Use the block erase command to
erase it.
2. The boot ROM area can only be rewritten in parallel I/O mode.
3. To specify a block, use an even address in that block.
Figure 21.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram
21.1.1 Boot Mode
The microcomputer enters boot mode when a hardware reset occurs while an “H ” signal is applied to the
CNVSS and P5_0 pins and an “L ” signal is applied to the P5_5 pin. A program in the boot ROM area is
executed.
In boot mode, the FMR05 bit in the FMR0 register selects access to the boot ROM area or the user ROM area.
The rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area before shipment.
The boot ROM area can be rewritten in parallel I/O mode only. If any rewrite control program using erasewrite mode (EW0 mode) is written in the boot ROM area, the flash memory can be rewritten according to
the system implemented.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 252 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting
The flash memory has a built-in ROM code protect function for parallel I/O mode and a built-in ID code
check function for standard serial I/O mode and CAN I/O mode to prevent the flash memory from reading or
rewriting.
21.2.1 ROM Code Protect Function
The ROM code protect function inhibits the flash memory from being read or rewritten during parallel I/O
mode. Figure 21.2 shows the ROMCP register. The ROMCP register is located in the user ROM area.
The ROM code protect function is enabled when the ROMCR bits are set to other than “11b ”. In this case,
set the bit 5 to bit 0 to “111111b ”.
When exiting ROM code protect, erase the block including the ROMCP register by the CPU rewrite mode
or the standard serial I/O mode or CAN I/O mode.
21.2.2 ID Code Check Function
Use the ID code check function in standard serial I/O mode and CAN I/O mode. The ID code sent from the
serial programmer is compared with the ID code written in the flash memory for a match. If the ID codes
do not match, commands sent from the serial programmer are not accepted. However, if the four bytes of
the reset vector are “FFFFFFFFh”, ID codes are not compared, allowing all commands to be accepted.
The ID codes are 7-byte data stored consecutively, starting with the first byte, into addresses 0FFFDFh,
0FFFE3h, 0FFFEBh, 0FFFEFh, 0FFFF3h, 0FFFF7h, and 0FFFFBh. The flash memory must have a
program with the ID codes set in these addresses.
Figure 21.3 shows the ID code store addresses.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 253 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
ROM Code Protect Control Address (5)
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
ROMCP
1 1 1 1 1 1
Bit Symbol
(b5-b0)
Address
0FFFFFh
Value when Shipped
FFh (1)
Bit Name
Reserved Bit
Function
Set to "1"
RW
RW
b7 b6
ROMCP1
ROM Code Protect Level 1
Set Bit (1) (2) (3) (4)
00:
0 1 : Protect enabled
10:
1 1 : Protect disabled
RW
RW
NOTES:
1. The ROMCP address is set to "FFh" when a block, including the ROMCP address, is erased.
2. When the ROM code protection is active by the ROMCP1 bit setting, the flash memory is protected against
reading or rewriting in parallel I/O mode.
3. Set the bit 5 to bit 0 to "111111b" when the ROMCP1 bit is set to a value other than "11b".
If the bit 5 to bit 0 are set to values other than "111111b", the ROM code protection may not become active
by setting the ROMCP1 bit to a value other than "11b".
4. To make the ROM code protection inactive, erase a block including the ROMCP address in CPU rewrite
mode, standard serial I/O mode or CAN I/O mode.
5. When a value of the ROMCPaddress is "00h" or "FFh", the ROM code protect function is disabled.
Figure 21.2 ROMCP Register
Address
0FFFDFh to 0FFFDCh
ID1
Undefined instruction vector
0FFFE3h to 0FFFE0h
ID2
Overflow vector
BRK instruction vector
0FFFE7h to 0FFFE4h
0FFFEBh to 0FFFE8h
ID3
Address match vector
0FFFEFh to 0FFFECh
ID4
Single step vector
0FFFF3h to 0FFFF0h
ID5
Oscillation stop and re-oscillation detection/Watchdog timer vector
0FFFF7h to 0FFFF4h
ID6
DBC vector
0FFFFBh to 0FFFF8h
ID7
NMI vector
0FFFFFh to 0FFFFCh ROMCP Reset vector
4 bytes
Figure 21.3 Address for ID Code Stored
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 254 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3 CPU Rewrite Mode
In CPU rewrite mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten when the CPU executes software commands.
The user ROM area can be rewritten with the microcomputer is mounted on a board without using a parallel,
serial or CAN programmer.
In CPU rewrite mode, only the user ROM area shown in Figure 21.1 can be rewritten. The boot ROM area
cannot be rewritten. Program and the block erase command are executed only in the user ROM area.
Erase-write 0 (EW0) mode and erase-write 1 (EW1) mode are provided as CPU rewrite mode.
Table 21.3 lists the differences between EW0 and EW1 modes.
Table 21.3 EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode
Item
Operation Mode
Space where Rewrite
Control Program can be
Placed
Space where Rewrite
Control Program can be
Executed
Space which can be
Rewritten
Software Command
Restriction
Modes after Program or
Erasing
CPU Status during Auto
Write and Auto Erase
Flash Memory Status
Detection
EW0 Mode
• Single-chip mode
• Memory expansion mode
• Boot mode
• User ROM area
• Boot ROM area
EW1 Mode
Single chip mode
User ROM area
The rewrite control program must be The rewrite control program can be
transferred to any space other than the executed in the user ROM area
flash memory (e.g., RAM) before being
executed (2)
User ROM area
User ROM area
However, this excludes blocks with the
rewrite control program
None
• Program and block erase commands
cannot be executed in a block having
the rewrite control program.
• Erase all unlocked block command
cannot be executed when the lock bit in
a block having the rewrite control program
is set to “1” (unlocked) or when the
FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set
to “1” (lock bit disabled).
• Read status register command cannot
be used
Read status register mode
Read array mode
Operating
Maintains hold state (I/O ports maintains
the state before the command was
executed) (1)
•Read the FMR00, FMR06 and FMR07 Read the FMR00, FMR06 and FMR07
bits in the FMR0 register by program bits in the FMR0 register by program
•Execute the read status register
command to read the SR7, SR5, and
SR4 bits in the status register
NOTES:
_______
1. Do not generate an interrupts (except NMI interrupt) and DMA transfer.
2. When in CPU rewrite mode, the PM10 and PM13 bits in the PM1 register are set to “1”. The rewrite
control program can only be executed in the internal RAM or in an external area that is enabled for use
when the PM13 bit = 1.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 255 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.1 EW0 Mode
The microcomputer enters CPU rewrite mode by setting the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to “1” (CPU
rewrite mode enabled) and is ready to accept commands. EW0 mode is selected by setting the FMR11 bit
in the FMR1 register to “0”. To set the FMR01 bit to “1”, set to “1” after first writing “0”.
The software commands control programming and erasing. The FMR0 register or the status register
indicates whether a program or erase operation is completed as expected or not.
21.3.2 EW1 Mode
EW1 mode is selected by setting FMR11 bit to “1” (by writing “0” and then “1” in succession) after setting
the FMR01 bit to “1” (by writing “0” and then “1” in succession). (Both bits must be set to “0” first before
setting to “1”.)
The FMR0 register indicates whether or not a program or erase operation has been completed as
expected. The status register cannot be read in EW1 mode.
When an erase/program operation is initiated the CPU halts all program execution until the operation is
completed or erase-suspend is requested.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 256 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.3 FMR0, FMR1 Registers
Figure 21.4 shows FMR0 and FMR1 registers.
Flash Memory Control Register 0
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
FMR0
01B7h
00000001b
Bit Symbol
Bit Name
Function
RW
FMR00
RY/BY Status Flag
0 : Busy (being written or erased) (1)
1 : Ready
FMR01
CPU Rewrite Mode
Select Bit (2)
0 : Disables CPU rewrite mode
1 : Enables CPU rewrite mode
RW
FMR02
Lock Bit Disable Select
Bit (3)
0: Enables lock bit
1: Disables lock bit
RW
FMSTP
Flash Memory Stop
Bit (4) (5)
0 Enables flash memory operation
1: Stops flash memory operation
(placed in low power dissipation mode,
flash memory initialized)
RW
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
-
(b4)
RO
FMR05
User ROM Area Select
0 : Boot ROM area is accessed
Bit (4)
1 : User ROM area is accessed
(Effective in only boot mode)
FMR06
Program Status Flag (6)
0 : Terminated normally
1 : Terminated in error
RO
FMR07
Erase Status Flag (6)
0 : Terminated normally
1 : Terminated in error
RO
RW
NOTES:
1.This status includes writing or reading with the lock bit program or read lock bit status command.
2. To set this bit to "1", write "0" and then "1" in succession. Make sure no interrupts or no DMA transfers will occur
before writing "1" after writing "0".
Write to this bit when the NMI pin is in the high state. Also, while in EW0 mode, write to this bit from a program in
other than the flash memory.
To set this bit to "0", in a read array mode.
3. To set this bit to "1", write "0" and then "1" in succession when the FMR01 bit = 1. Make sure no interrupts or no DMA
transfers will occur before writing "1" after writing "0".
4. Write to this bit from a program in other than the flash memory.
5. Effective when the FMR01 bit = 1 (CPU rewrite mode). If the FMR01 bit = 0, although the FMSTP bit can be set to
"1" by writing "1" in a program, the flash memory is neither placed in low power dissipation state nor initialized.
6. This bit is set to "0" by executing the clear status command.
Flash Memory Control Register 1
b7
0
b6
b5
b4
0
0
b3
b2
b1
b0
Symbol
Address
After Reset
FMR1
01B5h
0X00XX0Xb
Bit Symbol
-
(b0)
FMR11
-
(b3-b2)
-
(b5-b4)
FMR16
-
(b7)
Bit Name
Function
RW
Reserved Bit
The value in this bit when read is
indeterminate.
RO
EW1 Mode Select Bit (1)
0 : EW0 mode
1 : EW1 mode
RW
Reserved Bit
The value in this bit when read is
indeterminate.
RO
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
Lock Bit Status Flag
0 : Lock
1 : Unlock
RO
Reserved Bit
Set to "0"
RW
NOTE:
1. To set this bit to "1", write "0" and then "1" in succession when the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register = 1. Make sure no
interrupts or no DMA transfers will occur before writing "1" after writing "0".
Write to this bit when the NMI pin is in the high state.
The FMR01 and FMR11 bits both are set to "0" by setting the FMR01 bit to "0".
Figure 21.4 FMR0 Register and FMR1 Register
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 257 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.3.1 FMR00 Bit
This bit indicates the flash memory operating status. It is set to “0” while the program, block erase, erase
all unlocked block, lock bit program, or read lock bit status command is being executed; otherwise, it is
set to “1”.
21.3.3.2 FMR01 Bit
The microcomputer can accept commands when the FMR01 bit is set to “1” (CPU rewrite mode). Set the
FMR05 bit to “1” (user ROM area access) as well if in boot mode.
21.3.3.3 FMR02 Bit
The lock bit is disabled by setting the FMR02 bit to “1” (lock bit disabled). (Refer to 21.3.6 Data Protect
Function.) The lock bit is enabled by setting the FMR02 bit to “0” (lock bit enabled).
The FMR02 bit does not change the lock bit status but disables the lock bit function. If the block erase or
erase all unlocked block command is executed when the FMR02 bit is set to “1”, the lock bit status
changes “0” (locked) to “1” (unlocked) after command execution is completed.
21.3.3.4 FMSTP Bit
This bit resets the flash memory control circuits and minimizes power consumption in the flash memory.
Access to the flash memory is disabled when the FMSTP bit is set to “1”. Set the FMSTP bit by program
in a space other than the flash memory.
Set the FMSTP bit to “1” if one of the followings occurs:
• A flash memory access error occurs while erasing or programming in EW0 mode (FMR00 bit does not
switch back to “1” (ready))
• Low power dissipation mode or on-chip oscillator low power dissipation mode is entered
Use the following the procedure to change the FMSTP bit setting.
(1) Set the FMSTP bit to “1”
(2) Set tps (the wait time to stabilize flash memory circuit)
(3) Set the FMSTP bit to “0”
(4) Set tps (the wait time to stabilize flash memory circuit)
Figure 21.7 shows a flow chart illustrating how to start and stop the flash memory processing before and
after low power dissipation mode or on-chip oscillator low power dissipation mode. Follow the procedure
on this flow chart.
When entering stop or wait mode, the flash memory is automatically turned off. When exiting stop or wait
mode, the flash memory is turned back on. The FMR0 register does not need to be set.
21.3.3.5 FMR05 Bit
This bit selects the boot ROM or user ROM area in boot mode. Set to “0” to access (read) the boot ROM
area or to “1” (user ROM access) to access (read, write or erase) the user ROM area.
21.3.3.6 FMR06 Bit
This is a read-only bit indicating an auto program operation state. The FMR06 bit is set to “1” when a
program error occurs; otherwise, it is set to “0”. Refer to 21.3.8 Full Status Check.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 258 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.3.7 FMR07 Bit
This is a read-only bit indicating the auto erase operation status. The FMR07 bit is set to “1” when an
erase error occurs; otherwise, it is set to “0”. For details, refer to 21.3.8 Full Status Check.
21.3.3.8 FMR11 Bit
EW0 mode is entered by setting the FMR11 bit to “0” (EW0 mode).
EW1 mode is entered by setting the FMR11 bit to “1” (EW1 mode).
21.3.3.9 FMR16 Bit
This is a read-only bit indicating the execution result of the read lock bit status command. When the
block, where the read lock bit status command is executed, is locked, the FMR16 bit is set to “0”.
When the block, where the read lock bit status command is executed, is unlocked, the FMR16 bit is set
to “1”.
Figure 21.5 shows setting and resetting of EW0 mode. Figure 21.6 show setting and resetting of EW1
mode.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 259 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
Procedure to enter EW0 mode
Rewrite control program
Single-chip mode, memory expansion mode
or boot mode
In boot mode only
set the FMR05 bit to "1" (user ROM area access)
Transfer the rewrite control program in CPU rewrite
mode to a space other than the flash memory (5)
Set the FMR01 bit to "1" (CPU rewrite mode
enabled) after writing "0" (2)
Set CM0, CM1, and PM1 registers (1)
Execute software commands
Jump to the rewrite control program transferred to
a space other than the flash memory.
(In the following steps, use the rewrite control
program in a space other than the flash memory.)
Execute the read array command (3)
Set the FMR01 bit to "0"
(CPU rewrite mode disabled)
In boot mode only
Set the FMR05 bit to "0" (Boot ROM area
accessed) (4)
Jump to a desired address in the flash memory
NOTES:
1.In CPU rewrite mode, set the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and CM17 to CM16 bits in the CM1 register to CPU
clock frequency of 10 MHz or less. Set the PM17 bit in the PM1 register to "1" (with wait state).
2.Set the FMR01 bit to "1" immediately after setting it to "0". Do not generate an interrupts or DMA transfer between
setting the bit to "0" and setting it to "1".
Set the bit to "0" if setting to "0". Set this bit in a space other than the flash memory while the NMI pin is held "H".
3.Exit CPU rewrite mode after executing the read array command.
4.When CPU rewrite mode is exited while the FMR05 bit is set to "1", the user ROM area can be accessed.
5.When in CPU rewrite mode, the PM10 and PM13 bits in the PM1 register are set to "1". The rewrite control program
can only be executed in the internal RAM or in an external area that is enabled for use when the PM13 bit = 1.
Figure 21.5 Setting and Resetting of EW0 Mode
Procedure to enter EW1 mode
Program in the ROM
Single-chip mode (1)
Set CM0, CM1, and PM1 registers (2)
Set the FMR01 bit to "1" (CPU rewrite mode
enabled) after writing "0"
Set the FMR11 bit to "1" (EW1 mode) after
writing "0" (EW1 mode) (3)
Execute the software commands
Set the FMR01 bit to "0"
(CPU rewrite mode disabled)
NOTES:
1.In EW1 mode, do not enter the memory expansion mode or boot mode.
2.In CPU rewrite mode, set the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and the CM17 to CM16 bits in the CM1 register to
CPU clock frequency of 10.0 MHz or less. Set the PM17 bit in the PM1 register to "1" (with wait state).
3.Set the FMR01 bit to "1" immediately after setting it to "0". Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA transfer
between setting the bit to "0" and setting it to "1".
Set the FMR11 bit to "1" immediately after setting it to "0" while the FMR01 bit is set to "1".
Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA transfer between setting the FMR11 bit to "0" and setting it to "1".
Set the FMR01 and FMR11 bits while "H" is applied to the NMI pin.
Figure 21.6 Setting and Resetting of EW1 Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 260 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
Low power dissipation mode
or on-chip oscillator low power
dissipation mode program
Transfer a low power dissipation mode or on-chip
oscillator low power dissipation mode program to
a space other the flash memory
Jump to the low power dissipation mode or on-chip
oscillator low power dissipation mode program
transferred to a space other than the flash memory
(In the following steps, use the low power dissipation
mode in a space other than the flash memory.)
Set the FMR01 bit to "1" after setting it to "0"
(CPU rewrite mode enabled)
Set the FMSTP bit to "1" (the flash memory stops
operating. It is in a low power dissipation state) (1)
Switch the clock source of the CPU clock.
Turn main clock stops. (2)
Process in low power dissipation mode or
on-chip oscillator low power dissipation mode (4)
Start
Wait
Switch
> until oscillation > clock source of
main clock oscillation
stabilizes
the CPU clock (2)
Set the FMSTP bit to "0" (flash memory operation)
Set the FMR01 bit to "0"
(CPU rewrite mode disabled)
Wait until the flash memory circuit
stabilizes (tps µs) (3)
Jump to a desired address in the flash memory
NOTES:
1.Set the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register to "1" after setting the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to "1" (CPU rewrite mode).
2.Wait until clock stabilizes to switch clock source of the CPU clock to the main clock or sub clock.
3.Add tps µs wait time by program. Do not access the flash memory during this wait time.
4.Before entering wait mode or stop mode, be sure to set the FMR01 bit to "0" (CPU rewrite disabled).
Figure 21.7 Processing Before and After Low Power Dissipation Mode or On-chip Oscillator Low
Power Dissipation Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 261 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.4 Precautions on CPU Rewrite Mode
21.3.4.1 Operating Speed
Set the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and the CM17 to CM16 bits in the CM1 register to clock frequency
of 10 MHz or less before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 or EW1 mode). Also, set the PM17 bit in the
PM1 register to “1” (with wait state).
21.3.4.2 Prohibited Instructions
The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because the CPU tries to read data in flash
memory: UND instruction, INTO instruction, JMPS instruction, JSRS instruction, and BRK instruction
21.3.4.3 Interrupts (EW0 Mode)
• To use interrupts having vectors in a relocatable vector table, the vectors must be relocated to the RAM
area._______
• The NMI and watchdog timer interrupts are available since the FMR0 and FMR1 registers are forcibly
reset when either interrupt request is generated. Allocate the jump addresses for each_______
interrupt service
routines to the fixed vector table. Flash memory rewrite operation is aborted when the NMI or watchdog
timer interrupt request is generated. Execute the rewrite program again after exiting the interrupt routine.
• The address match interrupt is not available since the CPU tries to read data in the flash memory.
21.3.4.4 Interrupts (EW1 Mode)
• Do not acknowledge any interrupts with vectors in the relocatable vector table or address match interrupt
during the auto program or auto erase period.
• Do not
use the watchdog timer interrupt.
_______
• The NMI interrupt is available since the FMR0 and FMR1 registers are forcibly reset when the interrupt
request is generated. Allocate the jump address for the_______
interrupt service routine to the fixed vector table.
Flash memory rewrite operation is aborted when the NMI interrupt request is generated. Execute the
rewrite program again after exiting the interrupt service routine.
21.3.4.5 How to Access
To set the FMR01, FMR02 or FMR11 bit to “1”, write “1” after first setting the bit to “0”. Do not generate
an interrupt or a DMA transfer between the instruction _______
to set the bit to “0” and the instruction to set the bit
to “1”. Set the bit while an “H” signal is applied to the NMI pin.
21.3.4.6 Rewriting in User ROM Area (EW0 Mode)
The supply voltage drops while rewriting the block where the rewrite control program is stored, the flash
memory cannot be rewritten because the rewrite control program is not correctly rewritten. If this error
occurs, rewrite the user ROM area while in standard serial I/O mode or parallel I/O mode or CAN I/O
mode.
21.3.4.7 Rewriting in User ROM Area (EW1 Mode)
Avoid rewriting any block in which the rewrite control program is stored.
21.3.4.8 DMA Transfer
In EW1 mode, do not perform a DMA transfer while the FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register is set to “0” (auto
programming or auto erasing).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 262 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.4.9 Writing Command and Data
Write commands and data to even addresses in the user ROM area.
21.3.4.10 Wait Mode
When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to “0” (CPU rewrite mode disabled)
before executing the WAIT instruction.
21.3.4.11 Stop Mode
When the microcomputer enters stop mode, execute the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to “1” (stop
mode) after setting the FMR01 bit to “0” (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and disabling the DMA transfer.
21.3.4.12 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode
If the CM05 bit is set to “1” (main clock stopped), do not execute the following commands:
• Program
• Block erase
• Erase all unlocked blocks
• Lock bit program
• Read lock bit status
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 263 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.5 Software Commands
Software commands are described below. The command code and data must be read and written in 16-bit
unit, to and from even addresses in the user ROM area. When writing command code, the high-order 8
bits (D15 to D8) are ignored.
Table 21.4 lists the software commands.
Table 21.4 Software Commands
First Bus Cycle
Software Command
Read Array
Read Status Register
Clear Status Register
Program
Block Erase
Erase All Unlocked Block
(1)
Lock Bit Program
Mode
Write
Write
Write
Write
Write
Write
Write
Write
Data
Address (D15 to D0)
✕
xxFFh
xx70h
✕
xx50h
✕
xx40h
WA
xx20h
✕
xxA7h
✕
xx77h
BA
xx71h
✕
Second Bus Cycle
Data
Mode
Address (D15 to D0)
Read
Write
Write
Write
Write
Write
✕
WA
BA
✕
BA
SRD
WD
xxD0h
xxD0h
xxD0h
xxD0h
Read Lock Bit Status
BA
SRD:data in SRD register (D7 to D0)
WA: Address to be written (The address specified in the first bus cycle is the same even address as the
address specified in the second bus cycle.)
WD: 16-bit write data
BA: Highest-order block address (must be an even address)
✕: Any even address in the user ROM area
xx: High-order 8 bits of command code (ignored)
NOTE
1. It is only blocks 0 to 8 that can be erased by the erase all unlocked block command.
Block A cannot be erased. The block erase command must be used to erase the block A.
21.3.5.1 Read Array Command (FFh)
The read array command reads the flash memory.
By writing command code “xxFFh” in the first bus cycle, read array mode is entered. Content of a
specified address can be read in 16-bit unit after the next bus cycle.
The microcomputer remains in read array mode until another command is written. Therefore, contents
from multiple addresses can be read consecutively.
21.3.5.2 Read Status Register Command (70h)
The read status register command reads the status register (refer to 21.3.7 Status Register (SRD
Register) for detail).
By writing command code “xx70h” in the first bus cycle, the status register can be read in the second bus
cycle. Read an even address in the user ROM area.
Do not execute this command in EW1 mode.
21.3.5.3 Clear Status Register Command (50h)
The clear status register command clears the status register.
By writing “xx50h” in the first bus cycle, the FMR07, FMR06 bits in the FMR0 register are set to “00b”
and the SR5, SR4 bits in the status register are set to “00b”.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 264 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.5.4 Program Command (40h)
The program command writes 2-byte data to the flash memory.
By writing “xx40h” in the first bus cycle and data to the write address in the second bus cycle, an auto
program operation (data program and verify) will start. The address value specified in the first bus cycle
must be the same even address as the write address specified in the second bus cycle.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether an auto program operation has been completed.
The FMR00 bit is set to “0” (busy) during auto program and to “1” (ready) when an auto program operation
is completed.
After the completion of an auto program operation, the FMR06 bit in the FMR0 register indicates
whether or not the auto program operation has been completed as expected. (Refer to 21.3.8 Full
Status Check.)
An address that is already written cannot be altered or rewritten.
Figure 21.8 shows a flow chart of the program command programming.
The lock bit protects each block from being programmed inadvertently. (Refer to 21.3.6 Data Protect
Function.)
In EW1 mode, do not execute this command on the block where the rewrite control program is allocated.
In EW0 mode, the microcomputer enters read status register mode as soon as an auto program operation
starts. The status register can be read. The SR7 bit in the status register is set to “0” at the same time an
auto program operation starts. It is set to “1” when auto program operation is completed. The microcomputer
remains in read status register mode until the read array command is written. After completion of an auto
program operation, the status register indicates whether or not the auto program operation has been
completed as expected.
Start
Write the command code "xx40h"
to an address to be the written
Write data to an address
to be written
FMR00=1?
NO
YES
Full status check
Program operation is
completed
NOTE:
1.Write the command code and data to even addresses.
Figure 21.8 Program Command
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 265 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.5.5 Block Erase Command
The block erase command erases each block.
By writing “xx20h” in the first bus cycle and “xxD0h” to the highest-order even address of a block in the
second bus cycle, an auto erase operation (erase and verify) will start in the specified block.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether an auto erase operation has been completed.
The FMR00 bit is set to “0” (busy) during auto erase and to “1” (ready) when the auto erase operation is
completed.
After the completion of an auto erase operation, the FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether
or not the auto erase operation has been completed as expected. (Refer to 21.3.8 Full Status Check.)
Figure 21.9 shows a flow chart of the block erase command programming.
The lock bit protects each block from being programmed inadvertently. (Refer to 21.3.6 Data Protect
Function.)
In EW1 mode, do not execute this command on the block where the rewrite control program is allocated.
In EW0 mode, the microcomputer enters read status register mode as soon as an auto erase operation
starts. The status register can be read. The SR7 bit in the status register is set to “0” at the same time an
auto erase operation starts. It is set to “1” when an auto erase operation is completed. The microcomputer
remains in read status register mode until the read array command or read lock bit status command is
written. Also execute the clear status register command and block erase command at least 3 times until
an erase error is not generated when an erase error is generated.
Start
Write the command code "xx20h"
Write "xxD0h" to the highest-order
block address
FMR00=1?
NO
YES
Full status check (2) (3)
Block erase operation is
completed
NOTES:
1.Write the command code and data to even addresses.
2.Refer to Figure 21.12 Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Each Error.
3.Execute the clear status register command and block erase command at least 3 times
until an erase error is not generated when an erase error is generated.
Figure 21.9 Block Erase Command
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 266 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.5.6 Erase All Unlocked Block
The erase all unlocked block command erases all blocks except the block A.
By writing “xxA7h” in the first bus cycle and “xxD0h” in the second bus cycle, an auto erase (erase and
verify) operation will run continuously in all blocks except the block A.
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether an auto erase operation has been completed.
After the completion of an auto erase operation, the FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether
or not the auto erase operation has been completed as expected.
The lock bit can protect each block from being programmed inadvertently. (Refer to 21.3.6 Data Protect
Function.)
In EW1 mode, do not execute this command when the lock bit for any block storing the rewrite control
program is set to “1” (unlocked) or when the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to “1” (lock bit
disabled).
In EW0 mode, the microcomputer enters read status register mode as soon as an auto erase operation
starts. The status register can be read. The SR7 bit in the status register is set to “0” (busy) at the same
time an auto erase operation starts. It is set to “1” (ready) when an auto erase operation is completed.
The microcomputer remains in read status register mode until the read array command or read lock bit
status command is written.
Only blocks 0 to 8 can be erased by the erase all unlocked block command. The block A cannot be
erased. Use the block erase command to erase the block A.
21.3.5.7 Lock Bit Program Command
The lock bit program command sets the lock bit for a specified block to “0” (locked).
By writing “xx77h” in the first bus cycle and “xxD0h” to the highest-order even address of a block in the
second bus cycle, the lock bit for the specified block is set to “0”. The address value specified in the first bus
cycle must be the same highest-order even address of a block specified in the second bus cycle.
Figure 21.10 shows a flow chart of the lock bit program command programming. Execute read lock bit
status command to read lock bit state (lock bit data).
The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register indicates whether a lock bit program operation is completed.
Refer to 21.3.6 Data Protect Function for details on lock bit functions and how to set it to “1” (unlocked).
Start
Write command code "xx77h" to
the highest-order block address
Write "xxD0h" to the highest-order
block address
FMR00=1?
NO
YES
Full status check
Lock bit program operation
is completed
NOTE:
1.Write the command code and data to even addresses.
Figure 21.10 Lock Bit Program Command
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 267 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.5.8 Read Lock Bit Status Command (71h)
The read lock bit status command reads the lock bit state of a specified block.
By writing “xx71h” in the first bus cycle and “xxD0h” to the highest-order even address of a block in the
second bus cycle, the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register stores information on whether or not the lock bit
of a specified block is locked. Read the FMR16 bit after the FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register is set to “1”
(ready).
Figure 21.11 shows a flow chart of the read lock bit status command programming.
Start
Write the command code "xx71h"
Write "xxD0h" to the highest-order
block address
FMR00=1?
NO
YES
FMR16=0?
NO
YES
Block is locked
Block is not locked
NOTE:
1.Write the command code and data to even addresses.
Figure 21.11 Read Lock Bit Status Command
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 268 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.6 Data Protect Function
Each block in the flash memory has a nonvolatile lock bit. The lock bit is enabled by setting the FMR02 bit
in the FMR0 register to “0” (lock bit enabled). The lock bit allows each block to be individually protected
(locked) against program and erase. This helps prevent data from being inadvertently written to or erased
from the flash memory.
• When the lock bit status is set to “0”, the block is locked (block is protected against program and erase).
• When the lock bit status is set to “1”, the block is not locked (block can be programmed or erased).
The lock bit status is set to “0” (locked) by executing the lock bit program command and to “1” (unlocked)
by erasing the block. The lock bit status cannot be set to “1” by any commands.
The lock bit status can be read by the read lock bit status command.
The lock bit function is disabled by setting the FMR02 bit to “1”. All blocks are unlocked. However,
individual lock bit status remains unchanged. The lock bit function is enabled by setting the FMR02 bit to
“0”. Lock bit status is retained.
If the block erase or erase all unlocked block command is executed while the FMR02 bit is set to “1”, the
target block or all blocks are erased regardless of lock bit status. The lock bit status of each block are set
to “1” after an erase operation is completed.
Refer to 21.3.5 Software Commands for details on each command.
21.3.7 Status Register (SRD Register)
The status register indicates the flash memory operation state and whether or not an erase or program
operation is completed as expected. The FMR00, FMR06 and FMR07 bits in the FMR0 register indicate
status register states.
Table 21.5 shows the status register.
In EW0 mode, the status register can be read when the followings occur.
• Any even address in the user ROM area is read after writing the read status register command
• Any even address in the user ROM area is read from when the program, block erase, erase all unlocked
block, or lock bit program command is executed until when the read array command is executed.
21.3.7.1 Sequencer Status (SR7 and FMR00 Bits)
The sequence status indicates the flash memory operation state. It is set to “0” while the program, block
erase, erase all unlocked block, lock bit program, or read lock bit status command is being executed;
otherwise, it is set to “1”.
21.3.7.2 Erase Status (SR5 and FMR07 Bits)
Refer to 21.3.8 Full Status Check.
21.3.7.3 Program Status (SR4 and FMR06 Bits)
Refer to 21.3.8 Full Status Check.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 269 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
Table 21.5 Status Register
Bits in Status Bits in FMR0
Register
Register
Status Name
SR0 (D0)
-
Reserved
SR1 (D1)
-
Reserved
SR2 (D2)
-
SR3 (D3)
-
Reserved
Reserved
SR4 (D4)
SR5 (D5)
FMR06
FMR07
Program status
SR6 (D6)
-
Reserved
Erase status
Contents
Value after
Reset
“0”
“1”
0
Terminated normally Terminated in error
0
Terminated normally Terminated in error
Busy
Ready
1
SR7 (D7) FMR00
Sequencer status
D0 to D7: These data bus are read when the read status register command is executed.
NOTE:
1. The FMR06 bit (SR4) and FMR07 bit (SR5) are set to “0” by executing the clear status register command.
When the FMR06 bit (SR4) or FMR07 bit (SR5) is set to “1”, the program, block erase, erase all
unlocked block, and lock bit program commands are not accepted.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 270 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.3.8 Full Status Check
If an error occurs when a program or erase operation is completed, the FMR06, FMR07 bits in the FMR0
register are set to “1”, indicating a specific error. Therefore, execution results can be confirmed by checking these bits (full status check).
Table 21.6 lists errors and FMR0 register state. Figure 21.12 shows a flow chart of the full status check
and handling procedure for each error.
Table 21.6 Errors and FMR0 Register Status
FRM00 Register
(Status Register)
Status
Error
FMR07 bit FMR06 bit
(SR5)
(SR4)
1
1
Command
Error Occurrence Conditions
• Command is written incorrectly
Sequence
error
• A value other than “xxD0h” or “xxFFh” is written in the second
bus cycle of the lock bit program, block erase or erase all
0
Erase error
unlocked block command
• The block erase command is executed on a locked block
1
• The block erase or erase all unlocked block command is
executed on an unlock block and auto erase operation is not
completed as expected
(2)
Program error • The program command is executed on locked blocks
(1)
1
0
(2)
• The program command is executed on unlocked blocks but
program operation is not completed as expected
• The lock bit program command is executed but program
operation is not completed as expected
NOTES:
1. The flash memory enters read array mode by writing command code “xxFFh” in the second bus cycle of
these commands. The command code written in the first bus cycle becomes invalid.
2. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to “1” (lock bit disabled), no error occurs even under
the conditions above.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 271 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
Full status check
FMR06 =1
and
FMR07=1?
YES
Command
sequence error
(1) Execute the clear status register command and set the SR4 and SR5
bits to "0" (completed as expected).
(2) Rewrite command and execute again.
Erase error
(1) Execute the clear status register command and set the SR5 bit to "0".
(2) Execute the lock bit read status command. Set the FMR02 bit in the
FMR0 register to "1" (lock bit disabled) if the lock bit in the block where
the error occurred is set to "0" (locked).
(3) Execute the block erase or erase all unlocked block command again.
(4) Execute (1), (2) and (3) at least 3 times until an erase error is not
generated.
NO
FMR07=0?
NO
YES
NOTE: If similar error occurs, that block cannot be used.
If the lock bit is set to "1" (unlocked) in (2) above, that block cannot
be used.
NO
FMR06=0?
Program error
YES
[When a program operation is executed]
(1) Execute the clear status register command and set the SR4 bit to "0"
(completed as expected).
(2) Execute the read lock bit status command and set the FMR02 bit to "1"
if the lock bit in the block where the error occurred is set to "0".
(3) Execute the program command again.
NOTE: When a similar error occurs, that block cannot be used.
If the lock bit is set to "1" in (2) above, that block cannot be used.
[When a lock bit program operation is executed]
(1) Execute the clear status register command and set the SR4 bit to "0".
(2) Set the FMR02 bit to "1".
(3) Execute the block erase command to erase the block where the error
occurred.
(4) Execute the lock bit program command again.
NOTE: If similar error occurs, that block cannot be used.
Full status check completed
FMR06, FMR07: Bits in FMR0 register
NOTE:
1. When either FMR06 or FMR07 bit is set to "1" (terminated by error), the program, block erase, erase all unlocked block, lock bit program
and read lock bit status commands cannot be accepted.
Execute the clear status register command before each command.
Figure 21.12 Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Each Error
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 272 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.4 Standard Serial I/O Mode
In standard serial I/O mode, the serial programmer supporting the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) can be used
to rewrite the flash memory user ROM area in the microcomputer mounted on a board. For more information
about the serial programmer, contact your serial programmer manufacturer. Refer to the user's manual
included with your serial programmer for instructions.
Table 21.7 lists pin functions for standard serial I/O mode. Figures 21.13 and 21.14 show pin connections
for standard serial I/O mode.
21.4.1 ID Code Check Function
The ID code check function determines whether the ID codes sent from the serial programmer matches
those written in the flash memory. (Refer to 21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting.)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 273 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
Table 21.7 Pin Functions for Standard Serial I/O Mode
Pin
VCC1, VCC2, VSS
Name
Description
I/O
Power supply
Apply the Flash Program, Erase Voltage to VCC1 pin and VCC2 to
input
VCC2 pin. The VCC apply condition is that VCC2 = VCC1.
Apply 0 V to VSS pin.
CNVSS
I
Connect to VCC1 pin.
RESET
Reset input
I
Reset input pin. While RESET pin is "L" level, input 20 cycles or
longer clock to XIN pin.
XIN
Clock input
I
XOUT
Clock output
O
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between XIN and
XOUT pins. To input an externally generated clock, input it to XIN
BYTE
BYTE
I
AVCC, AVSS
Analog power
supply input
VREF
Reference
voltage input
I
P0_0 to P0_7
Input port P0
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P1_0 to P1_7
Input port P1
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P2_0 to P2_7
Input port P2
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P3_0 to P3_7
Input port P3
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P4_0 to P4_7
Input port P4
CNVSS
_____________
_____________
pin and open XOUT pin.
Connect this pin to VCC1 or VSS.
Connect AVCC to VCC1 and AVSS to VSS, respectively.
Enter the reference voltage for A/D and D/A converters from this
pin.
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P5_0
CE input
I
Input “H” level signal.
P5_1 to P5_4,
Input port P5
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
I
Input “L” level signal.
Input port P6
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
BUSY output
O
Standard serial I/O mode 1: BUSY signal output pin
_____
P5_6, P5_7
________
EPM input
P5_5
P6_0 to P6_3
_________
P6_4/RTS1
Standard serial I/O mode 2: Monitors the boot program operation
check signal output pin.
Standard serial I/O mode 1: Serial clock input pin.
P6_5/CLK1
SCLK input
I
P6_6/RXD1
RXD input
I
Serial data input pin
P6_7/TXD1
TXD output
O
Serial data output pin
P7_0 to P7_7
Input port P7
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P8_0 to P8_3,
Input port P8
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P8_4 input
I
Input “L” level signal.
I
Connect this pin to VCC1.
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or connect to a CAN transceiver.
Standard serial I/O mode 2: Input “L”.
(1)
P8_6, P8_7
P8_4
_______
P8_5/NMI
________
NMI input
P9_0 to P9_4, P9_7 Input port P9
CRX input
P9_5/CRX0
P9_6/CTX0
P10_0 to P10_7
NOTES:
(2)
CTX output
O
Input “H” level signal, open or connect to a CAN transceiver.
Input port P10
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
____________
1. When using the standard serial I/O mode, It is necessary to input “H” to the TXD1(P6_7) pin while the RESET pin
____________
is “L”. Therefore, the internal pull-up is enabled for the TXD1(P6_7) pin while the RESET pin is “L”.
2. When using the standard serial I/O mode, the P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 pins may become indeterminate
____________
while the P8_4 pin is “H” and the RESET pin is “L”. If this causes a problem, apply “L” to the P8_4 pin.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 274 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
21. Flash Memory Version
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
VCC2
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
(Flash memory version)
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
CE
EPM
BUSY
SCLK
RXD
TXD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
VSS
VCC1
CNVSS
RESET
Connect
oscillator
circuit
Mode setup method
Signal
Value
CNVSS
VCC1
EPM
VSS
RESET
VSS to VCC1
CE
VCC2
Package: PRQP0100JB-A
Figure 21.13 Pin Connections for Standard Serial I/O Mode (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 275 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
21. Flash Memory Version
VCC2
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
(Flash memory version)
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
CE
EPM
BUSY
SCLK
RXD
TXD
28
27
26
1
2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
VSS
VCC1
CNVSS
RESET
Connect
oscillator
circuit
Mode setup method
Signal
Value
CNVSS
VCC1
EPM
VSS
RESET
VSS to VCC1
CE
VCC2
Package: PLQP0100KB-A
Figure 21.14 Pin Connections for Standard Serial I/O Mode (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 276 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.4.2 Example of Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode
Figures 21.15 and 21.16 show example of circuit application in standard serial I/O mode 1 and mode 2,
respectively. Refer to the user’s manual of your serial programmer to handle pins controlled by a serial
programmer.
Note that when using the standard serial I/O mode 2, make sure a main clock input oscillation frequency
is set to 5 MHz, 10 MHz or 16 MHz.
VCC1
VCC2
Microcomputer
SCLK input
P6_6/CLK1
VCC1
P5_0(CE)
TXD output
P6_7/TXD1
BUSY output
P6_4/RTS1
P5_5(EPM)
VCC1
RXD input
P6_6/RXD1
VCC1
CNVSS
VCC1
Reset input
RESET
P8_5/NMI
User reset
signal
NOTES:
1.Control pins and external circuitry will vary according to programmer.
For more information, refer to the programmer manual.
2.In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial
I/O mode by controlling the CNVSS input with a switch.
3.If in standard standard serial I/O mode 1 there is a possibility that the user reset
signal will go low during standard serial I/O mode, break the connection between
the user reset signal and RESET pin by using, for example, a jumper switch.
Figure 21.15 Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode 1
Microcomputer
P6_5/CLK1
P5_0(CE)
TXD output
P6_7/TXD1
P5_5(EPM)
Monitor output
P6_4/RTS1
VCC2
VCC1
RXD input
P6_6/RXD1
VCC1
CNVSS
VCC1
Reset input
RESET
User reset
signal
P8_5/NMI
NOTES:
1.In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O
mode by controlling the CNVSS input with a switch.
Figure 21.16 Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 277 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.5 Parallel I/O Mode
In parallel I/O mode, the user ROM area and the boot ROM area can be rewritten by a parallel programmer
supporting the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4). Contact your parallel programmer manufacturer for more
information on the parallel programmer. Refer to the user's manual included with your parallel programmer
for instructions.
21.5.1 User ROM and Boot ROM Areas
An erase block operation in the boot ROM area is applied to only one 4-Kbyte block. The rewrite control
program in standard serial I/O and CAN I/O modes are written in the boot ROM area before shipment. Do
not rewrite the boot ROM area if using the serial programmer.
In parallel I/O mode, the boot ROM area is located in addresses 0FF000h to 0FFFFFh. Rewrite this
address range only if rewriting the boot ROM area. (Do not access addresses other than addresses
0FF000h to 0FFFFFh.)
21.5.2 ROM Code Protect Function
The ROM code protect function prevents the flash memory from being read and rewritten in parallel I/O
mode. (Refer to 21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting.)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 278 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.6 CAN I/O Mode
In CAN I/O mode, the CAN programmer supporting the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) can be used to
rewrite the flash memory user ROM area in the microcomputer mounted on a board. For more information
about the CAN programmer, contact your CAN programmer manufacturer. Refer to the user's manual
included with your CAN programmer for instructions.
Table 21.8 lists pin functions for CAN I/O mode. Figures 21.17 and 21.18 show pin connections for CAN I/O
mode.
21.6.1 ID Code Check Function
The ID code check function determines whether the ID codes sent from the CAN programmer matches
those written in the flash memory. (Refer to 21.2 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting.)
Table 21.8 Pin Functions for CAN I/O Mode
Pin
VCC1, VCC2, VSS
Name
I/O
Description
Power supply
Apply the Flash Program, Erase Voltage to VCC1 pin and VCC2
input
to VCC2 pin. The VCC apply condition is that VCC2 = VCC1.
Apply 0 V to VSS pin.
CNVSS
CNVSS
I
Connect to VCC1 pin.
RESET
Reset input
I
Reset input pin. While RESET pin is “L” level, input 20 cycles or
longer clock to XIN pin.
XIN
Clock input
I
XOUT
Clock output
O
Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between XIN and
XOUT pins. To input an externally generated clock, input it to XIN
_____________
____________
pin and open XOUT pin.
BYTE
BYTE
AVCC, AVSS
Analog power
supply input
VREF
Reference
I
Connect this pin to VCC1 or VSS.
Connect AVCC to VCC1 and AVSS to VSS, respectively.
I
Enter the reference voltage for A/D and D/A converters from this
pin.
voltage input
P0_0 to P0_7
Input port P0
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P1_0 to P1_7
Input port P1
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P2_0 to P2_7
Input port P2
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P3_0 to P3_7
Input port P3
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P4_0 to P4_7
Input port P4
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
_____
P5_0
CE input
I
Input “H” level signal.
P5_1 to P5_4,
Input port P5
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P5_6, P5_7
________
EPM input
P5_5
P6_0 to P6_4, P6_6 Input port P6
SCLK input
P6_5/CLK1
I
Input “L” level signal.
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
I
Input “L” level signal.
P6_7/TXD1
TXD output
O
Input “H” level signal.
P7_0 to P7_7
Input port P7
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P8_0 to P8_3,
Input port P8
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
P8_4 Input
I
Input “L” level signal.
I
Connect this pin to VCC1.
I
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open.
I
Connect to a CAN transceiver.
O
Connect to a CAN transceiver.
P8_6, P8_7
P8_4
_______
P8_5/NMI
NMI input
P9_0 to P9_4, P9_7 Input port P9
CRX input
P9_5/CRX0
P9_6/CTX0
(1)
________
CTX output
Input “H” or “L” level signal or open
Input port P10
I
P10_0 to P10_7
NOTE:
1. When using CAN
I/O mode, the P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 pins may become indeterminate while the P8_4 pin
____________
is “H” and the RESET pin is “L”. If this causes a problem, apply “L” to the P8_4 pin.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 279 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
21. Flash Memory Version
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
VCC2
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
CE
EPM
SCLK
TXD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
(Flash memory version)
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
VSS
VCC1
CNVSS
CTX
CRX
RESET
Connect
oscillator
circuit
Mode setup method
Signal
Value
CNVSS
VCC1
EPM
VSS
RESET
VSS to VCC1
CE
VCC2
SCLK
VSS
TXD
VCC1
Package: PRQP0100JB-A
Figure 21.17 Pin Connections for CAN I/O Mode (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 280 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
21. Flash Memory Version
VCC2
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
CTX
CRX
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
(Flash memory version)
CE
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
EPM
SCLK
TXD
28
27
26
1
2 3
4 5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
VSS
VCC1
CNVSS
RESET
Connect
oscillator
circuit
Mode setup method
Signal
Value
CNVSS
VCC1
EPM
VSS
RESET
VSS to VCC1
CE
VCC2
SCLK
VSS
TXD
VCC1
Package: PLQP0100KB-A
Figure 21.18 Pin Connections for CAN I/O Mode (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 281 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.6.2 Example of Circuit Application in CAN I/O Mode
Figure 21.19 shows example of circuit application in CAN I/O mode. Refer to the user’s manual of your
CAN programmer to handle pins controlled by a CAN programmer.
VCC1
Microcomputer
P6_7/TXD1
P5_0(CE)
P6_5/CLK1
P5_5(EPM)
VCC2
VCC1
CAN transceiver
CAN_H
CAN_L
CAN_H
P9_5/CRX0
CAN_L
CNVSS
P9_6/CTX0
VCC1
VCC1
RESET
P8_5/NMI
NOTES:
1.Control pins and external circuitry will vary according to programmer.
For more information, refer to the programmer manual.
2.In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and CAN I/O mode
by controlling the CNVSS input with a switch.
Figure 21.19 Circuit Application in CAN I/O Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 282 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.7 Electrical Characteristics
21.7.1 Electrical Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 21.9 lists the flash memory electrical characteristics. Table 21.10 lists the flash memory version
program/erase voltage and read operation voltage characteristics.
Table 21.9 Flash Memory Version Electrical Characteristics (1)
Parameter
Symbol
(2)
Min.
100
Standard
Typ.
-
Program and Erase Endurance
-
Word Program Time (VCC = 5.0V)
25
200
-
Lock Bit Program Time
200
-
Block Erase Time
4-Kbyte block
25
0.3
(VCC = 5.0V)
8-Kbyte block
32-Kbyte block
0.3
4
0.5
4
64-Kbyte block
0.8
4
-
Erase All Unlocked Blocks Time
Unit
Max.
4
4✕n
(3)
cycle
µs
µs
s
s
s
s
s
µs
tps
Flash Memory Circuit Stabilization Wait Time
15
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.5 to 5.5V, Topr = 0 to 60°C unless otherwise specified.
2. Program and Erase Endurance refers to the number of times a block erase can be performed.
If the program and erase endurance is n (n = 100), each block can be erased n times.
For example, if a 4-Kbyte block A is erased after writing 1 word data 2,048 times, each to a different
address, this counts as one program and erase endurance. Data cannot be written to the same
address more than once without erasing the block. (Rewrite prohibited)
3. n denotes the number of blocks to erase.
Table 21.10 Flash Memory Version Program/Erase Voltage and Read Operation Voltage Characteristics
(at Topr = 0 to 60 °C)
Flash Program, Erase Voltage
Flash Read Operation Voltage
VCC = 5.0 ± 0.5V
VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 283 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
21. Flash Memory Version
21.7.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 21.11 lists the flash memory electrical characteristics. Table 21.12 lists the flash memory version
program/erase voltage and read operation voltage characteristics.
Table 21.11 Flash Memory Version Electrical Characteristics
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
100
(2)
-
Program and Erase Endurance
-
Word Program Time (VCC = 5.0V)
-
Lock Bit Program Time
-
Block Erase Time
(VCC = 5.0V)
(1)
Standard
Typ.
25
25
200
4-Kbyte block
8-Kbyte block
0.3
4
0.3
4
32-Kbyte block
0.5
4
64-Kbyte block
0.8
4
200
4✕n
-
Erase All Unlocked Blocks Time
tps
Flash Memory Circuit Stabilization Wait Time
Unit
Max.
15
(3)
cycle
µs
µs
s
s
s
s
s
µs
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.5 to 5.5V, 3.0 to 3.6V, Topr = 0 to 60°C unless otherwise specified.
2. Program and Erase Endurance refers to the number of times a block erase can be performed.
If the program and erase endurance is n (n = 100), each block can be erased n times.
For example, if a 4-Kbyte block A is erased after writing 1 word data 2,048 times, each to a different
address, this counts as one program and erase endurance. Data cannot be written to the same
address more than once without erasing the block. (Rewrite prohibited)
3. n denotes the number of blocks to erase.
Table 21.12 Flash Memory Version Program/Erase Voltage and Read Operation Voltage Characteristics
(at Topr = 0 to 60 °C)
Flash Program, Erase Voltage
VCC = 3.3 ± 0.3V or 5.0 ± 0.5V
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 284 of 376
Flash Read Operation Voltage
VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
22. Electrical Characteristics
22.1 Electrical Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Rated Value
Unit
VCC
Supply Voltage (VCC1 = VCC2)
VCC = AVCC
–0.3 to 6.5
V
AVCC
Analog Supply Voltage
VCC = AVCC
–0.3 to 6.5
V
–0.3 to VCC+0.3
V
_____________
VI
Input
RESET, CNVSS, BYTE,
Voltage
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
VREF, XIN
P7_1, P9_1
VO
Output
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
Voltage
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
–0.3 to 6.5
V
–0.3 to VCC+0.3
V
–0.3 to 6.5
V
700
mW
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
P10_0 to P10_7, XOUT
Pd
P7_1, P9_1
Power Dissipation
Topr
Operating Ambient When the Microcomputer is
T version: –40 to 85
Temperature
V version: –40 to 125 (option)
Operating
Flash Program Erase
Tstg
Storage Temperature
option: All options are on request basis.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 285 of 376
Topr = 25°C
°C
0 to 60
–65 to 150
°C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.2 Recommended Operating Conditions (1)
Symbol
(1)
Parameter
Min.
Standard
Max.
Typ.
Unit
VCC
Supply Voltage (VCC1 = VCC2)
AVCC
Analog Supply Voltage
VCC
V
VSS
Supply Voltage
0
V
AVSS
Analog Supply Voltage
0
V
VIH
HIGH Input P3_1 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7,
Voltage
P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
4.2
5.0
5.5
V
VCC
V
0.8V CC
6.5
V
0.8V CC
VCC
V
0.5V CC
VCC
V
0
0.2VCC
V
0
0.2VCC
V
0
0.16VCC
V
–10.0
mA
–5.0
mA
10.0
mA
5.0
mA
0.8V CC
_____________
P10_0 to P10_7, XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
P7_1, P9_1
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(During single-chip mode)
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(Data input during memory expansion and microprocessor modes)
VIL
LOW Input
P3_1 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7,
Voltage
P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
_____________
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(During single-chip mode)
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(Data input during memory expansion and microprocessor modes)
IOH(peak)
HIGH Peak
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0,
P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
IOH(avg)
HIGH Average P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0,
P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
IOL(peak)
LOW Peak
IOL(avg)
LOW Average P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. The mean output current is the mean value within 100 ms.
3. The total IOL(peak) for ports P0, P1, P2, P8_6, P8_7, P9 and P10 must be 80mA max.
The total IOL(peak) for ports P3, P4, P5, P6, P7 and P8_0 to P8_4 must be 80mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P0, P1, and P2 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P3, P4 and P5 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P6, P7 and P8_0 to P8_4 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P8_6, P8_7, P9 and P10 must be –40mA max.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 286 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.3 Recommended Operating Conditions (2)
Symbol
f(XIN)
(1)
Parameter
Min.
Main Clock Input Oscillation No Wait Mask ROM Version VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V
Frequency
(2) (3) (4)
Standard
Max.
Typ.
0
Unit
16
MHz
50
kHz
Flash Memory Version
f(XCIN)
Sub Clock Oscillation Frequency
f(Ring)
On-chip Oscillation Frequency
f(PLL)
PLL Clock Oscillation Frequency
f(BCLK)
CPU Operation Clock
tsu(PLL)
PLL Frequency Synthesizer Stabilization Wait Time
20
ms
f(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable Frequency (VCC)
10
kHz
V P-P(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable Amplitude Voltage VCC = 5V
V CC(|∆V/∆T|)
Power Supply Ripple Rising/Falling Gradient
0.5
0.3
V/ms
32.768
1
VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless
otherwise specified.
2. Relationship between main clock oscillation frequency and supply
voltage is shown right.
3. Execute program/erase of flash memory by VCC = 5.0 ± 0.5 V.
4. When using over 16MHz, use PLL clock. PLL clock oscillation
frequency which can be used is 16MHz or 20MHz.
f(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable
Frequency (VCC)
VP-P(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable
Amplitude Voltage
page 287 of 376
20
MHz
0
20
MHz
V
Main clock input oscillation frequency
(Mask ROM version / Flash memory
version: no wait)
16.0
0.0
4.2
5.5
VCC [V] (main clock: no division)
f(ripple)
VCC
Figure 22.1 Timing of Voltage Fluctuation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
f(XIN) operating maximum frequency [MHz]
VCC = 5V
MHz
16
VP-P(ripple)
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.4 Electrical Characteristics (1)
(1)
Parameter
Symbol
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
XOUT
HIGHPOWER
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
LOWPOWER
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
HIGH Output
Voltage
LOWPOWER
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
VOL
XOUT
HIGHPOWER
LOW Output
Voltage
LOWPOWER
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
LOW Output
Voltage
LOWPOWER
_________ _______
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
HOLD,
RDY,
TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN,
________
________ _______ _____________ _________
_________
INT0 to INT5, NMI, ADTRG, CTS0 to CTS2,
SCL0 to SCL2, SDA0 to SDA2,
CLK0
to CLK3,
_____
_____
TA0OUT to TA4OUT, KI0 to KI3,
RXD0
to RXD2, SIN3
_____________
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
RESET
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
XIN
HIGH Input
IIH
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
Current
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
____________
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
LOW Input
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
IIL
Current
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 ____________
to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
RPULLUP Pull-up
Resistance
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to
P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
P10_0 to P10_7
Feedback Resistance
XIN
RfXIN
Feedback
Resistance
XCIN
RfXCIN
RAM Retention Voltage
VRAM
NOTES:
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
IOH = –5mA
Standard
Min. Typ. Max.
VCC
VCC-2.0
IOH = –200µA
VCC-0.3
VCC
V
3.0
3.0
VCC
VCC
V
Measuring Condition
IOH = –1mA
IOH = –0.5mA
With no load applied
With no load applied
IOL = 5mA
2.5
1.6
Unit
V
V
2.0
V
IOL = 200µA
0.45
V
IOL = 1mA
IOL = 0.5mA
With no load applied
With no load applied
2.0
2.0
V
0
0
V
0.2
1.0
V
0.2
0.2
V
VI = 5V
2.5
0.8
5.0
V
µA
VI = 0V
–5.0
µA
170
kΩ
VI = 0V
30
50
1.5
15
At stop mode
2.0
MΩ
MΩ
V
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V, VSS = 0V at Topr = –40 to 85°C, f(BCLK) = 20MHz unless otherwise specified.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 288 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Table 22.5 Electrical Characteristics (2)
Symbol
ICC
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
(1)
Parameter
Measuring Condition
Min.
Power Supply
Output pins are open Mask ROM
f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
Current
and other pins are VSS.
PLL operation,
(VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V)
Standard
Typ. Max.
18
32
Unit
mA
No division
On-chip oscillation,
No division
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 20MHz,
1
20
mA
34
mA
PLL operation,
No division
On-chip oscillation,
No division
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 10MHz,
Program
Mask ROM
mA
15
mA
25
mA
25
µA
25
µA
420
µA
50
µA
8.5
µA
3.0
µA
VCC = 5V
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 10MHz,
Erase
1.8
VCC = 5V
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode, ROM
(2)
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode, RAM
(2)
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode,
Flash memory
(2)
Mask ROM
On-chip oscillation,
Flash Memory Wait mode
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Wait mode (3),
Oscillation capacity High
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Wait mode (3),
Oscillation capacity Low
Stop mode,
0.8
3.0
µA
Topr = 25°C
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V, VSS = 0V at Topr = –40 to 85°C, f(BCLK) = 20MHz unless otherwise specified.
2. This indicates the memory in which the program to be executed exists.
3. With one timer operated using fC32.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 289 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.6 A/D Conversion Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
INL
Integral
10 bits
Error
8 bits
Absolute
Measuring Condition
Min.
VREF = VCC
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
Standard
Typ. Max.
10
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
= 5V External operation amp connection mode
Nonlinearity
–
(1)
10 bits
Accuracy
VREF = AVCC = VCC = 5V
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
Unit
Bit
±3
LSB
±7
LSB
±2
LSB
±3
LSB
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
= 5V External operation amp connection mode
±7
LSB
VREF = AVCC = VCC = 5V
±2
LSB
DNL
Differential Nonlinearity Error
±1
LSB
–
Offset Error
±3
LSB
–
Gain Error
±3
LSB
RLADDER
Resistor Ladder
VREF = VCC
10
40
kΩ
tCONV
10-bit Conversion Time,
VREF = VCC = 5V, φAD = 10MHz
3.3
µs
VREF = VCC = 5V, φAD = 10MHz
2.8
µs
µs
8 bits
Sample & Hold Available
8-bit Conversion time,
Sample & Hold Available
tSAMP
Sampling Time
0.3
VREF
Reference Voltage
2.0
VCC
V
0
VREF
V
VIA
NOTES:
Analog Input Voltage
1. Referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 4.2 to 5.5V, VSS = AVSS = 0V, –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. φAD frequency must be 10MHz or less.
3. When sample & hold is disabled, φAD frequency must be 250kHz or more in addition to a limit of NOTE 2.
When sample & hold is enabled, φAD frequency must be 1MHz or more in addition to a limit of NOTE 2.
Table 22.7 D/A conversion Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
–
Absolute Accuracy
tsu
Setup Time
RO
Output Resistance
IVREF
Reference Power Supply Input Current
(1)
Measuring condition
Min.
4
(NOTE 2)
Standard
Typ. Max.
8
10
Unit
Bits
1.0
%
3
µs
20
kΩ
1.5
mA
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 4.2 to 5.5V, VSS = AVSS = 0V, –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. This applies when using one D/A converter, with the DAi register (i = 0, 1) for the unused D/A converter set to “00h”.
The resistor ladder of the A/D converter is not included. Also, the current IVREF always flows even though VREF
may have been set to be unconnected by the ADCON1 register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 290 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Table 22.8 Power Supply Circuit Timing Characteristics
Symbol
Measuring
Condition
Parameter
Min.
Standard
Typ. Max.
2
Unit
td(P-R)
Time for Internal Power Supply Stabilization During Powering-On VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V
td(R-S)
STOP Release Time
150
µs
td(W-S)
Low Power Dissipation Mode Wait Mode Release Time
150
µs
td(P-R)
Time for Internal Power Supply
Stabilization During Powering-On
VCC
td(P-R)
CPU clock
td(R-S)
STOP Release Time
Interrupt for
(a) Stop mode release
or
(b) Wait mode release
td(W-S)
Low Power Dissipation Mode
Wait Mode Release Time
CPU clock
(a)
(b)
Figure 22.2 Power Supply Circuit Timing Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 291 of 376
td(R-S)
td(W-S)
ms
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.9 External Clock Input (XIN Input)
Symbol
Parameter
tC
External Clock Input Cycle Time
tw(H)
External Clock Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(L)
External Clock Input LOW Pulse Width
tr
External Clock Rise Time
tf
External Clock Fall Time
Standard
Min.
Max.
62.5
25
25
15
15
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.10 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
Symbol
Parameter
tac1(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with no wait)
tac2(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with wait)
tsu(DB-RD)
tsu(RDY-BCLK)
Data input setup time
Standard
Unit
Min.
Max.
(NOTE 1) ns
(NOTE 2) ns
(NOTE 3)
Data input access time (when accessing multiplexed bus area)
40
30
________
RDY input setup time
__________
tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD input setup time
th(RD-DB)
Data input hold time
________
th(BCLK-RDY) RDY input hold time
__________
th(BCLK-HOLD) HOLD input hold time
40
0
0
0
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 45 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 45 [ns]
n is “2” for 1-wait setting, “3” for 2-wait setting and “4” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 109
– 45 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 292 of 376
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.11 Timer A Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.12 Timer A Input (Gating Input in Timer Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
200
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.13 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in One-shot Timer Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
100
100
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.14 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in Pulse Width Modulation Mode)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
100
Symbol
Parameter
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.15 Timer A Input (Counter Increment/decrement Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
2000
1000
tc(UP)
TAiOUT Input Cycle Time
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT Input LOW Pulse Width
tsu(UP-TIN)
TAiOUT Input Setup Time
1000
400
th(TIN-UP)
TAiOUT Input Hold Time
400
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.16 Timer A Input (Two-phase Pulse Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT Input Setup Time
tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) TAiIN Input Setup Time
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 293 of 376
Standard
Max.
Min.
800
200
200
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.17 Timer B Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
200
80
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
80
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on both edges)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.18 Timer B Input (Pulse Period Measurement Mode)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
200
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.19 Timer B Input (Pulse Width Measurement Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
200
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.20 A/D Trigger Input
Symbol
tC(AD)
tw(ADL)
Parameter
_____________
ADTRG Input Cycle Time (trigger able minimum)
Standard
Min.
Max.
1000
_____________
ADTRG Input LOW Pulse Width
125
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.21 Serial Interface
CLKi Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
100
CLKi Input LOW Pulse Width
100
Symbol
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
tw(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Parameter
CLKi Input Cycle Time
80
TXDi Output Delay Time
RXDi Input Setup Time
0
70
RXDi Input Hold Time
90
TXDi Hold Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
_______
Table 22.22 External Interrupt INTi Input
Symbol
tw(INH)
tw(INL)
Parameter
_______
INTi Input HIGH Pulse Width
_______
INTi Input LOW Pulse Width
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 294 of 376
Standard
Min.
Max.
250
250
Unit
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.23 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for setting with no wait)
Symbol
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Measuring
condition
Parameter
Address output delay time
Figure 22.3
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
ALE signal output delay time
15
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
25
WR signal output hold time
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
40
(3)
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(3)
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
25
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output hold time
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
ns
4
ns
(NOTE 2)
ns
(NOTE 1)
ns
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns.
R
DBi
C
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
30pF
Figure 22.3 Port P0 to P10 Measurement Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 295 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.24 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for 1- to 3-wait setting and external area access)
Symbol
Measuring
condition
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Figure 22.3
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
25
ns
ns
15
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
40
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output delay time
ALE signal output hold time
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
0
WR signal output delay time
WR signal output hold time
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(3)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
ns
ns
4
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
(3)
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
ns
(NOTE 1)
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n – 0.5) ✕ 10
– 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
n is “1” for 1-wait setting, “2” for 2-wait setting and “3” for 3-wait setting.
When n = 1, f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns..
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 296 of 376
R
DBi
C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.25 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(for 2- to 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Symbol
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
th(WR-CS)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Measuring
condition
Figure 22.3
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
25
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
RD signal output delay time
ns
25
RD signal output hold time
25
WR signal output hold time
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
ns
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
ns
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to RD)
ns
ns
ns
4
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
Unit
40
ns
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
4
ns
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
ns
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
ns
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-ALE)
th(ALE-AD)
td(AD-RD)
td(AD-WR)
tdZ(RD-AD)
ALE signal output delay time (refers to BCLK)
40
ns
15
ns
–4
ns
ALE signal output delay time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 3)
ns
ALE signal output hold time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 4)
ns
RD signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ns
WR signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ALE signal output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output floating start time
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 40 [ns]
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 25 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
4. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 15 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 297 of 376
ns
8
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
VCC = 5V
XIN input
tr
tr
tw(H)
tw(L)
tc
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up/down input)
During event counter mode
TAiIN input
(When count on falling edge
is selected)
th(TIN—UP) tsu(UP—TIN)
TAiIN input
(When count on rising edge
is selected)
Two-phase pulse input in event counter mode
tC(TA)
TAiIN input
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
TAiOUT input
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C—Q)
TXDi
td(C—Q)
tsu(D—C)
RXDi
tw(INL)
INTi input
tw(INH)
Figure 22.4 Timing Diagram (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 298 of 376
th(C—D)
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(Effective for setting with wait)
BCLK
RD
(Separate bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Separate bus)
RD
(Multiplexed bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Multiplexed bus)
RDY input
tsu(RDY—BCLK)
th(BCLK—RDY)
(Common to setting with wait and setting without wait)
BCLK
tsu(HOLD—BCLK)
th(BCLK—HOLD)
HOLD input
HLDA output
td(BCLK—HLDA)
td(BCLK—HLDA)
Hi—Z
P0, P1, P2,
P3, P4,
P5_0 to P5_2 (1)
NOTE:
1. The above pins are set to high-impedance regardless of the input level of the BYTE pin,
the PM06 bit in the PM0 register and the PM11 bit in the PM1 register.
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : Determined with VIL = 1.0 V, VIH = 4.0 V
Output timing voltage: Determined with VOL = 2.5 V, VOH = 2.5 V
Figure 22.5 Timing Diagram (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 299 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For setting with no wait)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
RD
tac1(RD-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
tSU(DB-RD)
40ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.6 Timing Diagram (3)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min (0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
page 300 of 376
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 1-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
0ns.min
-4ns.min
25ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
th(RD-DB)
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
40ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
25ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.7 Timing Diagram (4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 301 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 2-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
40ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
tcyc =
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.8 Timing Diagram (5)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 302 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 3-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
0ns.min
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(3.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
40ns.min
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
DBi
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
4ns.min
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.9 Timing Diagram (6)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 303 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 1- or 2-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
Address
8ns.max
Address
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
tac3(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
40ns.min
td(AD-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
ADi
/DBi
Address
Data output
td(DB-WR)
td(AD-ALE)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
Address
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-WR)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
WR,WRL,
WRH
tcyc =
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.10 Timing Diagram (7)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 304 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (T/V-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
25ns.max
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
Address
td(BCLK-AD)
td(AD-RD)
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
8ns.max
th(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
0ns.min
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-AD)
40ns.min
4ns.min
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
ADi
/DBi
Address
4ns.min
Data output
td(AD-ALE)
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
-4ns.min
td(AD-WR)
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
WR, WRL
WRH
tcyc =
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
0ns.min
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.11 Timing Diagram (8)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 305 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
22.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.26 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Rated Value
Unit
VCC
Supply Voltage (VCC1 = VCC2)
VCC = AVCC
–0.3 to 6.5
V
AVCC
Analog Supply Voltage
VCC = AVCC
–0.3 to 6.5
V
–0.3 to VCC+0.3
V
–0.3 to 6.5
V
–0.3 to VCC+0.3
V
_____________
VI
Input
RESET, CNVSS, BYTE,
Voltage
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
VREF, XIN
P7_1, P9_1
VO
Output
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7,
Voltage
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
P10_0 to P10_7, XOUT
Pd
P7_1, P9_1
Power Dissipation
Topr
Operating Ambient When the Microcomputer is
Temperature
Storage Temperature
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
–0.3 to 6.5
V
700
mW
–40 to 85
°C
Operating
Flash Program Erase
Tstg
Topr = 25°C
page 306 of 376
0 to 60
–65 to 150
°C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.27 Recommended Operating Conditions (1)
Symbol
(1)
Parameter
Min.
Standard
Max.
Typ.
Unit
VCC
Supply Voltage (VCC1 = VCC2)
AVCC
Analog Supply Voltage
VCC
V
VSS
Supply Voltage
0
V
AVSS
Analog Supply Voltage
0
V
VIH
HIGH Input P3_1 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7,
Voltage
P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
3.0
5.0
5.5
V
VCC
V
0.8V CC
6.5
V
0.8V CC
VCC
V
0.5V CC
VCC
V
0
0.2VCC
V
0
0.2VCC
V
0
0.16VCC
V
–10.0
mA
–5.0
mA
10.0
mA
5.0
mA
0.8V CC
_____________
P10_0 to P10_7, XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
P7_1, P9_1
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(During single-chip mode)
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(Data input during memory expansion and microprocessor modes)
VIL
LOW Input
P3_1 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7,
Voltage
P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
_____________
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(During single-chip mode)
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0
(Data input during memory expansion and microprocessor modes)
IOH(peak)
HIGH Peak
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0,
P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
IOH(avg)
HIGH Average P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0,
P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
IOL(peak)
LOW Peak
IOL(avg)
LOW Average P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7,
Output Current P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. The mean output current is the mean value within 100 ms.
3. The total IOL(peak) for ports P0, P1, P2, P8_6, P8_7, P9 and P10 must be 80mA max.
The total IOL(peak) for ports P3, P4, P5, P6, P7 and P8_0 to P8_4 must be 80mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P0, P1, and P2 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P3, P4 and P5 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P6, P7 and P8_0 to P8_4 must be –40mA max.
The total IOH(peak) for ports P8_6, P8_7, P9 and P10 must be –40mA max.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 307 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.28 Recommended Operating Conditions (2)
Symbol
f(XIN)
(1)
Parameter
Min.
Main Clock Input Oscillation No Wait Mask ROM Version VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V
Frequency
(2) (3) (4)
Standard
Max.
Typ.
0
Unit
16
MHz
50
kHz
Flash Memory Version
f(XCIN)
Sub Clock Oscillation Frequency
f(Ring)
On-chip Oscillation Frequency
f(PLL)
PLL Clock Oscillation Frequency
f(BCLK)
CPU Operation Clock
tsu(PLL)
PLL Frequency Synthesizer Stabilization Wait Time
20
ms
f(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable Frequency (VCC)
10
kHz
VP-P(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable Amplitude Voltage VCC = 5V
0.5
0.3
V
0.3
0.3
V/ms
32.768
1
VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V
MHz
16
24
MHz
0
24
MHz
VCC = 3.3V
VCC(|∆V/∆T|)
Power Supply Ripple Rising/Falling Gradient
VCC = 5V
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless
otherwise specified.
2. Relationship between main clock oscillation frequency and supply
voltage is shown right.
3. Execute program/erase of flash memory by VCC = 3.3 ± 0.3 V or
VCC = 5.0 ± 0.5 V.
4. When using over 16MHz, use PLL clock. PLL clock oscillation
frequency which can be used is 16MHz, 20MHz or 24MHz.
f(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable
Frequency (VCC)
VP-P(ripple)
Power Supply Ripple Allowable
Amplitude Voltage
page 308 of 376
Main clock input oscillation frequency
(Mask ROM version / Flash memory
version: no wait)
16.0
0.0
3.0
5.5
VCC [V] (main clock: no division)
f(ripple)
VCC
Figure 22.12 Timing of Voltage Fluctuation
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
f(XIN) operating maximum frequency [MHz]
VCC = 3.3V
VP-P(ripple)
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.29 A/D Conversion Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
INL
Integral
10 bits
Error
8 bits
Absolute
Measuring Condition
Min.
VREF = VCC
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
Standard
Typ. Max.
10
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
= 5V External operation amp connection mode
Nonlinearity
–
(1)
10 bits
8 bits
Bit
±3
LSB
±7
LSB
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
±5
LSB
= 3.3V External operation amp connection mode
±7
LSB
VREF = AVCC = VCC = 5.0V, 3.3V
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
±2
LSB
±3
LSB
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
= 5V External operation amp connection mode
Accuracy
Unit
±7
LSB
VREF ANEX0, ANEX1 input, AN0 to AN7 input,
= VCC AN0_0 to AN0_7 input, AN2_0 to AN2_7 input
±5
LSB
= 3.3V External operation amp connection mode
±7
LSB
VREF = AVCC = VCC = 5.0V, 3.3V
±2
LSB
DNL
Differential Nonlinearity Error
±1
LSB
–
Offset Error
±3
LSB
–
Gain Error
±3
LSB
RLADDER
Resistor Ladder
VREF = VCC
10
40
kΩ
tCONV
10-bit Conversion Time,
VREF = VCC = 5V, φAD = 10MHz
3.3
µs
VREF = VCC = 5V, φAD = 10MHz
2.8
µs
Sample & Hold Available
8-bit Conversion time,
Sample & Hold Available
tSAMP
Sampling Time
VREF
Reference Voltage
VIA
Analog Input Voltage
µs
0.3
2.0
VCC
V
0
VREF
V
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 3.3 to 5.5V, VSS = AVSS = 0V, –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. φAD frequency must be 10MHz or less.
3. When sample & hold is disabled, φAD frequency must be 250kHz or more in addition to a limit of NOTE 2.
When sample & hold is enabled, φAD frequency must be 1MHz or more in addition to a limit of NOTE 2.
Table 22.30 D/A conversion Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
–
Absolute Accuracy
tsu
Setup Time
RO
Output Resistance
IVREF
Reference Power Supply Input Current
(1)
Measuring condition
Min.
4
(NOTE 2)
Standard
Typ. Max.
8
10
Unit
Bits
1.0
%
3
µs
20
kΩ
1.5
mA
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = AVCC = VREF = 3.3 to 5.5V, VSS = AVSS = 0V, –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified.
2. This applies when using one D/A converter, with the DAi register (i = 0, 1) for the unused D/A converter set to “00h”.
The resistor ladder of the A/D converter is not included. Also, the current IVREF always flows even though VREF
may have been set to be unconnected by the ADCON1 register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 309 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.31 Power Supply Circuit Timing Characteristics
Symbol
Measuring
Condition
Parameter
Min.
Standard
Typ. Max.
2
Unit
td(P-R)
Time for Internal Power Supply Stabilization During Powering-On VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V
td(R-S)
STOP Release Time
150
µs
td(W-S)
Low Power Dissipation Mode Wait Mode Release Time
150
µs
td(P-R)
Time for Internal Power Supply
Stabilization During Powering-On
VCC
td(P-R)
CPU clock
td(R-S)
STOP Release Time
Interrupt for
(a) Stop mode release
or
(b) Wait mode release
td(W-S)
Low Power Dissipation Mode
Wait Mode Release Time
CPU clock
(a)
(b)
Figure 22.13 Power Supply Circuit Timing Diagram
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 310 of 376
td(R-S)
td(W-S)
ms
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.32 Electrical Characteristics (1)
Symbol
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
HIGH Output
Voltage
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
LOW Output
Voltage
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
(1)
VCC = 5V
Standard
Parameter
Measuring Condition
Min. Typ. Max.
VCC
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOH = –5mA
VCC-2.0
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
VCC
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOH = –200µA
VCC-0.3
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
IOH = –1mA
VCC
3.0
XOUT
HIGHPOWER
IOH = –0.5mA
VCC
3.0
LOWPOWER
2.5
With
no
load
applied
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
1.6
With no load applied
LOWPOWER
2.0
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOL = 5mA
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOL = 200µA
0.45
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
IOL = 1mA
XOUT
HIGHPOWER
2.0
IOL = 0.5mA
LOWPOWER
2.0
0
With no load applied
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
0
With no load applied
LOWPOWER
_________ _______
0.2
1.0
HOLD, RDY, TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN,
________
________ _______ _____________ _________
Unit
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
_________
INT0 to INT5, NMI, ADTRG, CTS0 to CTS2,
SCL0 to SCL2, SDA0 to SDA2,
CLK0
to CLK3,
_____
_____
TA0OUT to TA4OUT, KI0 to KI3,
RXD0
to RXD2, SIN3
_____________
V
2.5
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
RESET
0.2
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
V
0.8
0.2
XIN
HIGH Input
IIH
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 5V
5.0
µA
Current
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 ____________
to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
LOW Input
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 0V
IIL
–5.0 µA
Current
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 ____________
to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
50
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 0V
170
kΩ
RPULLUP Pull-up
30
Resistance
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to
P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
P10_0 to P10_7
Feedback
Resistance
XIN
MΩ
1.5
RfXIN
Feedback Resistance
XCIN
MΩ
15
RfXCIN
V
RAM Retention Voltage
2.0
At stop mode
VRAM
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 4.2 to 5.5V, VSS = 0V at Topr = –40 to 85°C, f(BCLK) = 24MHz unless otherwise specified.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 311 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Table 22.33 Electrical Characteristics (2)
Symbol
ICC
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
(1)
Parameter
Measuring Condition
Min.
Power Supply
Output pins are open Mask ROM
f(BCLK) = 24MHz,
Current
and other pins are VSS.
PLL operation,
(VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V)
Standard
Typ. Max.
20
36
Unit
mA
No division
On-chip oscillation,
No division
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 24MHz,
1
22
mA
38
mA
PLL operation,
No division
On-chip oscillation,
No division
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 10MHz,
Program
Mask ROM
mA
15
mA
25
mA
25
µA
25
µA
420
µA
50
µA
8.5
µA
3.0
µA
VCC = 5V
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 10MHz,
Erase
1.8
VCC = 5V
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode, ROM
(2)
Flash Memory f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode, RAM
(2)
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Low power dissipation
mode,
Flash memory
(2)
Mask ROM
On-chip oscillation,
Flash Memory Wait mode
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Wait mode (3),
Oscillation capacity High
f(BCLK) = 32kHz,
Wait mode (3),
Oscillation capacity Low
Stop mode,
0.8
3.0
µA
Topr = 25°C
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 3.0 to 5.5V, VSS = 0V at Topr = –40 to 85°C, f(BCLK) = 24MHz unless otherwise specified.
2. This indicates the memory in which the program to be executed exists.
3. With one timer operated using fC32.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 312 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.34 External Clock Input (XIN Input)
Symbol
Parameter
tC
External Clock Input Cycle Time
tw(H)
External Clock Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(L)
External Clock Input LOW Pulse Width
tr
External Clock Rise Time
tf
External Clock Fall Time
Standard
Min.
Max.
62.5
25
25
15
15
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.35 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
Symbol
Parameter
tac1(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with no wait)
tac2(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with wait)
tsu(DB-RD)
tsu(RDY-BCLK)
Data input setup time
Standard
Unit
Min.
Max.
(NOTE 1) ns
(NOTE 2) ns
(NOTE 3)
Data input access time (when accessing multiplexed bus area)
40
30
________
RDY input setup time
__________
tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD input setup time
th(RD-DB)
Data input hold time
________
th(BCLK-RDY) RDY input hold time
__________
th(BCLK-HOLD) HOLD input hold time
40
0
0
0
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 45 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 45 [ns]
n is “2” for 1-wait setting, “3” for 2-wait setting and “4” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 109
– 45 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 313 of 376
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.36 Timer A Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.37 Timer A Input (Gating Input in Timer Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
200
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.38 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in One-shot Timer Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
100
100
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.39 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in Pulse Width Modulation Mode)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
100
Symbol
Parameter
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.40 Timer A Input (Counter Increment/decrement Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
2000
1000
tc(UP)
TAiOUT Input Cycle Time
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT Input LOW Pulse Width
tsu(UP-TIN)
TAiOUT Input Setup Time
1000
400
th(TIN-UP)
TAiOUT Input Hold Time
400
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.41 Timer A Input (Two-phase Pulse Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT Input Setup Time
tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) TAiIN Input Setup Time
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 314 of 376
Standard
Max.
Min.
800
200
200
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
VCC = 5V
Table 22.42 Timer B Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
Standard
Min.
Max.
100
40
40
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
200
80
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
80
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on both edges)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.43 Timer B Input (Pulse Period Measurement Mode)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
200
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.44 Timer B Input (Pulse Width Measurement Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
400
200
200
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.45 A/D Trigger Input
Symbol
tC(AD)
tw(ADL)
Parameter
_____________
ADTRG Input Cycle Time (trigger able minimum)
Standard
Min.
Max.
1000
_____________
ADTRG Input LOW Pulse Width
125
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.46 Serial Interface
CLKi Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
200
100
CLKi Input LOW Pulse Width
100
Symbol
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
tw(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Parameter
CLKi Input Cycle Time
80
TXDi Output Delay Time
RXDi Input Setup Time
0
70
RXDi Input Hold Time
90
TXDi Hold Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
_______
Table 22.47 External Interrupt INTi Input
Symbol
tw(INH)
tw(INL)
Parameter
_______
INTi Input HIGH Pulse Width
_______
INTi Input LOW Pulse Width
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 315 of 376
Standard
Min.
Max.
250
250
Unit
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.48 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for setting with no wait)
Symbol
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Measuring
condition
Parameter
Address output delay time
Figure 22.14
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
ALE signal output delay time
15
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
25
WR signal output hold time
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
40
(3)
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(3)
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
25
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output hold time
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
ns
4
ns
(NOTE 2)
ns
(NOTE 1)
ns
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns.
R
DBi
C
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
30pF
Figure 22.14 Port P0 to P10 Measurement Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 316 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.49 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for 1- to 3-wait setting and external area access)
Symbol
Measuring
condition
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Figure 22.14
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
25
ns
ns
15
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
40
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output delay time
ALE signal output hold time
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
0
WR signal output delay time
WR signal output hold time
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(3)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
ns
ns
4
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
(3)
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
ns
(NOTE 1)
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n – 0.5) ✕ 10
– 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
n is “1” for 1-wait setting, “2” for 2-wait setting and “3” for 3-wait setting.
When n = 1, f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns..
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 317 of 376
R
DBi
C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 5V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 5V
Table 22.50 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(for 2- to 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Symbol
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
th(WR-CS)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Measuring
condition
Figure 22.14
Standard
Min.
Max.
25
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
25
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
RD signal output delay time
ns
25
RD signal output hold time
25
WR signal output hold time
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
ns
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
ns
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to RD)
ns
ns
ns
4
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
Unit
40
ns
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
4
ns
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
ns
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
ns
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-ALE)
th(ALE-AD)
td(AD-RD)
td(AD-WR)
tdZ(RD-AD)
ALE signal output delay time (refers to BCLK)
40
ns
15
ns
–4
ns
ALE signal output delay time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 3)
ns
ALE signal output hold time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 4)
ns
RD signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ns
WR signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ALE signal output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output floating start time
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 40 [ns]
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 25 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
4. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 15 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 318 of 376
ns
8
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 5V
XIN input
tr
tr
tw(H)
tw(L)
tc
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up/down input)
During event counter mode
TAiIN input
(When count on falling edge
is selected)
th(TIN—UP) tsu(UP—TIN)
TAiIN input
(When count on rising edge
is selected)
Two-phase pulse input in event counter mode
tC(TA)
TAiIN input
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
TAiOUT input
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C—Q)
TXDi
td(C—Q)
tsu(D—C)
RXDi
tw(INL)
INTi input
tw(INH)
Figure 22.15 Timing Diagram (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 319 of 376
th(C—D)
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
VCC = 5V
(Effective for setting with wait)
BCLK
RD
(Separate bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Separate bus)
RD
(Multiplexed bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Multiplexed bus)
RDY input
tsu(RDY—BCLK)
th(BCLK—RDY)
(Common to setting with wait and setting without wait)
BCLK
tsu(HOLD—BCLK)
th(BCLK—HOLD)
HOLD input
HLDA output
td(BCLK—HLDA)
td(BCLK—HLDA)
Hi—Z
P0, P1, P2,
P3, P4,
P5_0 to P5_2 (1)
NOTE:
1. The above pins are set to high-impedance regardless of the input level of the BYTE pin,
the PM06 bit in the PM0 register and the PM11 bit in the PM1 register.
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : Determined with VIL = 1.0 V, VIH = 4.0 V
Output timing voltage: Determined with VOL = 2.5 V, VOH = 2.5 V
Figure 22.16 Timing Diagram (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 320 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For setting with no wait)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
RD
tac1(RD-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
tSU(DB-RD)
40ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.17 Timing Diagram (3)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min (0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
page 321 of 376
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 1-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
0ns.min
-4ns.min
25ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
th(RD-DB)
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
40ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
25ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.18 Timing Diagram (4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 322 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 2-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
40ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
tcyc =
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.19 Timing Diagram (5)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 323 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 5V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 3-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
td(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
25ns.max
0ns.min
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(3.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
40ns.min
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
DBi
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
4ns.min
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.20 Timing Diagram (6)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 324 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 1- or 2-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
Address
8ns.max
Address
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
tac3(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
40ns.min
td(AD-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
25ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
ADi
/DBi
Address
Data output
td(DB-WR)
td(AD-ALE)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
Address
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-WR)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
25ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
WR,WRL,
WRH
tcyc =
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.21 Timing Diagram (7)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 325 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 5V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
25ns.max
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
Address
td(BCLK-AD)
td(AD-RD)
25ns.max
ADi
BHE
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
8ns.max
th(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-45)ns.max
0ns.min
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-AD)
40ns.min
4ns.min
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
25ns.max
RD
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
ADi
/DBi
Address
4ns.min
Data output
td(AD-ALE)
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-25)ns.min
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
25ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
25ns.max
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
-4ns.min
td(AD-WR)
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
25ns.max
WR, WRL
WRH
tcyc =
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
0ns.min
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 5 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.8 V, VIH = 2.0 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.4 V, VOH = 2.4 V
Figure 22.22 Timing Diagram (8)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 326 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Table 22.51 Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
VOH
HIGH Output
Voltage
(1)
VCC = 3.3V
Standard
Parameter
Measuring Condition
Min. Typ. Max.
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOH = –1mA
VCC
VCC-0.5
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
Unit
V
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7,
P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0,
P9_2 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
VOH
VOL
VCC
VCC-0.5
VCC
XOUT
HIGH Output
Voltage
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
With no load applied
2.5
LOWPOWER
With no load applied
1.6
LOW Output
Voltage
HIGHPOWER
VCC-0.5
HIGH Output
Voltage
IOH = –0.1mA
LOWPOWER
IOH = –50µA
V
V
0.5
V
IOL = 0.1mA
0.5
V
IOL = 50µA
0.5
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, IOL = 1mA
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4,
P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7
VOL
LOW Output
Voltage
XOUT
LOW Output
Voltage
XCOUT HIGHPOWER
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
HIGHPOWER
LOWPOWER
LOWPOWER
_________ _______
With no load applied
0
With no load applied
0
V
0.2
0.8
V
RESET
0.2
1.8
V
XIN
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 3.3V
0.2
0.8
V
4.0
µA
–4.0
µA
500
kΩ
HOLD, RDY, TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN,
________
________ _______ _____________ _________
_________
INT0 to INT5, NMI, ADTRG, CTS0 to CTS2,
SCL0 to SCL2, SDA0 to SDA2, CLK0 to CLK3,
_____
_____
TA0OUT to TA4OUT, KI0 to KI3,
RXD0 to RXD2, SIN3
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
VT+-VT- Hysteresis
IIH
HIGH Input
Current
_____________
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
____________
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
IIL
LOW Input
Current
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 0V
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7,
P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7,
____________
XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE
RPULLUP Pull-up
Resistance
P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, VI = 0V
P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7,
50
100
P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to
P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0, P9_2 to P9_7,
P10_0 to P10_7
RfXIN
Feedback Resistance
XIN
3.0
MΩ
RfXCIN
Feedback Resistance
RAM Retention Voltage
XCIN
25
MΩ
V
VRAM
At stop mode
2.0
NOTES:
1. Referenced to VCC = 3.0 to 3.6V, VSS = 0V at Topr = –40 to 85°C, f(BCLK) = 24MHz unless otherwise specified.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 327 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.52 External Clock Input (XIN Input)
Symbol
Parameter
tC
External Clock Input Cycle Time
tw(H)
External Clock Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(L)
External Clock Input LOW Pulse Width
tr
External Clock Rise Time
tf
External Clock Fall Time
Standard
Min.
Max.
62.5
25
25
15
15
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.53 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
Symbol
Parameter
tac1(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with no wait)
tac2(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
Data input access time (for setting with wait)
tsu(DB-RD)
tsu(RDY-BCLK)
Data input setup time
Standard
Unit
Min.
Max.
(NOTE 1) ns
(NOTE 2) ns
(NOTE 3)
Data input access time (when accessing multiplexed bus area)
50
40
________
RDY input setup time
__________
tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD input setup time
th(RD-DB)
Data input hold time
________
th(BCLK-RDY) RDY input hold time
__________
th(BCLK-HOLD) HOLD input hold time
50
0
0
0
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 60 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 60 [ns]
n is “2” for 1-wait setting, “3” for 2-wait setting and “4” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 109
– 60 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 328 of 376
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.54 Timer A Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
150
60
60
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.55 Timer A Input (Gating Input in Timer Mode)
Parameter
Symbol
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
600
300
300
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.56 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in One-shot Timer Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
300
150
150
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.57 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in Pulse Width Modulation Mode)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
150
tw(TAL)
TAiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
150
Symbol
Parameter
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.58 Timer A Input (Counter Increment/decrement Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
Standard
Min.
Max.
3000
1500
tc(UP)
TAiOUT Input Cycle Time
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT Input HIGH Pulse Width
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT Input LOW Pulse Width
tsu(UP-TIN)
TAiOUT Input Setup Time
1500
600
th(TIN-UP)
TAiOUT Input Hold Time
600
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.59 Timer A Input (Two-phase Pulse Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
Parameter
tc(TA)
TAiIN Input Cycle Time
tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT Input Setup Time
tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) TAiIN Input Setup Time
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 329 of 376
Standard
Max.
Min.
2
500
500
Unit
µs
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Timing Requirements
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0V, at Topr = –40 to 85°C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.60 Timer B Input (Counter Input in Event Counter Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on one edge)
Standard
Min.
Max.
150
60
60
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
300
120
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width (counted on both edges)
120
TBiIN Input Cycle Time (counted on both edges)
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.61 Timer B Input (Pulse Period Measurement Mode)
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
600
300
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
300
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.62 Timer B Input (Pulse Width Measurement Mode)
Symbol
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
tw(TBL)
Parameter
TBiIN Input Cycle Time
TBiIN Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
600
300
300
TBiIN Input LOW Pulse Width
Unit
ns
ns
ns
Table 22.63 A/D Trigger Input
Symbol
tC(AD)
tw(ADL)
Parameter
_____________
ADTRG Input Cycle Time (trigger able minimum)
Standard
Min.
Max.
1500
_____________
ADTRG Input LOW Pulse Width
200
Unit
ns
ns
Table 22.64 Serial Interface
CLKi Input HIGH Pulse Width
Standard
Min.
Max.
300
150
CLKi Input LOW Pulse Width
150
Symbol
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
tw(CKL)
td(C-Q)
th(C-Q)
tsu(D-C)
th(C-D)
Parameter
CLKi Input Cycle Time
160
TXDi Output Delay Time
RXDi Input Setup Time
0
100
RXDi Input Hold Time
90
TXDi Hold Time
Unit
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
_______
Table 22.65 External Interrupt INTi Input
Symbol
tw(INH)
tw(INL)
Parameter
_______
INTi Input HIGH Pulse Width
_______
INTi Input LOW Pulse Width
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 330 of 376
Standard
Min.
Max.
380
380
Unit
ns
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.66 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for setting with no wait)
Symbol
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Standard
Min.
Max.
30
Measuring
condition
Parameter
Address output delay time
Figure 22.23
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
ALE signal output delay time
25
ns
ns
30
ns
ns
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
30
WR signal output hold time
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
40
(3)
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(3)
ns
4
ns
(NOTE 2)
ns
(NOTE 1)
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
30
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output hold time
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns.
R
DBi
C
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
30pF
Figure 22.23 Port P0 to P10 Measurement Circuit
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 331 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.67 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for 1- to 3-wait setting and external area access)
Symbol
Measuring
condition
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Figure 22.23
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Standard
Min.
Max.
30
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
0
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
30
ns
ns
25
ns
ns
30
ns
ns
30
ns
ns
40
ns
ns
4
ALE signal output delay time
ALE signal output hold time
–4
RD signal output delay time
RD signal output hold time
0
WR signal output delay time
WR signal output hold time
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(3)
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
ns
ns
4
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
(3)
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Unit
ns
(NOTE 1)
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
40
ns
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n – 0.5) ✕ 10
– 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
n is “1” for 1-wait setting, “2” for 2-wait setting and “3” for 3-wait setting.
When n = 1, f(BCLK) is 12.5 MHz or less.
3. This standard value shows the timing when the
output is off, and does not show hold time of
data bus.
Hold time of data bus varies with capacitor volume
and pull-up (pull-down) resistance value.
Hold time of data bus is expressed in
t = – CR ✕ ln (1 – VOL / VCC)
by a circuit of the right figure.
For example, when VOL = 0.2 VCC, C = 30 pF,
R =1 kΩ, hold time of output “L” level is
t = – 30 pF ✕ 1 kΩ ✕ ln (1 – 0.2 VCC / VCC) = 6.7 ns..
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 332 of 376
R
DBi
C
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Switching Characteristics
VCC
(Referenced to VCC = 3.3V, VSS = 0 V, at Topr = –40 to 85 °C unless otherwise specified)
= 3.3V
Table 22.68 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(for 2- to 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Symbol
Parameter
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
th(RD-AD)
th(WR-AD)
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
th(WR-CS)
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-WR)
th(BCLK-WR)
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
td(DB-WR)
th(WR-DB)
Address output delay time
Measuring
condition
Figure 22.23
Standard
Min.
Max.
50
Address output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Address output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output delay time
50
Chip select output hold time (refers to BCLK)
(NOTE 1)
Chip select output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
RD signal output delay time
ns
40
RD signal output hold time
40
WR signal output hold time
ns
ns
0
Data output delay time (refers to BCLK)
ns
ns
0
WR signal output delay time
ns
ns
ns
ns
4
Chip select output hold time (refers to RD)
ns
ns
ns
4
Address output hold time (refers to RD)
Unit
50
ns
Data output hold time (refers to BCLK)
4
ns
Data output delay time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 2)
ns
Data output hold time (refers to WR)
(NOTE 1)
ns
__________
td(BCLK-HLDA)
HLDA output delay time
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-ALE)
th(ALE-AD)
td(AD-RD)
td(AD-WR)
tdZ(RD-AD)
ALE signal output delay time (refers to BCLK)
40
ns
25
ns
–4
ns
ALE signal output delay time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 3)
ns
ALE signal output hold time (refers to Address)
(NOTE 4)
ns
RD signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ns
WR signal output delay from the end of Address
0
ALE signal output hold time (refers to BCLK)
Address output floating start time
NOTES:
1. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 10 [ns]
f(BCLK)
2. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
(n –0.5) ✕ 10
f(BCLK)
9
– 50 [ns]
n is “2” for 2-wait setting, “3” for 3-wait setting.
3. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 10 – 40 [ns]
f(BCLK)
9
4. Calculated according to the BCLK frequency as follows:
0.5 ✕ 109 – 15 [ns]
f(BCLK)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 333 of 376
ns
8
ns
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 3.3V
XIN input
tr
tr
tw(H)
tw(L)
tc
tc(TA)
tw(TAH)
TAiIN input
tw(TAL)
tc(UP)
tw(UPH)
TAiOUT input
tw(UPL)
TAiOUT input
(Up/down input)
During event counter mode
TAiIN input
(When count on falling edge
is selected)
th(TIN—UP) tsu(UP—TIN)
TAiIN input
(When count on rising edge
is selected)
Two-phase pulse input in event counter mode
tC(TA)
TAiIN input
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAIN—TAOUT)
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
TAiOUT input
tsu(TAOUT—TAIN)
tc(TB)
tw(TBH)
TBiIN input
tw(TBL)
tc(AD)
tw(ADL)
ADTRG input
tc(CK)
tw(CKH)
CLKi
tw(CKL)
th(C—Q)
TXDi
td(C—Q)
tsu(D—C)
RXDi
tw(INL)
INTi input
tw(INH)
Figure 22.24 Timing Diagram (1)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 334 of 376
th(C—D)
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
VCC = 3.3V
(Effective for setting with wait)
BCLK
RD
(Separate bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Separate bus)
RD
(Multiplexed bus)
WR, WRL, WRH
(Multiplexed bus)
RDY input
tsu(RDY–BCLK)
th(BCLK–RDY)
(Common to setting with wait and setting without wait)
BCLK
tsu(HOLD–BCLK)
th(BCLK–HOLD)
HOLD input
HLDA output
td(BCLK–HLDA)
P0, P1, P2,
P3, P4,
P5_0 to P5_2 (1)
td(BCLK–HLDA)
Hi–Z
NOTE:
1. The above pins are set to high-impedance regardless of the input level of the BYTE pin,
the PM06 bit in the PM0 register and the PM11 bit in the PM1 register.
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : Determined with VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage: Determined with VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.25 Timing Diagram (2)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 335 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For setting with no wait)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
30ns.max
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
RD
tac1(RD-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
tSU(DB-RD)
50ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
30ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.26 Timing Diagram (3)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min (0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
page 336 of 376
VCC = 3.3V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 1-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
0ns.min
-4ns.min
30ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
30ns.max
0ns.min
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
th(RD-DB)
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
50ns.min
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
tcyc
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
30ns.max
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR,WRL,
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
40ns.max
Hi-Z
DBi
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.27 Timing Diagram (4)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 337 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 3.3V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 2-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
30ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-RD)
30ns.max
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
50ns.min
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
td(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
30ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
td(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.28 Timing Diagram (5)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
th(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
page 338 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
VCC = 3.3V
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
VCC = 3.3V
(For 3-wait setting and external area access)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
CSi
th(BCLK-AD)
td(BCLK-AD)
30ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(RD-AD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
30ns.max
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
30ns.max
0ns.min
RD
tac2(RD-DB)
(3.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
DBi
Hi-Z
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
50ns.min
0ns.min
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
CSi
30ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
30ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
th(BCLK-ALE)
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
30ns.max
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
WR, WRL
WRH
DBi
td(BCLK-DB)
th(BCLK-DB)
40ns.max
4ns.min
Hi-Z
td(DB-WR)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
1
tcyc =
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.29 Timing Diagram (6)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 339 of 376
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
VCC = 3.3V
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
(For 2-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
40ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
Address
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
8ns.max
Address
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
tac3(RD-DB)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
tSU(DB-RD)
th(RD-DB)
0ns.min
50ns.min
td(AD-RD)
0ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
4ns.min
40ns.max
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
40ns.max
th(RD-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-RD)
th(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
40ns.max
RD
Write timing
BCLK
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
tcyc
40ns.max
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
4ns.min
50ns.max
ADi
/DBi
Address
Data output
td(DB-WR)
td(AD-ALE)
(1.5 ✕ tcyc-50)ns.min
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
Address
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
40ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
td(BCLK-ALE)
th(BCLK-ALE)
td(AD-WR)
-4ns.min
0ns.min
40ns.max
th(WR-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
40ns.max
WR,WRL,
WRH
tcyc =
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.30 Timing Diagram (7)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 340 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
22. Electric Characteristics (Normal-ver.)
Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode
VCC = 3.3V
(For 3-wait setting, external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
Read timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(RD-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
th(BCLK-CS)
6ns.min
40ns.max
CSi
td(AD-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
ADi
/DBi
th(ALE-AD)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-15)ns.min
Address
td(BCLK-AD)
td(AD-RD)
40ns.max
ADi
BHE
Data input
tdZ(RD-AD)
8ns.max
th(RD-DB)
tac3(RD-DB)
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-60)ns.max
0ns.min
tSU(DB-RD)
0ns.min
th(BCLK-AD)
50ns.min
4ns.min
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
40ns.max
th(RD-AD)
th(BCLK-ALE)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
-4ns.min
ALE
th(BCLK-RD)
td(BCLK-RD)
0ns.min
40ns.max
RD
Write timing
tcyc
BCLK
th(WR-CS)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-CS)
40ns.max
th(BCLK-CS)
4ns.min
CSi
th(BCLK-DB)
td(BCLK-DB)
50ns.max
ADi
/DBi
4ns.min
Address
Data output
td(AD-ALE)
td(DB-WR)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-40)ns.min
(2.5 ✕ tcyc-50)ns.min
th(WR-DB)
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
td(BCLK-AD)
th(BCLK-AD)
40ns.max
4ns.min
ADi
BHE
(no multiplex)
td(BCLK-ALE)
40ns.max
th(BCLK-ALE)
th(WR-AD)
-4ns.min
td(AD-WR)
ALE
td(BCLK-WR)
40ns.max
WR, WRL
WRH
tcyc =
(0.5 ✕ tcyc-10)ns.min
0ns.min
1
f(BCLK)
Measuring conditions :
VCC = 3.3 V
Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.6 V, VIH = 2.7 V
Output timing voltage : VOL = 1.65 V, VOH = 1.65 V
Figure 22.31 Timing Diagram (8)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 341 of 376
th(BCLK-WR)
0ns.min
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23. Usage Precaution
23.1 External Bus
When resetting CNVSS pin with “H” input, contents of internal ROM cannot be read out.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 342 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.2 PLL Frequency Synthesizer
Stabilize supply voltage so that the standard of the power supply ripple is met. (Refer to 22. Electrical
characteristics.)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 343 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.3 Power Control
____________
• When exiting stop mode by hardware reset, set RESET pin to “L” until a main clock oscillation is stabilized.
• Set the MR0 bit in the TAiMR register (i = 0 to 4) to “0” (pulse is not output) to use the timer A to exit stop
mode.
• When entering wait mode, insert a JMP.B instruction before a WAIT instruction. Do not execute any
instructions which can generate a write to RAM between the JMP.B and WAIT instructions. Disable the
DMA transfers, if a DMA transfer may occur between the JMP.B and WAIT instructions. After the WAIT
instruction, insert at least 4 NOP instructions. When entering wait mode, the instruction queue roadstead
the instructions following WAIT, and depending on timing, some of these may execute before the
microcomputer enters wait mode.
Program example when entering wait mode
Program Example:
JMP.B
L1
; Insert JMP.B instruction before WAIT instruction
FSET
WAIT
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
I
;
; Enter wait mode
; More than 4 NOP instructions
L1:
• When entering stop mode, insert a JMP.B instruction immediately after executing an instruction which
sets the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to “1”, and then insert at least 4 NOP instructions. When entering
stop mode, the instruction queue reads ahead the instructions following the instruction which sets the
CM10 bit to “1” (all clock stops), and, some of these may execute before the microcomputer enters stop
mode or before the interrupt routine for returning from stop mode.
Program example when entering stop mode
Program Example:
FSET
BSET
JMP.B
I
CM10
L2
; Enter stop mode
; Insert JMP.B instruction
L2:
NOP
NOP
NOP
NOP
; More than 4 NOP instructions
• Wait for main clock oscillation stabilization time, before switching the clock source for CPU clock to the
main clock.
Similarly, wait until the sub clock oscillates stably before switching the clock source for CPU clock to the
sub clock.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 344 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
• Suggestions to reduce power consumption.
Ports
The processor retains the state of each I/O port even when it goes to wait mode or to stop mode.
A current flows in active I/O ports. A pass current flows in input ports that high-impedance state.
When entering wait mode or stop mode, set non-used ports to input and stabilize the potential.
A/D converter
When A/D conversion is not performed, set the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register to “0” (VREF not
connection). When A/D conversion is performed, start the A/D conversion at least 1 µs or longer after
setting the VCUT bit to “1” (VREF connection).
D/A converter
When not performing D/A conversion, set the DAiE bit (i = 0, 1) in the DACON register to “0” (input
disabled) and DAi register to “00h”.
Stopping peripheral functions
Use the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to stop the unnecessary peripheral functions during wait mode.
However, because the peripheral function clock (fC32) generated from the sub-clock does not stop, this
measure is not conducive to reducing the power consumption of the chip. If low speed mode or low power
dissipation mode is to be changed to wait mode, set the CM02 bit to “0” (do not peripheral function clock
stopped when in wait mode), before changing wait mode.
Switching the oscillation-driving capacity
Set the driving capacity to “LOW” when oscillation is stable.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 345 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.4 Protection
Set the PRC2 bit to “1” (write enabled) and then write to any address, and the PRC2 bit will be set to “0”
(write protected). The registers protected by the PRC2 bit should be changed in the next instruction after
setting the PRC2 bit to “1”. Make sure no interrupts or no DMA transfers will occur between the instruction in
which the PRC2 bit is set to “1” and the next instruction.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 346 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.5 Interrupt
23.5.1 Reading Address 00000h
Do not read the address 00000h in a program. When a maskable interrupt request is accepted, the CPU
reads interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request priority level) from the address
00000h during the interrupt sequence. At this time, the IR bit for the accepted interrupt is set to “0”.
If the address 00000h is read in a program, the IR bit for the interrupt which has the highest priority among
the enabled interrupts is set to “0”. This causes a problem that the interrupt is canceled, or an unexpected
interrupt request is generated.
23.5.2 Setting SP
Set any value in the SP (USP, ISP) before accepting an interrupt. The SP (USP, ISP) is set to “0000h”
after reset. Therefore, if an interrupt is accepted before setting any value in the SP (USP, ISP), the
program may go out of_______
control.
Especially when using NMI interrupt, set a value in the ISP at the
beginning of the program. For the first
_______
and only the first instruction after reset, all interrupts including NMI interrupt are disabled.
_______
23.5.3 _______
NMI Interrupt
_______
• The NMI interrupt cannot be disabled. If this interrupt is unused, connect the NMI pin to VCC via a
resistor (pull-up).
_______
• The input level of the NMI pin can be read by accessing the_______
P8_5 bit in the P8 register. Note that the
P8_5 bit can only be read when determining the pin level
in
NMI
interrupt routine.
_______
• _______
Stop mode cannot be entered into while input on the NMI pin is low. This is because while input on the
NMI pin is low the CM10 bit in the CM1 register
is fixed to “0”.
_______
_______
• Do not go to wait mode while input on the NMI pin is low. This is because when input on the NMI pin
goes low, the CPU stops but CPU clock remains active; therefore, the current consumption in the chip
does not drop. In this case, normal condition is restored by_______
an interrupt generated thereafter.
• The low and high level durations of the input signal to the NMI pin must each be 2 CPU clock cycles +
300 ns or more.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 347 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.5.4 Changing Interrupt Generate Factor
If the interrupt generate factor is changed, the IR bit of the interrupt control register for the changed
interrupt may inadvertently be set to “1” (interrupt requested). If you changed the interrupt generate factor
for an interrupt that needs to be used, be sure to set the IR bit for that interrupt to “0” (interrupt not
requested).
Changing the interrupt generate factor referred to here means any act of changing the source, polarity or
timing of the interrupt assigned to each software interrupt number. Therefore, if a mode change of any
peripheral function involves changing the generate factor, polarity or timing of an interrupt, be sure to set
the IR bit for that interrupt to “0” (interrupt not requested) after making such changes. Refer to the description
of each peripheral function for details about the interrupts from peripheral functions.
Figure 23.1 shows the procedure for changing the interrupt generate factor.
Changing the interrupt source
Disable interrupt (2) (3)
Change the interrupt generate factor
(including a mode change of peripheral function)
Use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to "0"
(interrupt not requested) (3)
Enable interrupt (2) (3)
End of change
IR bit: A bit in the interrupt control register for the interrupt whose interrupt generate factor is
to be changed
NOTES:
1.The above settings must be executed individually. Do not execute two or more settings
simultaneously (using one instruction).
2.Use the I flag for the INTi interrupt (i = 0 to 5).
For the interrupts from peripheral functions other than the INTi interrupt, turn off the
peripheral function that is the source of the interrupt in order not to generate an interrupt
request before changing the interrupt generate factor. In this case, if the maskable
interrupts can all be disabled without causing a problem, use the I flag. Otherwise, use
the corresponding ILVL2 to ILVL0 bit for the interrupt whose interrupt generate factor is
to be changed.
3.Refer to 23.5.6 Rewrite Interrupt Control Register for details about the instructions to
use and the notes to be taken for instruction execution.
Figure 23.1 Procedure for Changing Interrupt Generate Factor
_____
23.5.5 INT Interrupt
• Either an “L” ________
level of at
least tW(INH) or an “H” level of at least tW(INL) width is necessary for the signal
________
input to pins INT0 to INT5 regardless of the CPU operation clock.
• If the POL bit in the INT0IC to INT5IC registers or the IFSR10 to IFSR17 bits in the IFSR1 register are
changed, the IR bit may inadvertently set to “1” (interrupt requested). Be sure to set the IR bit to “0”
(interrupt not requested) after changing any of those register bits.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 348 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.5.6 Rewrite Interrupt Control Register
(a) The interrupt control register for any interrupt should be modified in places where no interrupt requests
may be generated. Otherwise, disable the interrupt before rewriting the interrupt control register.
(b) To rewrite the interrupt control register for any interrupt after disabling that interrupt, be careful with
the instruction to be used.
Changing any bit other than IR bit
If while executing an instruction, an interrupt request controlled by the register being modified is
generated, the IR bit of the register may not be set to “1” (interrupt requested), with the result that
the interrupt request is ignored. If such a situation presents a problem, use the instructions shown
below to modify the register.
Usable instructions: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET
Changing IR bit
Depending on the instruction used, the IR bit may not always be set to “0” (interrupt not requested).
Therefore, be sure to use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to “0”.
(c) When using the I flag to disable an interrupt, refer to the sample program fragments shown below
as you set the I flag. (Refer to (b) for details about rewrite the interrupt control registers in the
sample program fragments.)
Examples 1 through 3 show how to prevent the I flag from being set to “1” (interrupt enabled) before
the interrupt control register is rewritten, owing to the effects of the internal bus and the instruction
queue buffer.
Example 1: Using the NOP instruction to keep the program waiting until the interrupt control register is modified
INT_SWITCH1:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupt.
AND.B #00h, 0055h
; Set the TA0IC register to “00h”.
NOP
;
NOP
FSET
I
; Enable interrupt.
The number of the NOP instruction is as follows.
• The PM20 bit in the PM2 register = 1 (1 wait) : 2
• The PM20 bit = 0 (2 waits) : 3
• When using HOLD function : 4
Example 2: Using the dummy read to keep the FSET instruction waiting
INT_SWITCH2:
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupt.
AND.B #00h, 0055h
; Set the TA0IC register to “00h”.
MOV.W MEM, R0
; Dummy read.
FSET
I
; Enable interrupt.
Example 3: Using the POPC instruction to changing the I flag
INT_SWITCH3:
PUSHC FLG
FCLR
I
; Disable interrupt.
AND.B #00h, 0055h
; Set the TA0IC register to “00h”.
POPC FLG
; Enable interrupt.
23.5.7 Watchdog Timer Interrupt
Initialize the watchdog timer after the watchdog timer interrupt request is generated.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 349 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.6 DMAC
23.6.1 Write to DMAE Bit in DMiCON Register (i = 0, 1)
When both of the conditions below are met, follow the steps below.
Conditions
• The DMAE bit is set to “1” again while it remains set (DMAi is in an active state).
• A DMA request may occur simultaneously when the DMAE bit is being written.
Step 1: Write “1” to the DMAE bit and DMAS bit in the DMiCON register simultaneously (1).
Step 2: Make sure that the DMAi is in an initial state (2) in a program.
If the DMAi is not in an initial state, the above steps should be repeated.
NOTES:
1. The DMAS bit remains unchanged even if “1” is written. However, if “0” is written to this bit, it is set
to “0” (DMA not requested). In order to prevent the DMAS bit from being modified to “0, “1” should be
written to the DMAS bit when “1” is written to the DMAE bit. In this way the state of the DMAS bit
immediately before being written can be maintained.
Similarly, when writing to the DMAE bit with a read-modify-write instruction, “1” should be written to
the DMAS bit in order to maintain a DMA request which is generated during execution.
2. Read the TCRi register to verify whether the DMAi is in an initial state. If the read value is equal to
a value which was written to the TCRi register before DMA transfer start, the DMAi is in an initial
state. (If a DMA request occurs after writing to the DMAE bit, the value written to the TCRi register
is “1”.) If the read value is a value in the middle of transfer, the DMAi is not in an initial state.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 350 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.7 Timers
23.7.1 Timer A
23.7.1.1 Timer A (Timer Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TAiMR (i =
0 to 4) register and the TAi register before setting the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TAiMR register is modified while the TAiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless
whether after reset or not.
While counting is in progress, the counter value can be read out at any time by reading the TAi register.
However, if the counter is read at the same time it is reloaded, the value “FFFFh” is read. Also, if the
counter is read before it starts counting after a value is set in the TAi register while not counting, the set
value is read.
______
If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI
pin when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three______
phase output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the TA1OUT, TA2OUT and TA4OUT pins go
to a high-impedance state.
23.7.1.2 Timer A (Event Counter Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TAiMR
(i = 0 to 4) register, the TAi register, the UDF register, the TAZIE, TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits in the ONSF
register and the TRGSR register before setting the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TAiMR register, the UDF register, the TAZIE, TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits in the
ONSF register and the TRGSR register are modified while the TAiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless
whether after reset or not.
While counting is in progress, the counter value can be read out at any time by reading the TAi register.
However, “FFFFh” can be read in underflow, while reloading, and “0000h” in overflow. When setting the
TAi register to a value during a counter stop, the setting value can be read before a counter starts
counting. Also, if the counter is read before it starts counting after a value is set in the TAi register while
not counting, the set value is read.
______
If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI
pin when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three______
phase output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the TA1OUT, TA2OUT and TA4OUT pins go
to a high-impedance state.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 351 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.7.1.3 Timer A (One-shot Timer Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TAiMR
(i = 0 to 4) register, the TAi register, the TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits in the ONSF register and the TRGSR
register before setting the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TAiMR register, the TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits and the TRGSR register are
modified while the TAiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless whether after reset or not.
When setting the TAiS bit to “0” (count stop), the followings occur:
• A counter stops counting and a content of reload register is reloaded.
• TAiOUT pin outputs “L”.
• After one cycle of the CPU clock, the IR bit in the TAiIC register is set to “1” (interrupt request).
Output in one-shot timer mode synchronizes with a count source internally generated. When an external
trigger has been selected, one-cycle delay of a count source as maximum occurs between a trigger
input to TAiIN pin and output in one-shot timer mode.
The IR bit is set to “1” when timer operation mode is set with any of the following procedures:
• Select one-shot timer mode after reset.
• Change an operation mode from timer mode to one-shot timer mode.
• Change an operation mode from event counter mode to one-shot timer mode.
To use the Timer Ai interrupt (the IR bit), set the IR bit to “0” after the changes listed above have been
made.
When a trigger occurs, while counting, a counter reloads the reload register to continue counting after
generating a re-trigger and counting down once. To generate a trigger while counting, generate a second
trigger between occurring the previous trigger and operating longer than one cycle of a timer count
source.
______
If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI
pin when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three______
phase output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the TA1OUT, TA2OUT and TA4OUT pins go
to a high-impedance state.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 352 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.7.1.4 Timer A (Pulse Width Modulation Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TAiMR
(i = 0 to 4) register, the TAi register, the TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits in the ONSF register and the TRGSR
register before setting the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to “1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TAiMR register, the TA0TGL and TA0TGH bits in the ONSF register and the
TRGSR register are modified while the TAiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless whether after reset
or not.
The IR bit is set to “1” when setting a timer operation mode with any of the following procedures:
• Select the pulse width modulation mode after reset.
• Change an operation mode from timer mode to pulse width modulation mode.
• Change an operation mode from event counter mode to pulse width modulation mode.
To use the Timer Ai interrupt (the IR bit), set the IR bit to “0” by program after the above listed changes
have been made.
When setting TAiS bit to “0” (count stop) during PWM pulse output, the following action occurs:
• Stop counting.
• When TAiOUT pin is output “H”, output level is set to “L” and the IR bit is set to “1”.
• When TAiOUT pin is output “L”, both output level and the IR bit remain unchanged.
______
If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI
pin when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three______
phase output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the TA1OUT, TA2OUT and TA4OUT pins go
to a high-impedance state.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 353 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.7.2 Timer B
23.7.2.1 Timer B (Timer Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TBiMR
(i = 0 to 5) register and TBi register before setting the TBiS bit (1) in the TABSR or the TBSR register to
“1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TBiMR register is modified while the TBiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless
whether after reset or not.
NOTE:
1. The TB0S to TB2S bits are the bits 5 to 7 in the TABSR register, the TB3S to TB5S bits are the bits
5 to 7 in the TBSR register.
A value of a counter, while counting, can be read in the TBi register at any time. “FFFFh” is read while
reloading. Setting value is read between setting values in the TBi register at count stop and starting a
counter.
23.7.2.2 Timer B (Event Counter Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, counter value, etc. using the TBiMR
(i = 0 to 5) register and TBi register before setting the TBiS bit in the TABSR or the TBSR register to “1”
(count starts).
Always make sure the TBiMR register is modified while the TBiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless
whether after reset or not.
The counter value can be read out on-the-fly at any time by reading the TBi register. However, if this
register is read at the same time the counter is reloaded, the read value is always “FFFFh.” If the TBi
register is read after setting a value in it while not counting but before the counter starts counting, the
read value is the one that has been set in the register.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 354 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.7.2.3 Timer B (Pulse Period/pulse Width Measurement Mode)
The timer remains idle after reset. Set the mode, count source, etc. using the TBiMR (i = 0 to 5) register
before setting the TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR register to “1” (count starts).
Always make sure the TBiMR register is modified while the TBiS bit remains “0” (count stops) regardless
whether after reset or not. To set the MR3 bit to “0” by writing to the TBiMR register while the TBiS bit =
1 (count starts), be sure to write the same value as previously written to the TM0D0, TM0D1, MR0, MR1,
TCK0 and TCK1 bits and a 0 to the MR2 bit.
The IR bit in the TBiIC register goes to “1” (interrupt request), when an effective edge of a measurement
pulse is input or timer Bi is overflowed. The factor of interrupt request can be determined by use of the
MR3 bit in the TBiMR register within the interrupt routine.
If the source of interrupt cannot be identified by the MR3 bit such as when the measurement pulse input
and a timer overflow occur at the same time, use another timer to count the number of times Timer B has
overflowed.
To set the MR3 bit to “0” (no overflow), set the TBiMR register with setting the TBiS bit to “1” and
counting the next count source after setting the MR3 bit to “1” (overflow).
Use the IR bit in the TBiIC register to detect only overflows. Use the MR3 bit only to determine the
interrupt factor.
When a count is started and the first effective edge is input, an indeterminate value is transferred to the
reload register. At this time, Timer Bi interrupt request is not generated.
A value of the counter is indeterminate at the beginning of a count. The MR3 bit may be set to “1” and
Timer Bi interrupt request may be generated between a count start and an effective edge input.
For pulse width measurement, pulse widths are successively measured. Use program to check whether
the measurement result is an “H” level width or an “L” level width.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 355 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.8 Serial Interface
23.8.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
23.8.1.1 Transmission/reception
_______
________
With an external clock selected, and choosing the RTS function, the output level of the RTSi pin goes to
“L” when the data-receivable status becomes ready,
which informs the transmission side that the recep________
________
tion has become ready. The
output
level
of
the
RTSi
pin
goes to “H” when reception starts. So if the RTSi
________
pin is connected to the CTSi pin on the transmission side,
the circuit can transmission and reception
_______
data with consistent timing. With the internal clock, the RTS function has no effect.
_______
If a low-level signal is applied to the NMI
pin when the IVPCR1
bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three_______
_________
phase output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the RTS2 and CLK2 pins go to a high-impedance state.
23.8.1.2 Transmission
When an external clock is selected, the conditions must be met while if the CKPOL bit in the UiC0
register = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and the receive data taken in at the rising edge of the
transfer clock), the external clock is in the high state; if the CKPOL bit = 1 (transmit data output at the
rising edge and the receive data taken in at the falling edge of the transfer clock), the external clock is in
the low state.
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The
TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data ________
present in UiTB register)
_______
• If CTS function is selected, input on the CTSi pin = L
23.8.1.3 Reception
In operating the clock synchronous serial I/O, operating a transmitter generates a shift clock. Fix settings
for transmission even when using the device only for reception. Dummy data is output to the outside
from the TXDi (i = 0 to 2) pin when receiving data.
When an internal clock is selected, set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to “1” (transmission enabled) and
write dummy data to the UiTB register, and the shift clock will thereby be generated. When an external
clock is selected, set the TE bit to “1” and write dummy data to the UiTB register, and the shift clock will
be generated when the external clock is fed to the CLKi input pin.
When successively receiving data, if all bits of the next receive data are prepared in the UARTi receive
register while the RI bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (data present in the UiRB register), an overrun error
occurs and the OER bit in the UiRB register is set to “1” (overrun error occurred). In this case, because
the content of the UiRB register is indeterminate, a corrective measure must be taken by programs on
the transmit and receive sides so that the valid data before the overrun error occurred will be retransmitted.
Note that when an overrun error occurred, the IR bit in the SiRIC register does not change state.
To receive data in succession, set dummy data in the lower-order byte of the UiTB register every time
reception is made.
When an external clock is selected, the conditions must be met while if the CKPOL bit = 0, the external
clock is in the high state; if the CKPOL bit = 1, the external clock is in the low state.
• The RE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (reception enabled)
• The TE bit in the UiC1 register = 1 (transmission enabled)
• The TI bit in the UiC1 register = 0 (data present in the UiTB register)
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 356 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.8.2 Special Modes
23.8.2.1 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode)
When generating start, stop and restart conditions, set the STSPSEL bit in the UiSMR4 register to “0”
(start and stop conditions not output) and wait for more than half cycle of the transfer clock before setting
each condition generate bit (STAREQ, RSTAREQ and STPREQ bits) from “0” (clear) to “1” (start).
23.8.2.2 Special Mode 2
_______
If a low-level signal is applied to _______
the NMI pin when the _________
IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three-phase
output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the RTS2 and CLK2 pins go to a high-impedance state.
23.8.2.3 Special Mode 4 (SIM Mode)
A transmit interrupt request is generated by setting the U2IRS bit in the U2C1 register to “1” (transmission
complete) and U2ERE bit in the U2C1 register to “1” (error signal output) after reset. Therefore, when
using SIM mode, be sure to set the IR bit to “0” (no interrupt request) after setting these bits.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 357 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.8.3 SI/O3
The SOUT3 default value which is set to the SOUT3 pin by the SM37 in the S3C register bit approximately
10ns may be output when changing the SM33 bit in the S3C register from “0” (I/O port) to “1” (SOUT3
output and CLK3 function) while the SM32 bit in the S3C register to “0” (SOUT3 output) and the SM36 bit
is set to “1” (internal clock). And then the SOUT3 pin is held high-impedance.
If the level which is output from the SOUT3 pin is a problem when changing the SM33 bit from “0” to “1”,
set the default value of the SOUT3 pin by the SM37 bit.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 358 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.9 A/D Converter
Set the ADCON0 (except bit 6), ADCON1 and ADCON2 registers when A/D conversion is stopped (before
a trigger occurs).
When the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register is changed from “0” (VREF not connected) to “1” (VREF
connected), start A/D conversion after passing 1 µs or longer.
To prevent noise-induced device malfunction or latch-up, as well as to reduce conversion errors, insert
capacitors between the AVCC, VREF, and analog input pins (ANi (i = 0 to 7), AN0_i, and AN2_i) each and
the AVSS pin. Similarly, insert a capacitor between the VCC pin and the VSS pin. Figure 23.2 shows an
example connection of each pin.
Make sure the port direction bits for those pins that are used as analog inputs are set to “0” (input mode).
Also, if the TGR bit in the ADCON0 register = 1 (external trigger), make sure the port direction bit for the
__________
ADTRG pin is set to “0” (input mode).
When using key input interrupt, do not use any of the four AN4 to AN7 pins as analog inputs. (A key input
interrupt request is generated when the A/D input voltage goes low.)
The φAD frequency must be 10 MHz or less. Without sample and hold, limit the φAD frequency to 250 kHz
or more. With the sample and hold, limit the φAD frequency to 1 MHz or more.
When changing an A/D operation mode, select analog input pin again in the CH2 to CH0 bits in the
ADCON0 register and the SCAN1 to SCAN0 bits in the ADCON1 register.
Microcomputer
VCC
C4
AVCC
VREF
C1
VSS
C2
AVSS
C3
ANi
ANi: ANi, AN0_i, and AN2_i (i =0 to 7)
NOTES:
1. C1 ≥ 0.47 µF, C2 ≥ 0.47 µF, C3 ≥ 100 pF, C4 ≥ 0.1 µF (reference).
2. Use thick and shortest possible wiring to connect capacitors.
Figure 23.2 Use of Capacitors to Reduce Noise
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 359 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
If the CPU reads the ADi register at the same time the conversion result is stored in the ADi register after
completion of A/D conversion, an incorrect value may be stored in the ADi register. This problem occurs
when a divide-by-n clock derived from the main clock or a sub clock is selected for CPU clock.
• When operating in one-shot or single-sweep mode
Check to see that A/D conversion is completed before reading the target ADi register. (Check the IR bit in
the ADIC register to see if A/D conversion is completed.)
• When operating in repeat mode or repeat sweep mode 0 or 1
Use the main clock for CPU clock directly without dividing it.
If A/D conversion is forcibly terminated while in progress by setting the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register to
“0” (A/D conversion halted), the conversion result of the A/D converter is indeterminate. The contents of ADi
registers irrelevant to A/D conversion may also become indeterminate. If while A/D conversion is underway
the ADST bit is set to “0” in a program, ignore the values of all ADi registers.
When setting the ADST bit to “0” in single sweep mode during A/D conversion and A/D conversion is
aborted, disable the interrupt before setting the ADST bit to “0”.
The applied intermediate potential may cause more increase in power consumption than other analog______
input ______
pins
(AN0 to AN3, AN0_0 to AN0_7 and AN2_0 to AN2_7), since the AN4 to AN7 are used with the KI0 to KI3.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 360 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.10 CAN Module
23.10.1 Reading CiSTR Register (i = 0, 1)
The CAN module on the M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) updates the status of the CiSTR register in a
certain period. When the CPU and the CAN module access to the CiSTR register at the same time, the
CPU has the access priority; the access from the CAN module is disabled. Consequently, when the
updating period of the CAN module matches the access period from the CPU, the status of the CAN
module cannot be updated. (See Figure 23.3 When Updating Period of CAN Module Matches Access
Period from CPU.)
Accordingly, be careful about the following points so that the access period from the CPU should not
match the updating period of the CAN module:
(a) There should be a wait time of 3fCAN or longer (see Table 23.1 CAN Module Status Updating Period)
before the CPU reads the CiSTR register. (See Figure 23.4 With a Wait Time of 3fCAN Before CPU
Read.)
(b) When the CPU polls the CiSTR register, the polling period must be 3fCAN or longer. (See Figure 23.5
When Polling Period of CPU is 3fCAN or Longer.)
Table 23.1 CAN Module Status Updating Period
3fCAN Period = 3 ✕ XIN (Original Oscillation Period)
(Example 1) Condition XIN 16 MHz CCLK: Divided by 1
(Example 2) Condition XIN 16 MHz CCLK: Divided by 2
(Example 3) Condition XIN 16 MHz CCLK: Divided by 4
(Example 4) Condition XIN 16 MHz CCLK: Divided by 8
(Example 5) Condition XIN 16 MHz CCLK: Divided by 16
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 361 of 376
✕
Division Value of CAN Clock (CCLK)
3fCAN period = 3 ✕ 62.5 ns ✕ 1 = 187.5 ns
3fCAN period = 3 ✕ 62.5 ns ✕ 2 = 375 ns
3fCAN period = 3 ✕ 62.5 ns ✕ 4 = 750 ns
3fCAN period = 3 ✕ 62.5 ns ✕ 8 = 1.5 µs
3fCAN period = 3 ✕ 62.5 ns ✕ 16 = 3 µs
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
fCAN
CPU read signal
Updating period of
CAN module
CPU reset signal
✕
CiSTR register
b8: State_Reset bit
0: CAN operation
mode
1: CAN reset/initialization mode
✕
✕
✕
✕
✕: When the CAN module’s State_Reset bit updating period matches the CPU’s read
period, it does not enter reset mode, for the CPU read has the higher priority.
i = 0, 1
Figure 23.3 When Updating Period of CAN Module Matches Access Period from CPU
Wait time
CPU read signal
Updating period of
the CAN module
CPU reset signal
CiSTR register
b8: Reset state flag
0: CAN operation
mode
1: CAN reset/initialization mode
: Updated without fail in period of 3fCAN
i = 0, 1
Figure 23.4 With a Wait Time of 3fCAN Before CPU Read
CPU read signal
4fCAN
Updating period of
the CAN module
CPU reset signal
CiSTR register
b8: State_Reset bit
0: CAN operation
mode
1: CAN reset/initialization mode
✕
✕: When the CAN module’s State_Reset bit updating period matches the CPU’s read
period, it does not enter reset mode, for the CPU read has the higher priority.
: Updated without fail in period of 4fCAN
i = 0, 1
Figure 23.5 When Polling Period of CPU is 3fCAN or Longer
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 362 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.10.2 Performing CAN Configuration
If the Reset bit in the CiCTLR register (i = 0, 1) is changed from “0” (operation mode) to “1” (reset/
initialization mode) in order to place the CAN module from CAN operation mode into CAN reset/initialization mode, always be sure to check that the State_Reset bit in the CiSTR register is set to “1” (reset mode).
Similarly, if the Reset bit is changed from “1” to “0” in order to place the CAN module from CAN reset/
initialization mode into CAN operation mode, always be sure to check that the State_Reset bit is set to “0”
(operation mode).
The procedure is described below.
To place CAN Module from CAN Operation Mode into CAN Reset/Initialization Mode
• Change the Reset bit from “0” to “1”.
• Check that the State_Reset bit is set to “1”.
To place CAN Module from CAN Reset/Initialization Mode into CAN Operation Mode
• Change the Reset bit from “1” to “0”.
• Check that the State_Reset bit is set to “0”.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 363 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.10.3 Suggestions to Reduce Power Consumption
When not performing CAN communication, the operation mode of CAN transceiver should be set to
“standby mode” or “sleep mode”.
When performing CAN communication, the power consumption in CAN transceiver in not performing
CAN communication can be substantially reduced by controlling the operation mode pins of CAN
transceiver.
Tables 23.2 and 23.3 show recommended pin connections.
Table 23.2 Recommended Pin Connections (In case of PCA82C250: Philips product)
Standby Mode
High-speed Mode
(1)
Rs Pin
“H”
“L”
Power Consumption in less than 170 µA
less than 70 mA
(2)
CAN Transceiver
CAN Communication impossible
possible
Connection
M16C/6N4
M16C/6N4
PCA82C250
PCA82C250
CTXi
TXD CANH
CTXi
TXD CANH
CRXi
RXD CANL
CRXi
RXD CANL
Port (3)
Port (3)
Rs
"H" output
Rs
"L" output
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. The pin which controls the operation mode of CAN transceiver.
2. In case of Ta = 25 °C
3. Connect to enabled port to control CAN transceiver.
Table 23.3 Recommended Pin Connections (In case of PCA82C252: Philips product)
Sleep Mode
_______
(1)
STB Pin
EN Pin (1)
Power Consumption in
CAN Transceiver (2)
CAN Communication
Connection
Normal Operation Mode
“L”
“L”
less than 50 µA
“H”
“H”
less than 35 mA
impossible
possible
M16C/6N4
PCA82C252
M16C/6N4
CTXi
TXD CANH
CTXi
TXD CANH
CRXi
RXD CANL
CRXi
RXD CANL
Port (3)
STB
Port (3)
STB
Port (3)
EN
Port (3)
EN
"L" output
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. The pin which controls the operation mode of CAN transceiver.
2. Ta = 25 °C
3. Connect to enabled port to control CAN transceiver.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
PCA82C252
page 364 of 376
"H" output
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.10.4 CAN Transceiver in Boot Mode
When programming the flash memory in boot mode via CAN bus, the operation mode of CAN transceiver
should be set to “high-speed mode” or “normal operation mode”. If the operation mode is controlled by
the microcomputer, CAN transceiver must be set the operation mode to “high-speed mode” or “normal
operation mode” before programming the flash memory by changing the switch etc. Tables 23.4 and 23.5
show pin connections of CAN transceiver.
Table 23.4 Pin Connections of CAN Transceiver (In case of PCA82C250: Philips product)
Standby Mode
High-speed Mode
(1)
Rs Pin
“H”
“L”
CAN Communication impossible
possible
Connection
M16C/6N4
M16C/6N4
PCA82C250
PCA82C250
CTXi
TXD CANH
CTXi
TXD CANH
CRXi
RXD CANL
CRXi
RXD CANL
Port (2)
Rs
Port (2)
Switch OFF
Rs
Switch ON
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. The pin which controls the operation mode of CAN transceiver.
2. Connect to enabled port to control CAN transceiver.
Table 23.5 Pin Connections of CAN Transceiver (In case of PCA82C252: Philips product)
Sleep Mode
Normal Operation Mode
_______
(1)
STB Pin
“L”
“H”
(1)
EN Pin
“L”
“H”
CAN Communication impossible
possible
Connection
M16C/6N4
PCA82C252
M16C/6N4
CTXi
TXD CANH
CTXi
TXD CANH
CRXi
RXD CANL
CRXi
RXD CANL
Port (2)
STB
Port (2)
STB
Port (2)
EN
Port (2)
EN
Switch OFF
i = 0, 1
NOTES:
1. The pin which controls the operation mode of CAN transceiver.
2. Connect to enabled port to control CAN transceiver.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
PCA82C252
page 365 of 376
Switch ON
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.11 Programmable I/O Ports_______
If a low-level signal is applied to the
NMI pin when the IVPCR1 bit in the TB2SC register = 1 (three-phase
_______
output forcible cutoff by input on NMI pin enabled), the P7_2 to P7_5, P8_0 and P8_1 pins go to a highimpedance state.
Setting the SM32 bit in the S3C register to “1” causes the P9_2 pin to go to a high-impedance state.
The input threshold voltage of pins differs between programmable I/O ports and peripheral functions.
Therefore, if any pin is shared by a programmable I/O port and a peripheral function and the input level at
this pin is outside the range of recommended operating conditions VIH and VIL (neither “high” nor “low”),
the input level may be determined differently depending on which side—the programmable I/O port or the
peripheral function—is currently selected.
Indeterminate values are read from the P3_7 to P3_4, PD3_7 to PD3_4 bits by reading the P3 and PD3
registers when the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register are set to “01b” (memory expansion mode) or
“11b” (microprocessor mode) and setting the PM11 bit to “1”.
Use the MOV instruction when rewriting the P3 and PD3 registers (including the case that the size specifier
is “.W” and the P2 and PD2 registers are rewritten).
When the PM01 to PM00 bits are rewritten, “L” is output from the P3_7 to P3_4 pins during 0.5 cycles of the
BCLK by setting the PM01 to PM00 bits in the PM0 register to “01b” (memory expansion mode) or “11b”
(microprocessor mode) from “00b” (single-chip mode) after setting the PM11 bit to “1”.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 366 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.12 Electrical Characteristic Differences Between Mask ROM and Flash Memory
Version Microcomputers
Flash memory version and mask ROM version may have different characteristics, operating margin, noise
tolerated dose, noise width dose in electrical characteristics due to internal ROM, different layout pattern,
etc. When switching to the mask ROM version, conduct equivalent tests as system evaluation tests
conducted in the flash memory version.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 367 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23.13 Mask ROM Version
When using the masked ROM version, write nothing to internal ROM area.
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 368 of 376
23. Usage Precaution
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.14 Flash Memory Version
23.14.1 Functions to Prevent Flash Memory from Rewriting
ID codes are stored in addresses 0FFFDFh, 0FFFE3h, 0FFFEBh, 0FFFEFh, 0FFFF3h, 0FFFF7h, and
0FFFFBh. If wrong data are written to theses addresses, the flash memory cannot be read or written in
standard serial I/O mode and CAN I/O mode.
The ROMCP register is mapped in address 0FFFFFh. If wrong data is written to this address, the flash
memory cannot be read or written in parallel I/O mode.
In the flash memory version of microcomputer, these addresses are allocated to the vector addresses (H)
of fixed vectors.
23.14.2 Stop Mode
When the microcomputer enters stop mode, execute the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to “1” (stop
mode) after setting the FMR01 bit to “0” (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and disabling the DMA transfer.
23.14.3 Wait Mode
When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to “0” (CPU rewrite mode disabled)
before executing the WAIT instruction.
23.14.4 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode
If the CM05 bit is set to “1” (main clock stopped), do not execute the following commands:
• Program
• Block erase
• Erase all unlocked blocks
• Lock bit program
• Read lock bit status
23.14.5 Writing Command and Data
Write commands and data to even addresses in the user ROM area.
23.14.6 Program Command
By writing “xx40h” in the first bus cycle and data to the write address in the second bus cycle, an auto
program operation (data program and verify) will start. The address value specified in the first bus cycle
must be the same even address as the write address specified in the second bus cycle.
23.14.7 Lock Bit Program Command
By writing “xx77h” in the first bus cycle and “xxD0h” to the highest-order even address of a block in the
second bus cycle, the lock bit for the specified block is set to “0”. The address value specified in the first
bus cycle must be the same highest-order even address of a block specified in the second bus cycle.
23.14.8 Operation Speed
Before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 or EW1 mode), set the CM11 bit in the CM1 register to “0” (main
clock), select 10 MHz or less for CPU clock using the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and CM17 to CM16
bits in the CM1 register. Also, set the PM17 bit in the PM1 register to “1” (with wait state).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 369 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.14.9 Prohibited Instructions
The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because the CPU tries to read data in flash
memory: UND instruction, INTO instruction, JMPS instruction, JSRS instruction, and BRK instruction
23.14.10 Interrupt
EW0 Mode
To use interrupts having vectors in a relocatable vector table, the vectors must be relocated to the RAM
area._______
• The NMI and watchdog timer interrupts are available since the FMR0 and FMR1 registers are forcibly
reset when either interrupt request is generated. Allocate the jump addresses for each_______
interrupt service
routines to the fixed vector table. Flash memory rewrite operation is aborted when the NMI or watchdog
timer interrupt request is generated. Execute the rewrite program again after exiting the interrupt routine.
• The address match interrupt is not available since the CPU tries to read data in the flash memory.
EW1 Mode
• Do not acknowledge any interrupts with vectors in the relocatable vector table or address match interrupt
during the auto program or auto erase period.
• Do not
use the watchdog timer interrupt.
_______
• The NMI interrupt is available since the FMR0 and FMR1 registers are forcibly reset when the interrupt
request is generated. Allocate the jump address for the_______
interrupt service routine to the fixed vector table.
Flash memory rewrite operation is aborted when the NMI interrupt request is generated. Execute the
rewrite program again after exiting the interrupt service routine.
23.14.11 How to Access
To set the FMR01, FMR02 or FMR11 bit to “1”, write “1” after first setting the bit to “0”. Do not generate an
interrupt or a DMA transfer between the instruction _______
to set the bit to “0” and the instruction to set the bit to
“1”. Set the bit while an “H” signal is applied to the NMI pin.
23.14.12 Rewriting in User ROM Area
EW0 Mode
The supply voltage drops while rewriting the block where the rewrite control program is stored, the flash
memory cannot be rewritten because the rewrite control program is not correctly rewritten. If this error
occurs, rewrite the user ROM area while in standard serial I/O mode or parallel I/O mode or CAN I/O
mode.
EW1 Mode
Avoid rewriting any block in which the rewrite control program is stored.
23.14.13 DMA Transfer
In EW1 mode, do not perform a DMA transfer while the FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register is set to “0” (auto
programming or auto erasing).
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 370 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.15 Flash Memory Programming Using Boot Program
When programming the internal flash memory using boot program, be careful about the pins state and
connection as follows.
23.15.1 Programming Using Serial I/O Mode
CTX0 pin : This pin automatically outputs “H” level.
CRX0 pin : Connect to CAN transceiver or connect via resister to VCC (pull-up)
Figure 23.6 shows a pin connection example for programming using serial I/O mode.
10-pin connector
1
M16C/6N4
VCC monitor input
3
Power
supply
GND
CLK1(P6_5)
4
RXD1(P6_6)
10
NMI(P8_5)
TXD1(P6_7)
2
PC card-type
Flash Programmer
VCC
RTS1(P6_4)
6
EPM(P5_5)
5
CRX0(P9_5)
CE(P5_0)
9
CNVSS
CTX0(P9_6)
8
RESET
7
user reset signal
Figure 23.6 Pin Connection for Programming Using Serial I/O Mode
23.15.2
Programming Using CAN I/O Mode
_________
RTS1 pin : This pin automatically outputs “H” and “L” level.
Figure 23.7 shows a pin connection example for programming using CAN I/O mode.
10-pin connector
1
10
4
M16C/6N4
VCC monitor input
CAN_H
PCA
CAN_L 82C250
6
CRX0(P9_5)
CE(P5_0)
NMI(P8_5)
PC card-type
CAN Programmer
9
CNVSS
RTS1(P6_4)
8
RESET
3
7
user reset signal
Figure 23.7 Pin Connection for Programming Using CAN I/O Mode
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 371 of 376
Power
supply
GND
CTX0(P9_6)
EPM(P5_5)
5
VCC
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
23. Usage Precaution
23.16 Noise
Connect a bypass capacitor (approximately 0.1 µF) across the VCC1 and VSS pins, and VCC2 and VSS
pins using the shortest and thicker possible wiring. Figure 23.8 shows the bypass capacitor connection.
Bypass Capacitor
Connecting Pattern
VSS
Connecting Pattern
VCC2
M16C/6N Group
(M16C/6N4)
VSS
Connecting Pattern
VCC1
Connecting Pattern
Bypass Capacitor
Figure 23.8 Bypass Capacitor Connection
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 372 of 376
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions
JEITA Package Code
P-QFP100-14x20-0.65
RENESAS Code
PRQP0100JB-A
Previous Code
100P6S-A
MASS[Typ.]
1.6g
HD
*1
D
80
51
81
50
E
*2
HE
NOTE)
1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2"
DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH.
2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT
INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET.
ZE
Reference
Symbol
100
31
30
Index mark
c
F
A2
ZD
A1
A
1
L
*3
e
y
JEITA Package Code
P-LQFP100-14x14-0.50
bp
Detail F
RENESAS Code
PLQP0100KB-A
Previous Code
100P6Q-A / FP-100U / FP-100UV
D
E
A2
HD
HE
A
A1
bp
c
e
y
ZD
ZE
L
Dimension in Millimeters
Min Nom Max
19.8 20.0 20.2
13.8 14.0 14.2
2.8
22.5 22.8 23.1
16.5 16.8 17.1
3.05
0.1 0.2
0
0.25 0.3 0.4
0.13 0.15 0.2
0∞
10∞
0.5 0.65 0.8
0.10
0.575
0.825
0.4 0.6 0.8
MASS[Typ.]
0.6g
HD
*1
D
51
75
NOTE)
1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2"
DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH.
2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT
INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET.
50
76
bp
c1
Reference
Symbol
c
E
*2
HE
b1
D
E
A2
HD
HE
A
A1
bp
b1
c
c1
100
26
1
ZE
Terminal cross section
25
Index mark
ZD
y
e
*3
bp
A1
c
A2
A
F
L
x
L1
Detail F
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 373 of 376
e
x
y
ZD
ZE
L
L1
Dimension in Millimeters
Min Nom Max
13.9 14.0 14.1
13.9 14.0 14.1
1.4
15.8 16.0 16.2
15.8 16.0 16.2
1.7
0.05 0.1 0.15
0.15 0.20 0.25
0.18
0.09 0.145 0.20
0.125
0∞
8∞
0.5
0.08
0.08
1.0
1.0
0.35 0.5 0.65
1.0
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Memo
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 374 of 376
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Register Index
Register Index
A
AD0 to AD7 ................................... 196
ADCON0 .... 195,198,200,202,204,206
ADCON1 .... 195,198,200,202,204,206
ADCON2 ....................................... 196
DAR0, DAR1 ................................... 99
DM0CON, DM1CON ....................... 98
DM0IC, DM1IC ................................ 80
DM0SL ............................................ 97
DM1SL ............................................ 98
DTT ............................................... 134
ADIC ................................................ 80
AIER ................................................ 92
F
AIER2 .............................................. 92
FMR0 ............................................ 257
FMR1 ............................................ 257
C
T
TA0 ................................................ 108
TA0IC .............................................. 80
TA0MR ............... 108,111,113,118,120
TA1 ......................................... 108,135
TA11 .............................................. 135
TA1IC .............................................. 80
TA1MR ........ 108,111,113,118,120,138
TA2 ......................................... 108,135
TA21 .............................................. 135
C01ERRIC ...................................... 80
I
TA2IC .............................................. 80
C01WKIC ........................................ 80
ICTB2 ............................................ 136
IDB0, IDB1 .................................... 134
IFSR0 .............................................. 89
IFSR1 .............................................. 89
INT0IC to INT5IC ............................ 81
INVC0 ............................................ 132
INVC1 ............................................ 133
TA2MR .... 108,111,113,115,118,120,138
C0AFS, C1AFS ............................. 224
C0CONR, C1CONR ...................... 223
C0CTLR, C1CTLR ........................ 220
C0GMR, C1GMR .......................... 218
C0ICR, C1ICR ............................... 222
C0IDR, C1IDR ............................... 222
C0LMAR, C1LMAR ....................... 218
K
C0LMBR, C1LMBR ....................... 218
C0MCTL0 to C0MCTL15 .............. 219
KUPIC ............................................. 80
C0RECIC ........................................ 80
O
C0RECR, C1RECR ....................... 224
C0SSTR, C1SSTR ........................ 225
PUR0 to PUR2 .............................. 247
C1RECIC ........................................ 81
C1TRMIC ........................................ 81
CAN0/1 Slot 0 to 15
: Time Stamp ....................... 216,217
TA41 .............................................. 135
TA4IC .............................................. 80
TA4MR .... 108,111,113,115,118,120,138
TABSR ............................ 109,124,137
TB0................................................ 123
TB0IC .............................................. 80
TB0MR ..................... 123,125,126,128
TB1IC .............................................. 80
: Message Box .................... 216,217
C1MCTL0 to C1MCTL15 .............. 219
TA4 ......................................... 108,135
P
: Data Field .......................... 216,217
C0TSR, C1TSR ............................. 224
TA3MR ......... 108,111,113,115,118,120
TB1................................................ 123
P0 to P10 ...................................... 246
PCLKR ............................................ 56
PCR ............................................... 248
PD0 to PD10 ................................. 245
PLC0 ............................................... 57
PM0 ................................................. 35
PM1 ................................................. 36
PM2 ................................................. 57
PRCR .............................................. 74
C0TRMIC ........................................ 80
TA3IC .............................................. 80
ONSF ............................................. 110
C0STR, C1STR ............................. 221
C0TECR, C1TECR ....................... 224
TA3 ................................................ 108
CCLKR ............................................ 56
TB1MR ..................... 123,125,126,128
TB2......................................... 123,135
TB2IC .............................................. 80
TB2MR .............. 123,125,126,128,138
TB2SC ........................................... 136
TB3................................................ 123
TB3IC .............................................. 80
TB3MR ..................... 123,125,126,128
TB4................................................ 123
TB4IC .............................................. 80
TB4MR ..................... 123,125,126,128
CM0 ................................................. 53
R
TB5................................................ 123
CM1 ................................................. 54
RMAD0 to RMAD3 .......................... 92
ROMCP ......................................... 254
TB5IC .............................................. 80
CM2 ................................................. 55
TBSR ............................................. 124
CPSRF .................................... 110,124
S
TCR0, TCR1 ................................... 99
S0RIC to S2RIC .............................. 80
S0TIC to S2TIC ............................... 80
S3BRG .......................................... 189
S3C ............................................... 189
S3IC ................................................ 81
S3TRR .......................................... 189
SAR0, SAR1 ................................... 99
TRGSR.................................... 110,137
CRCD ............................................ 212
CRCIN ........................................... 212
CSE ................................................. 47
CSR ................................................. 41
D
DA0, DA1 ....................................... 211
DACON .......................................... 211
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
TB5MR ..................... 123,125,126,128
page 375 of 376
U
U0BCNIC to U2BCNIC.................... 80
U0BRG to U2BRG ........................ 145
U0C0 to U2C0 ............................... 146
U0C1 to U2C1 ............................... 147
Under development
This document is under development and its contents are subject to change.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
U0MR to U2MR ............................. 146
U0RB to U2RB .............................. 145
U0SMR to U2SMR ........................ 148
U0SMR2 to U2SMR2 .................... 149
U0SMR3 to U2SMR3 .................... 149
U0SMR4 to U2SMR4 .................... 150
U0TB to U2TB ............................... 145
UCON ............................................ 148
UDF ............................................... 109
W
WDC ................................................ 94
WDTS .............................................. 94
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
REJ09B0009-0230
page 376 of 376
Register Index
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
1.00 May. 30, 2003
–
First edition issued
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
–
Revised edition issued
* Words standardizes (on-chip oscillator)
* 100P6Q-A (100-pin version) is added.
* Usage Notes Reference Book is added to Chapter 23 Usage Precaution.
* Revised parts and revised contents are as follows (except for change of chapter composition,
change of a layout, and an expressional change).
1. Overview 3rd line: "and LQFP" is added.
Table 1.1 Performance outline of M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
• Operation Mode is added.
• Address Space is added.
• Power Consumption is revised.
• "LQFP" is added to Package.
Table 1.2 Product List is revised.
Figure 1.2 Type No., Memory Size, and Package:
• "GP: Package 100P6Q-A" is added to Package type.
Figure 1.3 Pin Configuration (Top View) (1): "ZP" is added.
Figure 1.4 Pin Configuration (Top View) (2) is added. (100P6Q-A)
Table 1.4 Pin Description (2): "ZP" is added to Timer A.
3. Memory
• 5th to 6th lines: The description about the flash memory version (block A) is added.
Figure 3.1 Memory Map:
• Internal ROM (data area) is added.
• NOTES 3, 4 are added and NOTE 5 is revised.
Table 4.1 SFR Information (1)
• The value of After Reset in PM1 register is revised.
• The value of After Reset in CM2 register is revised.
Table 4.7 SFR Information (7)
• The value of After Reset in FMR0 register is revised.
Table 4.15 SFR Information (15)
• The value of After Reset in U0C1 register is revised.
• The value of After Reset in U1C1 register is revised.
• NOTE 1 is added.
Table 4.16 SFR Information (16)
• The value of After Reset in DA0, DA1 registers are revised.
Figure 5.1 Example Reset Circuit: NOTE 1 is added.
Figure 6.2 PM1 Register
• The value of After Reset is revised.
• NOTES 2, 6 are revised.
_____
Figure 6.6 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (3)
• NOTE 2 is added.
_____
Figure 6.7 Memory Map and CS Area in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (4)
• NOTE 1 is added.
1
2
4
5
6
8
12
13
19
27
28
30
34
37
C-1
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
38
39
Table 7.1 Difference between Separate Bus and Multiplexed Bus is added.
Figure 7.1 CSR Register: NOTE 2 is revised.
46
Table 7.8 Software Wait Related Bits and Bus Cycles
• Bus Cycle of SFR (PM20 = 0) is revised from "2 BCLK cycles" to "3 BCLK cycles".
• Bus Cycle of SFR (PM20 = 1) is revised from "3 BCLK cycles" to "2 BCLK cycles".
• From bottom to 5th item in CSR Register: The value is revised from "1" to "0".
• NOTE 5 is added.
49
Table 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit Specifications
• Clock Frequency in PLL Frequency Synthesizer: 16 MHz is added.
50
Figure 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit: Block diagram (upper) is revised.
51
Figure 8.2 CM0 Register
• Bit name of CM02 is revised.
• NOTE 6 (2) and NOTE 8 are revised.
52
Figure 8.3 CM1 Register: NOTE 3 of CM11 bit is deleted.
54
Figure 8.6 CCLKR Register: Location of NOTE 2 is changed and NOTE 3 is added.
55
Figure 8.7 PM2 Register: NOTE 2 is revised.
Figure 8.8 PLC0 Register: Function of 011b and 100b in PLC02 to PLC00 bits are revised
from "Multiply by 6 and Multiply by 8" to "Do not set a value".
58
8.1.4 PLL Clock 11th line: 16 MHz is added to PLL clock frequency.
Table 8.2 Example for Setting PLL Clock Frequencies
• PLL clock = 16 MHz is added. (8✕2, 4✕4)
• 16 MHz is added to NOTE 1.
59
Figure 8.11 Procedure to Use PLL Clock as CPU Clock Source
• 4th frame: “(To select a 16 MHz or higher PLL clock)” is revised to “(When PLL clock
>16 MHz)”.
61
8.4.1.2 PLL Operation Mode: 1st line
62
Table 8.3 Setting Clock Related Bit and Modes
• The main clock multiplied is revised from "by 2, 4, 6 or 8" to "by 2 or 4".
• CM21 bit in Low Power Dissipation Mode: Value is revised from "-" to "0".
• CM11 bit in Low-Speed Mode, Low Power Dissipation Mode, On-chip Oscillator Mode
and On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode: Value is revised from "-" to "0".
63
8.4.2 Wait Mode 4th line: "PLL clock" is deleted.
Table 8.4 Pin Status During Wait Mode
• Memory Expansion Mode, Microprocessor Mode in ALE: Value is revised from
"H" to "L".
64
Table 8.5 Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode
65
8.4.3 Stop Mode
• CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt: "in CAN sleep mode" is added.
• CAN0/1 Wake-up interrupt: "(when CAN sleep mode is selected)" is added.
Table 8.6 Pin Status in Stop Mode
• Memory Expansion Mode, Microprocessor Mode in ALE: Value is revised from
" H" to "indeterminate".
C-2
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
67
Summary
Figure 8.12 State Transition to Stop Mode and Wait Mode
• Figure is revised.
• NOTE 3 is revised.
68
Figure 8.13 State Transition in Normal Operation Mode
• Low-Speed and Low Power Dissipation Mode: "CM7 = 1” is revised to "CM7 = 0" (3 places).
• NOTES 2, 6 are revised.
71
Figure 8.14 Procedure to Switch Clock Source from On-chip Oscillator to Main Clock
is revised.
77
Table 10.2 Relocatable Vector Tables
• Interrupt Source: "Software interrupt" is revised to "INT Instruction Interrupt"
• NOTES 10, 11 are added.
78
Figure 10.3 Interrupt Control Registers (1): NOTES 5, 6, 7 are added.
79
Figure 10.4 Interrupt Control Registers (2)
• NOTE 2 is added to C1RECIC/INT5IC, C1TRMIC/S3IC/INT4IC
• NOTES 6, 7 are added.
87
Figure 10.11 (upper) IFSR0 Register: NOTE 3 is added.
88
10.9 CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt is revised.
Figure 10.13 CAN0/1 Wake-up Interrupt Block
Diagram is revised.
____________
91
Figure 11.1 Watchdog Timer Block Diagram: "RESET" is revised to "Internal RESET signal".
108
Figure 13.6 (upper and middle) ONSF Register, TRGSR Register: NOTE 2 is added.
109
Table 13.1 Specifications in Timer Mode
• Specification of Divide Ratio: "TAiMR register" is revised to "TAi register".
• Specification of Select Function: "When not counting, the pin outputs a low" is
revised to "When TAiS bit is set to "0" (stop counting), the pin outputs a low".
110
Table 13.2 Specifications in Event Counter Mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal)
• Specification in Select Function: "When not counting, the pin outputs a low" is
revised to "When TAiS bit is set to "0" (stop counting), the pin outputs a low".
114
13.1.2.1________
Counter Initialization by Two-Phase Pulse Signal Processing 4th line
• "the INT2 pin" is revised to "the ZP pin".
Figure
13.10 Two-phase Pulse (A phase and B phase) and Z Phase
________
• "INT2 (Z phase)" is revised to "ZP".
118
Figure 13.12 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in PWM Mode
• Bit name and Function in MR0 bit is revised from "Set to "1" in PWM mode" to "Pulse
Output Function Select Bit (3)".
• NOTE 3 is added.
123
Table 13.6 Specifications in Timer Mode
• Specification in Divide Ratio: "TBiMR register" is revised to "TBi register".
129
Figure 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram is revised.
130
Figure 14.2 INVC0 Register is revised.
131
Figure 14.3 INVC1 Register: Function of INV13 bit is revised.
132
Figure 14.4 (upper) IDB0 and IDB1 Registers: (b7-b6) is revised.
Figure 14.4 (lower) DTT Register: NOTE 2 is revised.
C-3
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
134
Figure 14.6 (upper) ICTB2 Register
• (b7-b4) is revised.
• NOTE 3 is added.
135
Figure 14.7 (upper) TRGSR Register: NOTE 2 is added.
136
Figure 14.8 (upper) TA1MR, TA2MR and TA4MR Registers
• Function of MR1 bit: "Has no effect" is revised to "Set to "0" ".
137
Figure 14.9 Triangular Wave Modulation Operation is revised.
139
15.1 UARTi: "UART0, UART1" in Special mode 3 is deleted.
140, 141 Figures 15.1 to 15.3 UART0 to 2 Block Diagram are revised.
142
Figure 15.4 UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit is revised.
144
Figure 15.6 (lower) U0C0 to U2C0 Registers: NOTES 3, 4 are revised.
145
Figure 15.7 (upper) U0C1, U1C1 Registers
• The value of After Reset is revised.
• (b5-b4) is revised from "When read, their contents are "0" " to "When read, their
contents are indeterminate".
• NOTE 1 is added.
Figure 15.7 (lower) U2C1 Register: NOTE 1 is added.
153
15.1.1.1 Counter Measure for Communication Error Occurs is added.
154
15.1.1.4 Continuous
Receive Mode: first to 4th lines are added.
_______ _______
15.1.1.7 CTS/RTS Function is added.
156
157
Table 15.5 UART Mode Specifications: NOTE 3 is added.
159
Table 15.7 I/O Pin Functions
• Method of Selection in TXDi: "Output dummy data" is revised to "Output "H" ".
161
15.1.2.1 Bit Rates and Table 15.9 Example of Bit Rates and Settings are added.
162
15.1.2.2 Counter
Measure for Communication Error Occurs is added.
_______ _______
15.1.2.6 CTS/RTS Function is added.
164
176
Table 15.15 Registers to Be Used and Settings in Special Mode 2
• "U2LCH" in UiC1 register is revised to "UiLCH".
179
Table 15.16 Registers to Be Used and Settings in IE Mode
• "UiRRM" in UiC1 register is revised to "U2RRM".
181
Table 15.17 SIM Mode Specifications: NOTE 3 is added.
189
Figure 15.39 Polarity of Transfer Clock is revised.
205
16.2.4 External Operation Amplifier (Op-Amp) Connection Mode: 6th line
• "Note that the ANEX0 and ANEX1 pins cannot be directly connected to each other."
is deleted.
206
16.2.6 Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion is added.
209
Figure 17.2 (lower) DA0 and DA1 Registers: The value of After Reset are revised.
216
Figure 19.4 Bit Mapping of Mask Registers in Byte Access: NOTES 1, 2 are added.
Figure 19.5 Bit Mapping of Mask Registers in Word Access: NOTES 1, 2 are added.
217
Figure 19.6 C0MCTLj and C1MCTLj Registers: NOTE 2 is revised.
218
Figure 19.7 C0CTLR and C1CTLR Registers (upper)
• NOTE 1 (Rev.1.00) is deleted and NOTES 1, 2, 3 are added.
Figure 19.7 C0CTLR and C1CTLR Registers (lower): NOTES 3, 4 are added.
C-4
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
219
223
Figure 19.8 C0STR and C1STR Registers (upper): NOTE 2 is added.
19.5 Operational Modes
• 1st line: "three operational modes" is revised to "four operational modes".
• 5th line: "CAN Interface Sleep Mode" is added.
Figure 19.12 Transition Between Operational Modes is revised.
19.5.1 CAN Reset/Initialization Mode is revised.
19.5.2 CAN Operation Mode is revised.
19.5.3 CAN Sleep Mode is revised.
19.5.4 CAN Interface Sleep Mode is added.
19.5.5 Bus Off State is revised.
19.12 Return from Bus Off Function is revised.
19.14 Listen-Only Mode
• last line: "When listen-only mode is selected, do not request the transmission." is added.
Figure 19.20 Timing of Receive Data Frame Sequence: Waveform of RecState bit is revised.
19.15.1 Reception: (4) (5) are revised.
Figure 19.21 Timing of Transmit Sequence
• The position of the number corresponding to the text is revised.
19.15.2 Transmission: (1) to (4) are revised.
21.2.1 ROM Code Protect Function is revised.
21.2.2 ID Code Check Function is revised.
Figure 21.2 ROMCP Register is revised.
Figure 21.4 (upper) FMR0 Register: The value of After Reset is revised.
21.3.3.1 FMR00 Bit is revised.
21.3.3.8 FMR11 Bit is revised.
21.3.3.9 FMR16 Bit is revised.
Figure 21.5 Setting and Resetting of EW0 Mode is revised.
Figure 21.6 Setting and Resetting of EW1 Mode: NOTE 3 is revised.
Figure 21.7 Processing Before and After Low Power Dissipation Mode: NOTE 4 is added.
21.3.4.12 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation
Mode is revised.
Table 21.4 Software Commands: NOTE 2 is deleted.
21.3.5.4 Program Command (40h)
• From bottom to 3rd line: "read command" is revised to "read array command".
Figure 21.11 Read Lock Bit Status Command
• "Locked", "Not locked" are revised to "Block is locked", "Block is not locked".
21.3.7.1 Sequencer Status (SR7 and FMR00 Bits) is revised.
Table 21.7 Pin Functions for Standard Serial I/O Mode
• "VCC" is revised to "VCC1", and "VCC2" is added.
• VCC1, VCC2, VSS: VCC apply condition is added.
Figure 21.14 Pin Connections for Standard Serial I/O Mode (2) is____________
added.
Figure 21.16 Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2: "RESET" is added.
Table 21.8 Pin Functions for CAN I/O Mode
• "VCC" is revised to "VCC1", and "VCC2" is added.
• VCC1, VCC2, VSS: VCC apply condition is added.
224
225
231
233
234
251
252
255
256
257
258
260
261
262
265
266
271
273
274
276
C-5
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
278
280
Summary
Figure 21.18 Pin Connections for CAN I/O Mode (2) is added.
Table 21.9 Flash Memory Version Electrical Characteristics
• Parameter is added and the value of some item is revised.
281
Table 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
283
Table 22.3 Recommended Operating Conditions (2)
• "Flash Program Erase" in Operating Ambient Temperature is added.
• Parameters of Power Supply Ripple are added.
• NOTE 4 is revised.
Figure 22.1 Timing of Voltage Fluctuation is added.
284
Table 22.4 Electrical Characteristics (1): Hysteresis
• "CLK4" is revised to ____________
"CLK3", and "TA2OUT" is revised to "TA0OUT".
• Max. of Standard in RESET is revised from "2.2" to "2.5".
• XIN is added.
286
Table 22.6 A/D Conversion Characteristics: "Tolerance Level Impedance" is added.
287
Table 22.8 Power Supply Circuit Timing Characteristics: "td(M-L)" is deleted.
Figure 22.2 Power Supply Circuit Timing Diagram is added.
288
Table 22.10 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode: "td(BCLK-HLDA)" is deleted.
290
Table 22.21 Serial I/O: Min. of standard in tsu(D-C) is revised from "30" to "70".
291
Table 22.23 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for setting with no wait)
• Max. of Standard in td(BCLK-ALE) is revised from "25" to "15".
• td(BCLK-HLDA) is added.
292
Table 22.24 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for 1- to 3-wait setting
and external area access)
• Max. of Standard in td(BCLK-ALE) is revised from "25" to "15".
• td(BCLK-HLDA) is added.
293
Table 22.25 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (for 2- to 3-wait setting,
external area access and multiplexed bus selection)
• td(BCLK-HLDA) is added.
• Max. of Standard in td(BCLK-ALE) is revised from "25" to "15".
294
Figure 22.4 Timing Diagram (1): "XIN input" is added.
296, 297 Figures 22.6 and 22.7 Timing Diagram (3) (4): "DB" in Read timing is revised to "DBi".
298, 299 Figures 22.8 and 22.9 Timing Diagram (5) (6): "DB" in Write timing is revised to "DBi".
301
Figure 22.11 Timing Diagram (8)
• "ADi/DB" in Read/Write timing is revised to "ADi/DBi".
302
23.1 External Bus: The description of the external ROM version is deleted.
303
23.2 PLL Frequency Synthesizer is revised.
304
23.3 Power Control
• 2nd item is added. (Set the MR0 bit in the TAiMR register to •••)
• 4th item is revised. (Wait for main clock oscillation •••)
• Section of "External clock" is deleted.
316
23.8.2.1 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) is added.
317
23.8.3 SI/O3 is added.
C-6
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.00 Nov. 10, 2004
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
319
322
23.9 A/D Converter: last item is added. (When setting the ADST bit to •••)
23.10.2 Performing CAN Configuration is added.
323
23.10.3 Suggestions to Reduce Power Consumption is added.
327
23.13 Mask ROM Version is added.
328
23.14.4 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation
Mode is revised.
2.10 Jun. 24, 2005
330
23.15 Flash Memory Programming Using Boot Program is added.
331
23.16 Noise is added.
332
Appendix 1. Package Dimensions: 100P6Q-A is added.
–
Revised edition issued
* The contents of product are revised. (Normal-ver. is added.)
* Revised parts and revised contents are as follows (except for expressional change).
2
Table 1.1 Performance outline of M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
4
Table 1.2 Product List is revised. (Normal-ver. is added.)
• Performance outline of Normal-ver. is added.
Figure 1.2 Type No., Memory Size, and Package:
• "(no): Normal-ver." is added to Characteristics.
19
Figure 4.7 SFR Information (7): NOTE 1 is revised.
53
Figure 8.4 CM2 Register: The value of After Reset is revised.
68
Figure 8.13 State Transition in Normal Operation Mode: NOTE 7 is revised.
217
Figure 19.6 C0MCTLj and C1MCTLj Registers
• RemActive bit: Function is revised.
• RspLock bit: Bit Name is revised.
• NOTE 2 is revised.
218
Figure 19.7 C0CTLR and C1CTLR Registers (upper)
• LoopBack bit: The expression of Function is revised.
• BasicCAN bit: The expression of Function is revised.
Figure 19.7 C0CTLR and C1CTLR Registers (lower)
• TSPreScale bit: Bit Symbol is revised. (“Bit1, Bit0” is deleted.)
• TSReset bit: The expression of Function is revised.
• RetBusOff bit: The expression of Function is revised.
• RXOnly bit: The expression of Function is revised.
219
Figure 19.8 C0STR and C1STR Registers (upper): NOTE 1 is deleted.
Figure 19.8 C0STR and C1STR Registers (lower)
• State_LoopBack bit: The expression of Function is revised.
• State_BasicCAN bit: The expression of Function is revised.
222
Figure 19.11 C0RECR, C1RECR Registers, C0TECR, C1TECR Registers, C0TSR,
C1TSR Registers, and C0AFS, C1AFS Registers
• C0RECR, C1RECR Registers: NOTE 2 is deleted.
• C0TECR, C1TECR Registers: NOTE 1 is deleted.
• C0TSR, C1TSR Registers: NOTE 1 is deleted.
233
19.15.1 Reception (1): “(refer to 19.15.2 Transmission)” is deleted.
C-7
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.10 Jun. 24, 2005
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
238
240
Figure 20.1 I/O Ports (1): “P7_0” in 4th figure is deleted.
Figure 20.3 I/O Ports (3): “P7_0” is added to middle figure.
242
Figure 20.6 I/O Pins: NOTE 1 is deleted.
284
Table 22.4 Electrical Characteristics (1)
285
Table 22.5 Electrical Characteristics (2): Mask ROM (5th item)
286
Table 22.6 A/D Conversion Characteristics: “Tolerance Level Impedance” is deleted.
• Measuring Condition of VOL is revised from “LOL = –200µA” to “LOL = 200µA”.
• “f(XCIN)” is changed to “(f(BCLK)).
2.30 Oct. 24, 2005
–
Revised edition issued
* Electric Characteristics of Normal-ver. is added.
* Revised parts and revised contents are as follows (except for expressional change).
1
1.1 Applications: Comment of Normal-ver. is added.
4
Table 1.2 Product List: NOTE 1 is added.
7, 8
Tables 1.3 and 1.4 Pin Characteristics (1)(2) are added.
9
Table 1.5 Pin Description (1)
31 to 33
5. Reset: Layout is changed.
33
5.5 Internal Space is added.
44
7.2.6 RDY Signal: Last sentence is revised.
51
Table 8.1 Clock Generating Circuit Specifications
• 3.0 to 3.6 V (Normal-ver.) is added to Description of Power supply input.
• Clock Frequency in PLL Frequency Synthesizer: 24 MHz
(1)
is added.
• NOTE 1 is added.
57
Figure 8.8 PLC0 Register
• PLC02 to PLC00 bits: Function of 011b is revised.
• NOTE 4 is added.
58
Figure 8.9 Examples of Main Clock Connection Circuit is revised.
59
Figure 8.10 Examples of Sub Clock Connection Circuit is revised.
60
8.1.4 PLL Clock
• 9th line: The sentence (When the PLL ... to) is added.
• 12th line: 24 MHz and NOTE 1 is added to PLL clock frequency.
• NOTE 1 is added.
Figure 8.2 Example for Setting PLL Clock Frequencies
• 24 MHz is added to PLL clock.
• 24 MHz is added to NOTE 1.
• NOTES 2 and 3 are added.
63
8.4.1.2 PLL Operation Mode
• 1st line: The main clock multiplied by “6” and NOTE 1 is added.
64
8.4.1.6 On-chip Oscillator Mode: Last sentence (When the operation mode is ...) is added.
8.4.1.7 On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation Mode: Last sentence (When the
operation mode is ...) is deleted.
67
Table 8.6 Interrrupts to Stop Mode and Use Conditions is added.
70
Figure 8.13 State Transition in Normal Operation Mode: NOTE 7 is deleted.
C-8
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.30 Oct. 24, 2005
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
86
10.5.8 Returning from an Interrupt Routine: Last sentence (Register bank ...) is added.
10.5.9 Interrupt Priority: First sentence (If two or more...) is revised.
10.5.10 Interrupt Priority Resolution Circuit: First sentence (The interrupt priority level ...)
is revised.
89
Figure 10.11 IFSR1 Register (upper)
• IFSR17: NOTE 2 is added to Bit Name.
• NOTE 2 is revised.
96
Table 12.1 DMAC Specifications: DMA transfer Cycles is added.
100
12.1.3 Effect of Software Wait: 3rd to 9th lines is moved from next section of 12.1.4.
120
Figure 13.12 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in PWM Mode: b2 is revised from “1” to “(blank)”.
131
Figure 14.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram is revised.
132
Figure 14.2 INVC0 Register: NOTES 5 and 6 are revised.
145
Figure 15.5 U0BRG to U2BRG Registers (lower): NOTE 3 is added.
146
Figure 15.6 U0C0 to U2C0 Registers (lower): NOTE 5 is added.
163
Table 15.9 Example of Bit Rates and Settings: 24 MHz and NOTE 1 is added.
189
Figure 15.37 S3C Register (upper): NOTE 5 is added.
193
Table 16.1 A/D Converter Performance
194
Figure 16.1 A/D Converter Block Diagram
Figure 15.37 S3BRG Register (middle): NOTE 3 is added.
• Performance of Integral Nonlinearity Error: “When AVCC = VREF = 3.3 V” is added.
• ADGSEL1 to ADGSEL0 (righit/lower) is revised from “10b” to “11b”.
208
16.2.6 Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion
• 10th line: f(XIN) is revised to f(φAD).
209
Figure 16.10 Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit
• fAD is revised to φAD.
210
Figure 17.1 D/A Convertoer Block Diagram is revised.
211
Figure 17.2 DA0 and DA1 Registers: Setting Range is added.
Figure 17.3 D/A Converter Equivalent Circuit: NOTE 2 is added.
213
Figure 18.3 CRC Calculation: Details of CRC operation is revised.
224
Figure 19.11 C0TECR, C1TECR Registers (2nd register): NOTE 1 is added.
229
Table 19.2 Examples of Bit-rate: 24 MHz and NOTE 2 is added.
247
Figure 20.9 PUR1 Register (middle): Value of After Reset is revised.
252
Figure 21.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram is revised.
254
Figure 21.2 ROMCP Register is revised.
255
Table 21.3 EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode: NOTE 1 is revised.
256
21.3.2 EW1 Mode: Last sentence (When an erase/program ...) is added.
258
21.3.3.4 FMSTP Bit
261
Figure 21.7 Processing Before and After Low Power Dissipation Mode or On-chipOscillator
• 8th line: Procedure to change the FMSTP bit setting (1) to (4) are added.
Low Power Dissipation Mode
• Title, First and second frames (left) and top of right: “on-chip oscillator low power
dissipation mode” is addded.
C-9
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
Date
2.30 Oct. 24, 2005
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Description
Page
Summary
263
21.3.4.11 Stop Mode is revised.
21.3.4.12 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation
266
21.3.5.5 Block Erase Command: Last sentence (Also execute ...) is added.
272
Figure 21.12 Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Each Error
Mode is partly revised.
Figure 21.9 Block Erase Command: NOTES 2 and 3 are added.
• Erase error: (4) is added.
274
Table 21.7 Pin Functions for Standard Serial I/O Mode
• Description of VCC1, VCC2, VSS is revised.
• Description of P8_4 is revised.
• NOTE 1 is revised.
• NOTE 2 is added.
277
Figures 21.15 and 21.16 Circuit Application in Serial I/O Mode 1/2
• “VCC1” and “VCC2” are added.
279
Table 21.8 Pin Functions for CAN I/O Mode
• Description of VCC1, VCC2, VSS is revised.
• Description of P8_4 is revised.
• NOTE 1 is added.
282
Figure 21.19 Circuit Application in CAN I/O Mode: “VCC1” and “VCC2” are added.
283
Table 21.9 Flash Memory Version Electrical Characteristics
• Measuring condition is revised in word program time and block erase time.
284
21.7.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.) is added.
306 to 341 22.2 Electrical Characteristics (Normal-ver.) is added.
344
23.3 Power Control: 3rd and 4th items (When entering wait mode ... and When entering
stop mode ...) are revised.
359
Figure 23.2 Use of Capacitors to Reduce Noise is partly revised.
360
23.9 A/D Converter: Last item (The applied intermediate ...) is added.
366
23.11 Programmable I/O Ports: 4th and 5th items (Indeterminate values ... and When the
369
23.14.2 Stop Mode is revised.
PM01 ...) are added.
23.14.4 Low Power Dissipation Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low Power Dissipation
Mode is partly revised.
23.14.8 Operation Speed is revised.
C-10
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4) Hardware Manual
Publication Data :
Rev.1.00 May 30, 2003
Rev.2.30 Oct 24, 2005
Published by : Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Renesas Technology Corp.
© 2005. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan.
M16C/6N Group (M16C/6N4)
Hardware Manual
2-6-2, Ote-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0004, Japan